Table of Contents

 

 

UNITED STATES

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D.C. 20549

FORM 20-F

 

REGISTRATION STATEMENT PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(b) OR (g) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

OR

 

ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

For the Fiscal Year Ended December 31, 2016

OR

 

TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

OR

 

SHELL COMPANY REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

Commission file number 000-12033

TELEFONAKTIEBOLAGET LM ERICSSON

(Exact Name of Registrant as Specified in its Charter)

LM ERICSSON TELEPHONE COMPANY

(Translation of Registrant’s name into English)

Kingdom of Sweden

(Jurisdiction of incorporation or organization)

SE-164 83 Stockholm, Sweden

(Address of principal executive offices)

Roland Hagman, Vice President Group Function Financial Control

Telephone: +46 10 719 53 80, Fax: +46 8 744 42 82

SE-164 83 Stockholm, Sweden

(Name, Telephone, E-mail and/or Facsimile number and Address of Company Contact Person)

Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:

 

Title of Each Class

 

Name of Each Exchange on which Registered

American Depositary Shares (each representing one B share)   The NASDAQ Stock Market LLC
B Shares *   The NASDAQ Stock Market LLC

 

* Not for trading, but only in connection with the registration of the American Depositary Shares representing such B Shares pursuant to the requirements of the Securities and Exchange Commission.

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act:

None

Securities for which there is a reporting obligation pursuant to Section 15(d) of the Act:

None

Indicate the number of outstanding shares of each of the issuer’s classes of capital or common stock as of the close of the period covered by the annual report:

 

B shares (SEK 5.00 nominal value)

     3,069,395,752  

A shares (SEK 5.00 nominal value)

     261,755,983  

C shares (SEK 1.00 nominal value)

     49,367,641  

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.    Yes  ☒    No  ☐

If this report is an annual or transition report, indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.    Yes  ☐    No  ☒

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.    Yes  ☒    No  ☐

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§ 232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files)    Yes  ☐    No  ☐

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer or an emerging growth company . See the definitions of “large accelerated filer” and “accelerated filer” and “emerging growth company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.

 

Large accelerated filer      Accelerated filer  
Non-accelerated filer      Emerging growth company  

If an emerging growth company that prepares its financial statements in accordance with U.S. GAAP, indicate by check mark if the registrant has elected not to use the extended transition period for complying with any new or revised financial accounting standards provided pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Exchange Act.  ☐

 

The term “new or revised financial accounting standard” refers to any update issued by the Financial Accounting Standards Board to its Accounting Standards Codification after April 5, 2012.

Indicate by check mark which basis of accounting the registrant has used to prepare the financial statements included in this filing:

 

☐  U.S. GAAP

 

                ☒     

  International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board    ☐  Other

If “Other” has been checked in response to the previous question, indicate by check mark which financial statement item the registrant has elected to follow.

Item 17  ☐    Item 18  ☐

If this is an annual report, indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act).    Yes  ☐    No  ☒

 

 

 


Table of Contents

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

                 Page  

PART I INTRODUCTION

     1  

ITEM 1.

  

IDENTITY OF DIRECTORS, SENIOR MANAGEMENT AND ADVISERS

     2  

ITEM 2.

  

OFFER STATISTICS AND EXPECTED TIMETABLE

     2  

ITEM 3.

  

KEY INFORMATION

     2  
  

A.

    

Selected Financial Data

     2  
  

B.

    

Capitalization and Indebtedness

     4  
  

C.

    

Reasons for the Offer and Use of Proceeds

     4  
  

D.

    

Risk Factors

     4  

ITEM 4.

  

INFORMATION ON THE COMPANY

     4  
  

A.

    

History and Development of the Company

     4  
  

B.

    

Business Overview

     5  
  

C.

    

Organizational Structure

     7  
  

D.

    

Property, Plant and Equipment

     9  

ITEM 4A.

  

UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS

     10  

ITEM 5.

  

OPERATING AND FINANCIAL REVIEW AND PROSPECTS

     10  
  

A.

    

Operating Results

     10  
  

B.

    

Liquidity and Capital Resources

     15  
  

C.

    

Research and Development, Patents and Licenses

     17  
  

D.

    

Trend Information

     18  
  

E.

    

Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements

     18  
  

F.

    

Tabular Disclosure of Contractual Obligations

     18  

ITEM 6.

  

DIRECTORS, SENIOR MANAGEMENT AND EMPLOYEES

     18  
  

A.

    

Directors and Senior Management

     18  
  

B.

    

Compensation

     19  
  

C.

    

Board Practices

     19  
  

D.

    

Employees

     20  
  

E.

    

Share Ownership

     21  

ITEM 7.

  

MAJOR SHAREHOLDERS AND RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS

     21  
  

A.

    

Major Shareholders

     21  
  

B.

    

Related Party Transactions

     21  
  

C.

    

Interests of Experts and Counsel

     22  

ITEM 8.

  

FINANCIAL INFORMATION

     22  
  

A.

    

Consolidated Statements and Other Financial Information

     22  
  

B.

    

Significant Changes

     22  

 

i


Table of Contents
                 Page  

ITEM 9.

  

THE OFFER AND LISTING

     26  
  

A.

    

Offer and Listing Details

     26  
  

B.

    

Plan of Distribution

     26  
  

C.

    

Markets

     26  
  

D.

    

Selling Shareholders

     26  
  

E.

    

Dilution

     26  
  

F.

    

Expenses of the Issue

     26  

ITEM 10.

  

ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

     26  
  

A.

    

Share Capital

     26  
  

B.

    

Memorandum and Articles of Association

     26  
  

C.

    

Material Contracts

     30  
  

D.

    

Exchange Controls

     30  
  

E.

    

Taxation

     30  
  

F.

    

Dividends and Paying Agents

     34  
  

G.

    

Statement by Experts

     34  
  

H.

    

Documents on Display

     34  
  

I.

    

Subsidiary Information

     34  

ITEM 11.

  

QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK

     34  

ITEM 12.

  

DESCRIPTION OF SECURITIES OTHER THAN EQUITY SECURITIES

     35  
  

A.

    

Debt Securities

     35  
  

B.

    

Warrants and Rights

     35  
  

C.

    

Other Securities

     35  
  

D.

    

American Depositary Shares

     35  

PART II

          36  

ITEM 13.

  

DEFAULTS, DIVIDEND ARREARAGES AND DELINQUENCIES

     36  

ITEM 14.

  

MATERIAL MODIFICATIONS TO THE RIGHTS OF SECURITY HOLDERS AND USE OF PROCEEDS

     36  

ITEM 15.

  

CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES

     36  
  

A.

    

Disclosure Controls and Procedures

     36  
  

B.

    

Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

     36  
  

C.

    

Attestation Report of the Registered Public Accounting Firm

     37  
  

D.

    

Changes in Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

     37  

ITEM 16.

  

[RESERVED]

     37  

ITEM 16A.

  

AUDIT COMMITTEE FINANCIAL EXPERT

     37  

ITEM 16B.

  

CODE OF ETHICS

     37  

ITEM 16C.

  

PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTANT FEES AND SERVICES

     38  

ITEM 16D.

  

EXEMPTIONS FROM THE LISTING STANDARDS FOR AUDIT COMMITTEES

     38  

 

ii


Table of Contents
                 Page  

ITEM 16E.

  

PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES BY THE ISSUER AND AFFILIATED PURCHASERS

     38  

ITEM 16F.

  

CHANGE IN REGISTRANT’S CERTIFYING ACCOUNTANT

     38  

ITEM 16G.

  

CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

     39  

ITEM 16H.

  

MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURE

     40  

PART III

          40  

ITEM 17.

  

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

     40  

ITEM 18.

  

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

     40  

ITEM 19.

  

EXHIBITS

     42  

 

iii


Table of Contents

PART I

INTRODUCTION

Unless otherwise indicated, all references herein to “Ericsson,” the “Company,” “the Group,” “we,” “us,” or “our” or “our company” are references to Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson and its consolidated subsidiaries.

This document is our Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended December 31, 2016 (the “2016 Form 20-F”). Reference is made to the English version of our Swedish Annual Report for 2016, with certain adjustments made to comply with U.S. requirements, which is attached hereto as Exhibit 15.1 (the “2016 Swedish Annual Report”). Only (i) the information included in this 2016 Form 20-F, (ii) the information in the 2016 Swedish Annual Report that is incorporated by reference in this 2016 Form 20-F, and (iii) the exhibits to the 2016 Form 20-F that are required to be filed pursuant to the Form 20-F shall be deemed to be filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission for any purpose, including incorporation by reference into the Registration Statement on Form F-3 filed on May 8, 2015 (File No. 333-203977) and any other document filed by us pursuant to the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, which incorporates by reference the 2016 Form 20-F. Any information in the 2016 Swedish Annual Report that is not referenced in the 2016 Form 20-F or filed as an exhibit thereto shall not be deemed to be so incorporated by reference.

Certain industry, technical and financial terms used in this 2016 Form 20-F are defined in the subsections entitled “Glossary” and “Financial Terminology” of the 2016 Swedish Annual Report, which are incorporate herein by reference.

Market data and certain industry forecasts used herein were obtained from internal surveys, market research, publicly available information and industry publications. While we believe that market research, publicly available information and industry publications we use are reliable, we have not independently verified market and industry data from third-party sources. Moreover, while we believe our internal surveys are reliable, they have not been verified by any independent source.

The information included on www.ericsson.com and other websites that appear in this 2016 Form 20-F is not incorporated by reference herein. From time to time, we may use our website as a channel of distribution of material company information. Financial and other material information regarding our company is routinely posted on and accessible at www.ericsson.com .

Forward-Looking Statements

This 2016 Form 20-F includes forward-looking statements, including statements reflecting management’s current views relating to the growth of the market, future market conditions, future events and expected operational and financial performance. The words “believe,” “expect,” “foresee,” “anticipate,” “assume,” “intend,” “may,” “could,” “plan,” “estimate,” “forecast,” “will,” “should,” “predict,” “aim,” “ambition,” “target,” “might,” or, in each case, their negative, and similar words are intended to help identify forward-looking statements.

Forward-looking statements may be found throughout this document, and include statements regarding:

 

    Our goals, strategies and operational or financial performance expectations

 

    Development of corporate governance standards, stock market regulations and related legislation

 

    The future characteristics of the markets in which we operate

 

    Projections and other characterizations of future events

 

    Our liquidity, capital resources, capital expenditures, our credit ratings and the development in the capital markets, affecting our industry or us

 

    The expected demand for our existing as well as new products and services

 

    The expected operational or financial performance of joint ventures and other strategic cooperation activities

 

    The time until acquired entities will be accretive to income

 

1


Table of Contents
    Technology and industry trends including regulatory and standardization environment, competition and our customer structure

 

    Our plans for new products and services including research and development expenditures.

Although we believe that the expectations reflected in these and other forward-looking statements are reasonable, we cannot assure you that these expectations will materialize. Because forward-looking statements are based on assumptions, judgments and estimates, and are subject to risks and uncertainties, actual results could differ materially from those described or implied herein

Important factors that could affect whether and to what extent any of our forward-looking statements materialize include, but are not limited to the factors described under “Item 3.D. Risk Factors” in this 2016 Form 20-F.

We undertake no obligation to publicly update or revise any forward-looking statements included in this 2016 Form 20-F, whether as a result of new information, future events or otherwise, except as required by applicable law or stock exchange regulation.

 

ITEM 1. IDENTITY OF DIRECTORS, SENIOR MANAGEMENT AND ADVISERS

Not applicable.

 

ITEM 2. OFFER STATISTICS AND EXPECTED TIMETABLE

Not applicable.

 

ITEM 3. KEY INFORMATION

 

A. Selected Financial Data

We present below certain selected financial data derived from our consolidated financial statements as of and for the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015, 2014, 2013 and 2012, included herein, prepared in accordance with the International Financial Reporting Standards (“IFRS”) as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (“IASB”). IFRS differs in certain significant respects from the accounting principles generally accepted in the United States, or “U.S. GAAP.”

The summary financial data should be read in conjunction with our consolidated financial statements and the notes thereto contained in this 2016 Form 20-F, as well as the information set forth under the heading “Item 5. Operating and Financial Review and Prospects” and the information set forth under the following headings of the 2016 Swedish Annual Report, which are incorporated herein by reference:

 

    Other Information

 

    Alternative Performance Measures (APMs)

 

    Financial Terminology and Exchange rates

 

2


Table of Contents
     2016     Change     2015     2014     2013     2012  

Income statement and cash flow items, SEK million

            

Net sales

     222,608       –10     246,920       227,983       227,376       227,779  

Operating expenses

     –60,501       –6     –64,129       –63,408       –58,509       –58,856  

Operating income

     6,299       –71     21,805       16,807       17,845       10,458  

Net income

     1,895       –86     13,673       11,143       12,174       5,938  

Restructuring charges

     7,567       50     5,040       1,456       4,453       3,447  

Cash flow from operating activities

     14,010       –32     20,597       18,702       17,389       22,031  

Year-end position, SEK million

            

Total assets

     283,347       0     284,363       293,558       269,190       274,996  

Property, plant and equipment

     16,734       5     15,901       13,341       11,433       11,493  

Stockholders’ equity

     139,817       –5     146,525       144,306       140,204       136,883  

Non-controlling interest

     675       –20     841       1,003       1,419       1,600  

Per share indicators

            

Earnings per share, basic, SEK

     0.53       –87     4.17       3.57       3.72       1.80  

Earnings per share, diluted, SEK

     0.52       –87     4.13       3.54       3.69       1.78  

Dividends per share, SEK

     1.00       –73     3.70       3.40       3.00       2.75  

Dividend per share (USD)

     0.11       –71     0.39       0.41       0.46       0.42  

Number of shares outstanding (in millions)

            

end of period, basic

     3,269       —         3,256       3,242       3,231       3,220  

average, basic

     3,263       —         3,249       3,237       3,226       3,216  

average, diluted

     3,303       1     3,282       3,270       3,257       3,247  

Capital stock, SEK million

     16,657         16,526       16,526       16,526       16,526  

Other information, SEK million

            

Additions to property, plant and equipment

     6,129       –26     8,338       5,322       4,503       5,429  

Depreciations and write-downs/impairments of property, plant and equipment

     4,569       –3     4,689       4,316       4,209       4,012  

Acquisitions/capitalization of intangible assets

     5,260       1     5,228       6,184       4,759       13,247  

Amortization and write-downs/impairments of intangible assets

     4,550       –18     5,538       5,629       5,928       5,877  

Research and development expenses

     31,635       –9     34,844       36,308       32,236       32,833  

as percentage of net sales

     14.2     —         14.1     15.9     14.2     14.4

Inventory turnover days

     69       8     64       64       62       73  
Alternative Performance Measures (APMs) 1)             

Gross margin

     29.8     —         34.8     36.2     33.6     31.6

Operating margin

     2.8     —         8.8     7.4     7.8     4.6

EBITA margin

     4.0     —         10.5     9.3     9.8     6.6

Cash conversion

     175.0     —         85     84     79     116

Capital employed, SEK million

     190,901       –2     195,150       189,839       180,903       176,653  

Return on equity

     1.2     —         9.3     8.1     8.7     4.1

Return on capital employed

     3.2     —         11.6     9.8     10.7     6.7

Equity ratio

     49.6     —         51.8     49.5     52.6     50.4

Capital turnover

     1.2       —         1.3       1.2       1.3       1.3  

Working capital, SEK million

     89,039       –15     104,811       103,246       106,940       100,619  

Gross cash, SEK million

     57,877       –13     66,270       72,159       77,089       76,708  

Net cash, SEK million 2)

     31,191       –24     41,150       48,014       47,634       48,041  
Statistical data, year-end             

Number of employees

     111,464       –4     116,281       118,055       114,340       110,255  

of which in Sweden

     15,303       –10     17,041       17,580       17,858       17,712  

Export sales from Sweden, SEK million

     107,036       –9     117,486       113,734       108,944       106,997  

 

1) A reconciliation to the most directly reconcilable line items in the financial statements for 2016 and five comparison years is available under the heading “Alternative Performance Measures” of the 2016 Swedish Annual Report. Reconciliation of ten years is available in a separate document available on www.ericsson.com/thecompany/investors/financial-reports.
2) The definition of Net cash has been adjusted in 2016 (Post-employment benefits are no longer included and Interest-bearing securities, non-current are included). Net cash for prior periods has been recalculated using the new definition.

Exchange Rates

The following tables provide information with respect to the exchange rate for SEK per USD 1.00 based on the noon buying rate for cable transfers in SEK as certified for customs purposes by the Federal Reserve Bank of New York. The noon buying rate of 7 April was SEK 9.0503 per USD 1.00. The average exchange rate is computed using the noon buying rate on the last business day of each month during the period indicated.

 

Year ended December 31,

   Average  

2012

     6.7247  

2013

     6.5152  

2014

     6.9222  

2015

     8.4643  

2016

     8.5959  

 

Month

   High      Low  

October 2016

     9.0646        8.5641  

November 2016

     9.2686        8.8938  

December 2016

     9.4207        9.0784  

January 2017

     9.1583        8.8254  

February 2017

     9.0134        8.7176  

March 2017

     9.0664        8.7701  

 

3


Table of Contents

Effects of exchange rate fluctuations on our business is described in the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements—Note C20, “Financial Risk Management and Financial Instruments.”

Noon buying rates are not used in the preparation of our financial statements. The exchange rates used in the preparation of our consolidated financial statements are presented below:

 

     2016      2015  

SEK/EUR

     

Average rate

     9.44        9.34  

Closing rate

     9.56        9.17  

SEK/USD

     

Average rate

     8.56        8.39  

Closing rate

     9.06        8.40  

 

B. Capitalization and Indebtedness

Not applicable.

 

C. Reasons for the Offer and Use of Proceeds

Not applicable.

 

D. Risk Factors

The information set forth under the heading “Financials–Risk Factors” of the 2016 Swedish Annual Report is incorporated herein by reference.

 

ITEM 4. INFORMATION ON THE COMPANY

 

A. History and Development of the Company

The information set forth under the following headings of the 2016 Swedish Annual Report is incorporated herein by reference:

 

    The Business

 

    Ericsson in Brief

 

    Change in Reporting Structure from 2017

 

    Financials – Board of Directors’ Report

 

    Business in 2016

 

    Financial Highlights – Capital expenditures

For capital expenditures we usually use available cash from operations

 

    Notes to the Consolidated financial statements

 

    Note C26 – Business combinations

 

    Note C32 – Events after the reporting period

 

4


Table of Contents

General facts on the company

Legal and commercial name of the Parent Company: Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson (publ).

Organization number: 556016-0680

Legal form of the Parent Company: A Swedish limited liability company, organized under the Swedish Companies Act.

Country of incorporation: Sweden.

Date of incorporation: The Parent Company was incorporated on August 18, 1918, as a result of a merger between AB LM Ericsson & Co. and Stockholms Allmänna Telefon AB.

Domicile: Our registered office is Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson, SE–164 83 Stockholm, Sweden. Our headquarters are located at Torshamnsgatan 21, Kista, Sweden.

Telephone number: +46 10 719 0000

Website: www.ericsson.com . The information included on our website is not incorporated herein by reference.

Agent in the US: Ericsson Inc., Vice President Legal Affairs, 6300 Legacy Drive, Plano, Texas 75024. Telephone number: +1 972 583 0000.

Shares: Ericsson’s Class A and Class B shares are traded on Nasdaq Stockholm. In the US, our American Depository Shares (ADS), each representing one underlying Class B share, are traded on NASDAQ New York.

Parent company operations: The business of the parent company, Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson, consists mainly of corporate management, holding company functions and internal banking activities. Our parent company operations also include customer credit management activities performed by Ericsson Credit AB on a commission basis.

Subsidiaries and associated companies: For a list of our significant subsidiaries, please see “Item 4C. Investments”. In addition to our joint venture ST-Ericsson (up until August 2, 2013), we are engaged in a number of minor joint ventures and cooperative arrangements. For more information regarding risks associated with joint ventures, strategic alliances and third-party agreements, please see “Item 3D. Financials–Risk Factors - Market, Technology and Business Risks”.

Company history and development

Innovating to empower people, business and society

Our origins date back to 1876 when Alexander Graham Bell filed a patent application in the United States for the telephone. The same year, Lars Magnus Ericsson opened a small workshop in Stockholm to repair telegraph instruments and sell his own telephone equipment.

Today, Ericsson is a leading provider of communications equipment, telecom services and support solutions. Our customers, in over 180 countries, are mainly operators of communications networks worldwide. We manage networks, or parts of networks, for one billion subscribers.

 

B. Business Overview

The information set forth under the following headings of the 2016 Swedish Annual Report is incorporated herein by reference:

 

    Ericsson in brief

 

5


Table of Contents
    The business

 

    This is Ericsson

 

    This is the market

 

    The customers

 

    Networks

 

    IT & Cloud

 

    Media

 

    Global presence 24/7

 

    Customer group Industry and Society

 

    Customer Group – IPR & Licensing

 

    Reporting Structure 2016

 

    Change in Reporting Structure from 2017

 

    Financials

 

    Board of Directors’ report

 

    Financial highlights – Research and development, patents and licensing

 

    Financial highlights – Seasonality

 

    Business results – Segments

 

    Business results – Regions

 

    Sourcing and supply

 

    Sustainability and corporate responsibility

 

    Notes to the consolidated financial statements

 

    Note C3 – Segment information

 

    Risk factors

 

    Market, technology and business risks

 

    Regulatory, compliance and corporate governance risks

 

    Corporate Governance

 

    Corporate Governance report 2016

 

    Regulation and compliance

 

6


Table of Contents

Disclosure pursuant to Section 219 of the Iran Threat Reduction and Syria Human Rights Act of 2012 (ITRA)

Ericsson has conducted business in Iran/Persia since the late nineteenth century, opened an office in Iran in 1973 and later established a local subsidiary in the country. Ericsson strongly believes in enabling communication for all and believes that access to communications can enable the right to health, education and freedom of expression. Ericsson’s business activities in Iran principally involve the sale of communications infrastructure related products and services, including support, installation and maintenance services. Ericsson’s exports from the European Union (the “EU”) to Iran are performed under export licenses from the Swedish Agency for Non-Proliferation and Export Controls.

Due to its operations in Iran, and having staff permanently in the country, Ericsson has contacts with its local customers and retains certain local suppliers, including banks, and service providers. In addition, Ericsson has other dealings incidental to its local activities, such as making payments for taxes, salaries, rents, utilities and office and similar supplies as well for local accommodation and transportation and customs related services. As a result, Ericsson has contact with companies that may be owned or controlled by the government of Iran. While Ericsson seeks to obtain information regarding the actual business names and ownership of customers and other counterparties in Iran through its policies and procedures designed to ensure that Ericsson “knows its customers”, it is difficult to determine ownership and control with certainty, particularly with respect to determining whether an entity engaged in commercial activities is owned or controlled by the government.

During 2016, Ericsson sold communications infrastructure related products and services in Iran to the following telecommunications companies operating in the country: MTNIrancell, Mobile Communication Company of Iran (“MCCI”) and Dadeh Gostare Asre Novin (“Hiweb”). Ericsson also contracted with Pars Online for such sales. During 2016, Ericsson’s gross revenue (reported as net sales) related to sales to Hiweb, MTNIrancell and MCCI in Iran was approximately SEK 2,801 million. Ericsson does not normally allocate net profit (reported as net income) on a country-by-country or activity-by-activity basis, other than as set forth in Ericsson’s consolidated financial statements prepared in accordance with IFRS as issued by the IASB. However, Ericsson has estimated that its operating income (income before taxes and financial net) from such sales, after internal cost allocation was approximately SEK - 332 million during 2016. Ericsson intends to continue to engage with existing customers and explore opportunities with new customers in Iran while continuously monitoring international developments as they relate to Iran and its government.

In some instances, Ericsson has had to arrange performance bonds or similar financial guarantees to secure Ericsson’s performance of obligations under the commercial agreements Ericsson has entered into relating to the business in Iran. In such instances, Ericsson usually engages its banks outside Iran, who in turn engage local banks in the country. These local banks include Tejarat Bank, Melli Bank and Saderat Bank. Although some bonds and guarantees are still in place, no new performance bonds or similar guarantees involving these three banks with respect to Ericsson’s business activities in Iran were issued during 2016, nor were payments made to beneficiaries under any such existing bond or guarantee.

During 2016, Bank Mellat, Post Bank of Iran and Tejarat Bank (local banks in Iran) issued bank guarantees to secure Iranian customer payment obligations to Ericsson and Eghtesad Novin Bank (a local bank in Iran) issued a letter of credit to one of Ericsson’s banks outside Iran, to secure an Iranian customer’s payment obligations to Ericsson. Further, some payments made to Ericsson’s local subsidiary and payments required to be made by the local subsidiary to suppliers involve banks controlled by the government of Iran, such as Bank Mellat, Tejarat Bank, Bank Melli, Saderat Bank, Keshavarzi Bank, Eghtesad Novin Bank, Refah Bank and Bank Sepah. Ericsson also received payments from customers to Ericsson’s accounts outside Iran.

 

C. Organizational Structure

The following list shows certain shareholdings owned directly and indirectly by our parent company as of December 31, 2016. A complete list of shareholdings, prepared in accordance with the Swedish Annual Accounts Act and filed with the Swedish Companies Registration Office (Bolagsverket), may be obtained upon request to: Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson, External Reporting, SE-164 83 Stockholm, Sweden.

 

7


Table of Contents

Shares owned directly by the Parent Company

 

Company

   Reg. No.      Domicile      Percentage
of
ownership
    Par value
in local
currency,
million
     Carrying
value,
SEK million
 

Subsidiary companies

             

Ericsson AB

     556056-6258        Sweden        100       50        20,731  

Ericsson Shared Services AB

     556251-3266        Sweden        100       361        2,216  

Netwise AB

     556404-4286        Sweden        100       2        306  

Datacenter i Rosersberg AB

     556895-3748        Sweden        100       —          88  

Datacenter i Mjärdevi Aktiebolag

     556366-2302        Sweden        100       10        69  

AB Aulis

     556030-9899        Sweden        100       14        6  

Ericsson Credit AB

     556326-0552        Sweden        100       5        5  

Other (Sweden)

  

 

 

 

  

 

 

 

     —         —          1,642  

Ericsson Austria GmbH

  

 

 

 

     Austria        100       4        65  

Ericsson Danmark A/S

  

 

 

 

     Denmark        100       90        216  

Oy LM Ericsson Ab

  

 

 

 

     Finland        100       13        196  

Ericsson Participations France SAS

  

 

 

 

     France        100       26        524  

Ericsson Germany GmbH

  

 

 

 

     Germany        100       —          4,232  

Ericsson Hungary Ltd.

  

 

 

 

     Hungary        100       1,301        120  

L M Ericsson Limited

  

 

 

 

     Ireland        100       4        34  

Ericsson Telecomunicazioni S.p.A.

  

 

 

 

     Italy        100       44        5,357  

Ericsson Holding International B.V.

  

 

 

 

     The Netherlands        100       222        3,200  

Ericsson A/S

  

 

 

 

     Norway        100       75        114  

Ericsson Television AS

  

 

 

 

     Norway        100       161        1,670  

Ericsson Corporatia AO

  

 

 

 

     Russia        100       5        5  

Ericsson España S.A.

  

 

 

 

     Spain        100       43        170  

Ericsson AG

  

 

 

 

     Switzerland        100       —          —    

Ericsson Holdings Ltd.

  

 

 

 

     United Kingdom        100       328        4,094  

Other (Europe, excluding Sweden)

  

 

 

 

  

 

 

 

     —         —          680  

Ericsson Holding II Inc.

  

 

 

 

     United States        100       2,897        29,907  

Companía Ericsson S.A.C.I.

  

 

 

 

     Argentina        95 1)       41        15  

Ericsson Canada Inc.

  

 

 

 

     Canada        100       —          51  

Belair Networks

  

 

 

 

     Canada        100       —          170  

Ericsson Telecom S.A. de C.V.

  

 

 

 

     Mexico        100       939        1,050  

Other (United States, Latin America)

  

 

 

 

  

 

 

 

     —         —          96  

Teleric Pty Ltd.

  

 

 

 

     Australia        100       20        100  

Ericsson Ltd.

  

 

 

 

     China        100       2        2  

Ericsson (China) Company Ltd.

  

 

 

 

     China        100       65        475  

Ericsson India Private Ltd.

  

 

 

 

     India        100       725        147  

Ericsson India Global Services PVT. Ltd

  

 

 

 

     India        100       389        64  

Ericsson Media Solutions Ltd

  

 

 

 

     Israel        100       9        711  

Ericsson-LG CO Ltd.

  

 

 

 

     Korea        75       375        2,544  

Ericsson (Malaysia) Sdn. Bhd.

  

 

 

 

     Malaysia        70       2        4  

Ericsson Telecommunications Pte. Ltd.

  

 

 

 

     Singapore        100       2        1  

Ericsson South Africa PTY. Ltd

  

 

 

 

     South Africa        70       —          135  

Ericsson Taiwan Ltd.

  

 

 

 

     Taiwan        90       270        36  

Ericsson (Thailand) Ltd.

  

 

 

 

     Thailand        49 2)       90        17  

Other countries (the rest of the world)

  

 

 

 

  

 

 

 

     —         —          299  
          

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

  

 

 

 

  

 

 

 

  

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

     81,564  
          

 

 

    

 

 

 

Joint ventures and associated companies

  

 

 

 

  

 

 

 

  

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  

 

 

 

ST-Ericsson SA

        Switzerland        50       137        —    

Rockstar Consortium Group

        Canada        21       1        —    

Ericsson Nikola Tesla d.d.

        Croatia        49       65        330  
          

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

                330  
          

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) Through subsidiary holdings, total holdings amount to 100% of Compania Ericsson S.A.C.I.
2) Through subsidiary holdings, total holdings amount to 100% of Ericsson (Thailand) Ltd.

 

8


Table of Contents

Shares owned by subsidiary companies

 

Company

   Reg. No.      Domicile      Percentage
of
ownership
 

Subsidiary companies

        

Ericsson Cables Holding AB

     556044-9489        Sweden        100  

Ericsson France SAS

        France        100  

Ericsson Telekommunikation GmbH 1)

        Germany        100  

Ericsson Telecommunicatie B.V.

        The Netherlands        100  

Ericsson Telekomunikasyon A.S.

        Turkey        100  

Ericsson Ltd.

        United Kingdom        100  

Creative Broadcast Services Holdings Ltd.

        United Kingdom        100  

Ericsson Inc.

        United States        100  

Ericsson Wifi Inc.

        United States        100  

Drutt Corporation Inc.

        United States        100  

Redback Networks Inc.

        United States        100  

Telcordia Technologies Inc.

        United States        100  

Ericsson Telecomunicações S.A.

        Brazil        100  

Ericsson Australia Pty. Ltd.

        Australia        100  

Ericsson (China) Communications Co. Ltd.

        China        100  

Nanjing Ericsson Panda Communication Co. Ltd.

        China        51  

Ericsson Japan K.K.

        Japan        100  

Ericsson Communication Solutions Pte Ltd.

        Singapore        100  

 

1) Disclosures Pursuant to Section 264b of the German Commercial Code (Handelsgesetzbuch – HGB) Applying Section 264b HGB, Ericsson Holding GmbH and Ericsson Telekommunikation GmbH, located in Frankfurt am Main/Germany, are exempted from the obligation to prepare, have audited and disclose financial statements and a management report in accordance with the legal requirements being applicable for German corporations.

 

D. Property, Plant and Equipment

The information set forth under the following headings of the 2016 Swedish Annual Report is incorporated herein by reference:

 

    The business

 

    Sustainability and corporate responsibility

 

    Financials

 

    Board of Directors’ report

 

    Financial highlights – Capital expenditures

 

    Sustainability and corporate responsibility

 

9


Table of Contents
    Notes to the consolidated financial statements

 

    Note C11 – Property, plant and equipment

 

    Note C27 – Leasing

 

    Risk factors

 

    Regulatory, Compliance and Corporate Governance risks

Primary manufacturing and assembly facilities

We continuously adjust our production capacity to meet expected customer demand. During 2016, our overall capacity utilization was around 85%.

The table below summarizes where we have major sites and the total floor space at year-end. Facilities are leased. The majority of the floor space within our production facilities is used for assembly.

 

     2016      2015      2014  
     Sites      Thousands
of

sq
meters**
     Sites*      Thousands
of sq
meters**
     Sites      Thousands
of sq
meters**
 

Sweden

     4        21.3        4        21.3        4        20.7  

China

     2        13        2        13        3        19.8  

Estonia

     1        6        1        6        1        9.1  

Italy

     0        0        0        0        1        16  

Brazil

     1        4.5        1        4.5        1        25.3  

Mexico

     1        0.8        1        0.8        1        0.8  

India

     1        10.8        1        10.8        1        24.5  

Total

     10        56.4        10        56.4        12        116.2  

 

* In 2015, we closed our facility in Italy and one facility in China.
** Floor space in square meters does not include any warehouses and any transportation areas

 

ITEM 4A. Unresolved Staff Comments

None.

 

ITEM 5. OPERATING AND FINANCIAL REVIEW AND PROSPECTS

 

A. Operating Results

The information set forth under the following headings of the 2016 Swedish Annual Report is incorporated herein by reference:

 

    Ericsson in brief

 

10


Table of Contents
    The business

 

    This is Ericsson

 

    Global presence 24/7

 

    Reporting Structure 2016

 

    Other information

 

    Five-year summary

 

    Alternative Performance Measures (APMs)

 

    Financials

 

    Board of Directors’ report

 

    Business in 2016

 

    Financial highlights

 

    Business results – Segments

 

    Business results – Regions

 

    Risk management

 

    Notes to the consolidated financial statements

 

    Note C1 – Significant accounting policies

 

    Note C20 – Financial risk management and financial instruments – Foreign exchange risk

 

    Risk Factors

 

    Market, technology and business risks

 

    Regulatory, Compliance and Corporate Governance risks

Operating results for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2015

Business in 2015

In 2015, net sales increased by 8% mainly due to sales growth in India, North America and Mainland China as well as higher IPR licensing revenues. All three segments showed sales growth. Both operating income and margin increased compared to last year despite significantly higher restructuring charges. The increase is mainly related to higher IPR licensing revenues, lower negative currency hedge effects and lower operating expenses, excluding restructuring charges. In the year, the US dollar strengthened towards a number of currencies including SEK, impacting sales and operating income positively.

The IPR strategy, to generate value from investments in R&D, has been successful and over the last five years IPR licensing revenues have more than tripled. IPR revenues were SEK 14.4 (9.9) billion. Ericsson now has agreements with the majority of handset suppliers.

In 2015, there was good progress in the targeted growth areas; IP network, Cloud, OSS and BSS, TV and Media as well as Industry and Society. Ericsson continued to invest in order to establish leadership in these areas.

 

11


Table of Contents

The effort to restore Network Rollout to a sustainable profitable business progressed well, with a break-even operating income, excluding restructuring charges, for the second half of 2015.

The global cost and efficiency program progressed according to plan, with the target to achieve net annual savings of SEK 9 billion during 2017 compared with 2014. Operating expenses, excluding restructuring charges, declined to SEK 61.4 (63.0) billion. Ericsson will continue to address operating expenses and increase efforts to further reduce cost of sales in order to improve the gross margin.

Ericsson delivered a full-year cash flow from operating activities of SEK 20.6 (18.7) billion, exceeding the cash conversion target of more than 70%. The Board of Directors proposes a dividend of SEK 3.70 (3.40) per share for 2015, an increase of 9% compared with last year.

Financial highlights

Net Sales

Reported sales increased by 8%. Sales growth in India, North America and Mainland China as well as higher IPR licensing revenues were partly offset by lower sales in Japan, Russia and Brazil.

All three segments showed sales growth. Global Services sales grew by 11%, with 15% growth in Professional Services, while Network Rollout sales were almost flat. Networks sales grew by 5% and Support Solutions sales by 19%.

IPR licensing revenues amounted to SEK 14.4 (9.9) billion. In 2015, a global patent license agreement was signed with Apple.

In the year, the US dollar strengthened towards a number of currencies including SEK, impacting sales positively. At the same time the strong US dollar gradually impacted investments negatively in some emerging markets.

Sales, adjusted for comparable units and currency, decreased by –5%.

Gross margin

Gross margin declined to 34.8% (36.2%). Excluding restructuring charges, the gross margin declined to 35.7% (36.6%) due to a mix with a lower share of mobile capacity business and higher share of Global Services sales. This was partly offset by higher IPR licensing revenues and effects of implemented efficiency measures.

The mix of sales by commodity was; software 23% (24%), hardware 34% (34%) and services 43% (42%).

Restructuring charges and global cost and efficiency program

Restructuring charges amounted to SEK –5.0 (–1.5) billion, in line with previous estimates. The charges were mainly related to the global cost and efficiency program announced in November 2014. The global cost and efficiency program is progressing according to plan and is expected to generate net annual savings of SEK 9 billion during 2017 compared with 2014.

With current visibility, total restructuring charges for 2016 are estimated to be approximately SEK 3–4 billion. This includes both restructuring charges related to the global cost and efficiency program and normal restructuring charges for the ongoing business transformation.

Operating expenses

Total operating expenses increased to SEK 64.1 (63.4) billion. Operating expenses, excluding restructuring charges, decreased from SEK 63.0 to SEK 61.4 billion, due to lower R&D expenses amounting to SEK 32.8 (36.0) billion. This is partly a result of implementation of activities related to the global cost and efficiency program. Additions to capitalized development expenses amounted to SEK 3.5 (1.5) billion. The increase was due to higher activity in technology platform development than a year ago.

Other operating income and expenses

Other operating income and expenses improved to SEK 0.1 (–2.2) billion. The increase is mainly related to currency hedge effects of SEK –1.1 (–2.8) billion. They derive from the hedge contract balance in US dollar, which has further decreased in value. The SEK has weakened towards the US dollar between December 31, 2014 (SEK/USD rate 7.79) and December 31, 2015 (8.40). The negative currency hedge effects were more than offset by several minor positive items and a capital gain of SEK 0.3 billion related to a real estate divestment in the US.

Operating income

Operating income increased to SEK 21.8 (16.8) billion despite significantly higher restructuring charges. The increase is mainly related to higher IPR licensing revenues, lower negative currency hedge effects and lower operating expenses, excluding restructuring charges. The net currency effect had a positive impact on operating income. Operating margin was 8.8% (7.4%).

 

12


Table of Contents

Financial net

Financial net amounted to SEK –1.9 (–1.0) billion. The decrease is mainly due to a negative effect of foreign currency revaluation and lower interest rates.

Taxes

The tax rate for 2015 was 31% compared with 30% in 2014, negatively impacted by the geographical mix. Tax costs were SEK –6.2 (–4.7) billion.

Net income and EPS

Net income increased to SEK 13.7 (11.1) billion, for the same reasons as for the increase in operating income. EPS diluted was SEK 4.13 (3.54).

Business results – Segments

Networks

Reported sales increased by 5% compared to last year. The increase was mainly due to higher IPR licensing revenues. Operator investments in mobile broadband in India and South East Asia increased. The large-scale LTE deployments in Mainland China continued at a high pace in 2015. Sales in North America were flat compared to last year, supported by the strengthened US dollar. Mobile broadband investments in North America were negatively impacted by operator focus on cash flow optimization in order to finance major acquisitions and spectrum auctions.

In 2015, sales in targeted growth area IP networks grew, mainly driven by investments in packet core, VoLTE and user data management.

During the year, the US dollar strengthened towards a number of currencies, including SEK, impacting sales positively. At the same time, the strong US dollar gradually impacted investments negatively in some emerging markets. Sales, adjusted for comparable units and currency, decreased by –8% compared to last year.

Operating income and margin decreased due to a higher share of mobile broadband coverage business and higher restructuring charges. Increased IPR licensing revenues, lower operating expenses and lower negative effect of currency hedge contracts contributed positively to operating income and margin.

The year started with a high level of R&D expenses which gradually decreased as a result of the global cost and efficiency program. The ambition to improve Networks profitability remains.

Restructuring charges amounted to SEK –2.8 (–0.4) billion and the negative effect from hedge contracts was SEK –0.9 (–2.1) billion.

Global Services

Reported sales increased by 11% compared to last year. Professional Services reported sales grew 15% with strong development across the portfolio and with growth in all ten regions.

Consulting and Systems Integration sales grew, driven by OSS and BSS transformation projects and by solutions for Industry & Society customers. Sales in Managed Services grew by 17% and the number of signed contracts increased by more than 40% compared with 2014.

Network Rollout sales were flat. Lower coverage project activities in Japan, North America and Latin America impacted sales negatively.

Global Services sales, adjusted for comparable units and currency, declined –2%.

Global Services operating income increased by more than 30% compared with 2014, driven by increased sales in Professional Services and reduced losses in Network Rollout. Professional Services margin was stable compared to last year.

The effort to restore Network Rollout profitability progressed well with a break-even result, excluding restructuring, for the second half of the year. Network Rollout full-year operating income improved to SEK –1.4 (–2.5) billion.

Restructuring charges for Global Services increased to SEK –1.7 (–0.8) billion. The implementation of the Global Services delivery strategy accelerated during the year as part of the global cost and efficiency program, resulting in a remote delivery rate of 50% (44%). The ambition to optimize service delivery and improve profitability will continue.

The effect of currency hedge contracts on operating income was SEK –0.2 (–0.6) billion.

Support Solutions

Reported sales increased by 19% compared with 2014, with North America and India as main contributors. Sales, adjusted for comparable units and currency, were flat. The overall transition of business models, from traditional telecom software licenses to recurrent license revenue deals, continued.

Sales in OSS and BSS developed favorably. Growth of mobile broadband drives operators to transform their OSS and BSS solutions, in order to monetize the data growth while at the same time managing the increased complexity. Two important TV & Media agreements were announced in North America in the second half of the year, showing the strong position Ericsson has in this transforming market.

 

13


Table of Contents

IPR licensing revenues increased compared with 2014.

Operating Income and margin improved significantly compared with 2014, driven by higher sales. Focus going forward is to improve earnings leverage through increased recurring software sales and efficiencies.

Restructuring charges increased to SEK –0.5 (–0.1) billion due to the global cost and efficiency program. The effect of currency hedge contracts on operating income was SEK –0.1 (–0.2) billion.

Business results – Regions

North America

Mobile broadband investments were slow as operators focused on cash flow optimization in order to finance major acquisitions and spectrum auctions. Investments stabilized during the second half of the year, driven by data traffic growth. ICT transformation, TV & Media and Professional Services developed favorably.

Latin America

Sales decreased compared to last year mainly due to lower activities in Brazil. Operator investments increased in local currency, but not enough to compensate for the depreciation towards the US dollar and currency restrictions in many parts of the region. Professional Services sales grew, mainly in OSS and BSS.

Northern Europe and Central Asia

Sales declined, primarily due to lower mobile broadband investments in Russia with sales of SEK 4.7 (6.7) billion. However, sales stabilized in the second half of the year, but at a lower level compared to the same period last year. Professional Services sales increased, driven by Managed Services and ICT transformation projects in the Nordics. TV & Media and OSS and BSS developed favorably, driving sales growth in Support Solutions.

Western and Central Europe

Investments in mobile broadband were driven by the transition from 3G to 4G and capacity enhancements. At the same time, some important projects peaked. Sales were stable with a shift towards Professional Services and Support Solutions, as operators focus on network optimization, efficiency and new functionality.

Mediterranean

Sales increased somewhat, driven by Managed Services. Investments in mobile broadband were driven by the transition from 3G to 4G and improvements of the quality and capacity of the networks.

Middle East

Sales increased, primarily in Global Services. In the first half of the year, Network sales growth was mainly driven by some major mobile broadband projects, which were completed in the second half of the year.

Sub-Saharan Africa

Sales increased across all segments, driven by strong consumer demand for mobile broadband, despite a challenging regulatory environment and recent macro-economic development. Operators’ focus on network quality and efficiency drove Professional Services sales growth.

India

Sales growth was driven by increased operator investments in mobile broadband infrastructure and Professional Services. Increased focus on network quality and cost optimization continued to drive strong sales growth for Managed Services. Support Solutions sales showed significant growth, driven by OSS and BSS.

North East Asia

Sales growth was driven by 4G deployments in Mainland China, partly offset by lower operator investments in Japan. Professional Services showed growth, supported by the acquisition of Sunrise Technologies’ telecom business.

 

14


Table of Contents

South East Asia and Oceania

Sales increased, primarily driven by mobile broadband deployments across several markets. Professional Services sales developed favorably as operators focused on efficiency and network optimization. TV & Media showed a positive development during the year.

Other

Sales increased, driven by the Apple global patent license agreement and currency, as a majority of the IPR contracts are in US dollar. Broadcast services showed good growth. IPR licensing revenues amounted to SEK 14.4 (9.9) billion.

 

B. Liquidity and Capital Resources

The information set forth under the following headings of the 2016 Swedish Annual Report is incorporated herein by reference:

 

    Financials

 

    Board of Directors’ report

 

    Financial highlights – Cash flow

 

    Financial highlights – Financial position

 

    Financial highlights – Seasonality

 

    Financial highlights – Capital expenditures

 

    Notes to the consolidated financial statements

 

    Note C19 – Interest-bearing liabilities

 

    Note C20 – Financial risk management and financial instruments

 

    Note C25 – Statement of cash flows

See “Item 8.B. Financial Information – Significant Changes” herein.

Balance sheet and other performance indicators for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2015

Cash flow

Cash flow from operating activities was SEK 20.6 (18.7) billion. The positive earnings were somewhat offset by increased working capital, due to a business mix with a high share of coverage projects in Mainland China and emerging markets.

Days sales outstanding (DSO) decreased to 87 (105) days and Inventory turnover days remained stable at 64 days. Accounts payable days decreased to 53 (56) days. Provisions amounted to SEK 3.8 (4.4) billion at year end. Cash outlays of SEK 2.8 billion related to restructuring charges were made during the year.

Total investing activities amounted to SEK –8.0 billion. Investments in property, plant and equipment increased to SEK –8.3 (–5.3) billion driven by continued investments in new ICT centers in Sweden and Canada. Acquisitions amounted to SEK –2.2 (–4.4) billion.

Financing activities were impacted by dividend payouts of SEK –11.3 (–9.8) billion.

Financial position

Net cash decreased to SEK 18.5 (27.6) billion in 2015, despite stronger cash flow from operating activities, mainly due to increased investments in ICT centers and in new facilities in Santa Clara, California, as well as increased dividends.

 

15


Table of Contents

Pension liabilities increased by SEK 2.3 billion following actuarial adjustments. The net cash position, excluding post-employment benefits (in the amount of SEK 22.7 billion) was SEK 41.2 (48.0) billion. Reported net cash was SEK 18.5 billion.

The average maturity of long-term borrowings as of December 31, 2015 was 4.8 years, compared with 5.7 years 12 months earlier. Ericsson has an unutilized Revolving Credit Facility of USD 2.0 billion. The facility expires in 2020.

Employees

In 2015, the number of employees decreased by 1,774. At the end of 2015, the total number of employees was 116,281 (118,055). Almost 15,000 employees joined Ericsson during the year and close to 17,000 employees left Ericsson, reflecting the natural attrition rate and ongoing company transformation.

Research and development, patents and licensing

In line with the global cost and efficiency program, the Company has decreased its R&D activities. The largest contribution to savings is a result of discontinuation of the modems operations. Approximately half of the global cost and efficiency program annual net savings of SEK 9 billion is estimated to come from operating expenses. R&D expenses amounted to SEK 34.8 (36.3) billion.

Research and development, patents and licensing

 

     2015     2014     2013  

Expenses (SEK billion)

     34.8       36.3       32.2  

As percent of Net sales

     14.1     15.9     14.2

Employees within R&D as of December 31  1)

     23,700       25,700       25,300  

Patents  1)

     39,000       37,000       35,000  

IPR revenues, net (SEK billion)

     14.4       9.9       10.6  

 

1) The number of employees and patents are approximate.

Seasonality

The Company’s sales, income and cash flow from operations vary between quarters, and are generally lowest in the first quarter of the year and highest in the fourth quarter. This is mainly a result of the seasonal purchase patterns of network operators.

Most recent five-year average seasonality

 

     First quarter     Second quarter     Third quarter     Fourth quarter  

Sequential change, sales

     –22     9     0     21

Share of annual sales

     22     24     24     29

Off-balance sheet arrangements

There are currently no material off-balance sheet arrangements that have, or would be reasonably likely to have, a current or anticipated material effect on the Company’s financial condition, revenues, expenses, result of operations, liquidity, capital expenditures or capital resources.

Capital expenditures

For 2015, capital expenditures were SEK 8.3 (5.3) billion, representing 3.4% of sales. Expenditures are largely related to test sites and equipment for R&D, network operation centers and manufacturing and repair operations.

Investments have been made in three new global ICT centers. The centers will support R&D and services in developing and verifying solutions more efficiently and bringing innovation faster to the market. The first center, in Linköping, Sweden, was opened in 2014. The second center, in Rosersberg, Sweden, was opened in the beginning of 2016. The third center, in Montreal, Canada, is planned to be opened during the second quarter of 2016. In addition, Ericsson has invested in two buildings in Santa Clara, California with the purpose to consolidate Ericsson’s Silicon Valley operations.

Apart from these investments, Ericsson believes that the Company’s property, plant and equipment and the facilities the Company occupies are suitable for its present needs in most locations.

 

16


Table of Contents

Annual capital expenditures are normally around 2% of sales. This corresponds to the needs for keeping and maintaining the current capacity level. The Board of Directors reviews the Company’s investment plans and proposals.

As of December 31, 2015, no material land, buildings, machinery or equipment were pledged as collateral for outstanding indebtedness.

Capital expenditures 2011–2015

 

SEK billion

   2015     2014     2013     2012     2011  

Capital -expenditures

     8.3       5.3       4.5       5.4       5.0  

Of which in -Sweden

     2.6       2.4       1.9       1.3       1.7  

Share of annual sales

     3.4     2.3     2.0     2.4     2.2

 

C. Research and Development, Patents and Licenses

The information set forth under the following headings of the 2016 Swedish Annual Report is incorporated herein by reference:

 

    Other information

 

    Five-year summary

 

    Alternative Performance Measures (APMs)

 

    The business

 

    This is Ericsson

 

    Business structure

 

    Networks

 

    IT & Cloud

 

    Media

 

    Global presence 24/7

 

    Customer group – Industry and Society

 

    Customer Group – IPR & Licensing

 

    Financials – Board of Directors’ report

 

    Financial highlights – Research and development, patents and licensing

 

    Consolidated financial statements

 

    Consolidated income statement

 

17


Table of Contents
D. Trend Information

The information set forth under the following headings of the 2016 Swedish Annual Report is incorporated herein by reference:

 

    The Business

 

    CEO dialogue

 

    This is Ericsson

 

    Profit improvement

 

    This is the market

See “Item 8.B. Financial Information – Significant Changes” herein.

 

E. Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements

The information set forth under the following headings of the 2016 Swedish Annual Report is incorporated herein by reference:

 

    Financials

 

    Board of Directors’ report

 

    Financial highlights – Off-balance sheet arrangements

 

    Notes to the consolidated financial statements

 

    Note C14 – Trade receivables and customer finance, Transfers of financial assets

 

    Note C24 – Contingent liabilities

 

F. Tabular Disclosure of Contractual Obligations

The information set forth under the section “Financials – Notes to the consolidated financial statements – Note C31 – Contractual obligations” of the 2016 Swedish Annual Report is incorporated herein by reference.

 

ITEM 6. DIRECTORS, SENIOR MANAGEMENT AND EMPLOYEES

 

A. Directors and Senior Management

The information set forth under the following headings of the 2016 Swedish Annual Report is incorporated herein by reference:

 

    Corporate Governance

 

    Corporate Governance report 2016

 

    Members of the Board of Directors

 

    Members of the Executive Leadership Team

See “Item 8.B. Financial Information – Significant Changes” herein.

 

18


Table of Contents
B. Compensation

The information set forth under the following headings of the 2016 Swedish Annual Report is incorporated herein by reference:

 

    Financials

 

    Board of Directors’ report

 

    Corporate governance – Remuneration

 

    Notes to the consolidated financial statements

 

    Note C17 – Post-employment benefits

 

    Note C28 – Information regarding members of the Board of Directors, the Group management and employees

 

    Corporate Governance

 

    Corporate Governance report 2016

 

    Remuneration to Board members

 

    Remuneration report

See “Item 8.B. Financial Information – Significant Changes” herein.

 

C. Board Practices

The information set forth under the following headings of the 2016 Swedish Annual Report is incorporated herein by reference:

 

    Financials

 

    Notes to the consolidated financial statements

 

    Note C28 – Information regarding members of the Board of Directors, the Group management and employees – Comments to the table

 

    Corporate Governance

 

    Corporate Governance report 2016

 

    Board of Directors – Composition of the Board of Directors

 

    Committees of the Board of Directors – Audit committee

 

    Committees of the Board of Directors – Remuneration committee

 

    Remuneration report

 

    The Remuneration Committee

 

19


Table of Contents

See “Item 8.B. Financial Information – Significant Changes” herein.

 

D. Employees

The information set forth under the following headings of the 2016 Swedish Annual Report is incorporated herein by reference:

 

    The Business

 

    The people

 

    Financials

 

    Board of Directors’ report

 

    Financial Highlights – Employees

 

    Notes to the Consolidated financial statements

 

    Note C28 – Information regarding members of the Board of Directors, the Group management and employees – Employee numbers, wages and salaries

 

    Other information

 

    Five-year summary – Statistical data, year-end

We consider that our relationship with the labor unions that represent our employees is good.

 

Number of employees by region at year-end

        
     2016      2015      2014  

North America

     11,547        14,548        15,516  

Latin America

     9,513        10,412        11,066  

Northern Europe & Central Asia 1) 2)

     19,136        20,700        21,633  

Western & Central Europe 2)

     13,646        12,220        12,617  

Mediterranean 2)

     12,578        12,702        13,387  

Middle East

     3,346        3,639        3,858  

Sub-Saharan Africa

     2,086        2,301        2,406  

India

     22,552        21,999        19,971  

North East Asia

     13,042        13,706        13,464  

South East Asia & Oceania

     4,018        4,054        4,137  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     111,464        116,281        118,055  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

1) Of which in Sweden

     15,303        17,041        17,580  

2) Of which in EU

     42,625        43,117        45,202  

 

20


Table of Contents
E. Share Ownership

The information set forth under the following headings of the 2016 Swedish Annual Report is incorporated herein by reference:

 

    Shareholders

 

    Share information

 

    Shareholders

 

    Corporate Governance

 

    Corporate Governance report 2016

 

    Shareholders

 

    Members of the Board of Directors

 

    Members of the Executive Leadership Team

 

    Remuneration report

 

    Total remuneration in 2016

 

    Financials – Notes to the consolidated financial statements

 

    Note C28 – Information regarding members of the Board of Directors, the Group management and employees

 

ITEM 7. MAJOR SHAREHOLDERS AND RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS

 

A. Major Shareholders

The information set forth under the following headings of the 2016 Swedish Annual Report is incorporated herein by reference:

 

    Corporate Governance

 

    Corporate Governance report 2016

 

    Shareholders

 

    Shareholders

 

    Share information

 

    Shareholders

 

B. Related Party Transactions

The information set forth under the section “Financials – Notes to the consolidated financial statements – Note C29 – Related party transactions” of the 2016 Swedish Annual Report is incorporated herein by reference.

 

21


Table of Contents
C. Interests of Experts and Counsel.

Not applicable.

 

ITEM 8. FINANCIAL INFORMATION

 

A. Consolidated Statements and Other Financial Information.

The information set forth under the following headings of the 2016 Swedish Annual Report is incorporated herein by reference:

 

    Financials

 

    Board of Directors’ report

 

    Legal proceedings

 

    Parent Company – Proposed disposition of earnings

 

    Consolidated financial statements

 

    Notes to the consolidated financial statements

 

    Report of independent registered public accounting firm

 

    Other information

 

    Five-year summary – Statistical data, year-end

See “Item 8.B. Financial Information – Significant Changes”, “Item 10.B. Memorandum and Articles of Association – Dividends” and “Item 17. Financial Statements”, herein.

Refer also to item 8.B herein

 

B. Significant Changes

New segment structure from January 1, 2017

From January 1, 2017, financial reporting is done according to the new structure, i.e., by the new segments Networks, IT & Cloud and Media.

Börje Ekholm took office as CEO and President on January 16, 2017

On January 16, 2017, Ericsson announced that in connection with Börje Ekholm assuming the position as President and CEO of Ericsson, Jan Frykhammar, who had temporarily held the position as President and CEO, remained a member of the Executive Leadership Team and was appointed Executive Vice President and advisor to the CEO. Jan Frykhammar has been supporting Börje Ekholm during the transition period and has focused on corporate governance and efficiency. Magnus Mandersson remains Executive Vice President, advisor to the CEO, focusing on customer relationships, and a member of the Executive Leadership Team. Magnus Mandersson also remains Chairperson of four out of Ericsson’s ten regions. Carl Mellander remains acting Chief Financial Officer and a member of the Executive Leadership Team.

 

22


Table of Contents

Ericsson issues two bonds of EUR 500 million each, maturing in 2021 and 2024, on February 24, 2017

Ericsson has successfully placed one Euro denominated 500 million four year bond with a fixed coupon rate of 0.875% and one Euro denominated 500 million seven year bond with a fixed coupon rate of 1.875% per year.

The bonds were issued under Ericsson’s Euro Medium Term Note Program (EMTN).

Joint bookrunners were Citi, Credit Agricole CIB and SEB and co-managers were Nordea, Standard Chartered and Swedbank.

The proceeds will be used to refinance debt maturing in 2017 and for general corporate purposes.

Ericsson presented focused business strategy

On March 28, 2017, Ericsson presented a focused business strategy to revitalize technology and market leadership, improve group profitability and enable customer success. The company announced that it will reallocate resources and increase investments in the following core portfolio areas: networks, digital services (OSS, BSS and telecom core) and Internet of Things (IoT).

In addition, the company will implement a refocused strategy for Managed Services to improve profitability and also explore strategic opportunities for the Media and Cloud infrastructure hardware businesses. When announced, the refocused strategy was estimated to have the following financial consequences in the short term: write down of assets to be made in Q1, 2017, with an estimated impact on operating income of SEK 3-4 b, restructuring charges estimated to approximately SEK 6-8 b. for 2017, of which approximately SEK 2 b. in Q1. The actual result reported in Q1 2017 was in line with the estimates: write down of assets were SEK 3.3 b., restructuring charges in Q1 2017 were SEK 1.7 b.

Separately, but in the same announcement, the company announced that it would make provisions of an estimated SEK 7-9 b. in Q1, triggered by recent negative developments related to certain large customer projects. The actual result recognized in Q1 2017 was SEK 8.4 b. and in line with the estimate.

In March, 2017, the Company made a restructuring provision of SEK 0.9 billion related to the reduction of operations in Borås and Kumla in Sweden. This was recognized in the first quarter of 2017.

Ericsson Simplifies Organization and Names Executive Team

In line with the business strategy announced on March 28, 2017, Ericsson has simplified its organizational structure by removing the two-tiered leadership structure, Executive Leadership Team and Global Leadership Team, and forming a single Executive Team. In addition, the geographical setup with ten regions has become five market areas, and the business areas were re-defined and reduced to three. The new Executive Team roles and the new organization took effect April 1, 2017.

The following Business Area and Market Area structure has been applied to Ericsson as of April 1, 2017:

 

    Business Area Networks; Business Area Digital Services; Business Area Managed Services

 

    Market Area North America; Market Area Europe & Latin America; Market Area Middle East & Africa; Market Area North East Asia; Market Area South East Asia, Oceania & India

Effective April 1, 2017, Ericsson’s Executive Team members are:

President and CEO – Börje Ekholm

Business Area Networks – Fredrik Jejdling, Senior Vice President, previously head of Business Unit Network Services

Business Area Managed Services – Peter Laurin, Senior Vice President, previously head of Region Northern Europe and Central Asia

Business Area Digital Services – Ulf Ewaldsson, Senior Vice President, previously head of Group Function Strategy & Technology

Market Area North America – Rima Qureshi, Senior Vice President, previously head of Region North America

Market Area Europe & Latin America – Arun Bansal, Senior Vice President, previously head of Business Unit Network Products

Market Area Middle East & Africa – Rafiah Ibrahim, Senior Vice President, previously head of Region Middle East

Market Area North East Asia – Chris Houghton, Senior Vice President, previously head of Region North East Asia

South East Asia, Oceania & India – Nunzio Mirtillo, Senior Vice President, previously head of Region Mediterranean

Technology & Emerging Business – Niklas Heuveldop, Senior Vice President, previously head of Group Function Sales

Finance & Common Functions – Carl Mellander, Senior Vice President, previously acting Head of Group Function Finance & Common Functions

Human Resources – MajBritt Arfert, Senior Vice President, previously acting Head of Group Function Human Resources

 

23


Table of Contents

Marketing & Communications – Helena Norrman, Senior Vice President, previously in the same role

Sustainability & Corporate Responsibility – Elaine Weidman Grunewald, Senior Vice President, previously in the same role

Legal Affairs – Nina Macpherson, Senior Vice President, previously in the same role

Advisor to the CEO – Jan Frykhammar, Executive Vice President¸ previously in the same role

Advisor to the CEO – Magnus Mandersson, Executive Vice President, previously in the same role

Per Borgklint, Anders Lindblad, Jean-Philippe Poirault and Charlotta Sund left the Executive Leadership Team effective April 1, 2017.

Changes resolved in connection with the Annual General Meeting of shareholders (AGM) held on March 29, 2017

Decisions at the AGM 2017 included:

 

  Payment of a dividend of SEK 1 per share

 

  Re-election of Leif Johansson as Chairman of the Board of Directors

 

  Re-election of other members of the Board of Directors: Nora Denzel, Börje Ekholm, Kristin Skogen Lund, Kristin S. Rinne, Sukhinder Singh Cassidy, Helena Sjernholm and Jacob Wallenberg

 

  Election of new Board members: Jon Fredrik Baksaas, Jan Carlson and Eric A. Elzvik

 

  Approval of Board of Directors’ fees:

 

    Chairman: SEK 4,075,000 (unchanged)

 

    Other non-employee Board members: SEK 990,000 each (unchanged)

 

    Chairman of the Audit Committee: SEK 350,000 (unchanged)

 

    Other non-employee members of the Audit Committee: SEK 250,000 each (unchanged)

 

    Chairmen of the Finance and Remuneration Committees: SEK 200,000 each (unchanged)

 

    Other non-employee members of the Finance and Remuneration Committees: SEK 175,000 each (unchanged)

 

    Chairman of the newly-established Technology and Science Committee: SEK 200,000

 

    Other non-employee members of the newly-established Technology and Science Committee: SEK 175,000 each

 

  Approval for part of the Directors’ fees to be paid in the form of synthetic shares

 

  Approval of Guidelines for remuneration to Group Management

 

  Implementation of a Long-Term Variable Compensation Program 2017 for the members of the Global Leadership Team, including a share issue of and authorization to the Board to buy back 3,000,000 shares for the program.

Information on new Board members

Jon Fredrik Baksaas

Born 1954. Master of Science in Economics, NHH Norwegian School of Economics & Business Administration, Norway.

Board member: Svenska Handelsbanken AB.

Holdings in Ericsson: None.*

Principal work experience and other information: President and CEO of Telenor (2002-2015). Previous positions within the Telenor Group since 1989, including deputy CEO, Chief Financial Officer and CEO of TBK AS. Previous positions include CFO of Aker AS, finance director of Stolt Nielsen Seaway AS and controller at Det Norske Veritas, Norway and Japan. Member of the GSMA Board (2008-2016) and Chairman of the GSMA Board (2014-2016).

 

24


Table of Contents

Jan Carlson

Born 1960. Master of Science degree in Engineering Physics and Electrical Engineering, the University of Linköping, Sweden.

Board Chairman: Autoliv Inc.

Board member: BorgWarner Inc., Teknikföretagen, The Confederation of Swedish Enterprise and Trelleborg AB.

Holdings in Ericsson: 7,900 Class B Shares.*

Principal work experience and other information: President and CEO of Autoliv Inc. since 2007 and Chairman of Autoliv Inc. since 2014. Previous positions within the Autoliv Group since 1999, including President Autoliv Europe, Vice President Engineering of Autoliv and President Autoliv Electronics. Previous positions include President of Saab Combitech and of Swedish Gate Array.

Eric A. Elzvik

Born 1960. Master of Science in Business Administration, Stockholm School of Economics, Sweden.

Board member: IMD Foundation, Lausanne and the Swiss Swedish Chamber of Commerce, Zurich, Switzerland.

Holdings in Ericsson: 10,000 Class B shares*.

Principal work experience and other information: Chief Financial Officer and member of the Group Executive Committee of ABB Ltd (2013-2017). Division CFO ABB Discrete Automation & Motion (2010-2012) and division CFO Automation Products Division (2006-2010). Previous positions within the ABB Group since 1984, including senior management positions within finance, mergers & acquisitions and new ventures.

 

* The holdings in Ericsson are as of the date of the notice convening the Annual General Meeting and includes holdings by related persons as well as holdings of ADS, if applicable.

The minutes from the AGM 2017 are available on Ericsson’s website.

The employee representatives appointed as of March 29, 2017 are: Kjell-Åke Soting, Roger Svensson and Karin Åberg, with the deputies Torbjörn Nyman, Anders Ripa and Loredana Roslund.

The Nomination Committee’s independence assessment

Before the AGM 2017, the Nomination Committee considered that at least the following Board members were independent in respect of all applicable independence requirements:

a. Jon Fredrik Baksaas

b. Jan Carlson

c. Nora Denzel

d. Eric A. Elzvik

e. Leif Johansson

f. Kristin Skogen Lund

g. Kristin S. Rinne

h. Sukhinder Singh Cassidy

New Board Committee on Technology and Science and new Committee members

At the statutory Board meeting held in connection with the Annual General Meeting 2017, the Board resolved to establish a new Board Committee on Technology and Science and the following Board members were appointed members of the new Committee: Kristin S. Rinne (Chairman), Jan Carlson, Nora Denzel and Roger Svensson (employee representative).

The tasks of the Committee include monitoring and preparing for consideration and/or resolution of the Board various matters relating to technology strategy and direction, technical matters, technology ecosystem and science direction.

The Board members appointed to the other Board Committees as of March 29, 2017 are:

Audit Committee: Eric A. Elzvik (Chairman), Nora Denzel, Kristin Skogen Lund and Karin Åberg (employee representative) Finance Committee: Leif Johansson (Chairman), Helena Stjernholm, Jacob Wallenberg and Roger Svensson (employee representative) Remuneration Committee: Leif Johansson (Chairman), Jon Fredrik Baksaas, Sukhinder Singh Cassidy and Kjell Åke Soting (employee representative)”.

 

25


Table of Contents
  Results for the First Quarter of 2017

For information about our results for the first quarter of 2017, see the report on Form 6-K filed with the SEC on April 26 2017, which is incorporated herein by reference.

 

ITEM 9. THE OFFER AND LISTING

 

A. Offer and Listing Details

The information set forth under the section “Shareholders – Share information – Share and ADS prices” of the 2016 Swedish Annual Report is incorporated herein by reference.

 

B. Plan of Distribution

Not applicable.

 

C. Markets

The information set forth the section “Shareholders – Share information – Share trading” of the 2016 Swedish Annual Report is incorporated herein by reference.

 

D. Selling Shareholders

Not applicable.

 

E. Dilution

Not applicable.

 

F. Expenses of the Issue

Not applicable.

 

ITEM 10. ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

A. Share Capital

Not applicable.

 

B. Memorandum and Articles of Association

Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson is registered under no. 556016–0680 in the Company Register kept by the Swedish Companies Registration Office. Our Company’s objective and purposes are described in article 2 of the Articles of Association, as follows: The objects of the Company are to, directly or indirectly, develop, construct, produce, sell and deliver and in other forms carry on trade and other commercial business related to goods, products and other equipment as well as maintenance and other services based on telecommunication and radio technology and other technologies for transference, transmission and other communications of speech, data, images, text, other kinds of information and means of payment and to carry on other activities consistent therewith.

Our Articles of Association do not stipulate anything regarding:

 

    a director’s power to vote on a proposal, arrangement, or contract in which the director is materially interested;

 

26


Table of Contents
    our directors’ power to vote for compensation to themselves;

 

    our directors’ borrowing powers;

 

    retirement rules for our directors; or

 

    the number of shares required for a director’s qualification.

Applicable provisions are found in the Swedish Companies Act (2005:551) (the “Swedish Companies Act”), as referred to in “Certain Powers of Directors and the President” below.

In addition to being of legal age, there are no age limit restrictions for directors and they are not required to own any shares in the Company.

Share Capital, Increases of Share Capital and Preferential Rights of Shareholders

The Articles of Association of Ericsson provide that the share capital of the Company may not be less than SEK 6,000,000,000 nor more than SEK 24,000,000,000, and that the number of shares in the Company shall amount to no less than 3,000,000,000 and no more than 12,000,000,000. The registered share capital is SEK 16,655,758,678 and the Company has in total issued 3,331,151,735 shares.

The Company’s shares are divided into three series: Class A shares, Class B shares and Class C shares; however, no Class C shares are currently outstanding. Under the Swedish Companies Act, shareholders must approve each issue of additional shares either by deciding on the share issue at a shareholders’ meeting, or by a shareholders’ approval of a decision on a share issue by the Board, or by giving an authorization to the Board to decide about a share issue. If we decide to issue new Class A, Class B and Class C shares by means of a cash issue, or an issue against payment through set-off of claims, Class A, Class B and Class C shareholders (except for Ericsson and its subsidiaries, in the event they hold shares in Ericsson) have a primary preferential right to subscribe for new shares of the same type in relation to the number of shares previously held by them. Shares not subscribed for through a preferential right shall be offered to all shareholders for subscription on a pro rata basis. If we decide to issue new shares of only one series by means of a cash issue or an issue against payment through set-off of claims, all shareholders, regardless of whether their shares are Class A, Class B or Class C, are entitled to a preferential right to subscribe for new shares in proportion to the number of shares previously held by them. Shareholders may vote to waive shareholders’ preferential rights at a general meeting.

If we decide to issue warrants or convertibles through a cash issue or an issue against payment through set-off of claims, the shareholders have preferential rights to subscribe to warrants as if the issue were of the shares that may be subscribed to pursuant to the warrant and, respectively, preferential rights to subscribe to convertibles as if the issue were of the shares that the convertibles may be converted to.

The above does not constitute any restriction to waive the shareholders’ preferential rights when deciding on either an issue of shares, warrants or convertibles by means of a cash issue or an issue against payment through set-off of claims.

Dividends

Our Class A and Class B shareholders have the same right to dividends. Class C shareholders do not have any right to dividends, as described in article 6 of our Articles of Association. No Class C shares are currently outstanding.

Under Swedish law, only a general meeting of shareholders may decide on payment of dividends, which may not exceed the amount proposed by the Board of Directors (except in certain limited circumstances), and may only be paid from funds legally available for that purpose. Under Swedish law, no interim dividends may be paid in respect of any fiscal period for which audited financial statements of the company have not yet been adopted by the annual general meeting of shareholders. The market practice in Sweden is most often for dividends to be paid annually. Under the Swedish Companies Act, dividends to shareholders and other transfers of value from a company—such as purchases of own shares (see below)—may only be made in case the company’s restricted equity remains fully covered after the transfer of value has been made. The calculation shall be based upon the most recently adopted

 

27


Table of Contents

balance sheet, and any changes in the restricted equity that has occurred after the balance sheet date shall be taken into account. In addition, dividends to shareholders and other transfers of value from the company may only be made if this is justifiable taken into account the type of business activities of the company, their scope and risks related thereto and the company’s need for financial resources, its liquidity and financial position. In respect of parent companies, also the business activities of the group, their scope and risks related thereto and the group’s need for financial resources, its liquidity and financial position shall be taken into account.

The Company’s shares are registered in the computerized book-entry share registration system administered by Euroclear Sweden AB (“Euroclear”). The rights attached to shares eligible for dividends accrue to those persons whose names are recorded in the register of shareholders on the record day. The dividends are then sent to a specified account as directed by the person registered with Euroclear, or to the address of that person. The relevant record day must, in most circumstances, be specified in the resolution declaring a dividend or resolving upon a capital increase or any similar matter in which shareholders have preferential rights, or the Board of Directors must be authorized to determine the relevant record day.

Where the registered holder is a nominee, the nominee receives, for the account of the beneficial owner, dividends and, on issues of shares with preferential rights for the shareholders, shares, as well as rights. Dividends are remitted in a single payment to the nominee who is responsible for the distribution of such dividends to the beneficial owner. A similar procedure is adopted for share issues. Specific authority to act as a nominee must be obtained from Euroclear. At the request of Euroclear, the nominee must provide information about all beneficial holders of shares to Euroclear. Euroclear is required to keep a register with regard to any holding on behalf of a single beneficial owner in excess of 500 shares in any one company. This list is prepared every third month and must reveal the names of the beneficial owner and be open to public inspection.

Voting

In a general meeting of Ericsson, each Class A share shall carry one vote, each Class B share one tenth of one vote and each Class C share one-thousandth of one vote.

We are required to publish notices to attend annual general meetings no earlier than six weeks and no later than four weeks prior to the annual general meeting and the same notice period requirements apply regarding extraordinary general meetings concerning changes in our articles of association. Notices to attend other types of extraordinary general meetings at Ericsson must be published no earlier than six weeks and no later than three weeks prior to the general meeting.

Directors are elected during the annual general meeting for a period of one year at a time and do not stand for reelection at staggered intervals.

A shareholder may attend and vote at the meeting in person or by proxy. For companies whose shares are registered in a central securities depositary register, proxies are valid for up to five years from the date of issuance. Any shareholder wishing to attend a general meeting must notify us no later than on the day specified in the notice. We are required to accept all notifications of attendance received at least five business days (Saturdays normally included) prior to the meeting. A person designated in the register as a nominee (including the depositary of the ADSs) is not entitled to vote at a general meeting, nor is a beneficial owner whose share is registered in the name of a nominee (including the depositary of the ADSs) unless the beneficial owner first arranges to have such owner’s own name entered in the register of shareholders maintained by Euroclear no later than the designated record day.

Under the Swedish Companies Act, elections are determined by a plurality vote. Resolutions, other than elections, are passed by a simple majority of votes cast at the meeting with the chairman of the meeting having a decisive vote, unless otherwise required by law or a company’s articles of association. Under the Swedish Companies Act, certain resolutions require special quorums and majorities, including, but not limited to, the following:

 

  a) a resolution to amend the articles of association requires a majority of two-thirds of the votes cast as well as two-thirds of the shares represented at the meeting, except in those circumstances described in b—d below;

 

  b) a resolution to amend the articles of association which reduces any shareholder’s rights to profits or assets, restricts the transferability of shares or alters the legal relationship between shares, normally requires the unanimous approval of the shareholders present at the meeting and who hold nine-tenths of all outstanding shares;

 

28


Table of Contents
  c) a resolution to amend the articles of association for the purpose of limiting the number of shares with which a shareholder may vote at a general meeting or allocating part of the net profit for the fiscal year to a restricted fund or limiting the use of the company’s profits or assets in a liquidation or dissolution, normally requires the approval of shareholders representing two-thirds of the votes cast and nine-tenths of the shares represented at the meeting;

 

  d) a resolution of the kind referred to under B or C above may, however, be taken with a lower supermajority requirement if the amendments referred to therein will only adversely affect specific shares or classes of shares. In such cases, the requirement under a above will apply together with the following separate supermajority: (a) where only a class of shares is adversely affected, approval of the owners of one-half of all shares of such class and nine-tenths of the shares of such class represented at the meeting, or (b) where the shares adversely affected do not constitute a class of shares, the unanimous approval of all such affected outstanding shares present at the meeting and who hold nine-tenths of all outstanding shares adversely affected;

 

  e) a resolution to issue, approve or authorize the issuance for cash of new shares, warrants or convertibles with a deviation from the preferential right for existing shareholders requires a two-thirds majority of votes cast at the meeting as well as two-thirds of the shares represented at the meeting;

 

  f) a resolution to reduce the outstanding share capital requires a two-thirds majority of votes cast at the meeting as well as two-thirds of the shares represented at the meeting. In case there are several classes of shares in a company, the above described majority requirement shall apply also within each share class represented at the meeting and for which the rights of the shares are adversely affected; and

 

  g) a resolution to approve a merger requires a two-thirds majority of the votes cast at the meeting and two-thirds of the shares represented at the meeting (however, under certain circumstances a higher majority is required).

At a general meeting of shareholders, a shareholder or proxy for one or more shareholders may cast full number of votes represented by the holder’s shares.

Purchase of Own Shares

A Swedish public limited liability company whose shares are traded on a regulated market place within the European Economic Area (“EEA”) or a market place comparable to a regulated market place outside the EEA is entitled to purchase its own shares under certain conditions. A purchase by us of our own shares may take place only if (a) the purchase has been decided upon by a general meeting of shareholders or the Board has been authorized by a general meeting of shareholders, in both cases by a two thirds majority of votes cast at the meeting as well as two-thirds of the shares represented at the meeting, (b) the purchase is effected on a regulated market place within the EEA or a market place comparable to a regulated market place outside the EEA (in the latter case with the approval of the Swedish Financial Supervisory Authority the “SFSA”) or pursuant to an offer to all shareholders or holders of a specific class of shares, (c) the Company’s restricted equity will still be fully covered and the purchase is justifiable taken into account the type of business activities of the Company and the group, their scope and risks related thereto and the Company’s and the group’s need for financial resources, their liquidity and financial position, and (d) we and our subsidiaries do not hold or, as a result of purchase, will not hold in excess of 10% of all our outstanding shares. As of December 31, 2016, the Company held an aggregate of 62,192,390 treasury stock of Class B shares.

Investment Restrictions

There are no limitations imposed by Swedish law or by our Articles of Association in respect of the rights of non-residents or foreign persons to purchase, own or sell securities issued by us.

There are, however, certain flagging and ownership examination rules that apply, irrespective of nationality.

Pursuant to the Swedish Financial Instruments Trading Act any change in a holding of shares, depository receipts with voting rights or financial instruments that entitle the holder to acquire shares in issue in a Swedish limited liability company whose shares are admitted for trading on a regulated market place within the EEA shall be reported

 

29


Table of Contents

by the holder to the company and the SFSA, where the change entails that the holder’s portion of all shares or votes in the company reaches, exceeds or falls below any of the limits of 5, 10, 15, 20, 25, 30, 50, 66 2/3 or 90 per cent. Such a change should, as a main rule, be reported not later than three trading days following the day on which the party with a duty to report has entered into an agreement for the acquisition or transfer of shares or any other change to the shareholding has occurred.

In addition, the EU Market Abuse Regulation requires, among other things, that the Company holds a register of all persons discharging managerial responsibilities and of persons closely associated with them. The Company and the SFSA must be notified of certain transactions conducted by the aforementioned persons. Such notifications shall be made no later than three business days after the date of the transaction.

 

C. Material Contracts

The information set forth under the following headings of the 2016 Swedish Annual Report is incorporated herein by reference:

 

    Financials – Board of Directors’ report

 

    Material contracts

 

D. Exchange Controls

There is no Swedish legislation affecting the import or export of capital or the remittance of dividends, interest or other payments to non-resident holders of our securities, except that, subject to the provisions in any tax treaty, dividends are subject to withholding tax.

 

E. Taxation

General

The taxation discussion set forth below does not purport to be a complete analysis or listing of all potential tax effects relevant to the acquisition, ownership or disposition of Class B shares or ADSs. The statements of United States and Swedish tax laws set forth below are based on the laws in force as of the date of this report and may be subject to any changes in United States or Swedish law, and in any double taxation convention or treaty between the United States and Sweden, occurring after that date, which changes may then have retroactive effect.

Specific tax provisions may apply for certain categories of taxpayers. Your tax treatment if you are a holder of Class B shares or ADSs depends in part on your particular situation. If you are a holder of Class B shares or ADSs, you should therefore consult a tax advisor as to the tax consequences relating to your particular circumstances resulting from the ownership of Class B shares or ADSs.

The tax consequences to holders of ADSs, as discussed below, apply equally to holders of Class B shares.

Certain Swedish Tax Considerations

This section describes the material Swedish income and net wealth tax consequences for a holder of ADSs or Class B shares who is not considered to be a Swedish resident for Swedish tax purposes. This section applies to you only if you are a holder of portfolio investments representing less than 10% of capital and votes and is not applicable if the ADSs or Class B shares pertain to a permanent establishment or fixed place of business in Sweden.

Taxation on Capital Gains

Generally, non-residents of Sweden are not liable for Swedish capital gains taxation with respect to the sale of ADSs or Class B shares. However, under Swedish tax law, capital gains from the sale of shares in Swedish companies and certain other securities by an individual may be taxed in Sweden at a rate of 30% if the seller has been a resident of Sweden or has lived permanently in Sweden at any time during the year of the sale or the 10 calendar years preceding the year of the sale (absent treaty provisions to the contrary). The provision is applicable to ADSs or Class B shares. From January 1, 2008, the rule has been extended so that it also applies to shares in foreign companies, provided that the shares were acquired during the time that the person was liable to tax in Sweden.

 

30


Table of Contents

This provision may, however, be limited by tax treaties that Sweden has concluded with other countries. Under the tax treaty between Sweden and the United States (the “U.S. Tax Treaty”), this provision applies for ten years from the date the individual became a non-resident of Sweden.

Taxation on Dividends

A Swedish dividend withholding tax at a rate of 30% is imposed on dividends paid by a Swedish corporation, such as us, to non-residents of Sweden. The same withholding tax applies to certain other payments made by a Swedish corporation, including payments as a result of redemption of shares and repurchase of stock through an offer directed to its shareholders. Exemption from the withholding tax or a lower tax rate may apply by virtue of a tax treaty. Under the U.S. Tax Treaty, the withholding tax on dividends paid on portfolio investments to eligible U.S. holders is reduced to 15%.

Under all Swedish tax treaties, except the tax treaty with Switzerland, withholding tax at the applicable treaty rate should be withheld by the payer of the dividends. With regard to dividends paid from shares in corporations registered with the Euroclear Sweden (such as our shares), a reduced rate of dividend withholding tax under a tax treaty is generally applied at the source by the Euroclear Sweden or, if the shares are registered with a nominee, the nominee, as long as the person entitled to the dividend is registered as a non-resident and sufficient information regarding the tax residency of the beneficial owner is available to the Euroclear Sweden or the nominee.

In those cases where Swedish withholding tax is withheld at the rate of 30% and the person who received the dividends is entitled to a reduced rate of withholding tax under a tax treaty, a refund may be claimed from the Swedish tax authorities before the end of the fifth calendar year following the year that the distribution was made.

Taxation on Interest

No Swedish withholding tax is payable on interest paid to non-residents of Sweden.

Net Wealth Taxation

The Swedish net wealth tax has been abolished from January 1, 2007.

Certain United States Federal Income Tax Consequences

The following discussion is a summary of the material United States federal income tax consequences relevant to the ownership and disposition of ADSs or Class B shares. This discussion is based on the tax laws of the United States (including the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “Code”), its legislative history, existing and proposed regulations thereunder, published rulings and court decisions) as in effect on the date hereof, all of which are subject to change, possibly with retroactive effect. The discussion is not a full discussion of all tax considerations that may be relevant to the ownership and disposition of ADSs or Class B shares, and does not address the Medicare tax on net investment income or the effects of any state, local or foreign tax laws. The discussion applies only if you will hold the ADSs and/or the Class B shares as capital assets and you use the USD as your functional currency. It does not deal with the tax treatment of investors subject to special rules, such as grantor trusts, real estate investment trusts, regulated investment companies, banks, brokers or dealers in securities or currencies, traders in securities that elect to use a mark-to-market method of recording for their securities holdings, financial institutions, insurance companies, tax-exempt entities, investors liable for alternative minimum tax, holders (either actually or constructively) of 10% or more of the voting power of our shares, persons holding ADSs and/or Class B shares as part of a hedging, straddle, conversion or constructive sale transaction and persons who are resident or ordinarily resident in Sweden. In addition, investors holding ADSs and/or Class B shares indirectly through partnerships are subject to special rules not discussed below. You should consult your own tax advisors about the United States federal, state, local and foreign tax consequences to you of the ownership and disposition of the ADSs or Class B shares.

The discussion below applies to you only if you are a beneficial owner of ADSs and/or Class B shares not resident in Sweden for purposes of the U.S. Tax Treaty and you are, for United States federal income tax purposes, (1) a citizen or resident of the United States, (2) a corporation or any other entity treated as a corporation that is organized in or under the laws of the United States or its political subdivisions, including the District of Columbia, (3) a trust if

 

31


Table of Contents

all of the trust’s substantial decisions are subject to the control of one or more United States persons and the primary supervision of the trust is subject to a United States court, or if a valid election is in effect with respect to the trust to be taxed as a United States person, or (4) an estate the income of which is subject to United States federal income taxation regardless of its source.

The discussion below assumes that the representations contained in the deposit agreement governing the ADSs are true and that the obligations in the deposit agreement and any related agreement will be complied with in accordance with the terms. If you hold ADSs, you will be treated as the holder of the underlying Class B shares represented by those ADSs for United States federal income tax purposes.

Dividends

Subject to the passive foreign investment company rules discussed below, the gross amount of dividends paid (before reduction for any Swedish withholding taxes) with respect to the ADSs or Class B shares generally will be included in your gross income as ordinary income from foreign sources to the extent paid out of our current or accumulated earnings and profits (as determined for United States federal income tax purposes). Distributions in excess of earnings and profits will be treated as a non-taxable return of capital to the extent of your adjusted tax basis in the ADSs or Class B shares and thereafter as capital gain. The dividends will not be eligible for the dividends received deduction available to corporations in respect of dividends received from other U.S. corporations. The amount of any dividend paid in SEK will be the USD value of the dividend payment based on the exchange rate in effect on the date of receipt (or constructive receipt) by you, in the case of Class B shares, or by the depositary, in the case of ADSs, whether or not the payment is converted into USD at that time. Your tax basis in the SEK received will equal such USD amount. Gain or loss, if any, recognized on a subsequent sale or conversion of the SEK will be U.S. source ordinary income or loss.

If you are a non-corporate holder of ADSs or Class B shares, dividends you receive on the ADSs or Class B shares may be taxed at the lower applicable long-term capital gains rate provided that (1) we are not a passive foreign investment company (as discussed below) for either our taxable year in which the dividend was paid or the preceding taxable year, (2) certain holding period requirements are met, (3) you are not under any obligation to make related payments with respect to substantially similar or related property and (4) either (a) in the case of ADSs our ADSs continue to be listed on the Nasdaq Stock Market (or a national securities exchange that is registered under section 6 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended) or (b) we are eligible for the benefits of the U.S. Tax Treaty. You should consult your own tax advisors regarding the availability of the lower rate for dividends paid with respect to ADSs or Class B shares.

Subject to certain limitations, you will generally be entitled to receive credit against your United States federal income tax liability (or a deduction against your United States federal taxable income) with respect to any Swedish tax withheld in accordance with the U.S. Tax Treaty and paid over to Sweden. If a refund of the tax withheld is available to you under the laws of Sweden or under the U.S. Tax Treaty, the amount of tax withheld that is refundable will not be eligible for such credit against your United States federal income tax liability (and will not be eligible for the deduction in computing your United States federal taxable income). For foreign tax credit limitation purposes, dividends will be income from sources without the United States, and will generally be treated as “passive category income” (or, in the case of certain holders, “general category income”).

Sale or Exchange of ADSs or Class B shares

Subject to the passive foreign investment company rules discussed below, you will generally recognize capital gain or loss on the sale or other disposition of the ADSs or Class B shares equal to the difference between the USD value of the amount realized and your adjusted tax basis (determined in USD) in the ADSs or Class B shares. Such gain or loss will generally be long-term capital gain or loss if you have held the ADSs or Class B shares for more than one year, and will generally be treated as arising from U.S. sources for foreign tax credit limitation purposes. If you are a non-corporate holder of ADSs or Class B Shares, long-term capital gains are eligible for reduced rates of taxation. The deductibility of capital losses is subject to limitations.

The amount realized on a disposition of ADSs or Class B shares for cash will generally be the amount of cash you receive for the ADSs or Class B shares (which, in the case of payment in a non-U.S. currency, will equal the USD value of the payment received determined on (a) the date of receipt of payment if you are a cash basis taxpayer and (b) the date of disposition if you are an accrual basis taxpayer). If the ADSs or Class B shares are treated as traded on an

 

32


Table of Contents

“established securities market,” if you are a cash basis taxpayer (or, if you are an accrual basis taxpayer, if you so elect) you will determine the USD value of the amount realized by translating the amount received at the spot rate of exchange on the settlement date of the sale.

You will have a tax basis in any foreign currency received equal to the USD value thereof on the date of receipt. Any gain or loss you realize on a subsequent sale or conversion of foreign currency will be U.S. source ordinary income or loss.

Passive Foreign Investment Company Status

A non-U.S. corporation is a passive foreign investment company (a “PFIC”) in any taxable year in which, after taking into account the income and assets of certain subsidiaries, either (a) at least 75% of its gross income is passive income or (b) at least 50% of the quarterly average value of its assets is attributable to assets that produce or are held to produce passive income. Based on the market value of our shares, the composition of our assets and income and our operations, we believe we were not a PFIC during the year 2016. However, whether or not we will be considered a PFIC will depend on the nature and source of our income and the composition and value of our assets, as determined from time to time. If we are treated as a PFIC, we will not provide information necessary for the “qualified electing fund” election as the term is defined in the relevant provisions of the Code. You should consult your own tax advisors about the consequences of our potential classification as a PFIC.

If we were classified as a PFIC with respect to your ADSs or Class B shares for any taxable year we would generally continue to be a PFIC (unless certain conditions are met) and you would be subject to special rules with respect to:

 

    any gain realized on the sale or other disposition of ADSs or Class B shares; or

 

    any other “excess distribution” made to you (generally, any distributions to you in respect of ADSs or Class B shares during a single taxable year that are, in the aggregate, greater than 125% of the average annual distributions received by you in respect of ADSs or Class B shares during the three preceding taxable years or, if shorter, your holding period for ADSs or Class B shares).

Under these rules:

 

    the gain or any other excess distribution would be allocated ratably over your holding period for ADSs or Class B shares;

 

    the amount allocated to the taxable year in which the gain or excess distribution was realized and any year before we became a PFIC would be taxable as ordinary income and

 

    the amount allocated to each prior year, other than the current year and any taxable year prior to the first taxable year in which we were a PFIC, would be subject to tax at the highest applicable marginal tax rate in effect for each such year; and an interest charge would be imposed.

If we are a PFIC for any taxable year, you will also be deemed to own shares in any of our subsidiaries that are also PFICs in such a year. As an alternative to the special rules described above, holders of “marketable stock” in a PFIC may elect mark-to-market treatment with respect to their ADSs or Class B shares. ADSs or Class B shares will not be considered marketable stock unless they are regularly traded on a qualified exchange or other market. If the mark-to-market election is available and you elect mark-to-market treatment you will, in general, include as ordinary income each year an amount equal to the increase in value of your ADSs or Class B shares for that year (measured at the close of your taxable year) and will generally be allowed a deduction for any decrease in the value of your ADSs or Class B shares for the year, but only to the extent of previously included mark-to-market income. In addition, any gain you recognize upon the sale or other disposition of the ADSs or Class B shares will be treated as ordinary income and any loss will be treated as ordinary loss, but only to the extent of previously included mark-to-market income. Any loss in excess of previously included mark-to-market income will be treated as a capital loss. However, a mark-to-market election would likely be unavailable with respect to your proportionate share in any of our subsidiaries that are PFICs.

 

33


Table of Contents

If you own ADSs or Class B shares during any year in which we are a PFIC, you will generally be required to make an annual return on IRS Form 8621.

Information Reporting and Backup Withholding

In general, information reporting requirements will apply to dividends paid in respect of ADSs or Class B shares and the proceeds received on the sale or exchange of the ADSs or Class B shares within the United States or by a broker with certain United States connections. Backup withholding may apply to payments to you of dividends paid in respect of ADSs or Class B shares or the proceeds of a sale or other disposition of ADSs or Class B shares if you fail to provide an accurate taxpayer identification number (certified on IRS Form W–9) or, upon request, to certify that you are not subject to backup withholding, or otherwise to comply with the applicable requirements of the backup withholding rules. The amount of any backup withholding from a payment to you will be allowed as a credit against your United States federal income tax liability and a refund of any excess amount withheld under the backup withholding rules may be obtained by filing the appropriate claim for refund with the Internal Revenue Service and furnishing any required information.

Additional Reporting Requirements

Certain holders who are individuals may be required to report information relating to an interest in ADSs or Class B shares, subject to certain exceptions (including an exception for ADSs or Class B shares held in accounts maintained by certain financial institutions). Holders should consult their tax advisors regarding the effects, if any, of these requirements on their ownership and disposition of ADSs or Class B shares.

 

F. Dividends and Paying Agents

Not applicable.

 

G. Statement by Experts

Not applicable.

 

H. Documents on Display

Annual reports and other information are filed with, or furnished to, the SEC in the United States, pursuant to the rules and regulations that apply to foreign private issuers. Electronic access to these documents may be obtained from the SEC’s website, www.sec.gov, where they are stored in the EDGAR database.

 

I. Subsidiary Information

See “Item 4.C. Information on the Company – Organizational Structure.”

 

ITEM 11. QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK

 

A. Quantitative information about market risk

The information set forth under the section “Financials – Notes to the consolidated financial statements – Note C20 – Financial risk management and financial instruments” of the 2016 Swedish Annual Report is incorporated herein by reference.

 

34


Table of Contents
B. Qualitative information about market risk

The information set forth under the following headings of the 2016 Swedish Annual Report is incorporated herein by reference:

 

    Financials – Board of Directors’ report

 

    Risk management

 

    Notes to the consolidated financial statements

 

    Note C20 – Financial risk management and financial instruments

 

    Corporate Governance

 

    Corporate Governance report 2016

 

    Management – Risk management

 

C. Interim periods

Not applicable.

 

D. Safe harbor

Not applicable.

 

E. Small business issuers

Not applicable.

 

ITEM 12. DESCRIPTION OF SECURITIES OTHER THAN EQUITY SECURITIES

 

A. Debt Securities

Not applicable.

 

B. Warrants and Rights

Not applicable.

 

C. Other Securities

Not applicable.

 

D. American Depositary Shares

Depositary fees, charges and payments

On October 24, 2016, Ericsson and the depositary of our ADSs, Deutsche Bank Trust Company America (“Deutsche Bank”) agreed to an amendment to the Deposit Agreement with Deutsche Bank and holders of our ADRs. The Deposit Agreement, as amendment, is filed as an exhibit to this Annual Report on form 20-F. The disclosure below reflects the amendment.

 

35


Table of Contents

Fees and charges payable by ADS holders

 

    

Service

  

Rate

  

By whom paid

1)

   Receipt of deposits and issuance of receipts    Up to USD 5 per 100 American Depositary Shares of fraction thereof    Party to whom receipts are issued

2)

   Delivery of deposited shares against surrender of receipts    Up to USD 5 per 100 American Depositary Shares or fraction thereof    Party surrendering receipts

3)

   Distribution of Cash Dividends and Cash Proceeds    Up to USD 3 per 100 American Depositary Shares    All holders of American Depositary Shares

4)

   Administration of the ADSs    Up to USD 3 per 100 American Depositary Shares per annum    All holders of American Depositary Shares

Except as otherwise provided in the Deposit Agreement, any and all other expenses of the depositary, including without limitation, expenses or charges for printing, stationery, postage, insurances, cables, etc, are to be borne by the depositary, or by the Company in accordance with agreements entered into from time to time with the Company.

Fees payable by the Depositary to the Issuer

Deutsche Bank has agreed to pay Ericsson a yearly fixed amount for revenues collected by Deutsche Bank as a result of charging issuance and cancellations fees and dividend or administrative fees from our ADS holders. In 2016, such amount received by Ericsson totalled approximately USD 8 million.

Deutsche Bank has further agreed to waive the costs associated with the administration of the ADS Program and reporting services. In 2016, the total amount of such expenses was approximately USD 78,000.

PART II

 

ITEM 13. DEFAULTS, DIVIDEND ARREARAGES AND DELINQUENCIES

None.

 

ITEM 14. MATERIAL MODIFICATIONS TO THE RIGHTS OF SECURITY HOLDERS AND USE OF PROCEEDS

None.

 

ITEM 15. CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES

 

A. Disclosure Controls and Procedures

The information set forth under the section “Corporate Governance – Corporate Governance report 2016 – Internal control over financial reporting 2016 – Disclosure controls and procedures” of the 2016 Swedish Annual Report is incorporated herein by reference.

 

B. Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

The information set forth under the section “Financials – Management’s report on internal control over financial reporting” of the 2016 Swedish Annual Report is incorporated herein by reference.

 

36


Table of Contents
C. Attestation Report of the Registered Public Accounting Firm

The information set forth under the section “Financials – Report of independent registered public accounting firm” of the 2016 Swedish Annual Report is incorporated herein by reference.

 

D. Changes in Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

The information set forth under the following headings of the 2016 Swedish Annual Report is incorporated herein by reference:

 

    Corporate Governance

 

    Corporate Governance report 2016

 

    Internal control over financial reporting 2016 – Internal control over financial reporting

 

    Financials

 

    Management’s report on internal control over financial reporting

 

ITEM 16. [RESERVED]

 

ITEM 16A. AUDIT COMMITTEE FINANCIAL EXPERT

The information set forth under the section “Corporate Governance – Corporate Governance report 2016 – Committees of the Board of Directors – Audit Committee – Members of the Audit Committee” of the 2016 Swedish Annual Report is incorporated herein by reference.

 

ITEM 16B. CODE OF ETHICS

The information set forth under the following headings of the 2016 Swedish Annual Report is incorporated herein by reference:

 

    The business

 

    Sustainability and corporate responsibility

 

    Financials – Board of Directors’ report

 

    Corporate Governance – Business integrity

 

    Corporate Governance

 

    Corporate governance report 2016

 

    Regulation and Compliance – Code of business ethics

Our Code of Business Ethics is included on our web site at www.ericsson.com/code-of-business-ethics . We intend to disclose any waivers to or amendments of our Code of Business Ethics for the benefit of our executive officers on our website to the extent public disclosure is required under applicable rules.

 

37


Table of Contents
ITEM 16C. PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTANT FEES AND SERVICES

The information set forth under the Section “Financials – Notes to the consolidated financial statements – Note C30 – Fees to auditors” of the 2016 Swedish Annual Report is incorporated herein by reference.

Audit committee pre-approval policies and procedures

The Audit Committee reviews and approves the scope of audits to be performed by external and internal auditors and analyzes their results and costs. The Committee keeps the Board of Directors informed about the external and internal auditors’ performance. It also makes recommendations to the Nomination Committee regarding the external auditor’s election and fees. In order to ensure the external auditor’s independence, the Audit Committee has established pre-approval policies and procedures for non-audit services to be performed by the external auditor. Pre-approval authority may not be delegated to management. The policies and procedures include a list of prohibited services and services that require pre-approval by the Committee. Such services fall into two broad categories:

 

    General pre-approval – certain services regarding taxes, transactions, risk management, business improvement, attestation and accounting services and the so called general services (other than prohibitted services) have received general pre-approval by the Audit Committee, provided that the estimated fee for each project does not exceed SEK 1 million. The external auditor must advise the Audit Committee with a quarterly summary of ongoing projects related to non-audit services and year-to-date report of fees and expenses for all audit and non-audit services.

 

    Specific pre-approval – all other non-audit services and services subject to general pre-approval exceeding SEK 1 million must receive specific pre-approval. The external auditor submits an application in writing to the Parent Company for final approval by the Audit Committee, including a statement as to whether, in the view of the external auditor, the contemplated services are consistent with applicable rules on their independence. The Audit Committee Chairman has the delegated authority for specific pre-approval in between Committee meetings, provided that the estimated fee in each case does not exceed SEK 2.5 million. The Chairman reports any pre-approval to the Audit Committee at its next meeting.

All services provided by the independent auditors were pre-approved in 2016.

 

ITEM 16D. EXEMPTIONS FROM THE LISTING STANDARDS FOR AUDIT COMMITTEES

All members of the Audit Committee of a NASDAQ New York-listed company must be independent in accordance with NASDAQ New York and SEC rules. SEC Rule 10A-3(b)(1)(iv)(C) under the Exchange Act includes a specific exemption from these independence requirements for Audit Committee members of foreign private issuers who are non-executive employee representatives appointed to the Audit Committee pursuant to local law. The Company relies on this exemption, and does not consider that such reliance materially adversely affects the ability of the Audit Committee to act independently or to satisfy other SEC requirements applicable to Audit Committees.

 

ITEM 16E. PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES BY THE ISSUER AND AFFILIATED PURCHASERS

None.

 

ITEM 16F. CHANGE IN REGISTRANT’S CERTIFYING ACCOUNTANT

None.

 

38


Table of Contents
ITEM 16G. CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

Ericsson, as a company whose shares are listed on NASDAQ New York, is subject to the listing requirements and certain of the corporate governance requirements of NASDAQ New York and to certain rules of the SEC.

All members of the Audit Committee of a NASDAQ New York- listed company must be independent in accordance with NASDAQ New York and SEC rules. SEC rules include a specific exemption from these independence requirements for Audit Committee members of foreign private issuers who are non-executive employee representatives appointed to the Audit Committee pursuant to local law. The Company relies on this exemption, and does not consider that such reliance materially adversely affects the ability of the Audit Committee to act independently or to satisfy other SEC requirements applicable to Audit Committees.

Under NASDAQ New York rules, Ericsson is permitted to follow home country practices in lieu of certain NASDAQ corporate governance requirements that would apply to US companies listed on NASDAQ New York. The rules require disclosures regarding the ways in which Ericsson’s corporate governance practices differ from those required of US companies under the rules of NASDAQ New York.

These differences include the following:

 

    Employee representatives are appointed to Ericsson’s Board of Directors and serve on Committees (including the Audit and the Remuneration Committees) in accordance with Swedish law.

 

    Employee representatives on the Ericsson Board and Committees may attend all meetings of the Board and committees on which they serve (including those of the Audit and the Remuneration Committees) in accordance with Swedish law.

 

    In accordance with Swedish market practices, the Nomination Committee is not fully comprised of Board members. In addition to the Chairman of the Board, representatives of the four largest shareholders are appointed as members of the Nomination Committee of Ericsson.

 

    The determination regarding independence of Board members is made by the Nomination Committee prior to the Annual General Meeting (“AGM”) instead of the Board. Before the AGM 2016, the Nomination Committee determined that the following Board members were independent under all applicable independence requirements, including the NASDAQ New York rules: Nora Denzel, Leif Johansson, Ulf J. Johansson, Kristin Skogen Lund, Kristin S. Rinne, and Sukhinder Singh Cassidy. When appointing members to the Committees of the Board, the Board of Directors makes determinations regarding Committee member independence.

 

    The Board of Directors holds non-executive Directors sessions but does not have regularly scheduled meetings with only independent directors present.

 

    Under applicable Swedish rules, we are not required to publicly disclose the material terms of all agreements and arrangements between any of our directors or nominees for directors and any person or entity (other than us) relating to compensation or other payment in connection with such person’s candidacy or service as a director of our company.

 

    The external auditor is elected by the shareholders and is proposed by the Nomination Committee upon recommendation from the Audit Committee.

 

    NASDAQ New York rules applicable to US companies require the consideration of six factors relating to the independence of compensation consultants, legal counsel or other advisers retained by compensation or remuneration committees. Consistent with Swedish practices, the Remuneration Committee’s procedures addressing independence of advisers do not expressly require the consideration of those six factors.

 

    Ericsson does not solicit proxies for shareholder meetings, which is in accordance with Swedish practices and rules.

 

39


Table of Contents
    There are no minimum quorum requirements for shareholder meetings under Swedish law, except under certain limited circumstances. Certain resolutions requiring special quorums and majorities are described under Memorandum and Articles of Association.

 

    Some of the requirements addressed by NASDAQ New York rules are included in the Swedish Corporate Governance Code or the work procedure for the Board of Directors instead of Committee charters. The work procedure establishes the attribution of various responsibilities among the Board, its Commit tees and the President and CEO. The work procedure for the Board is reviewed, evaluated and amended as required or appropriate, and adopted by the Board at least once a year.

See “Item 8.B. Financial Information – Significant Changes” herein.

 

ITEM 16H. MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURE

Not applicable.

PART III

 

ITEM 17. FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

See our consolidated financial statements and accompanying notes of the 2016 Swedish Annual Report.

 

    Consolidated income statement and Consolidated statement of comprehensive income

 

    Consolidated balance sheet

 

    Consolidated statement of cash flows

 

    Consolidated statement of changes in equity

 

    Notes to the consolidated financial statements

 

    Report of independent registered public accounting firm

 

ITEM 18. FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Not applicable.

 

ITEM 19. EXHIBITS

The exhibit index attached hereto is incorporate herein by reference.

 

40


Table of Contents

SIGNATURES

The registrant hereby certifies that it meets all of the requirements for filing on Form 20-F and that it has duly caused and authorized the undersigned to sign this Annual Report on Form 20-F on its behalf.

 

TELEFONAKTIEBOLAGET LM ERICSSON
By:  

/s/ R OLAND H AGMAN

Name:   Roland Hagman
Title:   Vice President, Group Controller
By:  

/s/ N INA M ACPHERSON

Name:   Nina Macpherson
Title:   Senior Vice President, Chief Legal Officer

Date: April 26, 2017

 

41


Table of Contents

EXHIBIT INDEX

The agreements and other documents filed as exhibits to this 2016 Form 20-F are not intended to provide factual information or other disclosure other than with respect to the terms of the agreements or other documents themselves, and you should not rely on them for that purpose. In particular, any representations and warranties made by the registrant in these agreements or other documents were made solely within the specific context of the relevant agreement or document and may not describe the actual state of affairs as of the date they were made or at any other time.

 

Exhibit
Number

  

Description

1    Articles of Association of Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson (amended April 2016)
2.1    Second Amended and Restated Deposit Agreement Among Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson (publ) and Deutsche Bank Trust Company Americas, as depositary, and holders of American Depositary Receipts, dated as of January 7, 2014 (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 2 to the Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended December 31, 2014 filed by the registrant on March 31, 2015 (File No. 000-12033 )
2.2    Amendment No. 1, dated as of October 24, 2016, to the Second Amended and Restated Deposit Agreement Among Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson (publ) and Deutsche Bank Trust Company Americas, as depositary, and holders of American Depositary Receipts, dated as of January 7, 2014
6    See “Financials – Notes to the consolidated financial statements – Note C1 - Significant accounting policies” of the 2016 Swedish Annual Report
7    For definitions of certain ratios used in this report, see the section of the 2016 Swedish Annual Report entitled “Financial Terminology”
8    See Item 4.C. Organizational Structure
12.1    Certification of the Chief Executive Officer pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
12.2    Certification of the Chief Financial Officer pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
13.1*    Certification of the Chief Executive Officer pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
13.2*    Certification of the Chief Financial Officer pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
15.1**    Swedish Annual Report for 2016 in English (adjusted version)
15.2    Consent of PriceWaterhouseCoopers AB

 

* This certification will not be deemed “filed” for purposes of Section 18 of the Exchange Act (15 U.S.C. §78r), or otherwise subject to the liability of that section. Such certification will not be deemed to be incorporated by reference into any filing under the Securities Act or the Exchange Act, except to the extent that the Registrant specifically incorporates it by reference.
** Certain of the information included in Exhibit 15.1is incorporated by reference into this 2016 Form 20-F, as specified elsewhere in this report, in accordance with Rule 12b-23(a)(3) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended. With the exception of the items so specified, the 2016 Swedish Annual Report is not deemed to be filed as part of this 2016 Form 20-F.

 

42

Exhibit 1

TRANSLATION

ARTICLES OF ASSOCIATION

OF

TELEFONAKTIEBOLAGET LM ERICSSON

STOCKHOLM

Org. No 556016-0680

§ 1

The name of the Company is Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson. The company is a public company (publ).

§ 2

The objects of the Company are to, directly or indirectly, develop, construct, produce, sell and deliver and in other forms carry on trade and other commercial business related to goods, products and other equipment as well as maintenance and other services based on telecommunication and radio technology and other technologies for transference, transmission and other communications of speech, data, images, text, other kinds of information and means of payment and to carry on other activities consistent therewith.

§ 3

The Registered Office of the Board of Directors of the Company is in Stockholm.

§ 4

The Share Capital shall amount to no less than six thousand million (6,000,000,000) kronor and no more than twentyfour thousand million (24,000,000,000) kronor.

§ 5

The number of Shares shall amount to no less than 3,000,000,000 and no more than 12,000,000,000.

§ 6

Shares may be issued in three classes, series A, series B and series C. Shares of series A may be issued to a maximum amount of 12,000,000,000, Shares of series B to a maximum amount of 12,000,000,000, and Shares of series C to a maximum amount of 40,000,000. In voting at a General Meeting each Share of series A confers one vote, each Share of series B one tenth part of one vote and each Share of series C one thousandth part of one vote. Shares of series C do not entitle to dividend.

 

1


§ 7

If the Company decides to issue new series A, B and series C shares through a cash issue or an issue against payment through set-off of claims, each owner of series A, B and C shares has a pre-emptive right to subscribe to new shares of the same type in proportion to the number of old shares that the shareholder owns (primary pre-emptive rights). Shares not subscribed through primary pre-emptive rights shall be offered for subscription to all shareholders (subsidiary pre-emptive rights). If the number of shares so offered is less than the number subscribed through subsidiary pre-emptive rights, the shares shall be distributed among the subscribers in proportion to the number of old shares they own or, to the extent that is not possible, by lot.

If the Company decides to issue through a cash issue or an issue against payment through set-off of claims new shares either of series A, B or series C only, all shareholders, regardless of whether their shares are series A, B or series C, are entitled to pre-emptive rights to subscribe to the new shares in proportion to the number of old shares they own.

If the Company decides to issue warrants or convertibles through a cash issue or an issue against payment through set-off of claims, the shareholders have pre-emptive rights to subscribe to warrants as if the issue were of the shares that may be subscribed to pursuant to the warrant and, respectively, pre-emptive rights to subscribe to convertibles as if the issue were of the shares that the convertibles may be converted to.

The above conditions shall not restrict in any way the possibility of deciding on a cash issue or an issue against payment through set-off of claims entailing exceptions to the shareholders’ pre-emptive rights.

In the case of an increase in share capital through a bonus issue, new shares of each series shall be issued in proportion to the number of shares of the same type previously on issue. In such a case, old shares of each type entitle the holder to new shares of the same type. The aforesaid shall not restrict in any way the possibility of issuing shares of a new type through a bonus issue after the requisite changes have been made in the Articles of Association.

§ 8

The Company’s shares shall be registered in a central securities depository register pursuant to the Financial Instruments Accounts Act (Sw: lagen (1998:1479) om kontoföring av finansiella instrument).

§ 9

The Board of Directors shall consist of no fewer than five and no more than twelve Directors with no more than six Deputy Directors.

§ 10

The Company shall as Auditor have no fewer than one and no more than three registered public accounting firms.

The Board of Directors is authorized to appoint one or several special auditors to audit such statements or plans prepared by the Board of Directors in accordance with the

 

2


Companies Act (2005:551) in relation to such an issue of shares, warrants or convertibles with provisions on non-cash consideration or that subscription shall be made against payment through set-off of claims or other provisions, transfer of own shares against non-cash consideration, reduction of the share capital or the statutory reserve, merger or division of limited companies.

§ 11

The financial year of the Company shall be the calendar year.

§ 12

The following matters shall be dealt with at the Annual General Meeting:

 

  1. election of a Chairman at the General Meeting;

 

  2. preparation and approval of a voting list;

 

  3. approval of the agenda;

 

  4. examination whether the Meeting has been properly convened;

 

  5. election of two persons to check the minutes;

 

  6. presentation of the Annual Report and the Auditors’ report and of the Consolidated Accounts and the Auditors’ report on the Group;

 

  7. resolutions in respect to

 

  a. adoption of the Profit and Loss Statement and the Balance Sheet and of the Consolidated Profit and Loss Statement and the Consolidated Balance Sheet,

 

  b. the Directors’ and the Managing Directors’ discharge from liability,

 

  c. appropriation of the Company’s profit or loss according to the adopted Balance Sheet;

 

  8. determining the number of Directors, Deputy Directors and Auditors;

 

  9. determining the remuneration payable to the Board of Directors and to Auditor;

 

  10. elections of Directors and of Deputy Directors;

 

  11. elections of Auditor;

 

  12. other matters which shall be dealt with at the Meeting.

§ 13

Notice convening a General Meeting shall be issued through announcement in Post- och Inrikes Tidningar as well as at the Company’s website. Announcement to the effect that notice convening a General Meeting has been issued shall be made in Dagens Nyheter and Svenska Dagbladet.

§ 14

In order to be admitted to a General Meeting, a Shareholder shall have given notice of his attendance to the company not later than the day mentioned in the notice convening the Meeting, at which time also the number of advisors shall be stated. This day may not be a Sunday, another public holiday, Saturday, Midsummer Eve, Christmas Eve or New Year’s Eve and may not fall earlier than five weekdays before the General Meeting.

§ 15

The Company’s Board of Directors is authorized to decide on a reduction of the share capital through redemption of all series C shares.

 

3


In conjunction with the adoption of a resolution regarding redemption, holders of series C shares shall be obliged to surrender their shares for an amount equal to the ratio value of the shares. Payment of the redemption amount shall take place immediately.

§ 16

The Company’s Board of Directors is authorized to convert all series C shares to shares of series B when the Company holds the shares. Conversion shall be notified for registration without delay and be effected upon registration.

 

 

April 2016

 

4

Exhibit 2.2

AMENDMENT NO. 1 TO DEPOSIT AGREEMENT

AMENDMENT No.  1 dated as of October 24, 2016 (the “Amendment”) to the Second Amended and Restated Deposit Agreement dated as of January 7, 2014 (the “Deposit Agreement”) among (i) Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson, a public company incorporated under the laws of Sweden, and its successors (the “Company”), (ii) Deutsche Bank Trust Company Americas, an indirect wholly owned subsidiary of Deutsche Bank A.G., acting in its capacity as depositary, and any successor depositary hereunder (the “Depositary”), and (iii) all Holders from time to time of American Depositary Receipts issued thereunder.

W I T N E S S E T H :

WHEREAS, the Company and the Depositary executed the Deposit Agreement for the purposes set forth therein; and

WHEREAS, pursuant to Section 6.01 of the Deposit Agreement, the Company and the Depositary desire to amend certain terms of the Deposit Agreement and American Depositary Receipts.

NOW, THEREFORE , for good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the Company and the Depositary hereby agree to amend the Deposit Agreement and the American Depositary Receipts, effective as of the dates set forth in Section 4.01 hereof, as follows:

ARTICLE I

DEFINITIONS

SECTION 1.01. Definitions . Unless otherwise defined in this Amendment, all capitalized terms used, but not otherwise defined, herein shall have the meaning given to such terms in the Deposit Agreement.

 

1


ARTICLE II

AMENDMENTS TO DEPOSIT AGREEMENT AND AMERICAN DEPOSITARY RECEIPTS

SECTION 2.01. All references in the Deposit Agreement and the American Depositary Receipts to the term “Deposit Agreement” shall, as of the dates set forth in Section 4.01 hereof with respect to particular sections below, refer to the Deposit Agreement, as amended by this Amendment.

SECTION 2.02 . The second sentence of the third paragraph of each of Section 4.07 of the Deposit Agreement and Paragraph (17) of the form of American Depositary Receipt and each outstanding American Depositary Receipt, are each amended to read as follows:

If the Depositary timely receives blocking and voting instructions from a Holder that fails to specify the manner in which the Depositary is to vote the Deposited Securities represented by such Holder’s ADSs on one or more matters presented at the relevant meeting, the Depositary will deem such Holder to have instructed the Depositary to abstain on those items for which the Holder failed to specify the manner in which the Depositary is to vote.

SECTION 2.03. The two references to “U.S.$ 2.00 per 100 ADSs” contained in Paragraph (6) of the form of American Depositary Receipt and each outstanding American Depositary Receipt are each amended to read “U.S. $ 3.00 per 100 ADSs.”

SECTION 2.04. The introductory paragraph of the form of American Depositary Receipt and each outstanding American Depositary Receipt is amended by replacing “Skandinaviska Enskilda Banken AB” with “the Custodian under the Deposit Agreement”.

SECTION 2.05. The references to “Up to $2 per 100 American Depositary Shares” and “ Up to $2 per 100 American Depositary Shares per annum” contained in Exhibit B of the Deposit Agreement are amended to read “Up to $3 per 100 American Depositary Shares” and “ Up to $3 per 100 American Depositary Shares per annum”, respectively.

 

2


SECTION 2.06. The form of American Depositary Receipt and each outstanding American Depositary Receipt, and the form of Exhibit B to the Deposit Agreement, each after giving effect to the amendments contained herein and other clarifying changes, are attached hereto as Exhibit A (for the form of American Depositary Receipt) and Exhibit B (for Exhibit B to the Deposit Agreement), respectively.

ARTICLE III

REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES

SECTION 3.01. Representations and Warranties of the Company .

Representations and Warranties . The Company represents and warrants to, and agrees with, the Depositary and the Holders, that:

(a) This Amendment, when executed and delivered by the Company, and the Deposit Agreement, as amended by this Amendment, will be, and the Deposit Agreement previously entered into has been, respectively, duly and validly authorized, executed and delivered by the Company, and each constitutes the legal, valid and binding obligation of the Company, enforceable against the Company in accordance with its respective terms, subject to applicable bankruptcy, insolvency, fraudulent transfer, moratorium and similar laws of general applicability relating to or affecting creditors’ rights and to general equity principles; and

(b) In order to ensure the legality, validity, enforceability or admissibility into evidence of this Amendment or the Deposit Agreement as amended hereby, and any other document furnished hereunder or thereunder in the Kingdom of Sweden, neither of such agreements need to be filed or recorded with any court or other authority in the Kingdom of Sweden.

 

3


Section  3.02 Representations and Warranties of the Depositary . The Depositary represents and warrants to the Company that this Amendment, when executed and delivered by Depositary, and the Deposit Agreement, as amended by this Amendment, will be duly and validly authorized, executed and delivered by the Depositary, and each constitutes the legal, valid and binding obligation of the Depositary, enforceable against the Depositary in accordance with its respective terms, subject to bankruptcy, insolvency, fraudulent transfer, moratorium and similar laws of general applicability relating to or affecting creditors’ rights and to general equity principles.

ARTICLE IV

MISCELLANEOUS

Section  4.01 Effective Date . This Amendment is dated as of the date set forth above and shall be effective as of the date hereof, provided, however, that the amendments set forth in Sections 2.02, 2.03 and 2.05 hereof shall not become effective until the open of business (NY time) thirty days from the date the Depositary first notifies Holders of the same.

Section  4.02 Outstanding American Depositary Receipts . American Depositary Receipts issued prior to the date hereof, which do not reflect the changes to the form of American Depositary Receipt effected hereby, do not need to be called in for exchange and may remain outstanding until such time as the Holders thereof choose to surrender them for any reason under the Deposit Agreement, as amended by this Amendment. The Depositary is authorized and directed to take any and all actions deemed necessary to effect the foregoing.

 

4


Holders and holders of American Depositary Shares issued prior to the date hereof and outstanding as of the date hereof, shall, from and after the date hereof, be deemed Holders and holders of American Depositary Shares issued pursuant and be subject to all of the terms and conditions of the Deposit Agreement, as amended by this Amendment, in all respects.

Section  4.03 Indemnification . The parties hereto accept and shall be entitled to the benefits of the indemnification provisions of Section 5.08 of the Deposit Agreement in connection with any and all liability it or they may incur as a result of the terms of this Amendment and the transactions contemplated herein.

Section  4.04 Governing Law . THIS AMENDMENT AND THE RIGHTS AND OBLIGATIONS OF THE PARTIES HEREUNDER SHALL BE CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH AND GOVERNED BY NEW YORK LAW.

Section  4.05 Counterparts . This Amendment may be executed in any number of counterparts, all of which taken together shall constitute one and the same instrument.

 

5


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Company and the Depositary have caused this Amendment to be executed by representatives hereunto duly authorized as of the date set forth above.

 

TELEFONAKTIEBOLAGET LM ERICSSON
(publ)  
By:   LOGO
 

 

Name:   Jan Frykhammar
Title:   President and CEO
By:   LOGO
 

 

Name:   Carl Mellander
Title:   Senior Vice President and CFO
DEUTSCHE BANK TRUST COMPANY AMERICAS, as the Depositary
By:   LOGO
 

 

Name:  

Christopher Konopelko

Title:  

Director

By:   LOGO
 

 

Name:  

Michael Fitzpatrick

Title:  

Vice President

 

6


Exhibit A

AMERICAN DEPOSITARY RECEIPT

AMERICAN DEPOSITARY SHARES

representing

DEPOSITED B SHARES OF

TELEFONAKTIEBOLAGET LM ERICSSON

(A Public Company Incorporated Under The Laws Of Sweden)

No.

DEUTSCHE BANK TRUST COMPANY AMERICAS , as Depositary (herein called the Depositary), hereby certifies that                      is the owner of                      American Depositary Shares, representing deposited B shares (such B shares are hereinafter referred to as Shares), without nominal value, of TELEFONAKTIEBOLAGET LM ERICSSON, a public company incorporated under the laws of Sweden (herein called the Company). At the date hereof, each American Depositary Share represents one (1) Share (or evidence of rights to receive one Share) deposited under the Deposit Agreement at the principal Stockholm office of the Custodian under the Deposit Agreement (herein called the Custodian). The address of the Depositary’s principal executive office is 60 Wall Street, New York, New York 10005, U.S.A.

(1) The Deposit Agreement . This American Depositary Receipt is one of an issue of American Depositary Receipts (“Receipts” or “ADRs”), all issued and to be issued upon the terms and conditions set forth in the Second Amended and Restated Deposit Agreement dated as of January 7, 2014 (as so amended and as amended or supplemented from time to time, the “Deposit Agreement”), by and among the Company, the Depositary and all Holders from time to time of ADSs issued thereunder, each of whom by accepting an ADS becomes bound by all the terms and provisions thereof. The Deposit Agreement sets forth the rights of Holders of the Receipts and the rights and duties of the Depositary in respect of the Shares deposited thereunder and any and all other securities, property and cash from time to time received in respect of such Shares and held thereunder (such Shares, securities, property and cash are hereinafter referred to as Deposited Securities). Copies of the Deposit Agreement are on file at the principal offices of the Depositary and the Custodians. The statements made on the face and the reverse of this Receipt are summaries of certain provisions of the Deposit Agreement and are qualified by and subject to the detailed provisions of the’ Deposit Agreement, to which reference is hereby made. The terms “deposit”, “surrender”, “deliver”, “transfer” or “withdraw” when used with respect to Shares, shall refer, where the context requires, to an entry or entries or an electronic transfer or transfers in an account or accounts maintained by institutions authorized under applicable law to effect transfers of securities (which may but need not be Euroclear (as defined in paragraph (3) below)), and not to the physical transfer of certificates representing the Shares.

(2) Surrender of Receipts and Withdrawal of Shares . Upon surrender at the Principal Office of the Depositary of this Receipt, and upon payment of the fee of the Depositary provided in paragraph (6) of this Receipt, and subject to the terms and conditions of the Deposit Agreement, the Holder hereof is entitled to delivery, to him or upon his order, of the Deposited Securities at the time represented by the American Depositary Shares for which this Receipt is issued. Delivery of such Deposited Securities may be made by the delivery of certificates in the name of the Holder hereof or as ordered by him or by the delivery of certificates endorsed or accompanied by proper instruments of transfer. Such delivery will be made without unreasonable delay and, at the option of the Holder hereof, either at the office of any Custodian or at the Principal Office of the Depositary, provided that the forwarding of certificates for Shares or other Deposited Securities for such delivery at the Principal office of the Depositary in the Borough of Manhattan, The City of New York shall be at the risk and expense of the Holder hereof.

 

7


(3) Transfers, Split-ups and Combinations . This Receipt is transferable on the books of the Depositary by the Holder hereof in person or by duly authorized attorney, upon surrender of this Receipt properly endorsed or accompanied by proper instruments of transfer and duly stamped as may be required by law; provided, however, that the Depositary may close the transfer books, at any time or from time to time, when deemed expedient by it in connection with the performance of its duties under the Deposit Agreement. This Receipt may be split into other Receipts or may be combined with other Receipts into one Receipt, representing the same aggregate number of American Depositary Shares as the Receipt or Receipts surrendered. As a condition precedent to the execution and delivery, registration of transfer, split-up, combination or surrender of any Receipt or withdrawal of any Deposited Securities, the Depositary or the Custodian may require payment of a sum sufficient to reimburse it for any tax or other governmental charge and any stock transfer or registration fee with respect thereto and payment of any applicable fees as provided in paragraph (6) of this Receipt, may require the production of proof satisfactory to it as to the identity and genuineness of any signature and may also require compliance with such regulations, if any, as the Depositary may establish consistent with the provisions of the Deposit Agreement.

The Depositary may refuse to execute and deliver Receipts, register the transfer of any Receipt, make any distribution of, or related to, Deposited Securities until it has received such proof of citizenship, residence, exchange control approval or other information as it may deem necessary or proper. The delivery of Receipts against deposits of Shares generally may be suspended, or the delivery of Receipts against the deposit of particular Shares may be withheld, or the registration of transfer of Receipts in particular instances may be refused, or the registration of transfers or surrenders of Outstanding Receipts generally may be suspended, during any period when the transfer books of the Depositary or the Company (or the appointed agent of the Company for transfer and registration of Shares, which may but need not be Euroclear Sweden AB (“Euroclear”) or its successor as agent of the Company for the transfer and registration for Shares) are closed, or if any such action is deemed necessary or advisable by the Depositary or the Company at any time or from time to time due to compliance with any requirement of applicable law or governmental regulation relating to Receipts or to the withdrawal of any Deposited Securities. Without limitation of the foregoing, the Depositary will not knowingly accept for deposit under the Deposit Agreement any Shares which, if sold by the holder thereof in the United States or its territories, would be subject to the registration provisions of the Securities Act of 1933, unless a registration statement is in effect as to such Shares.

(4) Liability of Holder for Taxes . If any tax or other governmental charge shall become payable with respect to any Deposited Securities represented hereby, such tax or other governmental charge shall be payable by the Holder hereof to the Depositary. The Depositary may refuse to effect any registration of transfer of this Receipt or any withdrawal of Deposited Securities represented hereby until such payment is made, and may withhold any dividends or other distributions, or may sell for the account of the Holder hereof any part or all of the Deposited Securities represented hereby, and may apply such dividends or other distributions or the proceeds of any such sale in payment of such tax or other governmental charge, the Holder hereof remaining liable for any deficiency. Every Holder and Beneficial Owner agrees to, and shall, indemnify the Depositary, the Company, the Custodian and each and every of their respective officers, directors, employees, agents and Affiliates against, and hold each of them harmless from, any claims with respect to taxes, additions to tax (including applicable interest and penalties thereon) arising out of any refund of taxes or reduced rate of withholding at source or other tax benefit obtained for or by such Holder and/or Beneficial Owner.

The Depositary, the Custodian or the Company and its agents may, but shall not be obligated to, file such reports as are necessary to reduce or eliminate applicable taxes on dividends and on other distributions

 

8


in respect of Deposited Securities under applicable tax treaties or laws for the Holders and Beneficial Owners. Holders and Beneficial Owners of American Depositary Shares may be required from time to time, and in a timely manner, to file such proof of taxpayer status, residence and beneficial ownership (as applicable), to execute such certificates and to make such representations and warranties, or to provide any other information or documents, as the Depositary or the Custodian may deem necessary or proper to fulfill the Depositary’s or the Custodian’s obligations under applicable law.

(5) Warranties by Depositor . Every person depositing Shares under the Deposit Agreement shall be deemed thereby to represent and warrant that (i) such Shares and each certificate therefore are validly issued, fully paid, non-assessable and free of any pre-emption rights of the holders of outstanding Shares, (ii) the person making such deposit is duly authorized so to do, (iii) the Shares presented for deposit are free and clear of any lien, encumbrance, security interest, charge, mortgage or adverse claim, and are not, and the American Depositary Shares issuable upon such deposit will not be, Restricted Securities and (iv) the Shares presented for deposit have not been stripped of any rights or entitlements. If any such representations or warranties are false in any way, the Company and the Depositary shall be authorized, at the cost and expense of the person depositing Shares, to take any and all actions necessary to correct the consequences thereof. Such representations and warranties shall survive the deposit of Shares and issuance of Receipts.

(6) Charges of Depositary . The Depositary will charge the following fees for the services performed under the terms of the Deposit Agreement : (i) to any party to whom Receipts are delivered against deposits, and any party surrendering Receipts for delivery of Deposited Securities, a fee not in excess of $5.00 for each 100 American Depositary Shares (or portion thereof) represented by the Receipts issued or surrendered; (ii) to any holder of ADSs (including, without limitation, Holders), a fee not in excess of U.S. $ 3.00 per 100 ADSs held for the distribution of cash proceeds, including cash dividends or sale of rights and other entitlements, not made pursuant to a cancellation or withdrawal; and (iii) for the operation and maintenance costs in administering the ADSs, an annual fee not in excess of U.S. $ 3.00 per 100 ADSs. Any and all expenses of the Depositary, including, without limitation, the charges and expenses of the Custodians under or in connection with the Deposit Agreement, other than those fees expressed to be paid by the Holders in the preceding sentence, or as may be agreed from time to time between the Company and the Depositary, will be borne by the Depositary, except (i) taxes and other governmental charges, (ii) share transfer registration fees on deposits of Shares, (iii) such cable and facsimile transmission and delivery charges as are expressly provided in the Deposit Agreement to be at the expense of persons depositing Shares or Holders of Receipts, and (iv) such expenses as are incurred by the Depositary in the conversion of foreign currency into dollars.

(7) Title to Receipts . It is a condition of this Receipt, and every successive Holder of this Receipt by accepting or holding the same consents and agrees, that title to this Receipt (and to each Certificated ADSs evidenced hereby) shall be transferable upon the same terms as a certificated security under the laws of the State of New York, provided that, in the case of Certificated ADSs, the Receipt has been properly endorsed or is accompanied by properly executed instruments of transfer. Notwithstanding any notice to the contrary, the Depositary and the Company may deem and treat the Holder of an ADS (that is, the person in whose name an ADS is registered on the books of the Depositary) as the absolute owner thereof for all purposes. Neither the Depositary nor the Company shall have any obligation or be subject to any liability under the Deposit Agreement to any holder of a Receipt or any beneficial owners unless such holder is registered as the Holder of such Receipt on the books of the Depositary or in the case of a Beneficial Owner, such Beneficial Owner or Beneficial Owner’s representative is registered as the Holder on the books of the Depositary.

(8) Validity of Receipt . This Receipt shall not be entitled to any benefits under the Deposit Agreement or be valid or obligatory for any purpose, unless this Receipt shall have been executed by the Depositary by the manual signature of a duly authorized officer or, if a Registrar for the Receipts shall have been appointed, by the manual signature of a duly authorized officer of such Registrar.

 

9


(9) Pre-release . Pursuant to the Deposit Agreement, the Depositary may issue Receipts for evidence of rights to receive Shares from the Company, or any Custodian, Registrar, transfer agent, clearing agency or other entity involved in ownership records or transaction records in respect of the Shares. Such evidence of rights is required to consist of written blanket or specific guarantees of ownership of Shares furnished on behalf of the holder thereof. The Depositary is not permitted to lend Shares or Receipts; except that the Depositary may (i) issue Receipts prior to the receipt of Shares pursuant to Section 2.02 of the Deposit Agreement and (ii) deliver Shares prior to the receipt and cancellation of Receipts pursuant to Section 2.05 of the Deposit Agreement, including Receipts which were issued under (i) above but for which Shares may not have been received. The Depositary may receive Receipts in lieu of Shares under (i) above and receive Shares in lieu of Receipts under (ii) above. The Depositary is required to cause each such transaction to be (a) accompanied by a written agreement whereby the Person to whom Receipts or Shares are to be delivered, or its customer, (1) represents that it owns the Shares or Receipts to be remitted, as the case may be (or in lieu of such representation such Person or its customer may provide such evidence of ownership of Shares or Receipts, as the case may be, as the Depositary deems appropriate), (2) agrees to indicate the Depositary as owner of such Shares or Receipts in its records and to hold such Shares or Receipts in trust for the Depositary until such Shares or Receipts are delivered to the Depositary or the Custodian, (3) unconditionally guarantees to deliver to the Depositary or the Custodian, as applicable, such Shares or Receipts and (4) agrees to any additional restrictions or requirements that the Depositary deems appropriate , (b) at all times fully collateralized (marked to market daily) with cash, United States Government securities or other collateral as the Depositary deems appropriate, (c) terminable by the Depositary on not more than five (5) business days’ notice, and (d) subject to such further indemnities and credit regulations as the Depositary deems appropriate. Pursuant to the Deposit Agreement, the Depositary has agreed to limit the number of Receipts and Shares involved in such transactions at any one time to thirty percent (30%) of the face amount of Receipts outstanding (without giving effect to Receipts outstanding under (i) above), and thirty percent (30%) of the principal amount of Shares actually deposited under the Deposit Agreement, respectively. Pursuant to the Deposit Agreement, the Depositary is required to set limits with respect to the number of Receipts and Shares involved in such transactions with any one person on a case-by-case basis as it deems appropriate. Pursuant to the Deposit Agreement collateral (but not any earnings thereon) is required to be held for the benefit of the Holder only. The Depositary may retain for its own account any compensation received by it in connection with the foregoing.

(10) Power of Attorney . The Holder hereby agrees that, upon acceptance of this Receipt issued in accordance with the terms of the Deposit Agreement, the Holder appoints the Depositary its attorney-in-fact, with full power to delegate, to act on its behalf and to take any and all steps or action provided for or contemplated herein and in the Deposit Agreement with respect to the Deposited Securities, including but not limited to those set forth in Article IV of the Deposit Agreement, and to take such further steps or action as the Depositary in its sole discretion may deem necessary or appropriate to carry out the purposes hereof and of the Deposit Agreement.

(11) Disclosure of Interest . The Holder of this Receipt agrees to comply with the Company’s Articles of Association, as they may be amended from time to time, and the laws of Sweden, with respect to disclosure requirements, if any, regarding ownership of Deposited Securities and shares in and other securities and debt obligations of the Company, all as if this Receipt was to the extent practicable the Shares represented hereby.

The Depositary shall, at the Company’s request, send to any Holder specified by the Company a notice requiring such Holder to notify the Depositary as to whether any of such Holder’s American Depositary Shares represented by any of the Receipts held by or registered in the name of such Holder are

 

10


being held, directly or indirectly, for some person other than such Holder and, if so, the name, address and citizenship of such other person or persons. Each Holder will provide to the Depositary at the Depositary’s principal office the information requested in the Depositary’s notice within five (5) business days after the date of the notice and the Depositary shall forthwith furnish the Company with the information provided. Should any Holder fail to provide the information sought within such five (5) business days, the Depositary shall notify the Company accordingly and, upon receipt of written instructions from the Company to that effect, the Depositary shall (i) discontinue the registration of transfers of all Receipts registered in the name of such Holder; (ii) suspend the distribution of payments of dividends to such Holder; and (iii) not give any further notices to such Holder; until such information is provided pursuant to Section 3.04 of the Deposit Agreement.

(12) Ownership Limitations . Holders and Beneficial Owners shall comply with any limitations on ownership of Shares under the constituent documents of the Company or applicable Swedish law as if they held the number of Shares their ADSs represent. The Company shall inform the Holders, Beneficial Owners and the Depositary of any such ownership restrictions in place from time to time, which may be through public disclosure, including via the Company’s website.

(13) Compliance with U.S. Securities Laws . Pursuant to the Deposit Agreement, the Company and the Depositary are required to exercise any rights they have under the Deposit Agreement to prevent the withdrawal or delivery of Deposited Securities in a manner which would not violate the United States securities laws, including, without being limited to, General Instruction I.A(1) to Form F-6 Registration Statement, as amended from time to time, under the Securities Act of 1933.

Dated:

 

Countersigned     DEUTSCHE BANK TRUST COMPANY AMERICAS,
      as Depositary
By  

 

    By  

 

Authorized Officer     Vice President

The address of the principal office of the Depositary is 60 Wall Street, New York, New York 10005, U.S.A..

 

11


[FORM OF REVERSE OF RECEIPT]

SUMMARY OF CERTAIN ADDITIONAL PROVISIONS

OF THE DEPOSIT AGREEMENT

(14) Dividends and Distributions; Rights . Whenever the Depositary shall receive any cash dividend or other cash distribution on the Deposited Securities, the Depositary will, if at the time of receipt thereof any amounts received in a foreign currency can in the judgment of the Depositary be converted on a reasonable basis into United States dollars transferable to the United States, and subject to the provisions of the Deposit Agreement, convert such dividend or distribution into United States dollars and will distribute the amount thus received to the Holders of Receipts entitled thereto, in proportion to the number of American Depositary Shares representing such Deposited Securities held by them respectively; provided, however, that the amount distributed will be reduced by any amounts required to be withheld by the Company or the Depositary on account of taxes. If in the judgment of the Depositary amounts received in foreign currency may not be converted on a reasonable basis into United States dollars transferable to the United States, or may not be so convertible for all of the Holders of Receipts entitled thereto, the Depositary may in its discretion make such conversion, if any, and distribution in United States dollars to the extent permissible to the Holders of Receipts entitled thereto and may distribute the balance of the foreign currency received and not so convertible by the Depositary to, or hold such balance for the account of, the Holders of Receipts entitled thereto. If in the opinion of the Depositary any distribution other than cash or Shares upon any Deposited Securities cannot be made proportionately among the Holders of Receipts entitled thereto, or if for any other reason the Depositary deems such distribution not to be feasible, the Depositary may adopt such method as it may deem equitable and practicable for the purpose of effecting such distribution, including the sale (at public or private sale) of the securities or property thus received, or any part thereof, and the net proceeds of any such sale will be distributed by the Depositary to the Holders of Receipts entitled thereto as in the case of a distribution received in cash. If any distribution upon any Deposited Securities consists of a dividend in, or free distribution of, Shares, the Depositary may with the Company’s approval, and shall if the Company shall so request, distribute to the Holders of outstanding Receipts entitled thereto, in proportion to the number of American Depositary Shares representing such Deposited Securities held by them respectively, additional Receipts for an aggregate number of American Depositary Shares representing the number of Shares received as such dividend or free distribution. In lieu of delivering Receipts for fractional American Depositary Shares in any such case, the Depositary may sell the number of Shares represented by the aggregate of such fractions and distribute the net proceeds, converted into United States dollars if not in such dollars (if such conversion may in the judgment of the Depositary be achieved on a reasonable basis), to the Holders of Receipts entitled thereto. If additional Receipts are not so distributed (except as pursuant to the preceding sentence), each American Depositary Share shall thenceforth also represent the additional Shares distributed upon the Deposited securities represented thereby. In the event that the Company shall offer or cause to be offered to the holders of any Deposited Securities any rights to subscribe for additional Shares or any rights of any nature, the Depositary shall have discretion as to whether such rights are to be made available to the Holders of Receipts; provided, however, that the Depositary will, if requested by the Company, either (a) make such rights available to Holders of Receipts by means of warrants or otherwise, if lawful and feasible, or (b) if making such rights available is not lawful or not feasible, or if the rights represented by such warrants or other instruments are not exercised and appear to be about to lapse, sell such warrants or other instruments at public or private sale, at such place or places and upon such terms as the Depositary may deem proper, and allocate the proceeds of such sales for account of the Holders of Receipts otherwise entitled thereto upon an averaged or other practicable basis without regard to any distinctions among such Holders because of exchange restrictions, or the date of delivery of any Receipt or Receipts, or otherwise.

If the Depositary is unable to make any rights available to Holders upon the terms described in clause (a) of this paragraph (14) or to arrange for the sale of the rights upon the terms described in clause (b)

 

12


of this paragraph (14), the Depositary shall allow such rights to lapse. The Depositary shall not be responsible for (i) any failure to determine that it may be lawful or practicable to make such rights available to Holders in general or any Holders in particular, (ii) any foreign exchange exposure or loss incurred in connection with such sale, or exercise, or (iii) the content of any materials forwarded to the Holders on behalf of the Company in connection with the rights distribution.

Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this Receipt or the Deposit Agreement, if registration under the Securities Act of 1933 of the securities to which any rights relate is required in order for the Company to offer such rights to Holders of Receipts and sell the securities represented by such rights, the Depositary will not offer such rights to the Holders of Receipts unless and until such a registration statement is in effect, or unless the offering and sale of such securities to the Holders of such Receipts are exempt from registration under the provisions of such Act.

There can be no assurance that Holders generally, or any Holder in particular, will be given the opportunity to exercise rights on the same terms and conditions as the holders of Shares or be able to exercise such rights. Nothing herein shall obligate the Company to file any registration statement in respect of any rights or Shares or other securities to be acquired upon the exercise of such rights.

(15) Elective Distributions in Cash or Shares . Whenever the Company intends to distribute a dividend payable at the election of the holders of Shares in cash or in additional Shares, the Company shall give notice thereof to the Depositary at least 30 days prior to the proposed distribution stating whether or not it wishes such elective distribution to be made available to Holders. Upon receipt of notice indicating that the Company wishes such elective distribution to be made available to Holders, the Depositary shall consult with the Company to determine, and the Company shall assist the Depositary in its determination, whether it is lawful and reasonably practicable to make such elective distribution available to the Holders. The Depositary shall make such elective distribution available to Holders only if (i) the Company shall have timely requested that the elective distribution is available to Holders of ADRs, (ii) the Depositary shall have determined that such distribution is reasonably practicable and (iii) the Depositary shall have received satisfactory documentation within the terms of the Deposit Agreement including, without limitation, any legal opinions of counsel in any applicable jurisdiction that the Depositary in its reasonable discretion may request, at the expense of the Company. If the above conditions are not satisfied, the Depositary shall, to the extent permitted by law, distribute to the Holders, on the basis of the same determination as is made in the local market in respect of the Shares for which no election is made, either cash or additional ADSs representing such additional Shares upon the terms described in the Deposit Agreement. If the above conditions are satisfied, the Depositary shall establish an ADS Record Date and establish procedures to enable Holders to elect the receipt of the proposed dividend in cash or in additional ADSs. The Company shall assist the Depositary in establishing such procedures to the extent necessary. Subject to paragraph (6) of this Receipt and Exhibit B to the Deposit Agreement, if a Holder elects to receive the proposed dividend (x) in cash, the dividend shall be distributed upon the terms described in Section 4.01 of the Deposit Agreement, or (y) in ADSs, the dividend shall be distributed upon the terms described in Section 4.03 of the Deposit Agreement. Nothing herein shall obligate the Depositary to make available to Holders a method to receive the elective dividend in Shares (rather than ADSs). There can be no assurance that Holders generally, or any Holder in particular, will be given the opportunity to receive elective distributions on the same terms and conditions as the holders of Shares.

(16) Record Dates . Whenever any cash dividend or other cash distribution shall become payable or any distribution other than cash shall be made, or whenever rights shall be issued, with respect to the Deposited Securities, or whenever the Depositary shall receive notice of any meeting of holders of Shares or other Deposited Securities, the Depositary will fix a record date for the determination of the Holders of Receipts who shall be entitled to receive such dividend, distribution or rights, or the net proceeds of the sale thereof, or to give instructions for the exercise of voting rights at any such meeting, subject to the provisions of the Deposit Agreement.

 

13


(17) Voting of Deposited Securities . Upon receipt of notice from the Company of any meeting, or solicitation of consent or proxy, of holders of Shares or other Deposited Securities, the Depositary shall, as soon as practicable thereafter, establish a record date applicable to Holders of American Depositary Shares entitled to instruct the Depositary to vote the Shares or other Deposited Securities represented by such Holder’s ADSs and distribute to the Holders of American Depositary Shares a notice which shall contain (a) such information as is contained in such notice of meeting, solicitation of consent or proxy, and (b) a statement that the Holders of American Depositary Shares at the close of business in New York on the specified record date will be entitled, subject to any applicable provisions of Swedish law, the Articles of Association of the Company and the Deposit Agreement, to instruct the Depositary as to the exercise of the voting rights, if any, pertaining to the amount of Shares or other Deposited Securities represented by their respective American Depositary Shares. Upon the instruction of a Holder of American Depositary Shares as of such record date, received on or before the date established by the Depositary for such purpose, to block the Holder’s American Depositary Shares in the name of the Holder (for the period specified for such purpose by the Depositary in the applicable notice to Holders) and to vote the Shares or other Deposited Securities represented thereby, the Depositary shall endeavor in so far as practicable and as permitted under Swedish law, the Company’s Articles of Association, and the terms of the Deposit Agreement, to vote or cause to be voted the amount of Shares or other Deposited Securities represented by such Holder’s American Depositary Shares in accordance with the instructions from the applicable Holder. The Depositary agrees not to exercise any voting rights or powers under any Shares or other Deposited Securities represented by the American Depositary Shares unless it has received such blocking and voting instructions from the Holder of the American Depositary Shares, and then only in accordance with such instructions.

Notwithstanding anything contained in the Deposit Agreement or any ADR, the Depositary may, to the extent not prohibited by law or regulations, or by the requirements of the stock exchange on which the ADSs are listed, in lieu of distribution of the materials provided to the Depositary in connection with any meeting of, or solicitation of consents or proxies from, holders of Deposited Securities, distribute to the Holders a notice that provides Holders with, or otherwise publicize to Holders, instructions on how to retrieve such materials or receive such materials upon request (i.e., by reference to a website containing the materials for retrieval or a contact for requesting copies of the materials).

Neither the Depositary nor the Custodian shall under any circumstances exercise any discretion as to voting and neither the Depositary nor the Custodian shall vote, attempt to exercise the right to vote, or in any way make use of for purposes of establishing a quorum or otherwise, the Deposited Securities represented by ADSs, except pursuant to and in accordance with the blocking and voting instructions timely received from Holders or as otherwise contemplated herein. If the Depositary timely receives blocking and voting instructions from a Holder that fails to specify the manner in which the Depositary is to vote the Deposited Securities represented by such Holder’s ADSs on one or more matters presented at the relevant meeting, the Depositary will deem such Holder to have instructed the Depositary to abstain on those items for which the Holder failed to specify the manner in which the Depositary is to vote. Deposited Securities represented by ADSs for which no timely blocking and voting instructions are received by the Depositary from the Holder shall not be voted.

Notwithstanding anything else contained in the Deposit Agreement or any ADR, the Depositary shall not have any obligation to take any action with respect to any meeting, or solicitation of consents or proxies, of holders of Deposited Securities if the taking of such action would violate U.S. laws. The Company agrees to take any and all actions reasonably necessary to enable Holders and Beneficial Owners to exercise the voting rights accruing to the Deposited Securities and to deliver to the Depositary an opinion of U.S. counsel addressing any actions requested to be taken if so requested by the Depositary.

 

14


There can be no assurance that Holders generally or any Holder in particular will receive the notice described above with sufficient time to enable the Holder to return blocking and voting instructions to the Depositary in a timely manner.

(18) Changes Affecting Deposited Securities . Upon any change in nominal value or par value, split-up, consolidation or any other reclassification of Deposited Securities, or upon any recapitalization, reorganization, merger or consolidation or sale of assets affecting the Company or to which it is a party, any securities which shall be received by the Depositary in exchange for or in conversion of or in respect of Deposited Securities shall be treated as new Deposited Securities under the Deposit Agreement, and the American Depositary Shares shall thenceforth represent the new Deposited Securities so received in exchange or conversion, unless additional Receipts are delivered pursuant to the following sentence. In any such case the Depositary may with the Company’s approval, and shall if the Company shall so request, execute and deliver additional Receipts as in the case of a stock dividend, or call for the surrender of outstanding Receipts to be exchanged for new Receipts. Notwithstanding the foregoing, in the event that any security so received may not be lawfully distributed to some or all Holders, the Depositary may, with the Company’s approval, and shall, if the Company requests, subject to receipt of an opinion of counsel to the Company, furnished at the expense of the Company, satisfactory to the Depositary that such action is not in violation of any applicable laws or regulations, sell such securities at public or private sale, at such place or places and upon such terms as it may deem proper and may allocate the net proceeds of such sales (net of (a) fees and charges of, and expenses incurred by, the Depositary and (b) taxes and/or governmental charges) for the account of the Holders otherwise entitled to such securities upon an averaged or other practicable basis without regard to any distinctions among such Holders and distribute the net proceeds so allocated to the extent practicable as in the case of a distribution received in cash.

(19) Reports; Inspection of Transfer Books . The Depositary will make available for inspection by Holders of Receipts at its Principal office any reports and communications received from the Company, including any proxy soliciting material, which are both (a) received by the Depositary as the holder of the Deposited Securities, and (b) made generally available to the holders of such Deposited Securities by the Company. The Depositary will also send to Holders of Receipts copies of such reports when furnished by the Company as provided in the Deposit Agreement. The Depositary will keep books for the registration of Receipts and their transfer which at all reasonable times will be open for inspection by the Holders of Receipts, provided that such inspection shall not be for the purpose of communicating with Holders of Receipts in the interest of a business or object other than the business of the Company or a matter related to the Deposit Agreement or the Receipts.

(20) Liability of the Company and the Depositary . Neither the Depositary nor the Company shall incur any liability to any Holder of this Receipt, if by reason of any provision of any present or future law of any country or of any governmental authority, or by reason of any provision, present or future, of the Articles of Association of the Company, or by reason of any act of God or war or other circumstance beyond its control, the Depositary or the Company shall be prevented or forbidden from doing or performing any act or thing which by the terms of the Deposit Agreement it is provided shall be done or performed. Neither the Company nor the Depositary assumes any obligation or shall be subject to any liability under the Deposit Agreement to Holders of Receipts, except that they agree to perform their obligations specifically set forth in the Deposit Agreement without gross negligence or willful misconduct. Neither the Depositary nor the Company shall be under any obligation to appear in, prosecute or defend any action, suit or other proceeding in respect of any Deposited Securities or in respect of the Receipts, which in its opinion may involve it in expense and liability, unless indemnity satisfactory to it against all expense and liability be furnished as often as may be required, and no Custodian shall be under any obligation whatsoever with respect to such proceedings, the responsibility of the Custodians being solely to the Depositary. Neither the Depositary nor the Company shall be liable for any (i) action or non-action by it in reliance upon the advice of or information from legal counsel, accountants, any person presenting Shares for

 

15


deposit, any Holder of a Receipt, or any other person believed by it in good faith to be competent to give such advice or information, (ii) the inability by a Holder or Beneficial Owner to benefit from any distribution, offering, right or other benefit which is made available to holders of Deposited Securities but is not, under the terms of the Deposit Agreement, made available to Holders of American Depositary Shares or (ii) any special, consequential, indirect or punitive damages for any breach of the terms of the Deposit Agreement or otherwise. The Depositary will not be responsible for any failure to carry out any instructions to vote any of the Deposited Securities, or for the manner in which any such vote is cast or effect of any such vote, provided that any such action or non-action is in good faith. The Depositary may own and deal in any class of securities of the Company and its affiliates and in Receipts. The Company agrees to indemnify the Depositary and each Custodian against, and hold each of them harmless from, any inability or expense which may arise out of acts performed in accordance with the provisions of the Deposit Agreement and of the Receipts, as the same may be amended, modified or supplemented from time to time, (i) by either the Depositary or any Custodian, except for any liability arising out of the negligence or bad faith of either of them, or (ii) by the Company or any of its agents.

(21) Resignation and Removal of Depositary; Substitution of Custodian . The Depositary may at any time resign as Depositary under the Deposit Agreement by written notice of its election so to do delivered to the Company, such resignation to take effect upon the appointment of a successor depositary and its acceptance of such appointment as provided in the Deposit Agreement. The Depositary may at any time be removed by the Company by written notice of such removal, effective upon the appointment of a successor depositary and its acceptance of such appointment as provided in the Deposit Agreement. The Depositary may at any time appoint a substitute or additional custodian and the term “Custodian” shall also refer to such substitute or additional custodian.

(22) Amendment of Deposit Agreement and Receipts . The Receipts and the Deposit Agreement may at any time and from time to time be amended by agreement between the Company and the Depositary. Any amendment which shall impose or increase any fees or charges (other than the fees of the Depositary for the issuance and delivery of ADSs and taxes and other governmental charges), or which shall otherwise prejudice any substantial existing right of Holders of ADSs, shall, however, not become effective as to outstanding ADSs until the expiration of one (1) month after notice of such amendment shall have been given to the Holders of outstanding ADSs. Every Holder of a Receipt at the time any amendment so becomes effective shall be deemed, by continuing to hold such Receipt, to consent and agree to such amendment and to be bound by the Deposit Agreement as amended thereby. In no event shall any amendment impair the right of the Holder hereof to surrender this Receipt and receive therefor the Deposited Securities represented hereby. Any amendments which (i) are reasonably necessary (as agreed by the Company and the Depositary) in order for (a) the American Depositary Shares to be registered on Form F-6 under the Securities Act or (b) the American Depositary Shares or the Shares to be traded solely in electronic book-entry form and (ii) do not in either such case impose or increase any fees or charges to be borne by Holders, shall be deemed not to materially prejudice any substantial rights of Holders or Beneficial Owners. Notwithstanding the foregoing, if any governmental body should adopt new laws, rules or regulations which would require amendment or supplement of the Deposit Agreement to ensure compliance therewith, the Company and the Depositary may amend or supplement the Deposit Agreement and the Receipts at any time in accordance with such changed laws, rules or regulations. Such amendment or supplement to the Deposit Agreement in such circumstances may become effective before a notice of such amendment or supplement is given to Holders or within any other period of time as required for compliance with such laws, rules or regulations.

(23) Termination of Deposit Agreement . The Depositary will at any time at the direction of the Company terminate the Deposit Agreement by mailing notice of such termination to the Holders of all Receipts then outstanding at least 30 days prior to the date fixed in such notice for such termination, The Depositary may likewise terminate the Deposit Agreement at any time 90 days after the Depositary shall

 

16


have resigned, if a successor depositary shall not have been appointed and accepted its appointment. If any Receipts shall remain outstanding after the date of termination, the Depositary thereafter will discontinue the registration of transfers of Receipts, will suspend the distribution of dividends to the holders thereof, and will not give any further notices or perform any further acts under the Deposit Agreement, except the collection of dividends and other distributions pertaining to Deposited Securities, the sale of rights and the delivery of Deposited Securities, together with any dividends or other distributions received with respect thereto and the net proceeds of the sale of any rights or other property, in exchange for Receipts surrendered to the Depositary. At any time after the expiration of six (6) months from the date of termination, the Depositary may sell the Deposited Securities then held under the Deposit Agreement and may thereafter hold the net proceeds of any such sale, together with any other cash then held by it under the Deposit Agreement, without liability for interest, for the pro rata benefit of the Holders of ADSs not theretofore surrendered. After making such sale, the Depositary shall be discharged from all obligations under the Deposit Agreement, except for its obligations under Section 5.08 thereof and except to account for the claims of Holders, as creditors of the Depositary, for such net proceeds and other cash, after deducting, or charging, as the case may be, the fees of the Depositary for the surrender of a Receipt, any expenses for the account of the Holder in accordance with the terms and conditions of this Deposit Agreement and any applicable taxes or governmental charges or assessments. Upon the termination of the Deposit Agreement, the Company shall be discharged from all obligations under the Deposit Agreement, except for the Company’s obligations under Section 5.08 thereof. The obligations under the terms of the Deposit Agreement and the Receipts of Holders and Beneficial Owners of ADSs outstanding as of the effective date of any termination shall survive such effective date of termination and shall be discharged only when the applicable ADSs are presented by their Holders to the Depositary for cancellation under the terms of the Deposit Agreement and the Holders have each satisfied any and all of their obligations thereunder (including, but not limited to, any payment and/or reimbursement obligations which relate to prior to the effective date of termination but which payment and/or reimbursement is claimed after such effective date of termination).

(24) Available Information . The Company currently is subject to the periodic reporting requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 and accordingly files certain reports with the Securities and Exchange Commission (hereinafter the Commission). Such reports and other information may be inspected and copied at public reference facilities maintained by the Commission in Washington, D.C.

 

17


EXHIBIT B

CHARGES OF THE DEPOSITARY

 

Service

  

Rate

  

By Whom Paid

(1) Receipt of deposits and issuance of Receipts    Up to $ 5 per 100 American Depositary Shares or fraction thereof    Party to whom Receipts are issued
(2) Delivery of deposited Shares against surrender of Receipts    Up to $ 5 per 100 American Depositary Shares or fraction thereof    Party surrendering Receipts
(3) Distribution of Cash Dividends and Cash Proceeds    Up to $ 3 per 100 American Depositary Shares    All holders of American Depositary Shares
(4) Administration of the ADSs    Up to $ 3 per 100 American Depositary Shares per annum    All holders of American Depositary Shares

Except as otherwise provided in the Deposit Agreement, any and all other expenses of the Depositary, including, without limitation, expenses or charges for printing, stationery, postage, insurance, cables, etc., are to be borne by the Depositary, or by the Company in accordance with agreements entered into from time to time with the Company.

 

18

Exhibit 12.1

Certification of Chief Executive Officer

Pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

I, Börje Ekholm, certify that:

 

1. I have reviewed this annual report on Form 20-F of Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson (publ) (the “Company”);

 

2. Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;

 

3. Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the Company as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;

 

4. The Company’s other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the Company and have:

 

  (a) designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the Company, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;

 

  (b) designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;

 

  (c) evaluated the effectiveness of the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and

 

  (d) disclosed in this report any change in the Company’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the period covered by the annual report that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting; and

 

5. The Company’s other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the Company’s auditors and the audit committee of the Company’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):

 

  (a) all significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the Company’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and

 

  (b) any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.

Dated April 26, 2017

 

/s/ Börje Ekholm

Börje Ekholm

President and Chief Executive Officer

Exhibit 12.2

Certification of Chief Financial Officer

Pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

I, Carl Mellander, certify that:

 

1. I have reviewed this annual report on Form 20-F of Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson (publ) (the “Company”);

 

2. Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;

 

3. Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the Company as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;

 

4. The Company’s other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the Company and have:

 

  (a) designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the Company, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;

 

  (b) designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;

 

  (c) evaluated the effectiveness of the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and

 

  (d) disclosed in this report any change in the Company’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the period covered by the annual report that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting; and

 

5. The Company’s other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the Company’s auditors and the audit committee of the Company’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):

 

  (a) all significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the Company’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and

 

  (b) any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.

Dated April 26, 2017

 

/s/ Carl Mellander

Carl Mellander

Executive Vice President and

Chief Financial Officer

Exhibit 13.1

Certification of Chief Executive Officer

Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. §1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, the undersigned officer of Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson (publ) (the “Company”) hereby certifies, to such officer’s knowledge, that:

 

  (i) the Annual Report on Form 20-F of the Company for the period ended December 31, 2016 (the “Report”) fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or Section 15(d), as applicable, of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended; and

 

  (ii) the information contained in the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of the Company.

Dated April 26, 2017

 

/s/ Börje Ekholm

Börje Ekholm

President and Chief Executive Officer

The foregoing certification is being furnished solely to accompany the Report pursuant to 18 U.S.C. § 1350, and is not being filed for purposes of Section 18 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, and is not to be incorporated by reference into any filing of the Company, whether made before or after the date hereof, regardless of any general incorporation language in such filing.

Exhibit 13.2

Certification of Chief Financial Officer

Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. §1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, the undersigned officer of Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson (publ) (the “Company”) hereby certifies, to such officer’s knowledge, that:

 

  (i) the Annual Report on Form 20-F of the Company for the period ended December 31, 2016 (the “Report”) fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or Section 15(d), as applicable, of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended; and

 

  (ii) the information contained in the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of the Company.

Dated April 26, 2017

 

/s/ Carl Mellander

Carl Mellander

Executive Vice President and

Chief Financial Officer

The foregoing certification is being furnished solely to accompany the Report pursuant to 18 U.S.C. § 1350, and is not being filed for purposes of Section 18 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, and is not to be incorporated by reference into any filing of the Company, whether made before or after the date hereof, regardless of any general incorporation language in such filing.

Exhibit 15.1

 

LOGO

SWEDISH ANNUAL REPORT

FOR 2016 IN ENGLISH

(ADJUSTED VERSION)


CONTENTS

 

The business

  

Ericsson in brief

     1  

CEO dialogue

     2  

This is Ericsson

     4  

Profit improvement

     5  

This is the market

     7  

The customers

     10  

Networks

     11  

IT & Cloud

     13  

Media

     16  

Global presence 24/7

     18  

Customer Group Industry and Society

     19  

Customer Group IPR & Licensing

     20  

The People

     21  

Sustainability and corporate responsibility

     23  

Reporting structure 2016

     25  

Letter from the Chairman

     27  

Financials

  

Board of Directors’ report

     28  

Report of independent registered public accounting firm

     43  

Consolidated financial statements

     44  

Notes to the consolidated financial statements

     51  

Management’s report on internal control over financial reporting

     92  

Risk factors

     93  

Forward-looking statements

     102  

Corporate Governance

  

Corporate Governance report, 2016

     103  

Remuneration report

     131  

Shareholders

  

Ericsson and the Capital market

     135  

Share information

     138  

Other information

  

Five-year summary

     142  

Alternative Performance Measures (APM)

     143  

Financial terminology and Exchange rates

     148  

Glossary

     149  

Shareholder information

     150  


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

THE BUSINESS – Ericsson in Brief

ERICSSON IN BRIEF

Ericsson’s vision is a Networked Society where every person and every industry is empowered to reach their full potential. The potential of the Networked Society lies in transformation through mobility. Transformation in the way people organize their individual lives and carry out vital tasks. Transformation in the way we work, the way we share information, and the way we do business. Transformation in the way we consume and the way we create. To realize the vision of a Networked Society, Ericsson provides industry-leading high performing solutions for Networks, IT & Cloud and Media. The aim is to develop, produce and offer products and services with excellent and sustainable performance, at the right cost. In the fast developing ICT (Information and Communications Technology) landscape, the ambition is to be a preferred transformation partner for existing and new customers.

Ericsson has its headquarters in Stockholm, and the Ericsson share trades on Nasdaq Stockholm and on NASDAQ, New York.

 

LOGO

Changes in Ericsson’s organization and in the Company’s reporting structure

Starting July 1, 2016, Ericsson has implemented a series of organizational and structural changes. The new organizational structure focuses on meeting changing customer requirements and on capturing market opportunities to strengthen strategy execution and drive growth and profitability.

The financial reporting during 2016 has been based on the same segment structure as 2015 with the three reporting segments Networks, Global Services and Support Solutions.

From January 1, 2017, financial reporting is done according to a new structure, with three new financial reporting segments, Networks, IT & Cloud and Media. The new segments contain both products and services and the structure aligns company reporting with strategy execution in a simpler and more transparent way.

In this Annual Report, Ericsson’s operations are described according to the new organizational structure, while all financial data except for impairment testing of intangible assets and goodwill are made according to the prior financial reporting structure Networks, Global Services and Support Solutions.

 

LOGO

 

1


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

THE BUSINESS – CEO dialogue

SHIFTING FOCUS FROM GROWTH TO PROFITABILITY

Ericsson’s CEO Börje Ekholm and Jan Frykhammar, who served as CEO July 2016 – mid January 2017, discuss a number of issues concerning 2016 and important topics for the Company going forward.

What’s your reflection on the year 2016?

Jan | The negative trend with low mobile broad band investments accelerated through 2016, especially in markets with a weak macro-economic environment. As a result, the leadership team and I have been fully committed to the work to reduce cost and improve efficiency, in order to secure resilience and competitiveness for the company. The cost and efficiency program, which was intensified in the second half of 2016, is expected to reduce the annual run rate of operating expenses, excluding restructuring charges, to SEK 53 billion in the second half of 2017. This is to be compared with SEK 63 billion for full-year 2014.

Börje | Operators continued to be cautious with investments in equipment as their revenues overall have come under pressure. This was reflected in our results in 2016 which did not reach our expectations. The short-term reality is that growth is limited and we have to adjust to that and prioritize what to focus on. The first task is to establish profitability and adjust the size of our operations to the demand level.

What do you consider to be the most important event during 2016?

Jan | This has been a very special year for me. I took on the role as a CEO mid-year with the ambition to stay until the search for a new CEO was completed.

During 2016 our ambition was to unite the company around the shift in focus from growth to profitability. The successful execution of the intensified activities during the second half of the year is a clear sign that the mindset of the organization has changed, enabling us to continue our work to improve profitability.

Börje | After 10 years as member of the board I got the question if I wanted to assume the day-to-day leadership of Ericsson. One of the major reasons to why I accepted was that I believe that Ericsson is a great company and that there is great business potential to exploit. This company has connected billions of people and soon we will connect many machines. Another reason to accepting the job is that I do not have anything against challenges – on the contrary. They trigger me. Thus, I look forward to refining the strategy to focus investments into areas where Ericsson both can and must win. Even if I have a decade of experience working for Ericsson as a board member, I am assuming this new responsibility with humility, understanding there is much left for me to learn.

How will Ericsson restore profitability?

Jan | As reported in 2016, the cost and efficiency program is progressing towards the target. During the year, we have pushed for strong accountability and focus on performance throughout the company. The program has been expanded to adjust the organization to lower sales volumes, and the priority has been to execute on the cost-out activities and to reduce working capital.

During 2016, operating expenses were significantly reduced through headcount reductions around the world. As the sales decline impacted the gross margin negatively, we also intensified the focus on reducing cost of sales, and thereby improving the gross margin.

Börje | Only consistent profitability and strong cash flow will provide us the freedom to continue investing in our research & development and into our future growth. In the near term, this means we prioritize profitability over growth. We aim at establishing competitive cost structures across all parts of our operations and our portfolio and continue to execute on our ongoing cost and efficiency program. We are also reviewing our overall priorities to focus on the most attractive areas. This effort involves key teams in the company, to secure quality of decisions and speed in implementation once decisions are made. All these activities are done to ensure that we remain at the forefront of technological development – building on the combined strength across products, services and solutions.

How will Ericsson work to further improve customer relations?

Jan | After I assumed the CEO position at the end of June the leadership team and I spent three months visiting a majority of Ericsson’s largest customers. In fact, the whole organization has been very active in 2016 in addressing the demands of our customers with the aim to support them in expanding their businesses, monetize on their business ideas and help them keep pace with the latest industry developments. The new organization, effective from July 1, has been developed to mirror our customers’ way of working and to better meet the needs of different customer segments.

Börje | Our task is to make our customers successful, which in turn will make us successful. It may sound like a management cliché, but we need to make decisions foremost with the customer in mind, thereafter Ericsson and finally the individual business unit. We want to be a partner to our customers as it is through partnership we can add true value. It should be easy to do business with us, and we need to reduce the complexity and simplify our processes in order to be more agile in our responses to customers.

 

2


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

What are Ericsson’s competitive strengths?

Jan | Our strength is in the combination of our technology and services leadership, combined with our global presence and scale. There is actually a natural competitive advantage in our unique combination of products and services, as the network depends on the services we deliver, and the other way around. Our 111,464 employees are seriously committed and have done a great job during 2016 despite the challenging environment.

Börje | Ericsson has shaped an entire industry and led global technology developments in mobility. We are only at the beginning of the mobility journey and as the networks and applications become even more important in a 5G connected world, our customers and the industry look for continuous innovation. Ericsson is built on amazing innovations and great people and our technology leadership is reflected in the 42,000 patents we have in our IPR portfolio. It is easy to quantify our technological strength. However, our competitive advantage arises when we can combine our products, with services and solutions.

Börje, could you comment on the strategic direction going forward?

Börje | As CEO of Ericsson one of my main tasks is to create a long-term strategic plan and execute on that. Emphasis will be on refining the strategy to focus investments into areas where we both can and must win. We need to ensure that Ericsson remains at the forefront of technological development – across our portfolio and markets.

Meeting changing customer requirements and capturing market opportunities is key to being successful and to achieve this we need to continue to build from our core strengths, in both products and services. The job is to ensure that Ericsson emerges as an even stronger leader, providing the industry and our customers with superior products, services and solutions.

In the near term, stability will be key to establishing a strong base for future growth. This means prioritizing profitability over growth, but also to diligently continue to work on efficiency and effectiveness across all operations.

Stockholm, February 24, 2017

 

LOGO

 

LOGO

 

3


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

THIS IS ERICSSON

Ericsson provides high performing solutions for Networks, IT & Cloud, and Media. The company provides infrastructure, services and software to the telecom industry and other sectors. Ericsson has approximately 110,000 employees with customers in more than 180 countries.

During 140 years, Ericsson has delivered customer value by continuously evolving its business portfolio through its core assets – technology and services, global scale and skills. This, in combination with its business expertise, has resulted in a profound technology and services leadership. Ericsson believes that the Company’s technological and financial capability to adapt and the will to change are major competitive strengths.

Ericsson’s ability to transform its core business and its ambition to enter into new and adjacent markets are key to generating customer and shareholder value.

In 2016, approximately 67% of Ericsson’s business was related to services and software sales, compared with less than 50% ten years ago.

This change reflects the ongoing transformation from a hardware-centric business to one where the share of the software and services business continues to increase. However, competitive hardware also remains an important performance differentiator. The number of product platforms has been significantly reduced over time, while the scope has extended from mainly mobile infrastructure and related services to include IT, Cloud, support systems, media and new industry verticals. The workforce is also going through a transformation, reflecting the Company’s business and competence shift. In 2016, approximately 15,000 employees joined Ericsson and about 20,000 employees left the Company, resulting in a net reduction of 4,800 employees.

 

LOGO

 

4


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

PROFIT IMPROVEMENT

In order to restore profitability, Ericsson is focusing on three areas: efficiency improvements, monetize Networks and build success in IT & Cloud, Media and Industry and Society. The cost and efficiency program is progressing towards the target and has been expanded to adjust the organization to lower sales volumes.

Efficiency improvements

In November 2014, Ericsson launched a global cost and efficiency program with the aim to generate savings of SEK 9 billion during 2017, with half of the savings in operating expenses and the other half within cost of sales. On July 19, 2016, the Company announced additional activities, targeting a new lower annual run rate of operating expenses, excluding restructuring charges, of SEK 53 billion in the second half of 2017. This can be compared with SEK 63 billion for full-year 2014 and equates to double the previously targeted savings in operating expenses. All efficiency measures are progressing according to plan. Operating expenses were SEK 60.5 (64.1) billion in 2016 and operating expenses excluding restructuring charges amounted to SEK 56.4 (61.4) billion. Total restructuring charges in 2016 were SEK 7.6 (5.0) billion.

During 2016, the negative industry trends intensified and thus impacted demand for mobile broadband, especially in markets with a weak macro-economic environment. Ericsson’s sales in Europe also declined, as a result of lower capacity sales and the completion of large mobile broadband projects. The sales decline has impacted the gross margin negatively, and implemented cost reductions have not been sufficient to offset the effect. To adapt operations to a lower mobile broadband market, the Company has intensified actions to reduce cost of sales further. The Company’s ambition is to make cost of sales reductions visible in an improved gross margin in the second half of 2017 compared to full year 2016.

The scope of the global cost and efficiency program involves cost of sales reductions in service delivery and supply, as well as operating expense reductions in R&D and SG&A (Selling, General and Administrative expenses) including common support functions. Major elements of the cost of sales improvement plan include activities related to service delivery such as centralization, automation and standardization, and production related activities such as increased outsourcing and production site consolidation. The target is to increase production outsourcing to above 50% in 2017 from less than 40% in 2015. Major elements in the operating expense improvement plan involve headcount reductions and outsourcing. The shift in workforce and competence is also an important long-term, value driving priority.

 

LOGO

 

5


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Monetize Networks

Ericsson’s strong position in both mobile infrastructure and telecom services has resulted in a large installed global base to build on, which Ericsson aims to monetize to increase sales and improve profitability. In telecom services, the Company monetizes its strong global footprint in managed services, with more than 300 ongoing contracts. In mobile infrastructure, the ambition is to increase capacity and software sales into the installed base. While market conditions are challenging in certain parts of the world, the Company continues its work to capture business opportunities as more markets shift from 3G to 4G. At the same time, the Company intends to capture growth on the strong 4G footprint with the ambition to extend its technology leadership in the emerging 5G market. The ambition is to lead in 5G transformation and thereby also strengthen profitability within the Networks business. Improving the Network Rollout business from negative to break-even or positive result is included in the monetize Network’s area.

Build success in IT & Cloud, Media and Industry and Society

Some of the attractive characteristics in the adjacent areas IT & Cloud, Media and Industry and Society are recurring revenues and a higher share of software and professional services. Over time, growth is primarily expected to be organic, complemented by selective acquisitions and a broad range of partnerships and collaborations. The overall ambitions of the partnerships, collaborations and selective M&A activities are to expand market footprint, strengthen competitive assets, fill portfolio gaps, and, above all, strengthen Ericsson’s ability to create value and to accelerate profitable growth. The strategic partnership with Cisco is an example of an important collaboration initiative.

The plan also includes expansion and capturing growth through the customer group Industry and Society in the industry verticals of utilities, transport and public safety by reusing Ericsson’s core offerings.

 

LOGO

 

6


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

THIS IS THE MARKET

Over the next few years, telecom networks will transform into open, horizontal and programmable platforms that can connect all clouds to all devices. The increasing amount of industry use cases, including autonomous cars, massive and critical machine-to-machine communications and the vast usage of sensors will require more spectrum – as well as new spectrum. This will add a new set of requirements to existing telecom networks, creating new business opportunities for Ericsson.

A market in transformation

The market is transforming, creating new needs for Ericsson’s customers. By applying network slicing and virtualization, the network can be segmented in a smart and efficient way. This enables operators to expand their business and address new enterprise segments and industry verticals. Ericsson has taken a broad approach with the ambition to lead and drive the digitalization and transformation of the telecom industry as well as of other industries including utility, transport, and public safety.

Global market trends

The overall macro environment in 2016 has been challenging, especially in emerging markets, with a negative impact on investment willingness in certain regions and markets. In developed markets, investments in Europe have been slow, while investments in the US have remained stable. Investments in China have continued on a high level driven by 4G deployments. Only about 40 percent of the world’s population was covered by 4G/LTE at the end of 2015, which means that there is a great need for additional mobile broadband coverage before the next technology, 5G, becomes available. The demand and interest in digital transformation enabled by 5G, IoT (Internet of Things) and Cloud has accelerated, while at the same time, the industry convergence continues across IT, telecom and media.

In 2022, Ericsson estimates that there will be around 10 billion mobile subscriptions (including cellular M2M) and over 6.8 billion connected smartphones. While the earlier generations of mobile technology offered connectivity to mobile phones and smartphones, the transition to the next generation, 5G, will involve devices beyond smartphones. Ericsson estimates that there will be 29 billion connected devices in 2022, of which 18 billion will be related to Internet of Things. Video is expected to represent 75% of all mobile traffic in 2022.

 

LOGO

 

7


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

New services and IoT communications have a wide variety of requirements on connectivity performance, coverage, security and reliability. Earlier generations of mobile technologies such as GSM and LTE operate on licensed spectrum. In 5G, licensed and unlicensed spectrum will be needed and both traditional (e.g. Wi-Fi, LTE) and new radio access technologies will be used. In the existing spectrum, 5G technology is an evolution of LTE networks and therefore backwards compatible with earlier generations of mobile communications, while the new spectrum will be addressed by new technologies. The technologies will interwork and offer strengthened capabilities to support a broad range of services.

Enriched mobile communications via smart-phones have different requirements than machine type of communications.

IoT communications also have different requirements depending on if it is critical or massive. Critical IoT might require high quality of service (QoS) or telecom grade connectivity, while the requirements of massive IoT applications such as smart sensors that connect to the cloud once in a while, are related to low cost, low energy consumption and low bandwidth.

In an environment with high data volumes, low latencies and a large number of devices, the architecture needs to be horizontalized. The benefits of a horizontal platform include the possibility to slice the network to allocate resources in the most optimal way and to connect a device to applications relevant to that device in the cloud.

Building network infrastructure in a cloud environment also requires a decoupling of network functions (software) from hardware, which is achieved through technology virtualization.

 

LOGO

 

8


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

5G

Ericsson is at the forefront of the 5G market, having signed 28 MoUs (Memorandum of Understanding) with operators, and with 20 different industry partners and some 45 universities and research institutes involved in the development of 5G. In addition, Ericsson is taking a leading and active role in 5G standardization globally. The Company expects 5G in large commercial deployments by 2020.

The 5G network will spur both business and technical innovation across many industries. Ericsson has several testbeds and is performing field trials of 5G radio technology, with larger pre-commercial operator trials planned for 2017.

5G forms a network where fixed and mobile services converge and will therefore also require a transformation of both the core network and the transport network. The network will consist of different access and connectivity solutions, driven by software, addressing the demands on mobile communications beyond 2020. The network will be sustainable, flexible and operationally scalable, addressing multiple industries and use cases. In fact, it will change the way the telecom industry has worked so far.

During the lifetime of traditional mobile communications, the development and adoption of new technology generations has been done through standardization processes and bodies. 5G is different as it will include devices beyond smartphones and therefore have more extensive adaption. Hence, the broad variety of use cases requires cross industry collaboration and a combination of conventional standardization and the use of Open source solutions. Thus, 5G will form a new global ecosystem with multiple use cases where Ericsson’s offering includes telecom transformation as well as digital transformation of other industries.

The increased traffic capacity and the very high data rates of 5G technology will require the development of a new flexible air interface, NX, and the introduction of new spectrum within the existing spectrum below 6 GHz, as well as new spectrum in higher frequency bands up to 100 GHz. As capacity needs have continued to grow, the use of spectrum has shifted towards higher frequencies where larger channel bandwidths are more easily found. Compared to 4G-licensed spectrum, the efficiency of 5G-licensed spectrum is significantly enhanced. Backhaul capacity also needs to evolve further to support future extreme capacity needs.

With data rates up to 100 times faster, network latency lowered by a factor of five, mobile data volumes 1,000 times greater than today’s, and battery life of remote cellular devices stretched to 10 years or more, 5G will enable new capabilities, of which greater efficiency, agile networks and seamless connectivity are a few examples. The 5G network will also, supported by its inherent sustainability characteristics, consume much less energy than earlier generations and be more cost efficient through automation and hardware optimization.

 

LOGO

 

9


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

THE CUSTOMERS

Ericsson’s main customers are telecom operators around the world, representing approximately 90% of revenues in 2016. In addition, the Company has customers in the selected industries of utility, transport and public safety. The IPR licensing business customer base is mainly handset suppliers.

Operators

For operators to be competitive, the telecom networks need to remain a relevant part of providing high quality user experience, and they need to deliver added value in new and unique ways. Operators focus on differentiating their offerings, investing in agile and efficient networks, managing the user experience and complexity and securing good coverage and performance for all services. During 2016, there has also been an increased operator focus on 5G and IoT, digital transformation and core network transformation.

As mobile data traffic and the number of devices continue to increase, operators need to invest in infrastructure that supports throughput, performance and the large volumes of devices. While quality of service is the foundation of success, some operators differentiate by investing in high performing networks, some by swiftly adapting to market conditions and others by being first in the market with uniquely designed service offerings.

Utility, transport and public safety

The industries of utility, transport and public safety use ICT technologies in the ongoing market transformation, which is driven by mobility and new evolving technologies including smart grids, intelligent transport systems and services. Customers in these industries use ICT as an enabler to enhance the customer experience through innovation as they develop new business models and form new ecosystems.

Handset suppliers

Ericsson’s revenues from IPR (Intellectual Property Rights) has a customer base mainly consisting of handset suppliers. Smartphones are based on mobile technology, and Ericsson’s essential patents cover 2G, 3G, and 4G technologies. Over the next few years the IPR and licensing customer base is expected by Ericsson to expand to suppliers of IoT-connected devices.

 

LOGO

 

10


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

THE BUSINESS – Business structure

NETWORKS

From 2017, the Networks segment consists of two business units, Network Products and Network Services. The overall focus is on evolving and managing access networks, including the development of hardware and software for next generation radio access and transport networks. Networks will be reported separately within the new reporting structure from 2017.

 

LOGO

Introduction

In Networks, Ericsson supports its operator customers by leveraging the advantages of technology and services leadership. The portfolio of radio networks and backhaul solutions are based on industry standards and can also be industrialized and adjusted to meet the demands of other industry verticals. In addition, Ericsson’s services capabilities address operator demand in an increasingly complex network environment.

The new organizational structure enables a close set-up between products and services, and allows technology and services expertise to stay close to customers, which also supports simplicity and speed in the delivery process.

Market trends and addressable market

The addressable market for Networks is estimated by Ericsson to be USD 100 billion in 2016, including both products and services.

The competitive portfolio of radio networks and backhaul solutions are based on the technology platforms that the Company develops for telecom operators. Telecom operator revenues in developed markets have been flat during recent years, and investments in many emerging markets have been impacted by a weak macro-economic environment. These circumstances have impacted the overall RAN (Radio Access Network) equipment market, which is estimated by Ericsson to have declined by 10–15% in 2016. This trend is expected to prevail and the Company is estimating that the RAN equipment market will decline by 2–6% in 2017.

Offering – main components

Networks includes several generations of radio networks as well as small cells and microwave products. Ericsson offers hardware and software both for radio access and transport. The Company also has a broad and global range of product-related services comprising design, optimization, network rollout and customer support. In addition, Ericsson provides managed services, which is a vendor agnostic service business that manages operator networks regardless of the equipment supplier. The Company operates and manages any network, or integrates any network technology, regardless of the equipment that is currently installed.

Business model

Mobile broadband

Ericsson’s most traditional business model is mobile broadband, where the Company delivers and rolls out telecom networks including all

 

LOGO

 

11


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

necessary hardware and software. Key aspects for an operator to roll out a new technology – such as 4G/LTE – include satisfying end user demand in an efficient way, while maintaining a high-quality user experience and maximizing the revenue potential. When building network coverage across one or more geographic areas, the coverage phase, there is a large share of hardware, and the project often includes network rollout services. For Ericsson, the initial build-out or rollout phase is capital-intensive and has a lower-than-average gross margin. Currently LTE coverage is growing quickly in urban, suburban and rural areas in many countries, and Ericsson estimates that world population coverage by LTE technology will be above 80% in 2022.

When the network is up and running and demands for capacity expansions and quality improvements arise, profitability increases, driven by an increased share of software sales, network densification and less complex hardware installations, network optimization and customer support. This phase is called the capacity phase. The coverage phases are normally 1–2 years while the capacity phase lasts until the equipment is phased out, normally after 7–10 years in operation. One of the key drivers for increased capacity in the mobile networks is increased mobile data usage. Ericsson estimates that traffic generated by smart-phones alone will increase tenfold between 2016 and 2022.

Managed Services

In Managed Services, Ericsson takes over aspects of a customer’s business operation as a commitment over several years. The Managed Services business model includes three phases. The initial phase, the transition, is coupled with lower profitability, as it involves up-front costs when staff and expertise are transferred from the customer to Ericsson. In the second phase, the transformation phase, Ericsson introduces its global processes, methods and tools and implements a global delivery model. In the third phase, Ericsson focuses on optimization and industrialization by simplifying, implementing and consolidating resources, processes, methods and tools to allow for improved profitability. Managed services contracts are normally 5–7 years long. The first two phases last for 1–1.5 years while the optimization phase represents the remainder of the contract period.

The Company believes that it has reached a good balance of contracts in the transition, transformation and optimization phases.

Priorities

Ericsson is a leading and trusted network partner. Networks’ mid-term priorities are to leverage the installed base, improve profitability and increase the competiveness of its portfolio with the best total cost of ownership for its customers, as well as secure leadership in the evolution to 5G. To leverage the installed base Ericsson plans to grow its managed services and customer support business by addressing end user experience and network evolution, grow capacity sales and leverage new spectrum. In addition, the Company focuses on increasing the availability of its new radio platform Ericsson Radio System. To improve profitability and increase competitiveness, Ericsson is taking actions within Networks to improve R&D efficiency, change the supply strategy to fewer sites and a higher share of outsourced production, scale Ericsson Radio System deliveries, leverage its service delivery efficiency and promote industrialization and automation of tools and process in services delivery. In order to secure leadership in the evolution to 5G, Networks is offering capabilities for consultation and integration of solutions for 5G and IoT, is leveraging 5G software “plug-ins” (5G software features that can be applied to 4G networks) and is introducing the world’s first commercial 5G radio. In addition, the Company is driving the 5G ecosystem through collaboration with customers, universities and other industries and partnerships.

 

LOGO

 

12


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

IT & CLOUD

The IT & Cloud business includes two business units: IT & Cloud Products and IT & Cloud Services. The focus in IT & Cloud is to help telecom operators and selected enterprises through the digital transformations ahead. This is handled mainly in three domains: Support Systems (OSS and BSS), Telecom core and IT Cloud. IT & Cloud will be reported separately within the new reporting structure from 2017.

 

LOGO

Introduction

The technology evolution driven by mobility, broadband, analytics, Internet of Things (IoT) and cloud is triggering a new wave of digital transformation. It is not only a technology shift but also a strong enabler for business transformation across many industries. For operators, three main business drivers for transformation can be defined:

 

   

Digital operations – using cloud, virtualization and automation to build a more agile and efficient network and operations

 

   

Digital engagement – as operators move from just selling connectivity to providing a full customer and application centric business, they need new tools and ways to constantly be able to engage with customers and partners

 

   

Digital services – the ability to innovate and introduce services in days, not months, using insights derived from data analytics to identify and capture new business

Digital transformation for operators is not only a way to stay competitive, it is also a necessary shift to prepare for the growing IoT business.

IT & Cloud address these emerging demands, and with its extensive product portfolio and comprehensive service offering, IT & Cloud is equipped to handle transformations.

The desired position for Ericsson is to become a leading digital business transformation partner in and across the support systems, Telecom core and IT Cloud domains.

Market trends and addressable market

IT & Cloud’s focus is on creating opportunities for operators to unlock the full potential of mobility, mobile broadband, analytics, IoT and cloud.

Digital transformation for operators is closely related to the support systems domain and is driven by the fact that today’s customers, both consumers and enterprises, exhibit different expectations and behavior compared to what

 

LOGO

 

13


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

many incumbent businesses are used to. This has resulted in many operators realizing that they need to embrace digital transformation to change the way they interact with their customers and to be able to provide a convenient and context-aware experience across all customer touch points. In addition, operators increasingly work with partners to participate in or drive ecosystems that accelerate innovation and increase value for consumers and industries. Lastly, to reach agility, automation and resource efficiency from software-defined infrastructure, virtualization of network functions and software-defined networking, operators are looking to transform their back-office operations and IT environments to take advantage of advanced analytics and machine learning technology.

The market for Telecom core transformation is driven by operators wanting the ability to address new enterprise segments cost efficiently, with new offerings, business models and use cases based on 5G or IoT, or both. This need is satisfied by using new Telecom core technologies like software-defined infrastructure and networking, virtualization, open systems and analytics, which allow the operator to slice its network to serve a particular industry or business segment, for example. Slicing provides dedicated yet dynamic resource utilization and quality assurance for each business, independent of others, at a much lower total cost for operators.

IT operations are under pressure to deliver speed, scalability and flexibility that meet business demands, while at the same time reducing CAPEX and OPEX. The virtualization of network functions and the related horizontal network architecture creates a market for cloud transformation and convergence of IT and networks. In addition, new cloud technology allows any enterprise to build cloud infrastructures to support their digital transformation, including architecture and economics equivalent to that of the traditional cloud service providers. The market also shows an increasing interest in making more use of public clouds for enterprise applications and in creating a hybrid cloud that shares resources from private and public clouds to run their workloads.

Offering – main components

Transformation implies journeys from the current state to a future state in many dimensions of the business. Ericsson’s IT & Cloud product and service portfolio provides customer solutions for all of the above mentioned transformation journeys. The Company believes that the ability to offer a combination of products, technology and expertise in networks, software, cloud and business processes is a significant competitive advantage. This ability is highly relevant to other industries as well as it enables expansion of the business beyond telecom operators even further.

IT & Cloud Services

With over 17,000 consultants and systems integrators building and using common best practices, service automation and asset tools, Ericsson is in a strong position to guide customers through the challenging, complex and in many cases multi-year transformation journeys. Ericsson’s services capabilities enable customer engagements ranging from consulting, setting the business direction and transformation plan, systems integration and building the new environment to establishing business processes and IT operations on behalf of the customer. The systems integrators implement the new solutions and migrate operations to the new environment, and the lifespan of the customers’ legacy applications can be extended with the Application Development and Modernization services.

 

LOGO

 

14


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Support Systems products

Ericsson has a market leading comprehensive, pre-integrated and modular support systems (OSS and BSS) software offering for Revenue & Customer Management, Analytics, Service Orchestration, Assurance and Network Management. Improved end-user experience with personalized offerings, consistent and effortless omnichannel experiences, simplification of network complexity, 5G and IoT are all examples of drivers for a transformed support systems environment to become a digital operator or enterprise.

Telecom core products

Ericsson provides a complete end-to-end offering for communications services including IP Multimedia Subsystem (IMS) core, application servers, subscriber databases, mobile soft switch, VoLTE and evolved packet core. These network functions are offered as physical or virtual instances to suit a wide range of operator requirements. Ericsson has a leading portfolio of virtualized network functions and an end-to-end portfolio including Service Provider SDN to support orchestration of virtualized applications in an automated way. In addition, Ericsson also provides what is known as NFV infrastructure which is a common platform for network functions that are virtualized during transformation of the core network.

IT Cloud products

A cloud system contains a range of compute, storage and networking modules that work together to build a wide range of virtual systems. Ericsson’s Cloud Infrastructure offering entails software-defined data centers and hardware platforms, software-defined networks, open platform technologies and cloud management. One of the major products is the Hyperscale Datacenter System 8000 – a new generation of datacenter system that uses a disaggregated hardware architecture for better resource utilization.

Ericsson’s cloud infrastructure solutions are based on open source and OpenStack, making the solution relevant for any industry. It can be used for different businesses in different industries, ranging from telecom cloud to hyperscale software-defined infrastructure.

Business model

The traditional business model has been to offer products and services. This has over time developed towards project business with larger and more complex undertakings. The undertakings are becoming larger, turning into full transformation projects with business benefit goals, and they include hardware and software from multiple vendors. A transformation project can turn into an IT managed services contract where Ericsson operates the transformed environment on behalf of the customer. Over time there will also be as-a-Service models in the IT & Cloud market.

Priorities

The business and operational priorities for IT & Cloud are as follows:

 

   

Monetize the leading position – address the large installed customer base in Support Systems and Telecom core to extend the existing engagements and to grow the recurring revenues

 

   

Re-focus the go-to-market approach – leverage the relationship with operator Chief Technology Officers to address operator Chief Information Officers. Also investigate opportunities in the enterprise markets

 

   

Shift the portfolio – re-allocate product investments to support the growth areas, which are driven by digital transformations. This also includes the strategic partnership with Cisco to broaden the IP portfolio

 

   

Develop service delivery – modernize tools and methods for service automation, increase use of partners and open source and establish digital transformation centers for knowledge build-up and sharing

 

   

Shift people and competence – continue the shift towards IT, business process transformation and cloud competence

 

15


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

MEDIA

Ericsson’s Media business offering includes products and services, and focuses on new market entry and expanding the Company’s footprint globally. The segment Media will be reported separately within the new reporting structure from 2017.

 

LOGO

Introduction

Consumer behavior is a key driver in the transformation of the media market. As an increasing share of TV and video is accessed over a smart-phone, delivering seamless TV experiences on smartphones will be a basic requirement as well. Mobile video consumption is vastly outgrowing traditional linear consumption. Ericsson offers innovative solutions that enable content owners, broadcasters, TV service providers and network operators to efficiently deliver, manage and monetize new TV experiences. Ericsson’s ambition is to be a transformation partner – which shapes the future of TV. To show its commitment to the media business the segment Media brings together media products and services competence for Content owners, Broadcasters, TV service providers and Network operators to support Ericsson’s customers in the ongoing industry transformation.

Market trends and addressable market

The fragmented TV market includes IP technology, networks and the vast amount of video-enabled connected devices that are driving the transformation of the market. Ericsson estimates that the share of video traffic will increase to 75% of total mobile traffic in 2022, compared to 50% today. The industry convergence and competitive landscape require a new set of skills and there is an increased demand for outsourcing of media operations.

While the cable operator market is moving in the direction of all IP delivery, broadcasters are seeing increased competitive pressure from the telecom operators, which are moving into broadcasting by packaging and distributing content over broadband. They are expanding their business from controlling the bit pipe to also include production and control of content. This is reflected for example in AT&T’s move towards content and its proposed takeover of Time Warner, and in Verizon’s acquisition of AOL and Yahoo.

The over-the-top players (OTT) that create global offerings at lower price points constitute another group of competitors to broadcasters. Compared to the global over-the-top players, broadcasters have a strong advantage in their localized content. They know the culture and the local consumption habits, something that Ericsson in its offering is also trying to leverage. The aim is to be global but with a localized managed services model.

Offering – main components

Ericsson develops and delivers software-based solutions for TV and media and combines a product portfolio that spans the TV value chain, with systems integration and managed services. The portfolio includes compression, software and hardware-based video processing and storage, content publishing via set-top box or pure OTT, content delivery and analytics. Services include broadcast playout, media management, captioning, content discovery and Systems Integration. The end to end offering allows Ericsson to advise, guide, support, implement and manage its customers’ transformation in the evolution of TV.

 

LOGO

 

16


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

MediaFirst

At the core of Ericsson’s MediaFirst offering is the MediaFirst TV platform, which enables personalization, interactivity and multiscreen viewing capabilities. The platform is a software and cloud-based platform, which was developed to cater for the creation, management and delivery of next generation pay TV. Hence the MediaFirst portfolio includes the cloud TV platform, media delivery solutions and media processing.

Broadcast managed services

Every year, Ericsson Broadcast Services distributes more than 4 million hours of programming in more than 60 languages for more than 500 TV channels worldwide.

When Ericsson manages broadcast services, the Company handles the technical platforms and operational services including content logistics, library management, quality control, playout services, WebTV and mobile services. The Media service offering enables broadcasters to reduce time to market, minimize business continuity risk and achieve significant OPEX and CAPEX savings.

Package and Deliver managed services

Ericsson’s end-to-end Package and Deliver managed services offering includes the cloud media processing platform. The service platform utilizes cloud-based tools to deliver highly resilient, secure and flexible non-linear contribution, archiving and media processing. These services can deliver scalability, flexibility and elasticity to broadcasters, TV platforms and content owners.

Business model

Ericsson is moving towards a business model with a high degree of recurring software and service sales. In the new organization, Ericsson’s Media business centrally manages broadcast and cable customers. The go-to-market strategy is to move from a fragmented model to a more focused model to drive sales in selected top accounts. This will include geographical prioritization and involve both direct sales and partnering.

Priorities

Ericsson’s ambition is to be its customers’ video transformation partner. Focus is on capturing growth in media through increased software sales and expanding recurring revenues. Providing technology that brings cloud capabilities into the TV network, with the flexibility and elasticity needed to deploy software applications, continues to be a top priority. Ericsson’s ambition is to increase sales to non-operator customers and work with channel and portfolio partners, while capturing synergies from the new organization. The Company is transferring investments from legacy hardware based products to next-generation software and cloud based solutions, while focusing on a go-to-market model that drives profitable growth.

 

17


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

GLOBAL PRESENCE 24/7

Ericsson is a global company, with customers in more than 180 countries. The Company has been present in many countries, such as China, Brazil and India, for more than 100 years. The go-to-market organization is based in 10 geographical regions and one region Other.

NORTH AMERICA -6%

Mobile broadband investments were stable. Professional Services sales were negatively impacted by a reduced scope in a Managed Services contract. Support Solutions sales declined due to delayed investment decisions by customers. The focus on 5G strongly increased, with trials ongoing with all major customers.

SHARE OF GROUP REVENUES: 25%

LATIN AMERICA -16%

Sales decreased following reduced mobile broadband investments due to a weak macroeconomic environment and due to devaluation of local currencies. The strong momentum for digital transformation continued. Professional Services sales declined due to lower activities in Managed Services.

SHARE OF GROUP REVENUES: 8%

WESTERN AND CENTRAL EUROPE -18%

Sales declined as the initial LTE deployments were finalized. Operators continue to focus on transforming their networks to meet the increasing demand for coverage and capacity, while at the same time improving efficiency.

SHARE OF GROUP REVENUES: 7%

MEDITERRANEAN -10%

Sales declined due to lower investments in mobile broadband infrastructure, mainly related to capacity business. Operator investments in ICT transformation and demand for Managed Services continued.

SHARE OF GROUP REVENUES: 9%

NORTHERN EUROPE AND CENTRAL ASIA -15%

Sales declined, primarily due to continued lower mobile broadband investments in Russia. Global Services sales were flat with a decline in Network Rollout, offset by increased Managed Services sales in Sweden. OSS and BSS sales were flat while TV and Media sales declined.

SHARE OF GROUP REVENUES: 4%

MIDDLE EAST -16%

Sales declined, primarily in Networks due to lower broadband investments in Egypt, Pakistan, Ethiopia and Turkey. The decrease was partly offset by growth in Global Services sales, mainly in Network Rollout and optimization services in Saudi Arabia.

SHARE OF GROUP REVENUES: 9%

NORTH EAST ASIA -3%

Sales declined slightly due to lower investments in Mainland China and Korea, partly offset by market share gains in Japan and Taiwan. In Mainland China 4G deployments continued. However, reduced investments in legacy technologies and significantly reduced investment by one customer, impacted sales negatively.

SHARE OF GROUP REVENUES: 12%

INDIA -20%

Mobile broadband sales declined mainly driven by delayed spectrum auctions which delayed operator investments. Professional Services sales remained stable with operators’ higher focus on network quality and cost optimization.

SHARE OF GROUP REVENUES: 5%

SUB-SAHARAN AFRICA -11%

Investments declined, impacted by a weak macroeconomic environment, local currency depreciation in key markets as well as low oil and commodity prices.

SHARE OF GROUP REVENUES: 4%

SOUTH EAST ASIA AND OCEANIA 15%

Sales increased, primarily driven by mobile broadband deployments across several markets. Professional Services sales developed favorably as operators focus on efficiency and network optimization services.

SHARE OF GROUP REVENUES: 10%

OTHER -23%

IPR licensing revenues amounted to SEK 10.0 (14.4) billion. Sales in 2015 were positively impacted by a global patent license agreement signed with Apple.

SHARE OF GROUP REVENUES: 7%

Legend: ± XX%

The percentage figure shows sales change 2016 compared to 2015, %

 

18


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

CUSTOMER GROUP INDUSTRY AND SOCIETY

Customer Group Industry and Society addresses industries beyond telecommunications with existing Ericsson capabilities, IoT solutions and industry-adapted offerings in order to ensure scale and efficient operations across the Company. Industry and Society plays an important role in Ericsson’s strategy to expand the business beyond telecom operators by reusing and extending the current portfolio of both services and products.

Introduction

The digital transformation offers huge potential in terms of new innovations, improved efficiency, sustainability and safety in any industry. The industries benefit from Ericsson’s mobility expertise and services innovation, including, for example, solutions for smart grids in utilities and for connected vehicles in the automotive industry.

Market trends and addressable market

Ericsson’s selected industries within Industry and Society – utilities, transport and public safety – have geographically dispersed networks, regulatory frameworks and business models. This is particularly true for utilities and transport, which in many ways face conditions that are similar to those of telecom operators. Like telecom operators, they need to transform, increase their operational efficiency, improve customer experience and deliver a higher degree of innovation.

Offering – main components

For the selected industries in Industry and Society, Ericsson reuses its existing products and services offerings developed for operator customers. Ericsson has also developed a number of industry-specific cloud solutions, such as Connected Vehicle Cloud. These industry-specific solutions combine industry applications, service enablement, connectivity management and consulting as well as systems integration and managed operations services.

Business model

The new organizational structure enables Ericsson’s technology and service expertise to be close to the selected industries. Industry and Society operates with direct sales channels and work closely with partners to optimize the solutions. Ericsson supports companies not only through innovative offerings but also through its analytical capabilities, local and global presence and ability to support the customers as they develop and deploy new business models.

Priorities

Industry and Society focuses to profitably extend the business globally in the utilities, public safety and transport industries. Ericsson also evaluates the potential of entering into other industries.

 

LOGO

 

19


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

CUSTOMER GROUP IPR & LICENSING

Ericsson has more than 42,000 granted patents. The Company is a net receiver of licensing royalties and has agreements with the largest handset suppliers in the world. Ericsson continues to expand its IPR licensing business into new technologies and industries.

Introduction

Ericsson’s technology leadership in mobile communications is demonstrated by a further strengthened IPR portfolio of more than 42,000 granted patents compared to 39,000 granted patents in 2015. Through its IPR licensing, the Company is able to encourage innovation and re-invest in further development of the communications eco-system. At the same time, IPR licensing strengthens Ericsson’s position as one of the technology leaders in the ICT industry and ensures a fair return on the Company’s R&D investment through fair, reasonable and non-discriminatory (FRAND) licensing.

IPR licensing revenues were SEK 10.0 (14.4) billion in 2016 with margins above the Company average. The Company is currently expanding its licensing business beyond handset suppliers to include other industries such as media and IoT device manufacturers. Internet of Things represents an opportunity for connected device manufacturers to expand their product offerings to new areas, and for Ericsson to expand its IPR business and become a preferred technology partner in new industries.

Market trends and addressable market

Ericsson’s licensing business promotes open standards, which enable decreased costs of technology for consumers through economies of scale and fair pricing. The open standards also lower barriers to market entry and, through interoperability and high performance, enable large markets for digital products and services. The majority of today’s IPR licensing revenues are generated from handset suppliers. The Company has agreements with the largest handset suppliers in the world. However, over the last couple of years an increasing share of the handset market is represented by the Chinese suppliers. Ericsson does not yet have agreements with some of these suppliers, which affects the IPR licensing revenue negatively in the short-term. The company is addressing new handset suppliers with the ambition to sign license agreements with them.

Ericsson is expanding the licensing business to cover products beyond handsets as connectivity is introduced in industries other than telecommunications. By 2022, the number of connected devices is expected by Ericsson to grow to 29 billion from today’s 16 billion devices.

These other industries need efficient ways to allow for all connected devices to be adequately licensed. As standard-essential patents are licensed, licensing terms are adapted for each use case to reflect the value of the patented standardized technology for the device in question and its user. The value of wireless connectivity differs greatly depending on the use case, and FRAND licensing practices are flexible enough to handle this.

The Avanci platform

In 2016, Ericsson led the formation of Avanci, a one stop shop for licensing of standard essential patents for certain IoT applications. Avanci is a third party entity through which holders of standard essential patents can license their wireless technologies to companies and manufacturers who develop and create connected devices for the IoT. For device manufacturers, the open marketplace simplifies access to wireless technologies. Avanci connects the patent holders with the companies developing the IoT devices in an uncomplicated manner and simplifies the process of identifying what essential patents are required in each device. Avanci’s initial focus will be on licenses for connected vehicles and smart meters.

Offering – main components

Ericsson’s IPR portfolio includes both patents and technology know-how. Patent licensing includes giving access to patents for different technology standards, while in technology licensing Ericsson provides specifications for proprietary technologies such as different interfaces.

Business model

For Ericsson, there is great value in the IPR portfolio in terms of securing cross-licensing agreements. These agreements are signed with other IPR patent holders in order to avoid litigation or disputes, and they give both signing companies the freedom to market products and solutions that utilize each other’s technology. As Ericsson has a strong patent portfolio, the Company believes that this approach also enables the Company to commercialize and obtain a fair return on the IPR portfolio when others use the Company’s technology.

Over the past five years, annual R&D investments have been SEK 32–36 billion, and in 2016 revenues from the IPR licensing business were SEK 10.0 (14.4) billion. As IPR licensing margins are above the Company average, they have an accretive impact on profitability.

Priorities

Ericsson’s ambition is to capture growth in the IPR licensing business by leveraging its technology leadership, ensuring license agreements with handset suppliers and expanding its business to industries other than telecommunications.

 

20


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

THE PEOPLE

The People strategy is essential for Ericsson during its journey of transformation. Being a people business, Ericsson’s future success depends on the Company’s ability to attract, develop, motivate and retain talent.

By attracting and developing the best talent and establishing a high-performance organization, Ericsson can maintain a leading position in the industry. The core values of Professionalism, Respect and Perseverance are part of the Ericsson culture of creativity and innovation. The enabling culture empowers individuals and teams, which continue to transform the business and fulfill their own potential.

 

LOGO

Attracting the best talent

Competition for talent in the ICT industry is intense and Ericsson works continuously to attract the best talent.

The work of Ericsson employees can positively impact the lives of people around the world. Employees can also volunteer their time in many of the Company’s Technology For Good programs to bring the benefits of the Networked Society to all. In that sense, Ericsson is for people who want to make a real difference.

Ericsson strives to be a global employer of choice with consistent values. At the same time it is important to meet local needs. Ericsson wants to be recognized as a company that can fulfill both personal and career ambitions of current and potential employees.

Through an employee referral program, Ericsson involves top talent to attract other top talent from the market. The “You + Ericsson Concept” communicates people stories in social media that demonstrate Ericsson’s culture and global opportunities. Ericsson also works with universities all over the world to attract talent early. Furthermore, the Company works to promote computer science and STEM (science, technology, engineering and mathematics) education together with tech-oriented groups and community associations.

Skills as a core asset

In a rapidly evolving market, Ericsson’s employees work hard to develop and evolve the necessary skills needed to maintain a leading position in the ICT industry and to successfully support Ericsson’s customers’ transformation journey. The Company’s approach to learning is two-pronged: the first prong is a bottom-up approach with a strong focus on skills and career development at the individual level; the second

 

LOGO

 

21


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

prong is a top-down approach that aims to close key competence gaps to enable proper execution of the Company’s business strategies and operating objectives.

Ericsson Academy prides itself on giving its employees in around 150 countries easy and equal access to innovative digital learning. Ericsson’s new Virtual Faculties, which consist of the Company’s experts in different areas such as cloud, 5G, small cell and service delivery, offer live virtual recordings in interactive sessions with employees. Through virtual sandboxes, employees get the possibility to learn about Ericsson’s portfolio to supplement their work experience.

Engagement and leadership

Ericsson’s ambition is for employees to stay motivated and engaged. To measure overall employee motivation and commitment to the company’s success, Ericsson conducts an employee survey – the Employee Engagement Index.

In 2016, due to organizational changes that took place from July 1 and a new organizational structure that was not yet complete, Ericsson conducted a poll of a representative sample of 25% of the global employee population instead of the Group wide survey normally conducted annually. Complex industry and organizational changes were reflected in overall engagement levels; the engagement index was 68% in 2016 compared to 76% in 2015. However, for Ericsson as an organization, the employees continue to report a very high sense of pride, with 82% stating that they are “proud to work for Ericsson”, compared to 88% in 2015.

Developing the right leadership capabilities and skills is essential for Ericsson’s Networked society strategy. Strong leadership is critical to taking the business forward as the Company continues to evolve.

Diversity at an inclusive workplace

Ericsson is a global company with over 170 nationalities within the organization and customers in more than 180 countries. With diversity and inclusion as one of the prime drivers of culture, Ericsson aspires to be as diverse as the world in which the Company operates. Diversity is supported by an inclusive workplace where people are valued for the different perspectives, ideas and experiences that they bring to the Company.

Attracting more women to the technology sector remains a challenge. One of Ericsson’s goals for 2020 is for 30 percent of all executives, line managers and the overall workforce at the Company to be women. To achieve this goal, the gender perspective is included in strategic processes, including talent acquisition and development programs. Ericsson also works with universities and through employer branding to attract more women. Additionally, the Global Leadership Team members all have diversity and inclusion objectives related to gender in their performance management goals.

 

LOGO

 

22


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

SUSTAINABILITY AND CORPORATE RESPONSIBILITY

As a responsible and relevant driver of positive change in society, Ericsson is committed to creating business value while reducing risk.

Key focus areas

Ericsson’s Sustainability and Corporate Responsibility (CR) focus areas are conducting business responsibly, the environment, energy and climate action, and internet for all. Since launch in 2015, the UN Sustainable Development Goals (SDGs) to end poverty, fight inequality and injustice and halt climate change provide a framework for describing and measuring Ericsson’s impacts on society.

Conducting business responsibly

Responsible business practices are embedded in Ericsson’s operations to manage risks. The Ericsson Group Management System includes Group policies, processes and directives encompassing responsible sourcing, occupational health and safety, environmental management, anti-corruption and human rights. External assurance providers audit the system and the Ericsson Sustainability and CR report.

Governance

The Code of Business Ethics (CoBE) sets the tone for how Ericsson conducts business globally. All employees periodically acknowledge the CoBE with the next such acknowledgement planned for 2017. The Code of Conduct applies to employees and suppliers and is based on the UN Global Compact (UNGC) ten principles on human rights, labor conditions, environmental management and anti-corruption. Ericsson is committed to implementing the UN Guiding Principles on Business and Human Rights (UNGP) across its business operations and addresses and reports on its most salient human rights issues (the right to privacy, freedom of expression and labor standards) according to the UNGP Reporting Framework annually in its Sustainability and CR report.

Anti-corruption

Ericsson has a zero-tolerance approach to corruption and has invested continuously and systematically over the past decade in order to strengthen anti-corruption processes. The Company’s anti-corruption program, headed by a Chief Compliance Officer, focuses on prevention and accountability. In 2016 it was strengthened through introducing an automated anti-corruption screening tool for supplier and third-party due diligence. The tool was piloted in one region during 2016 and is planned to be further rolled out in 2017. By the end of 2016, over 95,900 employees have completed the anti-corruption e-learning launched in 2013.

Ericsson is currently voluntarily cooperating with inquiries from the United States Securities and Exchange Commission and the United States Department of Justice regarding its compliance with the U.S. Foreign Corrupt Practices Act. These inquiries concern a period from January 1, 2007 and onwards, and the Company will make additional disclosures regarding these inquiries to the extent required.

It is important to underline that Ericsson has a zero-tolerance approach to corruption and the Company continuously strengthen its compliance processes and how they are implemented. Over the last year Ericsson intensified its efforts, adding both internal resources as well as engaging outside counsel to support the overall process and give an outside view of the robustness of its programs.

Human rights

To fulfil its responsibility to respect human rights in accordance with the UNGP, Ericsson has developed and strengthened its human rights framework. The Ericsson Sales Compliance Process includes a forum that regularly reviews potential human rights impacts, with mitigation actions determined by the Sales Compliance Board where necessary.

Since 2013, Ericsson has performed UNGP-aligned Human Rights Impact Assessments in Myanmar, Iran and Ethiopia. In 2016, work was also initiated to evaluate Cuba from a human rights perspective.

Health and safety

As part of its zero major incidents vision within Occupational Health and Safety (OHS), Ericsson applies a risk-based approach to control and prevent work-related hazards. Selected operations undergo internal audits to ensure compliance with the OHSAS 18001 standard. To support a safe work environment for anyone working on

 

23


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

the Company’s behalf, Ericsson takes a comprehensive and inclusive approach. The Company reports in the Sustainability and Corporate Responsibility Report on both its own incidents and fatalities and those of suppliers building and servicing networks on behalf of Ericsson.

Environment, energy and climate change

Ericsson is committed to develop and deliver solutions to support climate action. At the UN Climate Change Conference of the Parties (COP 22) in Morocco in 2016, Ericsson and other leading companies joined world leaders in supporting the goals set out in the Paris Agreement. In 2016, Ericsson’s Connected Mangroves project was one of the five winners of the United Nations Framework Convention on Climate Change “Momentum for Change” award at COP22, which honored ICT initiatives contributing to climate resilience.

Energy performance and water management

Ericsson products are designed with the aim of minimizing the components, packaging and climate impacts. In 2016, continued improvements were made in energy performance across the entire product portfolio, including Ericsson Radio System (ERS), which provides a 50% improvement in energy efficiency on previous generation. ICT also has significant transformative potential to help other sectors such as Energy and Transport to reduce their environmental impact. As a signatory to the UN Global Compact’s CEO Water Mandate, Ericsson signals its commitment to adopting and implementing a comprehensive approach to water management.

Global Product Take-Back

The Ericsson Global Product Take-back Program oversees responsible treatment of products at the end of their lifecycle. The program is offered to customers globally free of charge, not only in markets where this is required by law. In 2016, 9,600 tons of used products were taken back for controlled materials recycling. During take-back, over 98% of the materials are recycled.

Smart, sustainable cities

Deployment of broadband infrastructure is an enabler of many future services such as smart grids and intelligent transport. The Stockholm Royal Seaport project, in which Ericsson has participated for more than five years, offers a blueprint for how Swedish innovation can be applied to the sustainable city design. In 2016, Ericsson began research into enhanced consumer awareness and control of energy consumption through use of connected appliances.

Internet for all

In 2016, Ericsson launched a suite of business solutions to increase viability of mobile internet investments in developing markets. Network innovations help operators create viable and inclusive business in rural or off-grid settings by improving mobile network performance and efficiency and reducing associated network costs, and by enabling affordable 2G to 3G upgrades. These solutions build on Ericsson Radio System to cut total cost of ownership by up to 40% for operators involved in expanding mobile broadband. The Company’s Pure Solar solution launched in Myanmar for off-grid service with no diesel backup.

Technology for Good™

In the Networked Society, Ericsson is a leading advocate for Technology for Good™ using core competence and technology to address sustainable development challenges. Examples include:

 

   

Education – Ericsson is the lead technology partner in Connect to Learn, a global education initiative, now in 23 countries, engaging 16 mobile operators and benefitting about 80,000 students.

 

   

Refugees – Under a global partnership with the International Rescue Committee (IRC), Connect to Learn is working in Domiz refugee camps in Northern Iraq with operator AsiaCell to provide educational support to Internally Displaced People (IDPs) and refugees in their host communities.

 

   

Humanitarian Response – Ericsson Response, deployed under the ICT Humanitarian Response Working Group for Haiti, established 16 sites to support humanitarian users. There were six Ericsson Response volunteers deployed in 2016 to Haiti, with two additional volunteers supporting the deployment through the end of January 2017.

Read more about Ericsson’s approach, performance and initiatives in the Sustainability and Corporate Responsibility Report: www.ericsson.com/sustainability.

 

24


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

REPORTING STRUCTURE 2016

For 2016, Ericsson reported three segments, namely Networks, Global Services and Support Solutions.

Networks

The segment delivered hardware and software that are needed for mobile and fixed communications, several generations of radio networks, IP and transmission networks, core networks and cloud. The major business models were based on network coverage build followed by network capacity expansions and upgrades with a revenue mix consisting of hardware and software. Gross margins were affected by the business mix between sales of network coverage build-outs, upgrades and network expansions. A majority of the Company’s Research and Development (R&D) investments were made within Networks in 2016. Major competitors included Huawei, Nokia and ZTE.

 

LOGO

Global Services

The segment delivered network rollout services and professional services such as managed services, consulting and systems integration (CSI) and customer support as well as network design and optimization services. Through Ericsson’s service delivery organization and it’s four Global Service Centers, Ericsson deployed, operated and evolved networks and related support systems. Ericsson provided managed services to networks that were typically multi-vendor, multi-technology environments. In broadcast services Ericsson expanded its service portfolio offering automation and standardization of processes, methods and tools.

The business mix in Global Services was divided between network rollout services and professional services, and approximately 2/3 of professional services sales were recurring. Major competitors included Accenture, Huawei, IBM and Nokia.

 

LOGO

Support Solutions

The segment developed and delivered software-based solutions for OSS and BSS as well as TV and media solutions. Sales were dominated by software, while the services part of the business was reported in Global Services. Ericsson is transforming the business model from one based on a revenue from traditional telecom software licenses to one that emphasizes recurring software licensing built on subscription-based software offerings. Due to its high software content, gross margin was typically higher than Company average, and at the same time R&D intensive. Major competitors included Amdocs, Huawei, IBM and Oracle.

 

LOGO

 

25


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

CHANGE IN REPORTING STRUCTURE FROM 2017

Ericsson implemented a new organizational structure in 2016. The new structure builds on the Company’s technology leadership, services leadership and global scale and skills, and it supports cost reductions and efficiency improvements. It also removes duplication across portfolios and capabilities. Ericsson has adapted its organization to mirror its customers’ ways of working, with the aim to create a more efficient and purpose-built organization to meet the needs of different customer segments and more quickly seize business opportunities.

From January 1, 2017, financial reporting is done according to a new structure, with three new financial reporting segments, Networks, IT & Cloud and Media. The new segments contain both products and services and the structure aligns company reporting with strategy execution in a simpler and more transparent way.

 

LOGO

 

26


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

LETTER FROM THE CHAIRMAN

Dear shareholders,

During 2016, the market situation became increasingly challenging, mainly driven by a weak macro-economic environment. As a result, the Company increased its focus on improving profitability and on addressing the needs of customers, partly through the implementation of a series of organizational and structural changes. At the same time the Board decided that the time was right for a new leader to drive the next phase of Ericsson’s transformation.

The ambition was to find a CEO with the right background, attitude and leadership ability to take on the challenging situation, and this resulted in the appointment of Börje Ekholm as the new CEO. Börje Ekholm will lead the Company into the next phase, implement and develop the strategy, while executing on the cost and efficiency program. The Board believes that he has deep insight and understanding both of the commercial consequences and the technical aspects of the digital transformation enabled by 5G, IoT and Cloud. The Board would also at this point like to take the opportunity to thank Hans Vestberg for his energetic and inspiring leadership as CEO for almost seven years. We would also like to thank Jan Frykhammar, who shifted from CFO to interim CEO, for steering Ericsson through the second half of 2016 in a very successful way.

The Board believes that good talent management and succession planning are important tools not only on the executive level but also in technology and commercial management. By attracting and developing the best talent and establishing a high-performance organization, Ericsson can maintain a leading position in the highly competitive and ever transforming market. Also, as Ericsson speeds up strategy implementation, the Company needs to remain true to its core values of professionalism, respect and perseverance, which is reflected in a culture of endeavor and innovation.

In order to deliver value and to retain the trust of its stakeholders, Ericsson needs to continuously focus on corporate governance and to conduct business responsibly to meet demanding financial, social and environmental standards. The Board invests a significant amount of time in corporate governance and in 2016 we paid special attention to the Company’s anti-corruption program which in 2016 was strengthened through the introduction of an automated anti-corruption screening tool for supplier and third-party due diligence. Currently Ericsson is voluntarily cooperating with inquiries from the United States Securities and Exchange Commission and the United States Department of Justice regarding its compliance with the U.S. Foreign Corrupt Practices Act. These inquiries concern the last ten years and we will make additional disclosures regarding these inquiries to the extent required. It is important to underline that Ericsson has a zero-tolerance approach to corruption and has over the years continuously and systematically focused on strengthening the anti-corruption processes.

For stakeholders in the capital market, including our shareholders, Ericsson’s capital structure is an area of high interest which the Board invests significant time in analyzing and monitoring. Business plans and investments in R&D and other assets are carefully evaluated. The Board’s proposal for the AGM is a dividend of SEK 1.00 for 2016 as we believe that it is prudent to align the dividend level with 2016 earnings and the current market outlook. However, the Board expresses confidence in the ongoing actions to improve Ericsson’s financial performance, and has the ambition to increase the dividend over time as our performance improves.

Ericsson’s ambition is to be a leading transformation partner for existing and new customers. We as the Board believe the Company’s assets in combination with close customer relations and its will to transform, provide a solid foundation for long term profitable growth and value creation.

Leif Johansson

Chairman of the Board of Directors

 

27


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

FINANCIALS – Board of Directors’ report

BOARD OF DIRECTORS’ REPORT

Reporting structure in 2016

Starting July 1, 2016, Ericsson has implemented an organizational change. The financial reporting during 2016 has been carried out according to the same segment structure as in 2015; Networks, Global Services and Support Solutions. The 2016 reporting structure is applied in this Board of Directors’ report.

From January 1, 2017, financial reporting is done according to the new structure, i.e., by the new segments Networks, IT & Cloud and Media.

Full-year highlights

 

   

Reported sales decreased by –10% mainly due to weaker demand for mobile broadband, especially in markets with a weak macroeconomic environment. IPR licensing revenues declined to SEK 10.0 (14.4) billion.

 

   

Operating income declined to SEK 6.3 (21.8) billion due to lower sales and a changed business mix in mobile broadband, with a lower proportion of capacity business. This was partly offset by lower operating expenses.

 

   

Cash flow from operating activities was SEK 14.0 (20.6) billion. Net cash at year-end was SEK 31.2 billion.

 

   

The Board of Directors proposes a dividend for 2016 of SEK 1.00 (3.70) per share to the AGM.

 

28


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

 

LOGO   LOGO

Business in 2016

In 2016, net sales decreased by –10% mainly due to lower demand for mobile broadband, especially in markets with a weak macroeconomic environment. Sales declined in all three segments. Both operating income and margin decreased compared to last year due to lower sales and lower gross margin, partly offset by lower operating expenses.

IPR licensing revenues were SEK 10.0 (14.4) billion. IPR licensing revenues in 2015 were positively impacted by a global patent license agreement signed with Apple, which included an initial payment.

Full-year sales for the targeted growth areas; IP network, Cloud, OSS and BSS, TV and Media as well as Industry and Society, were flat and accounted for 20% of group sales.

The global cost and efficiency program, first initiated in November 2014, and expanded in 2016, progressed according to plan. The target of the program is to reduce the annual run rate of operating expenses, excluding restructuring charges, to SEK 53 billion in the second half of 2017. Operating expenses in 2016 decreased to SEK 60.5 (64.1) billion which included restructuring charges of SEK –4.1 (–2.8) billion.

Ericsson delivered a full-year cash flow from operating activities of SEK 14.0 (20.6) billion, exceeding the 70% cash conversion target.

 

LOGO

 

29


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Financial highlights

Net sales

Reported sales decreased by –10% mainly due to lower demand for mobile broadband, especially in markets with a weak macroeconomic environment. Sales in Europe declined following completion of mobile broadband projects in 2015. Mobile broadband sales in North America remained stable while Professional Services sales declined, mainly due to lower managed services activities. A significant managed services contract in North America was renewed with reduced scope. Sales in South East Asia increased, driven by large deliveries in coverage projects.

IPR licensing revenues amounted to SEK 10.0 (14.4) billion. Sales in 2015 were positively impacted by a global patent license agreement signed with Apple, which included an initial payment. The baseline for current IPR licensing contract portfolio is approximately SEK 7 billion on an annual basis. Smartphone volume growth, agreements with currently unlicensed handset suppliers and IoT licensing will determine growth opportunities going forward.

Currency exchange rates had no material impact on full-year sales. Sales, adjusted for comparable units and currency, decreased by –10%.

Full-year sales for targeted growth areas were flat and accounted for 20% of group sales. The partnership with Cisco has to date generated more than 100 deals across all regions.

The sales mix by commodity was: software 22% (23%), hardware 33% (34%) and services 45% (43%).

Gross margin

Gross margin declined to 29.8% (34.8%) due to a sales mix with lower share of mobile capacity business, higher share of Global Services sales and lower IPR licensing revenues as well as lower Global Services margins. In addition, restructuring charges included in the gross margin increased to SEK –3.5 (–2.3) billion.

Restructuring charges and efficiency program

Restructuring charges amounted to SEK –7.6 (–5.0) billion. The charges were mainly related to the cost and efficiency program initially announced in November 2014, and expanded in 2016. The cost and efficiency program is progressing according to plan and the target is to reduce the annual run rate of operating expenses, excluding restructuring charges, to SEK 53 billion in the second half of 2017. Efforts continue in order to reduce cost of sales, targeting to improve gross margin in the second half of 2017 compared with full-year 2016. With current plans, total restructuring charges for 2017 are estimated to be SEK 3 billion.

Operating expenses

Total operating expenses decreased to SEK 60.5 (64.1) billion as a result of the cost and efficiency program and lower amortizations of intangible assets. Operating expenses included restructuring charges of SEK –4.1 (–2.8) billion.

Other operating income and expenses

Other operating income and expenses were SEK 0.4 (0.2) billion. Currency hedge contract effects impacted the result with SEK –0.9 (–1.1) billion. They derive from the hedge contract balance in USD. The SEK has weakened against the USD between December 31, 2015 (SEK/USD rate 8.40) and December 31, 2016 (SEK/USD rate 9.06). The negative currency hedge effects were more than offset by several minor positive items.

 

 

 

LOGO   LOGO

 

30


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Operating income

Operating income decreased to SEK 6.3 (21.8) billion due to lower sales and lower gross margin, partly offset by lower operating expenses. Operating margin was 2.8% (8.8%).

Financial net

The financial net declined to SEK –2.3 (–1.9) billion following decreased interest rates and depreciated local currencies in certain markets.

Taxes

Tax cost decreased to SEK –2.1 (–6.2) billion due to lower net income, offset by prior-year adjustments and non-deductible expenses. These factors resulted in a tax rate of 53% in 2016 compared with the more normal tax rate of 31% in 2015. Average tax rate for the years 2011–2015 was 32%.

Net income and EPS

Net income decreased to SEK 1.9 (13.7) billion., for the same reasons as for the decrease in operating income. EPS diluted was SEK 0.52 (4.13) and EPS (Non-IFRS) was SEK 2.66 (6.06).

Cash flow

Cash flow from operating activities was SEK 14.0 (20.6) billion. The decline was mainly due to lower income, larger tax payments and last year’s signed global patent license agreement with Apple, which included an initial payment. Operating net assets decreased by SEK 6.0 billion, supported by reduced trade receivables and increased provisions. In addition, trade payables increased supported by implementation of supply chain financing. Inventory increased slightly.

Cash outlays related to restructuring charges were SEK –2.4 (–2.8) billion during the year.

Cash flow from investing activities was impacted by investments in property, plant and equipment of SEK –6.1 (–8.3) billion, with continued investments in the Global ICT centers. In addition, SEK –4.5 (–3.3) billion of development expenses were capitalized. The capitalized development expenses refer to development of new product platforms like the new IPTV platform, Ericsson MediaFirst, and the new BSS platform, Ericsson Revenue Manager. The company invested SEK 0.6 (2.2) billion in acquisitions of smaller companies, such as Ericpol and Node-Prime in 2016.

Cash flow from financing activities amounted to SEK –11.7 billion, impacted by SEK –12.3 billion of dividend payouts.

Financial position

Net cash decreased to SEK 31.2 (41.2) billion due to lower income and increased dividends. The decrease was partly offset by reduced operating assets.

Pension liabilities increased by SEK 1.1 billion, due to decreased discount rates.

In 2016, Standard & Poor’s and Moody’s downgraded Ericsson’s long-term rating from BBB+/Baa1 with stable outlook to BBB/Baa3 with negative outlook.

The average maturity of long-term borrowings as of December 31, 2016, was 3.8 years, compared with 4.8 years 12 months earlier. Ericsson has an unutilized Revolving Credit Facility of USD 2.0 billion. The facility expires in 2021. In addition, the company signed a new EUR 0.5 billion term loan facility in 2016. The new facility has a tenure of two years with one extension option of one year. The facility serves for general corporate purposes and is unutilized.

Intangible assets

The amount of intellectual property rights and other intangible assets amounted to SEK 51.1 (50.4) billion, including goodwill of SEK 43.4 (41.1) billion. The goodwill impairment testing has been based on the new segments that became effective as per January 1, 2017. For the Media segment the headroom is SEK 5.6 billion when a discount of 8.0% is applied. The recoverable amount is equal to its carrying amount when the discount factor is increased to 10.0%. For more information, see Note 3 “Segment reporting” and Note 10 “Intangible assets.”

Employees

In 2016, the number of employees decreased by almost 5,000 driven by the ongoing cost and efficiency program. At year-end 2016, the total number of employees was 111,464 (116,281).

 

 

LOGO   LOGO   LOGO

 

31


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Research and development, patents and licensing

In line with the global cost and efficiency program, the Company has decreased its R&D expenses. In 2016, R&D expenses amounted to SEK 31.6 (34.8) billion. The number of R&D resources increased mainly due to an acquisition of Ericpol, a long-time supplier to Ericsson with software development in Poland and Ukraine. Approximately 2,000 employees joined Ericsson from Ericpol. The number of patents continued to increase and amounted to approximately 42,000 by end of 2016.

Research and development, patents and licensing

 

     2016     2015     2014  

Expenses (SEK billion)

     31.6       34.8       36.3  

As percent of Net sales

     14.2     14.1     15.9

Employees within R&D as of December 31 1)

     24,100       23,700       25,700  

Patents 1)

     42,000       39,000       37,000  

IPR revenues, net (SEK billion)

     10.0       14.4       9.9  

 

1) The number of employees and patents are approximate.

Seasonality

The Company’s sales, income and cash flow from operations vary between quarters, and are generally lowest in the first quarter of the year and highest in the fourth quarter. This is mainly a result of the seasonal purchase patterns of network operators.

Most recent five-year average seasonality

 

     First
quarter
    Second
quarter
    Third
quarter
    Fourth
quarter
 

Sequential change, sales

     –24     9     –2     24

Share of annual sales

     22     24     24     30

Off-balance sheet arrangements

There are currently no material off-balance sheet arrangements that have, or would be reasonably likely to have, a current or anticipated material effect on the Company’s financial condition, revenues, expenses, result of operations, liquidity, capital expenditures or capital resources.

Capital expenditures

For 2016, capital expenditure was SEK 6.1 (8.3) billion, representing 2.8% of sales. Expenditures are largely related to test sites and equipment for R&D, network operation centers and manufacturing and repair operations.

Investments have been made in three new global ICT centers. The centers will support R&D and services in developing and verifying solutions more efficiently and bringing innovation faster to the market. The first center, in Linköping, Sweden, was opened in 2014. The second center, in Rosersberg, Sweden, was opened in the beginning of 2016. The third center, in Montreal, Canada, was opened in December 2016. The level of capital expenditure will continue to decline as the investments in the Global ICT centers peaked in 2015.

In addition, Ericsson has invested in several buildings in Santa Clara, California and in Manchester, U.K. The purpose with the investments in Santa Clara is to consolidate Ericsson’s Silicon Valley operations. In Manchester Ericsson is investing in a new dedicated customer technical facility for its broadcast media business. The new facility is expected to be ready in April 2017 and is part of a larger transformation and investment strategy.

Apart from these investments, Ericsson believes that the Company’s property, plant and equipment and the facilities the Company occupies are suitable for its present needs.

Annual capital expenditures are normally around 2% of sales. This corresponds to the needs for keeping and maintaining the current capacity level. The Board of Directors reviews the Company’s investment plans and proposals.

As of December 31, 2016, no material land, buildings, machinery or equipment were pledged as collateral for outstanding indebtedness.

Capital expenditures 2012–2016

 

SEK billion

   2016     2015     2014     2013     2012  

Capital expenditures

     6.1       8.3       5.3       4.5       5.4  

Of which in Sweden

     2.0       2.6       2.4       1.9       1.3  

Share of annual sales

     2.8     3.4     2.3     2.0     2.4

 

32


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Business results—Segments

Networks

Background

Networks represented 48.7% of net sales in 2016 (50.1% in 2015), The segment delivers products and solutions that are needed for mobile and fixed communication, several generations of radio networks, IP and transmission networks, core networks and cloud.

Business in 2016

Sales as reported decreased by –12%. The decrease was mainly due to lower sales of mobile broadband, reduced sales of core networks and lower IPR licensing revenues. Core networks sales declined due to lower sales of legacy products, not offset by growth of the new portfolio.

Mobile broadband investments were negatively impacted by a weak macroeconomic environment in a number of markets such as Latin America, the Middle East and South Africa. In addition, sales declined in Europe following the completion of large coverage projects in 2015 and in India due to delayed spectrum auctions. The sales decline was partly offset by sales growth in South East Asia where large deliveries in mobile broadband coverage projects were made.

In North America and in North East Asia, investments in network equipment were stable. In Mainland China, large-scale LTE deployments continued for the third consecutive year.

Sales, adjusted for comparable units and currency, decreased by –13%.

Operating income and margin decreased, mainly due to a lower share of mobile broadband capacity sales and lower IPR licensing revenues. The decrease was partly offset by reduced operating expenses, mainly as an effect of the ongoing cost and efficiency program. The work to improve profitability continued with significant headcount reductions and structural changes.

Restructuring charges amounted to SEK –4.0 (–2.8) billion and the negative effect from currency hedge contracts was SEK –0.7 (–0.9) billion.

 

LOGO

 

33


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Global Services

Background

Global Services represented 45.7% of net sales in 2016 (43.7% in 2015). The segment delivers network rollout services and professional services (i.e., managed services, consulting and systems integration (CSI), customer support as well as network design and optimization services).

Business in 2016

Sales as reported decreased by –6%. Professional Services sales declined due to lower managed services activities in North America where a contract has been renewed with reduced scope. CDMA sales declined YoY impacting Professional Services sales negatively. Network Rollout sales declined due to lower mobile broadband demand, primarily in Europe and Latin America.

Sales, adjusted for comparable units and currency, decreased by –5%.

Global Services operating income decreased to SEK 3.3 (8.2) billion. Activities were performed to adapt the service delivery organization to lower business volumes and to increase the efficiency. Restructuring charges increased to SEK –3.0 (–1.7) billion.

Professional Services operating income declined to SEK 5.2 (9.6) billion due to increased restructuring charges of SEK –2.3 (–0.7) billion, lower sales and a negative impact from large projects in systems integration transformation, where operators are looking to transform their IT environments to increase efficiency and prepare for 5G. Ericsson has been successful and won several IT transformation contracts. However, the short-term margin impact from these contracts is challenging as a consequence of investments in competence build-up and market share.

Network Rollout operating income declined to SEK –1.9 (–1.4) billion due to lower sales in combination with increased cost and negative effects from a few contracts in emerging markets. The effort to improve Network Rollout profitability continues through efficiency improvements including implementation of global methods and tools.

 

LOGO

Support Solutions

Background

Support Solutions represented 5.6% of net sales in 2016 (6.1% in 2015). The portfolio of Support Solutions is designed around measurable performance improvements in an operator’s business processes, with software that is scalable, configurable and that provides end-to-end capabilities. The business segment develops and delivers software-based solutions for OSS and BSS as well as TV and media solutions.

Business in 2016

Sales as reported decreased by –17%, partly due to lower IPR licensing revenues. OSS and BSS sales declined due to lower sales of legacy products and lower software sales in digital transformation projects where sales are mainly project milestone based. In addition, sales declined in markets with a weak macroeconomic environment.

Sales in TV & Media declined due to lower sales of legacy products primarily in North America. Customer trials on the next-generation TV & Media platform are ongoing, but have not yet translated into sales.

Operating income declined to SEK –1.0 (1.5) billion mainly due to lower IPR licensing revenues and lower sales in both OSS and BSS as well as in TV & Media. Several activities in order to reduce cost and adjust the organization to lower business volumes are ongoing.

The overall transition of business models continues, from traditional telecom software licenses to recurrent license revenue deals.

 

LOGO

 

34


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Business results—Regions

 

   

North America

Mobile broadband investments were stable. Professional Services sales were negatively impacted by reduced scope in a managed services contract. Support Solutions sales declined due to delayed investment decisions by customers. The focus on 5G strongly increased, with trials ongoing with all major customers.

 

   

Latin America

Sales decreased following reduced mobile broadband investments due to a weak macroeconomic environment in the region and due to devaluation of local currencies. The strong momentum for digital transformation continued. Professional Services sales declined due to lower activities in managed services.

 

   

Northern Europe and Central Asia

Sales declined, primarily due to continued lower mobile broadband investments in Russia. Global Services sales were flat with a decline in Network Rollout, offset by increased Managed Services sales in Sweden. OSS and BSS sales were flat while TV & Media sales declined.

 

   

Western and Central Europe

Sales declined as the initial LTE deployments were finalized. Operators continue to focus on transforming their networks to meet the increasing demand for coverage and capacity, while at the same time improving efficiency.

 

   

Mediterranean

Sales declined due to lower investments in mobile broadband infrastructure, mainly related to capacity business. Operator investments in ICT transformation and demand for managed services continued.

 

   

Middle East

Sales declined, primarily in Networks due to lower broadband investments in Egypt, Pakistan, Ethiopia and Turkey. The decrease was partly offset by growth in Global Services sales, mainly in network rollout and optimization services in Saudi Arabia.

 

   

Sub-Saharan Africa

Investments declined, impacted by a weak macroeconomic environment, local currency depreciation in key markets as well as low oil and commodity prices.

 

   

India

Mobile broadband sales declined mainly driven by delayed spectrum auctions which delayed operator investments. Professional Services sales remained stable with operators’ higher focus on network quality and cost optimization.

 

   

North East Asia

Sales declined slightly due to lower investments in Mainland China and Korea, partly offset by market share gains in Japan and Taiwan. In Mainland China 4G deployments continued. However, reduced investments in legacy technologies and significantly reduced investment by one customer, impacted sales negatively.

 

   

South East Asia and Oceania

Sales increased, primarily driven by mobile broadband deployments across several markets. Professional Services sales developed favorably as operators focus on efficiency and network optimization services.

 

   

Other

IPR licensing revenues amounted to SEK 10.0 (14.4) billion. Sales in 2015 were positively impacted by a global patent license agreement signed with Apple, which included an initial payment.

Sales per region and segment 2016 and percent change from 2015

 

     Networks     Global Services     Support Solutions     Total  

SEK million

   2016     Change     2016     Change     2016     Change     2016     Change  

North America

     26,978       3     24,692       –11     3,077       –26     54,747       –6

Latin America

     7,830       –20     9,270       –14     833       –2     17,933       –16

Northern Europe and Central Asia

     4,767       –23     4,059       –1     243       –26     9,069       –15

Western and Central Europe

     5,388       –20     10,223       –16     599       –20     16,210       –18

Mediterranean

     7,324       –20     12,823       –4     758       1     20,905       –10

Middle East

     7,553       –36     10,473       8     1,130       –9     19,156       –16

Sub-Saharan Africa

     4,059       –15     4,649       –5     469       –28     9,177       –11

India

     5,536       –32     4,617       1     595       –18     10,748       –20

North East Asia

     18,077       –3     8,564       –3     724       6     27,365       –3

South East Asia and Oceania

     12,249       22     9,571       10     360       –33     22,180       15

Other

     8,577       –30     2,781       –3     3,760       –14     15,118 1)       –23
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

     108,338       –12     101,722       –6     12,548       –17     222,608 1)       –10
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Share of total

     48.7       45.7       5.6       100  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

1) Discontinued segment Modems is not shown separately in the table. SEK 0 (133) million is included as region Other in the total column.

 

35


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Corporate Governance

In accordance with the Annual Accounts Act and the Swedish Corporate Governance Code (the “Code”), a separate Corporate Governance Report, including an Internal Control section, has been prepared and attached to this Annual Report.

Continued compliance with the Swedish Corporate Governance Code

Ericsson is committed to complying with best-practice corporate governance standards on a global level wherever possible. For 2016, Ericsson does not report any deviations from the Code.

Business integrity

Ericsson’s Code of Business Ethics summarizes the Group’s basic policies and directives governing its relationships internally, with its stakeholders and with others. It also sets out how the Group works to secure that business activities are conducted with a strong sense of integrity.

Board of Directors

At the Annual General Meeting, held on April 13, 2016, Leif Johansson was re-elected Chairman of the Board and Nora Denzel, Börje Ekholm, Ulf J. Johansson, Kristin Skogen Lund, Sukhinder Singh Cassidy, Hans Vestberg and Jacob Wallenberg were re-elected members of the Board. Helena Stjernholm and Kristin S. Rinne were elected new Board members and Roxanne S. Austin, Alexander Izosimov and Anders Nyrén left the Board. Hans Vestberg left his positions within Ericsson, including his Board position, as of July 25, 2016. As of April 13, 2016, Pehr Claesson, Mikael Lännqvist and Karin Åberg were appointed employee representatives by the unions, with Zlatko Hadzic, Roger Svensson and Kjell-Åke Soting as deputies.

Management

Hans Vestberg left his position as President and CEO of the Group effective July 25, 2016 and was replaced by the Executive Vice President Jan Frykhammar. Effective January 16, 2017, Börje Ekholm was appointed new President and CEO of the Group. The President and CEO is supported by the Group management, consisting of the Executive Leadership Team (ELT).

A global management system is in place to ensure that Ericsson’s business is well controlled and has the ability to fulfill the objectives of major stakeholders within established risk limits. The management system also monitors internal control and compliance with applicable laws, listing requirements and governance codes.

Remuneration

Remuneration to the members of the Board of Directors and to Group management, as well as the Guidelines for remuneration to Group management resolved by the Annual General Meeting 2016, are reported in Notes to the consolidated financial statements – Note C28, “Information regarding members of the Board of Directors, the Group management and employees”.

The Board of Directors’ proposal for guidelines for remuneration to Group management

The Board of Directors proposes that the 2017 Annual General Meeting of shareholders resolve on the guidelines below for remuneration to Group Management for the period up to the 2018 Annual General Meeting. Compared to the guidelines resolved by the 2016 Annual General Meeting, it has been added that targets for variable compensation may also include share price-related targets.

 

LOGO

 

36


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Guidelines for Remuneration to Group Management

For Group Management consisting of the Executive Leadership Team, including the President and CEO, total remuneration consists of fixed salary, short- and long-term variable compensation, pension and other benefits. The following guidelines apply for the remuneration of the Executive Leadership Team:

 

   

Variable compensation is in cash and stock-based programs, awarded against specific business targets derived from the long-term business plan approved by the Board of Directors. Targets may include share price-related or financial targets at either Group or unit level, operational targets, employee engagement targets or customer satisfaction targets.

 

   

All benefits, including pension benefits, follow the competitive practice in the home country taking total compensation into account.

 

   

By way of exception, additional arrangements can be made when deemed necessary. An additional arrangement can be renewed but each such arrangement shall be limited in time and shall not exceed a period of 36 months and twice the remuneration that the individual would have received had no additional arrangement been made.

 

   

The mutual notice period may be no more than six months. Upon termination of employment by the Company, severance pay amounting to a maximum of 18 months fixed salary is paid. Notice of termination given by the employee due to significant structural changes, or other events that in a determining manner affect the content of work or the condition for the position, is equated with notice of termination served by the Company.

Executive Performance Stock Plan

The Company has operated a Long-Term Variable Compensation program (LTV), building on a common platform of investment in, and matching of, Ericsson shares. It has consisted of three separate plans: one targeting all employees, one targeting key contributors and one targeting senior managers. The program has been designed to encourage long-term value creation in alignment with shareholders’ interests. The aim of the plan for senior managers has been to attract, retain and motivate executives in a competitive market through performance-based share-related incentives and to encourage the build-up of significant equity stakes. The performance criteria for senior managers under the Executive Performance Stock Plan have been approved by the Annual General Meeting.

The targets for the 2014, 2015 and 2016 Executive Performance Stock Plans are shown in the illustration on page 46. The performance criteria are:

Up to one-third of the award will vest if the target for compound annual growth rate of consolidated net sales is achieved.

Up to one-third of the award will vest if the target for compound annual growth rate of consolidated operating income, is achieved.

Up to one-third of the award will vest if cash conversion is at or above 70% during each of the years, vesting one-ninth of the award for each year the target is achieved. The cash conversion targets were reached in 2016, 2015 and 2014.

Before the number of performance shares to be matched is finally determined, the Board of Directors shall examine whether the performance matching is reasonable considering the Company’s financial results and position, conditions on the share market and other circumstances, and if not, reduce the number of performance shares to be matched.

Since no Stock Purchase Plan will be proposed for 2017, alternative arrangements have been developed to replace the Executive Performance Stock Plan. For the Global Leadership Team, a share-based program is proposed for approval by the Annual General Meeting of shareholders (“AGM”) 2017. Details of the performance criteria are outlined in the notice of the AGM 2017.

Material contracts

Material contractual obligations are outlined in Note C31, “Contractual obligations.” These were entered into in the ordinary course of business and were primarily related to operating leases for office and production facilities, purchase contracts for outsourced manufacturing, R&D and IT operations, and the purchase of components for the Company’s own manufacturing. Ericsson is party to certain agreements, which include provisions that may take effect or be altered or invalidated by a change in control of the Company as a result of a public takeover offer. Such provisions are not unusual for certain types of agreements, such as for example financing agreements and certain license agreements. However, considering among other things the Company’s strong financial position, the Company believes that none of the agreements currently in effect would in and of itself entail any material consequence for Ericsson due to a change in control of the Company.

Risk management

Risks are defined in both a short-term and long-term perspective. They are related to long-term objectives as per the strategic direction as well as short-term objectives for next coming year. Risks are categorized into industry and market risks, commercial risks, operational risks and compliance risks. Ericsson’s risk management is

 

37


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

based on the following principles, which apply universally across all business activities and risk types:

 

   

Risk management is an integrated part of the Ericsson Group Management System.

 

   

Each operational unit is accountable for owning and managing its risks according to policies, directives and process tools. Decisions are made or escalated according to defined delegation of authority. Financial risks are coordinated through Group Function Finance.

 

   

Risks are dealt with during the strategy process, annual planning and target setting, continuous monitoring through monthly and quarterly steering group meetings and during operational processes (customer projects, customer bid/contract, acquisition, investment and product development projects). They are subject to various controls such as decision tollgates and approvals.

At least twice a year, in connection with the approval of strategy and targets, risks are reviewed by the Board of Directors.

A central security unit coordinates management of certain risks, such as business interruption, information security and physical security. The Group Crisis Management Council deals with events of a serious nature.

For information on risks that could impact the fulfillment of targets and form the basis for mitigating activities, see the other sections of the Board of Directors’ report, Notes C2 “Critical accounting estimates and judgments,” C14 “Trade receivables and customer finance,” C19 “Interest-bearing liabilities,” C20 “Financial risk management and financial instruments” and the chapter Risk factors.

Sourcing and supply

Ericsson’s hardware largely consists of electronics. For manufacturing, the Company purchases customized and standardized components and services from several global providers as well as from local and regional suppliers.

The production of electronic modules and sub-assemblies is mostly outsourced to manufacturing services companies, of which the vast majority are in low-cost countries. Final configuration of products is largely done in-house. This consists of assembling and testing modules and integrating them into complete units. Final assembly and testing are concentrated to a few sites. Ericsson has 10 manufacturing sites in Brazil, China, Estonia, India, Mexico and Sweden.

A number of suppliers design and manufacture highly specialized and customized components. The Company generally negotiates global supply agreements with its primary suppliers. Ericsson’s suppliers are required to comply with the requirements of Ericsson’s Code of Conduct.

In general, Ericsson has alternative supply sources and seeks to avoid single source supply situations.

Variations in market prices for raw materials generally have a limited effect on total cost of goods sold. For more information, see the chapter Risk factors.

Sustainability and Corporate Responsibility

Sustainability and Corporate Responsibility (CR) are central to Ericsson’s core business and the Company’s commitment to the triple bottom line of responsible financial and environmental performance and socio-economic development. Ericsson’s ambition is to be a relevant and responsible driver of positive change. The Company aims to do this by creating positive impacts in society and minimizing risks for stakeholders.

Ericsson’s approach to Sustainability and Corporate Responsibility is integrated into business operations throughout the value chain; performance is regularly measured and assessed. The Board of Directors is briefed on Sustainability and Corporate Responsibility issues twice per year, or as needed on an ad hoc basis. Group policies and directives are implemented to ensure consistency across global operations. Ericsson’s annual Sustainability and Corporate Responsibility Report provides additional information.

Responsible business practices

Since 2000, Ericsson has supported the UN Global Compact, endorses its ten principles regarding human rights and labor standards, anti-corruption and environmental protection, and reports its Communication on Progress at the Advanced level. In 2016, for the third year, Ericsson reported according to the UN Guiding Principles on Business and Human Rights Reporting Framework. The Ericsson Group Management System includes a Code of Business Ethics, a Code of Conduct, a Sustainability Policy and an Occupational Health and Safety Policy which reflect responsible business practices. These policies and practices are reinforced by employee awareness training and monitoring, and their implementation is externally assured.

Anti-corruption

Ericsson’s anti-corruption program, focused on prevention and accountability, is continuously strengthened. In 2016, that included: adding additional resources to the Compliance Office headed by the Chief Compliance Officer; launching an automated anti-corruption screening tool for conducting due diligence of suppliers and other third parties in Region Northern Europe and Central Asia, with global rollout

 

38


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

planned for 2017. Between 2013 and the end of 2016, more than 95,900 active employees completed an anti-corruption e-learning course.

Human rights

The Code of Business Ethics and Code of Conduct reflect the Company’s ongoing commitment to respect human rights. Ericsson works actively to integrate the United Nations Guiding Principles on Business and Human Rights into its governance framework. Human rights due diligence was strengthened in areas such as Sales Compliance which evaluates possible risks to human rights based on unintended use of technology according to established criteria that is implemented globally. During 2016, more than 600 cases within the Sales Compliance Process were reviewed; 7% were rejected and 93% were approved or approved with mitigating conditions.

Since 2013, Ericsson has performed UNGP-aligned Human Rights Impact Assessments in Myanmar, Iran and Ethiopia. In 2016, work was also initiated to evaluate Cuba from a human rights perspective. During 2016, a review of both the Code of Conduct and the Code of Business Ethics was initiated for example to assess the needs for updates and improvements in light of new legislation in the UK on modern slavery and human trafficking.

Responsible sourcing

Suppliers must comply with the requirements of Ericsson’s Code of Conduct. In 2016, third-party audits were introduced, which will enhance the credibility and robustness of supplier audits and assessments. The Company uses a risk-based approach to ensure that the high-risk portfolio areas, and highest-risk markets, are targeted first. For prioritized areas such as road and vehicle safety, working at heights, working hours and labor rights, Ericsson performs regular audits and works with suppliers to ensure measurable and continuous improvements. Findings are followed up to ensure that improvements are made. In 2016, over 330 audits and assessments were performed.

Ericsson addresses the issue of conflict minerals, including compliance with the US Dodd-Frank Act and the disclosure rule adopted by the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission, through measures in its sourcing processes. The Company also works with suppliers on this issue and engages in industry initiatives such as the Conflict-Free Sourcing Initiative, driven by the Global e-Sustainability Initiative and the Electronic Industry Citizenship Coalition. Ericsson encourages smelters not yet validated as conflict free to undergo the Conflict-Free Smelter Program audit to ensure their conflict-free status.

 

 

LOGO   LOGO

Occupational health and safety (OHS)

Providing a safe and healthy work environment is of paramount importance to Ericsson. The Company takes a transparent and inclusive approach, which includes engagement with suppliers. Ericsson has a special focus on suppliers building and servicing networks on behalf of Ericsson. The vision is zero major incidents.

OHS is integrated across operations globally, with a focus on awareness and prevention. In 2016, an Incident Review Board and Global OHS Board were established for overall governance of OHS.

Supporting climate action

At the UN Climate Change Conference of the Parties (COP 22) in Marrakech, Morocco in 2016, industries joined world leaders to support the goals set out in the Paris Agreement, which entered into force on November 4, 2016.

Ericsson is committed to develop and deliver solutions to support climate action. An ongoing priority is improving the life-cycle carbon footprint as part of a broader circular economy approach. The Company works to reduce negative environmental impacts while delivering solutions that enable a low-carbon economy. As energy use of products in operation remains the Company’s most significant environmental impact, Ericsson works with mobile operators to encourage network and site energy optimization, through innovative products, software and solutions. Processes and controls are in place to ensure compliance with relevant product-related environmental, customer and regulatory requirements. An important aspect of Ericsson’s Design for Environment initiatives is materials management and efficiency.

Ericsson has a long-term objective to maintain absolute CO 2 e emissions from its own activities for business travel, product transportation and facilities energy use in 2017 at the same level as in 2011. To achieve this long-term objective, the Company aims to reduce CO 2 e emissions per employee by 30% over five years. The Company achieved a 5% reduction of CO 2 e emissions per employee in 2016.

Over the past five years, CO 2 e emissions per employee have been reduced by 45% compared to a 2011 baseline. The company met its target to reduce twice as much societal CO 2 emissions via its product and service offerings in areas such as utilities (smart meters) and transportation as emitted from Ericsson’s own operations.

Radio waves and health

Ericsson employs rigid product testing and installation procedures with the goal of ensuring that radio wave exposure levels from products

 

39


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

and network solutions are below established safety limits. The Company also provides public information on radio waves and health, and supports independent research to further increase knowledge in this area. Since 1996, Ericsson has co-sponsored over 100 studies related to electromagnetic fields and health, primarily through the Mobile Manufacturers Forum.

To assure scientific independence, firewalls were in place between the industrial sponsors and the researchers conducting these studies. Independent expert groups and public health authorities, including the World Health Organization, have reviewed the total amount of research and have consistently concluded that the balance of evidence does not demonstrate any health effects associated with radio wave exposure from either mobile phones or radio base stations.

Reporting in accordance with GRI G4 core

Ericsson publishes an annual Sustainability and Corporate Responsibility report and full key performance data is made available on the Ericsson website according to the Global Reporting Initiative (GRI) Sustainability Reporting Guidelines. The performance data is assured by a third-party.

Legal proceedings

In March 2016, Ericsson and Adaptix Inc. (Adap-tix) reached a settlement agreement, resolving all pending litigation between the parties including the patent infringement lawsuits filed by Adaptix against Ericsson with the US District Court for Eastern District of Texas and with the Tokyo District Court in Japan.

In 2013, Ericsson filed a patent infringement lawsuit in the Delhi High Court against Indian handset company Micromax, seeking damages and an injunction. As part of its defense, Micro-max filed a complaint with the Competition Commission of India (CCI) and the CCI has decided to refer the case to the Director General’s Office for an in-depth investigation. In January 2014, the CCI opened another investigation against Ericsson based on claims made by Intex Technologies (India) Limited. Ericsson has challenged CCI’s jurisdiction in these cases before the Delhi High Court and is waiting for a final decision by the Delhi High Court. Ericsson has made numerous attempts to sign a license agreement with both Micromax and Intex on Fair, Reasonable and Non-discriminatory (FRAND) terms.

In 2012, Wi-LAN Inc., a Canadian patent licensing company, filed a complaint against Ericsson in the US District Court for the Southern District of Florida alleging that Ericsson’s LTE products infringe three of Wi-LAN’s US patents. On May 22, 2015, the Florida Court granted a Motion for Summary Judgment in favor of Ericsson, which judgement was in January 2017 vacated by the Court of Appeals for the Federal Circuit. The case was remanded to the District Court for further proceedings consistent with the Federal Circuit’s opinion.

In 2014, Ericsson was joined as a party to- litigation brought by Unwired Planet against Google, Samsung and Huawei in the English High Court in London, in which Unwired Planet accused the defendants of infringing certain patents, some of which were purchased from Ericsson in 2013. Around the same time Ericsson has also intervened in the similar proceedings ongoing in the Dusseldorf District Court in which the defendants also include HTC and LG. The Defendants’ counter-allegations included that the agreement entered into between Unwired Planet and Ericsson in 2013 for the sale of part of Ericsson’s patent portfolio is invalid because of breach of competition law. Ericsson has rejected these claims. Unwired Planet has since settled its cases with Google and Samsung (both in the UK and Germany). In connection therewith these defendants’ counter-claims against Ericsson have been discontinued.

In a decision issued in January, 2016, the Dusseldorf District Court found that there is no ground for the allegation that Ericsson’ sale of patents to Unwired Planet is not in breach of competition law, and rejected this and all other allegations made by the defendants’ against Ericsson. Ericsson remains as intervener in the German cases. This decision has been appealed.

Further, in October 2016 Huawei withdrew its counterclaim against Ericsson in the UK.

In addition to the proceedings discussed above, the Company is, and in the future may be, involved in various other lawsuits, claims and proceedings incidental to the ordinary course of business.

Parent Company

The Parent Company business consists mainly of corporate management, holding company functions and internal banking activities. It also handles customer credit management, performed on a commission basis by Ericsson Credit AB.

The Parent Company has 5 (5) branch offices. In total, the Group has 79 (81) branch and representative offices.

Financial information

Income after financial items was SEK 15.6 (16.8) billion. The Parent Company had no sales in 2016 or 2015 to subsidiaries, while 43% (43%) of total purchases of goods and services were from such companies.

 

40


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Major changes in the Parent Company’s financial position for the year included:

 

   

Increased current and non-current receivables from subsidiaries of SEK 17.1 billion.

 

   

Decreased gross cash of SEK 5.7 billion.

 

   

Increased current and non-current liabilities to subsidiaries of SEK 7.6 billion.

At the end of the year, gross cash: cash, cash equivalents, short-term investments, and interest-bearing securities non-current amounted to SEK 42.9 (48.6) billion.

Share information

As of December 31, 2016, the total number of shares in issue was 3,331,151,735, of which 261,755,983 were Class A shares, each carrying one vote, and 3,069,395,752 were Class B shares, each carrying one tenth of one vote. Both classes of shares have the same rights of participation in the net assets and earnings. The two largest shareholders at year-end were Investor AB and AB Industrivärden holding 21.77% and 15.15% respectively of the voting rights in the Parent Company.

In accordance with the conditions of the Long- Term Variable Compensation Program (LTV) for Ericsson employees, 13,275,251 treasury shares were distributed to employees or sold in 2016. The quotient value of these shares was SEK 5.00, totaling SEK 66.4 million, representing less than 1% of capital stock, and compensation received for shares sold and distributed shares amounted to SEK 137.8 million.

The holding of treasury stock at December 31, 2016 was 62,192,390 Class B shares. The quotient value of these shares is SEK 5.00, totaling SEK 311 million, representing 1.9% of capital stock, and the purchase price amounts to SEK 454.3 million.

The Annual General Meeting (AGM) 2016 resolved to issue 26.1 million Class C shares for the Long-Term Variable Remuneration Program (LTV). In accordance with an authorization from the AGM, in the second quarter 2016, the Board of Directors resolved to repurchase the new issued shares, which were subsequently converted into Class B shares. The quotient value of the repurchased shares was SEK 5.00, totaling SEK 130.5 million, representing less than 1% of capital stock, and the acquisition cost was approximately SEK 130.7 million.

Proposed disposition of earnings

The Board of Directors proposes that a dividend of SEK 1.00 (3.70) per share be paid to shareholders duly registered on the record date of March 31, 2017, and that the Parent Company shall retain the remaining part of non-restricted equity. The Class B treasury shares held by the Parent Company are not entitled to receive dividend. Assuming that no treasury shares remain on the record date, the Board of Directors proposes that earnings be distributed as follows:

 

Amount to be paid to the shareholders

     SEK   3,331,151,735  

Amount to be retained by the Parent Company

     SEK 41,420,521,393  

Total non-restricted equity of the Parent Company

     SEK 44,751,673,128  
  

 

 

 

As a basis for its dividend proposal, the Board of Directors has made an assessment in accordance with Chapter 18, Section 4 of the Swedish Companies Act of the Parent Company’s and the Group’s need for financial resources as well as the Parent Company’s and the Group’s liquidity, financial position in other respects and long-term ability to meet their commitments. The Group reports an equity ratio of 49.6% (51.8%) and a net cash amount of SEK 31.2 (41.2) billion.

The Board of Directors has also considered the Parent Company’s result and financial position and the Group’s position in general. In this respect, the Board of Directors has taken into account known commitments that may have an impact on the financial positions of the Parent Company and its subsidiaries.

The proposed dividend does not limit the Group’s ability to make investments or raise funds, and it is the Board of Directors’ assessment that the proposed dividend is well-balanced considering the nature, scope and risks of the business activities as well as the capital requirements for the Parent Company and the Group in addition to coming years’ business plans and economic development.

Post-closing events

New segment structure from January 1, 2017

From January 1, 2017, financial reporting is done according to the new structure, i.e., by the new segments Networks, IT & Cloud and Media.

Börje Ekholm takes office as CEO and President

Börje Ekholm takes office as CEO and President. On January 16, 2017, Ericsson announced that in connection with Börje Ekholm assuming the position as President and CEO of Ericsson, Jan Frykhammar, who has temporarily held the position as President and CEO, remains a member of the Executive Leadership Team and is appointed Executive Vice President and Advisor to the CEO. Jan Frykhammar will support Börje Ekholm during a transition period and will focus on corporate governance and efficiency.

Magnus Mandersson remains Executive Vice President, advisor to the CEO, focusing on customer relationships, and a member of the Executive Leadership Team. Magnus Mandersson also remains Chairperson of four out of Ericsson’s ten regions.

Carl Mellander remains acting Chief Financial Officer and a member of the Executive Leadership Team.

 

41


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Board assurance

The Board of Directors and the President declare that the consolidated financial statements have been prepared in accordance with IFRS, as issued by the IASB and adopted by the EU, and give a fair view of the Group’s financial position and results of operations. The financial statements of the Parent Company have been prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles in Sweden and give a fair view of the Parent Company’s financial position and results of operations.

The Board of Directors’ Report for the Ericsson Group and the Parent Company provides a fair view of the development of the Group’s and the Parent Company’s operations, financial position and results of operations and describes material risks and uncertainties facing the Parent Company and the companies included in the Group.

 

42


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

To the Shareholders of Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson (publ)

In our opinion, the accompanying consolidated balance sheets and the related consolidated statements of income, comprehensive income, changes in equity and cash flows present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson and its subsidiaries at December 31, 2016 and 2015, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2016, in conformity with International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board and in conformity with International Financial Reporting Standards as adopted by the European Union. Also in our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2016, based on criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission. The Company’s management is responsible for these financial statements, for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in “Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting”. Our responsibility is to express opinions on these financial statements and on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our integrated audits. We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) and International Standards on Auditing. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audits to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement and whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audits of the financial statements included examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, and evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. Our audit of internal control over financial reporting included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audits also included performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinions.

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (i) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (ii) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (iii) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

April 26, 2017, Stockholm, Sweden

 

By:   /s/ PricewaterhouseCoopers
Name:   PricewaterhouseCoopers AB

 

43


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Consolidated income statement

 

January–December, SEK million

   Notes      2016     2015     2014  

Net sales

     C3, C4        222,608       246,920       227,983  

Cost of sales

        –156,243       –161,101       –145,556  
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross income

        66,365       85,819       82,427  

Gross margin (%)

        29,8     34.8     36.2

Research and development expenses

        –31,635       –34,844       –36,308  

Selling and administrative expenses

        –28,866       –29,285       –27,100  
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating expenses

        –60,501       –64,129       –63,408  

Other operating income and expenses

     C6        404       153       –2,156  

Share in earnings of joint ventures and associated companies

     C3, C12        31       –38       –56  
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating income

     C3        6,299       21,805       16,807  

Financial income

     C7        –115       525       1,277  

Financial expenses

     C7        –2,158       –2,458       –2,273  
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income after financial items

        4,026       19,872       15,811  

Taxes

     C8        –2,131       –6,199       –4,668  
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income

        1,895       13,673       11,143  

Net income attributable to:

         

Stockholders of the Parent Company

        1,716       13,549       11,568  

Non-controlling interest

        179       124       –425  

Other information

         

Average number of shares, basic (million)

     C9        3,263       3,249       3,237  

Earnings per share attributable to stockholders of the Parent Company, basic
(SEK)
1)

     C9        0.53       4.17       3.57  

Earnings per share attributable to stockholders of the Parent Company, diluted (SEK) 1)

     C9        0.52       4.13       3.54  
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

1) Based on Net income attributable to stockholders of the Parent Company.

 

44


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Consolidated statement of comprehensive income

 

January–December, SEK million

   2016      2015      2014  

Net income

     1,895        13,673        11,143  

Other comprehensive income

        

Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss

        

Remeasurements of defined benefits pension plans including asset ceiling

     –1,766        –2,026        –10,017  

Tax on items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss

     520        721        2,218  

Items that may be reclassified to profit or loss

        

Available-for-sale financial assets

        

Gains/losses arising during the period

     –7        —          —    

Revaluation of other investments in shares and participations

        

Fair value remeasurement

     –2        457        47  

Changes in cumulative translation adjustments

     4,235        –604        8,734  

Share of other comprehensive income of joint ventures and associated companies

     –362        141        579  

Tax on items that may be reclassified to profit or loss

     1        —          5  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total other comprehensive income, net of tax

     2,619        –1,311        1,566  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total comprehensive income

     4,514        12,362        12,709  

Total comprehensive income attributable to:

        

Stockholders of the Parent Company

     4,285        12,218        12,981  

Non-controlling interests

     229        144        –272  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

45


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Consolidated balance sheet

 

December 31, SEK million

   Notes      2016      2015  

Assets

        

Non-current assets

        

Intangible assets

     C10, C26        

Capitalized development expenses

        8,076        5,493  

Goodwill

        43,387        41,087  

Intellectual property rights, brands and other intangible assets

        7,747        9,316  

Property, plant and equipment

     C11, C26, C27        16,734        15,901  

Financial assets

        

Equity in joint ventures and associated companies

     C12        775        1,210  

Other investments in shares and participations

     C12        1,179        1,275  

Customer finance, non-current

     C12        2,128        1,739  

Interest-bearing securities, non-current

     C12, C20        7,586        —    

Other financial assets, non-current

     C12        4,442        5,634  

Deferred tax assets

     C8        15,522        13,183  
     

 

 

    

 

 

 
        107,576        94,838  

Current assets

        

Inventories

     C13        30,307        28,436  

Trade receivables

     C14        68,117        71,069  

Customer finance, current

     C14        2,625        2,041  

Other current receivables

     C15        24,431        21,709  

Interest-bearing securities, current

     C20        13,325        26,046  

Cash and cash equivalents

     C25        36,966        40,224  
     

 

 

    

 

 

 
        175,771        189,525  
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total assets

        283,347        284,363  
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

Equity and liabilities

        

Equity

        

Stockholders’ equity

     C16        139,817        146,525  

Non-controlling interest in equity of subsidiaries

        675        841  
     

 

 

    

 

 

 
        140,492        147,366  

Non-current liabilities

        

Post-employment benefits

     C17        23,723        22,664  

Provisions, non-current

     C18        946        176  

Deferred tax liabilities

     C8        2,147        2,472  

Borrowings, non-current

     C19, C20        18,653        22,744  

Other non-current liabilities

        2,621        1,851  
     

 

 

    

 

 

 
        48,090        49,907  

Current liabilities

        

Provisions, current

     C18        5,411        3,662  

Borrowings, current

     C19, C20        8,033        2,376  

Trade payables

     C22        25,318        22,389  

Other current liabilities

     C21        56,003        58,663  
     

 

 

    

 

 

 
        94,765        87,090  
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total equity and liabilities 1)

        283,347        284,363  
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) Of which interest-bearing liabilities SEK 26,686 (25,120) million.

 

46


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Consolidated statement of cash flows

 

January–December, SEK million

   Notes      2016      2015      2014  

Operating activities

           

Net income

        1,895        13,673        11,143  

Adjustments to reconcile net income to cash

     C25        6,112        10,611        11,200  
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
        8,007        24,284        22,343  

Changes in operating net assets

           

Inventories

        –613        –366        –2,924  

Customer finance, current and non-current

        –950        824        –710  

Trade receivables

        5,933        7,000        1,182  

Trade payables

        2,775        –2,676        1,265  

Provisions and post-employment benefits

        3,106        544        –859  

Other operating assets and liabilities, net

        –4,248        –9,013        –1,595  
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
        6,003        –3,687        –3,641  
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cash flow from operating activities

        14,010        20,597        18,702  

Investing activities

           

Investments in property, plant and equipment

     C11        –6,129        –8,338        –5,322  

Sales of property, plant and equipment

        482        1,301        522  

Acquisitions of subsidiaries and other operations

     C25, C26        –984        –2,201        –4,442  

Divestments of subsidiaries and other operations

     C25, C26        362        1        48  

Product development

     C10        –4,483        –3,302        –1,523  

Other investing activities

        –3,004        –543        –3,392  

Interest–bearing securities

        5,473        5,095        6,596  
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cash flow from investing activities

        –8,283        –7,987        –7,513  
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cash flow before financing activities

        5,727        12,610        11,189  

Financing activities

           

Proceeds from issuance of borrowings

        1,527        1,179        1,282  

Repayment of borrowings

        –1,072        –1,336        –9,384  

Proceeds from stock issue

        131        —          —    

Sale/repurchase of own shares

        –26        169        —    

Dividends paid

        –12,263        –11,337        –9,846  

Other financing activities

        –39        615        –277  
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cash flow from financing activities

        –11,742        –10,710        –18,225  

Effect of exchange rate changes on cash

        2,757        –2,664        5,929  
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net change in cash

        –3,258        –764        –1,107  

Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of period

        40,224        40,988        42,095  
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents, end of period

     C25        36,966        40,224        40,988  
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

47


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Consolidated statement of changes in equity

Equity and Other comprehensive income 2016

 

SEK million

   Capital
stock
     Additional
paid in
capital
     Retained
earnings
     Stock-
holders’
equity
    Non-
controlling
interest
     Total
equity
 

January 1, 2016

     16,526        24,731        105,268        146,525       841        147,366  

Net income

                

Group

     —          —          1,690        1,690       179        1,869  

Joint ventures and associated companies

     —          —          26        26       —          26  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other comprehensive income

                

Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss

                

Remeasurements related to post-employment benefits

                

Group

     —          —          –1,770        –1,770       4        –1,766  

Tax on items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss

     —          —          521        521       –1        520  

Items that may be reclassified to profit or loss

                

Available-for-sale financial assets

                

Gains (+)/Losses (–) arising during the period

                

Group

     —          —          –7        –7       —          –7  

Revaluation of other investments in shares and participations

                

Group

     —          —          –2        –2       —          –2  

Changes in cumulative translation adjustments

                

Group

     —          —          4,188        4,188 1)       47        4,235  

Joint ventures and associated companies

     —          —          –362        –362       —          –362  

Tax on items that may be reclassified to profit or loss

     —          —          1        1       —          1  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total other comprehensive income, net of tax

     —          —          2,569        2,569       50        2,619  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total comprehensive income

     —          —          4,285        4,285       229        4,514  

Transactions with owners

                

Stock issue

     131        —          —          131       —          131  

Sale of own shares

     —          —          105        105       —          105  

Repurchase of own shares

     —          —          –131        –131       –190        –321  

Stock purchase plans

                

Group

     —          —          957        957       —          957  

Dividends paid

     —          —          –12,058        –12,058 2)       –205        –12,263  

Transactions with non-controlling interest

     —          —          3        3       —          3  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

December 31, 2016

     16,657        24,731        98,429        139,817       675        140,492  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) Changes in cumulative translation adjustments include changes regarding revaluation of goodwill in local currency of SEK 2,355 million (SEK 1,592 million in 2015 and 4,794 million in 2014), and realized gain/losses net from sold/liquidated companies, SEK –90 million (SEK –3 million in 2015 and SEK 3 million in 2014).
2) Dividends paid per share amounted to SEK 3.70 (SEK 3.40 in 2015 and SEK 3.00 in 2014).

 

48


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Equity and Other comprehensive income 2015

 

SEK million

   Capital
stock
     Additional
paid in
capital
     Retained
earnings
     Stock-
holders’
equity
     Non-
controlling
interest
     Total
equity
 

January 1, 2015

     16,526        24,731        103,049        144,306        1,003        145,309  

Net income

                 

Group

     —          —          13,587        13,587        124        13,711  

Joint ventures and associated companies

     —          —          –38        –38        —          –38  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other comprehensive income

                 

Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss

                 

Remeasurements related to post-employment benefits

                 

Group

     —          —          –2,033        –2,033        7        –2,026  

Tax on items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss

     —          —          722        722        –1        721  

Items that may be reclassified to profit or loss

                 

Revaluation of other investments in shares and participations

                 

Group

     —          —          457        457        —          457  

Changes in cumulative translation adjustments

                 

Group

     —          —          –618        –618        14        –604  

Joint ventures and associated companies

     —          —          141        141        —          141  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total other comprehensive income, net of tax

     —          —          –1,331        –1,331        20        –1,311  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total comprehensive income

     —          —          12,218        12,218        144        12,362  

Transactions with owners

                 

Sale/repurchase of own shares

     —          —          169        169        —          169  

Stock purchase plans

                 

Group

     —          —          865        865        —          865  

Dividends paid

     —          —          –11,033        –11,033        –304        –11,337  

Transactions with non-controlling interest

     —          —          —          —          –2        –2  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

December 31, 2015

     16,526        24,731        105,268        146,525        841        147,366  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

49


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Equity and Other comprehensive income 2014

 

SEK million

   Capital
stock
     Additional
paid in
capital
     Retained
earnings
     Stock-
holders’
equity
     Non-
controlling
interest
     Total
equity
 

January 1, 2014

     16,526        24,731        98,947        140,204        1,419        141,623  

Net income

                 

Group

     —          —          11,624        11,624        –425        11,199  

Joint ventures and associated companies

     —          —          –56        –56        —          –56  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other comprehensive income

                 

Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss

                 

Remeasurements related to post-employment benefits

                 

Group

     —          —          –10,014        –10,014        –3        –10,017  

Tax on items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss

     —          —          2,218        2,218        —          2,218  

Items that may be reclassified to profit or loss

                 

Revaluation of other investments in shares and participations

                 

Group

     —          —          47        47        —          47  

Changes in cumulative translation adjustments

                 

Group

     —          —          8,578        8,578        156        8,734  

Joint ventures and associated companies

     —          —          579        579        —          579  

Tax on items that may be reclassified to profit or loss

     —          —          5        5        —          5  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total other comprehensive income, net of tax

     —          —          1,413        1,413        153        1,566  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total comprehensive income

     —          —          12,981        12,981        –272        12,709  

Transactions with owners

                 

Sale/repurchase of own shares

     —          —          106        106        —          106  

Stock purchase plans

                 

Group

     —          —          717        717        —          717  

Dividends paid

     —          —          –9,702        –9,702        –144        –9,846  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

December 31, 2014

     16,526        24,731        103,049        144,306        1,003        145,309  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

50


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

C1    Significant accounting policies

Introduction

The consolidated financial statements comprise Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson, the Parent Company, and its subsidiaries (“the Company”) and the Company’s interests in joint ventures and associated companies. The Parent Company is domiciled in Sweden at Torshamnsgatan 21, SE-164 83 Stockholm.

The consolidated financial statements for the year ended December 31, 2016 have been prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) as endorsed by the EU and RFR 1 “Additional rules for Group Accounting,” related interpretations issued by the Swedish Financial Reporting Board (Rådet för Finansiell Rapportering), and the Swedish Annual Accounts Act. For the financial reporting of 2016, the Company has applied IFRS as issued by the IASB (IFRS effective as per December 31, 2016). There is no difference between IFRS effective as per December 31, 2016, and IFRS as endorsed by the EU, nor is RFR 1 related interpretations issued by the Swedish Financial Reporting Board (Rådet för Finansiell Rapportering) or the Swedish Annual Accounts Act in conflict with IFRS, for all periods presented.

The financial statements were approved by the Board of Directors on February 24, 2017. The balance sheets and income statements are subject to approval by the Annual General Meeting of shareholders.

Amendments applied as from January 1, 2016

There have not been any significant amendments of IFRS concerning the Company during 2016.

The following changes are not due to changes in IFRS:

Presentation in financial statements

In the consolidated Balance sheet, Interest-bearing securities, non-current has been added as a new line and Short term investments has been renamed Interest-bearing securities, current. On the statement of Cash flow, the line Short-term investments has been renamed Interest-bearing securities.

Basis of presentation

The financial statements are presented in millions of Swedish Krona (SEK). They are prepared on a historical cost basis, except for certain financial assets and liabilities that are stated at fair value: derivative financial instruments, financial instruments held for trading, financial instruments classified as available-for-sale and plan assets related to defined benefit pension plans. Financial information in the consolidated income statement, the consolidated statement of comprehensive income, the consolidated statement of cash flows and the consolidated statement of changes in equity with related notes are presented with two comparison years while for the consolidated balance sheet financial information with related notes is presented with only one comparison year.

Basis of consolidation and composition of the Group

The consolidated financial statements are prepared in accordance with the purchase method. Accordingly, consolidated stockholders’ equity includes equity in subsidiaries, joint ventures and associated companies earned only after their acquisition.

Subsidiaries are all companies for which Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson, directly or indirectly, is the parent. To be classified as a parent, Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson, directly or indirectly, must control another company which requires that the Parent Company has power over that other company, is exposed to variable returns from its involvement and has the ability to use its power over that other company. The financial statements of subsidiaries are included in the consolidated financial statements from the date that control commences until the date that such control ceases.

Intra-group balances and any unrealized income and expense arising from intra-group transactions are fully eliminated in preparing the consolidated financial statements. Unrealized losses are eliminated in the same way as unrealized gains, but only to the extent that there is no evidence of impairment.

The Company is composed of a parent company, Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson, with generally fully-owned subsidiaries in many countries of the world. The largest operating subsidiaries are the fully-owned telecom vendor companies Ericsson AB, incorporated in Sweden and Ericsson Inc., incorporated in the US.

Business combinations

At the acquisition of a business, the cost of the acquisition, being the purchase price, is measured as the fair value of the assets given, and liabilities incurred or assumed at the date of exchange, including any cost related to contingent consideration. Transaction costs attributable to the acquisition are expensed as incurred. The acquisition cost is allocated to acquired assets, liabilities and contingent liabilities based upon appraisals made, including assets and liabilities that were not recognized on the acquired entity’s balance sheet, for example intangible assets such as customer relations, brands, patents and financial liabilities. Goodwill arises when the purchase price exceeds the fair value of recognizable acquired net assets. In acquisitions with non-controlling interests full or partial goodwill can be recognized. Final amounts are established within one year after the transaction date at the latest.

In case there is a put option for non-controlling interest in a subsidiary a corresponding financial liability is recognized.

Non-controlling interest

The Company treats transactions with non-controlling interests as transactions with equity owners of the Company. For purchases from non-controlling interests, the difference between any consideration paid and the relevant share acquired of the carrying value of net assets of the subsidiary is recorded in equity. Gains or losses on disposals to non-controlling interests are also recorded in equity.

When the Company ceases to have control, any retained interest in the entity is remeasured to its fair value, with the change in carrying amount recognized in profit or loss. The fair value is the initial carrying amount for the purposes of subsequently accounting for the retained interest in an associate or financial asset. In addition, any amounts previously recognized in Other comprehensive income in respect of that entity are accounted for as if the Company had directly disposed of the related assets or liabilities. This may mean that amounts previously recognized in Other comprehensive income are reclassified to profit or loss.

At acquisition, there is a choice on an acquisition-by-acquisition basis to measure the non-controlling interest in the acquiree either at fair value or at the non-controlling interest’s proportionate share of the acquiree’s net assets.

Joint ventures and associated companies

Joint ventures and associated companies are accounted for in accordance with the equity method. Under the equity method, the investment in joint venture or associate is initially recognized at cost and the carrying amount is increased or decreased to recognize the investor’s share of the profit or loss of the investee after the date of acquisition. If the Company’s interest in an associated company is nil, the Company shall not, as prescribed by IFRS, recognize its part of any future losses. Provisions related to obligations for such an interest shall, however, be recognized in relation to such an interest.

Investments in associated companies, i.e., when the Company has significant influence and the power to participate in the financial and operating policy decisions of the associated company, but is not in control or joint control over those policies. Normally, this is the case in voting stock interest, including effective potential voting rights, which stand at least at 20% but not more than 50%.

 

51


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

The Company’s share of income before taxes is reported in item “Share in earnings of joint ventures and associated companies,” included in Operating Income. This reflects the fact that these interests are held for operating rather than investing or financial purposes. Ericsson’s share of income taxes related to associated companies is reported under the line item “Taxes,” in the income statement.

Unrealized gains on transactions between the Company and its joint ventures and associated companies are eliminated to the extent of the Company’s interest in these entities. Unrealized losses are also eliminated unless the transaction provides evidence of an impairment of the asset transferred.

Shares in earnings of joint ventures and associated companies included in consolidated equity which are undistributed are reported in Retained earnings in the balance sheet.

Impairment testing as well as recognition or reversal of impairment of investments in each joint venture and associated company is performed in the same manner as for intangible assets other than goodwill. The entire carrying value of each investment, including goodwill, is tested as a single asset. See also description under “Intangible assets other than goodwill” below.

If the ownership interest in an associate is reduced but significant influence is retained, only a proportionate share of the amounts previously recognized in Other comprehensive income are reclassified to profit or loss where appropriate.

In Note C2, “Critical Accounting Estimates and Judgments,” further disclosure is presented in relation to (i) key sources of estimation uncertainty and (ii) the decision made in relation to accounting policies applied.

Foreign currency remeasurement and translation

Items included in the financial statements of each entity of the Company are measured using the currency of the primary economic environment in which the entity operates (‘the functional currency’). The consolidated financial statements are presented in Swedish Krona (SEK), which is the Parent Company’s functional and presentation currency.

Transactions and balances

Foreign currency transactions are translated into the functional currency using the exchange rates prevailing at the dates of each respective transactions. Foreign exchange gains and losses resulting from the settlement of such transactions and from the translation at period-end exchange rates of monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies are recognized in the income statement, unless deferred in Other comprehensive income under the hedge accounting practices as described below.

Changes in the fair value of monetary securities denominated in foreign currency classified as available-for-sale are analyzed between translation differences resulting from changes in the amortized cost of the security and other changes in the carrying amount of the security. Translation differences related to changes in the amortized cost are recognized in profit or loss, and other changes in the carrying amount are recognized in OCI.

Translation differences on non-monetary financial assets and liabilities are reported as part of the fair value gain or loss.

Group companies

The results and financial position of all the group entities that have a functional currency different from the presentation currency are translated into the presentation currency as follows:

Assets and liabilities for each balance sheet presented are translated at the closing rate at the date of that balance sheet.

Period income and expenses for each income statement are translated at period average exchange rates.

All resulting net exchange differences are recognized as a separate component of Other comprehensive income (OCI).

On consolidation, exchange differences arising from the translation of the net investment in foreign operations, and of borrowings and other currency instruments designated as hedges of such investments, are accounted for in OCI. When a foreign operation is partially disposed of or sold, exchange differences that were recorded in OCI are recognized in the income statement as part of the gain or loss on sale.

Goodwill and fair value adjustments arising on the acquisition of a foreign entity are treated as assets and liabilities of the foreign entity and translated at the closing rate.

The Company is continuously monitoring the economies with high inflation, the risk of hyperinflation and potential impact on the Company. There is no significant impact due to any currency translation of a hyper-inflationary economy.

Statement of cash flows

The statement of cash flows is prepared in accordance with the indirect method. Cash flows in foreign subsidiaries are translated at the average exchange rate during the period. Payments for subsidiaries acquired or divested are reported as cash flow from investing activities, net of cash and cash equivalents acquired or disposed of respectively.

Cash and cash equivalents consist of cash, bank, and interest-bearing securities that are highly liquid monetary financial instruments with a remaining maturity of three months or less at the date of acquisition.

Revenue recognition

Background

The Company offers a comprehensive portfolio of telecommunication and data communication systems, professional services, and support solutions. Products, both hardware and software as well as services, are in general standardized. The impact of this is that any acceptance terms are normally only formal requirements. In Note C3, “Segment information,” the Company’s products and services are disclosed in more detail as per operating segment.

The Company’s products and services are generally sold under delivery-type or multi-year recurring services contracts. The delivery type contracts often contain content from more than one segment.

Accounting treatment

Sales are based on fair values of consideration received and recorded net of value added taxes, goods returned and estimated trade discounts. Revenue is recognized when risks and rewards have been transferred to the customer, with reference to all significant contractual terms, when:

 

   

The product or service has been delivered

 

   

The revenue amount is fixed or determinable

 

   

The customer has received and activation has been made of separately sold software

 

   

Collection is reasonably assured

Estimations of contractual performance criteria impact the timing and amounts of revenue recognized and may therefore defer revenue recognition until the performance criteria are met. The profitability of contracts is periodically assessed, and provisions for any estimated losses are made immediately when losses are probable.

Allocation and/or timing criteria specific to each type of contract are:

 

   

Delivery-type contracts – These contracts relate to delivery, installation, integration of products and provision of related services, normally under multiple elements contracts. Under multiple elements contracts, accounting is based on that the revenue recognition criteria are applied to the separately identifiable components of the contract. Revenue, including the impact of any discount or rebate, is allocated to each element based on relative fair values. Networks, Global Services and Support Solutions have contracts that relate to this type of arrangement.

 

   

Contracts for services – These relate to multi-year service contracts such as support- and managed service contracts and other types of recurring services. Revenue is recognized when the services have been provided, generally pro rata over the contract period. Global- Services has contracts that relate to this type of arrangement.

 

   

Contracts generating license fees from third-parties for the use of the Company’s intellectual property rights – License fees are measured based on the substance of the contract. Examples are a percentage of sales or currency amount per unit and recognized over the license period or at a single point of time when no obligations remain. The amount of consideration shall also be reasonably certain. Networks and Support Solutions have contracts that relate to this type of arrangement.

 

52


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

For sales between consolidated companies, associated companies, joint ventures and segments, the Company applies arm’s length pricing.

In Note C2, “Critical accounting estimates and judgments,” a further disclosure is presented in relation to (i) key sources of estimation uncertainty and (ii) the decision made in relation to accounting policies applied.

Earnings per share

Basic earnings per share are calculated by dividing net income attributable to stockholders of the Parent Company by the weighted average number of shares outstanding (total number of shares less treasury stock) during the year.

Diluted earnings per share are calculated by dividing net income attributable to stockholders of the Parent Company, when appropriately adjusted by the sum of the weighted average number of ordinary shares outstanding and dilutive potential ordinary shares. Potential ordinary shares are treated as dilutive when, and only when, their conversion to ordinary shares would decrease earnings per share.

Rights to matching shares are considered dilutive when the actual fulfillment of any performance conditions as of the reporting date would give a right to ordinary shares.

Financial assets

Financial assets are recognized when the Company becomes a party to the contractual provisions of the instrument. Regular purchases and sales of financial assets are recognized on the settlement date.

Financial assets are derecognized when the rights to receive cash flows from the investments have expired or have been transferred and the Company has transferred substantially all risks and rewards of ownership. Separate assets or liabilities are recognized if any rights and obligations are created or retained in the transfer.

The Company classifies its financial assets in the following categories: at fair value through profit or loss, loans and receivables, and available-for-sale. The classification depends on the purpose for which the financial assets were acquired. Management determines the classification of its financial assets at initial recognition.

Financial assets are initially recognized at fair value plus transaction costs for all financial assets not carried at fair value through profit or loss. Financial assets carried at fair value through profit or loss are initially recognized at fair value, and transaction costs are expensed in the income statement.

The fair values of quoted financial investments and derivatives are based on quoted market prices or rates. If official rates or market prices are not available, fair values are calculated by discounting the expected future cash flows at prevailing interest rates. Valuations of foreign exchange options and Interest Rate Guarantees (IRG) are made by using the Black-Scholes formula. Inputs to the valuations are market prices for implied volatility, foreign exchange and interest rates.

Financial assets at fair value through profit or loss

Financial assets at fair value through profit or loss either are designated as such at initial recognition or are financial assets held for trading. A financial asset is classified as held for trading if it is acquired principally for the purpose of selling in the near term.

Derivatives are classified as held for trading, unless they are designated as hedging instruments for the purpose of hedge accounting. Assets held for trading are classified as current assets.

Gains or losses arising from changes in the fair values of the “Financial assets at fair value through profit or loss” category (excluding derivatives) are presented in the income statement within Financial income in the period in which they arise. Derivatives are presented in the income statement either as Cost of sales, Other operating income, Financial income or Financial expense, depending on the intent with the transaction.

Loans and receivables

Receivables, including those that relate to customer financing, are subsequently measured at amortized cost using the effective interest rate method, less allowances for impairment charges. Trade receivables include amounts due from customers. The balance represents amounts billed to customers as well as amounts where risk and rewards have been transferred to the customer but the invoice has not yet been issued.

Collectability of the receivables is assessed for purposes of initial revenue recognition.

Available-for-sale financial assets

Investments in liquid bonds with low credit risk which are not held for trading are classified as available-for-sale. If the maturity is longer than one year the bonds are included in Interest-bearing securities, non-current. Bonds held as available-for-sale with a maturity shorter than one year are included in Interest-bearing securities, current. Unrealized gains and losses are recognized in OCI. When these securities are derecognized, the accumulated fair value adjustments will be included in financial income.

Dividends on available-for-sale equity instruments are recognized in the income statement as part of financial income when the Company’s right to receive payments is established.

Changes in the fair value of monetary securities denominated in a foreign currency and classified as available-for-sale are analyzed between translation differences resulting from changes in the amortized cost of the security and other changes in the carrying amount of the security. Translation differences on monetary securities are recognized in profit or loss; translation differences on non-monetary securities are recognized in OCI. Changes in the fair value of monetary and non-monetary securities classified as available-for-sale are recognized in OCI. When securities classified as available-for-sale are sold or impaired, the accumulated fair value adjustments previously recognized in OCI are included in the income statement.

Impairment

At each balance sheet date, the Company assesses whether there is objective evidence that a financial asset or a group of financial assets is impaired. In the case of equity securities classified as available-for-sale, a significant or prolonged decline in the fair value of the security below its cost is considered as evidence that the security is impaired. If any such evidence exists for available-for-sale financial assets, the cumulative loss – measured as the difference between the acquisition cost and the current fair value, less any impairment loss on that financial asset previously recognized in profit or loss – is removed from OCI and recognized in the income statement. Impairment losses recognized in the income statement on equity instruments are not reversed through the income statement.

An assessment of impairment of receivables is performed when there is objective evidence that the Company will not be able to collect all amounts due according to the original terms of the receivable. Significant financial difficulties of the debtor, probability that the debtor will enter bankruptcy or financial reorganization, and default or delinquency in payments are considered indicators that the trade receivable is impaired. The amount of the allowance is the difference between the asset’s carrying amount and the present value of estimated future cash flows, discounted at the original effective interest rate. The carrying amount of the asset is reduced through the use of an allowance account, and the amount of the loss is recognized in the income statement within selling expenses. When a trade receivable is finally established as uncollectible, it is written off against the allowance account for trade receivables. Subsequent recoveries of amounts previously written off are credited to selling expenses in the income statement.

Financial liabilities

Financial liabilities are recognized when the Company becomes bound to the contractual obligations of the instrument.

Financial liabilities are derecognized when they are extinguished, i.e., when the obligation specified in the contract is discharged, cancelled or expires.

Borrowings

Borrowings are initially recognized at fair value, net of transaction costs incurred. Borrowings are subsequently stated at amortized cost; any

 

53


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

difference between the proceeds (net of transaction costs) and the redemption value is recognized in the income statement over the period of the borrowings using the effective interest method.

Borrowings are classified as current liabilities unless the Company has an unconditional right to defer settlement of the liability for at least 12 months after the balance sheet date.

Trade payables

Trade payables are recognized initially at fair value and subsequently measured at amortized cost using the effective interest method.

Fair value hedging and fair value hedge accounting

The purpose of fair value hedges is to hedge the variability in the fair value of fixed-rate debt (issued bonds) from changes in the relevant benchmark yield curve for its entire term by converting fixed interest payments to a floating rate (e.g., STIBOR or LIBOR) by using interest rate swaps (IRS). The credit risk/spread is not hedged. The fixed leg of the IRS is matched against the cash flows of the hedged bond. Hereby, the fixed-rate bond/ debt is converted into a floating-rate debt in accordance with the policy.

Changes in the fair value of derivatives that are designated and qualify as fair value hedges are recorded in the income statement, together with any changes in the fair value of the hedged asset or liability that are attributable to the hedged risk, when hedge accounting is applied. The Company only applies fair value hedge accounting for hedging fixed interest risk on borrowings. Both gains and losses relating to the interest rate swaps hedging fixed rate borrowings and the changes in the fair value of the hedged fixed rate borrowings attributable to interest rate risk are recognized in the income statement within Financial expenses. If the hedge no longer meets the criteria for hedge accounting, the adjustment to the carrying amount of a hedged item for which the effective interest method is used is amortized to the income statement over the remaining period to maturity.

When applying fair value hedge accounting, derivatives are initially recognized at fair value at trade date and subsequently re-measured at fair value.

At the inception of the hedge, the Company documents the relationship between hedging instruments and hedged items, as well as its risk management objectives and strategy for undertaking various hedging transactions. The Company also documents its assessment, both at hedge inception and on an ongoing basis, of whether the derivatives that are used in hedging transactions are highly effective in offsetting changes in fair values or cash flows of the hedged items.

The fair values of various derivative instruments used for hedging purposes are disclosed in Note C20, “Financial risk management and financial instruments.” Movements in the hedging reserve in OCI are shown in Note C16, “Equity and other comprehensive income.”

The fair value of a hedging derivative is classified as a non-current asset or liability when the remaining maturity of the hedged item is more than 12 months, and as a current asset or liability when the remaining maturity of the hedged item is less than 12 months. Trading derivatives are classified as current assets or liabilities.

Financial guarantees

Financial guarantee contracts are initially recognized at fair value (i.e., usually the fee received). Subsequently, these contracts are measured at the higher of:

 

   

The amount determined as the best estimate of the net expenditure required to settle the obligation according to the guarantee contract.

 

   

The recognized contractual fee less cumulative amortization when amortized over the guarantee period, using the straight-line-method.

 

   

The best estimate of the net expenditure comprising future fees and cash flows from subrogation rights.

Inventories

Inventories are measured at the lower of cost or net realizable value on a first-in, first-out (FIFO) basis.

Risks of obsolescence have been measured by estimating market value based on future customer demand and changes in technology and customer acceptance of new products.

A significant part of Inventories is Contract work in progress (CWIP). Recognition and derecognition of CWIP relates to the Company’s revenue recognition principles meaning that costs incurred under a customer contract are recognized as CWIP. When revenue is recognized, CWIP is derecognized and is instead recognized as Cost of sales.

In Note C2, “Critical accounting estimates and judgments,” further disclosure is presented in relation to (i) key sources of estimation uncertainty and (ii) the decision made in relation to accounting policies applied.

Intangible assets

Intangible assets other than goodwill

Intangible assets other than goodwill comprise intangible assets acquired through business combinations, such as patents, customer relations, trademarks and software, as well as capitalized development expenses and separately acquired intangible assets, mainly consisting of software. At initial recognition, acquired intangible assets related to business combinations are stated at fair value and capitalized development expenses and software are stated at cost. Subsequent to initial recognition, these intangible assets are stated at initially recognized amounts less accumulated amortization and any impairment. Amortization and any impairment losses are included in Research and development expenses, which mainly consists of capitalized development expenses and technology; in Selling and administrative expenses, which mainly consists of expenses relating to customer relations and brands; and in Cost of sales.

Costs incurred for development of products to be sold, leased, or otherwise marketed or intended for internal use are capitalized as from when technological and economic feasibility has been established until the product is available for sale or use. Research and development expenses directly related to orders from customers are accounted for as a part of Cost of sales. Other research and development expenses are charged to income as incurred. Amortization of acquired intangible assets, such as patents, customer relations, trademarks, and software, is made according to the straight-line method over their estimated useful lives, not exceeding ten years.

The Company has not recognized any intangible assets with indefinite useful life other than goodwill.

Impairment tests are performed whenever there is an indication of possible impairment. However, intangible assets not yet available for use are tested annually. An impairment loss is recognized if the carrying amount of an asset or its cash-generating unit exceeds its recoverable amount. The recoverable amount is the higher of the value in use and the fair value less costs to sell. In assessing value in use, the estimated future cash flows after tax are discounted to their present value using an after-tax discount rate that reflects current market assessments of the time value of money and the risks specific to the asset. Application of after tax amounts in calculation, both in relation to cash flows and discount rate is applied due to that available models for calculating discount rate include a tax component. The after tax discount rate applied by the Company is not materially different from a discounting based on before-tax future cash flows and before-tax discount rates, as required by IFRS.

Corporate assets have been allocated to cash-generating units in relation to each unit’s proportion of total net sales. The amount related to corporate assets is not significant. Impairment losses recognized in prior periods are assessed at each reporting date for any indications that the loss has decreased or no longer exists. An impairment loss is reversed if there has been a change in the estimates used to determine the recoverable amounts and if the recoverable amount is higher than the carrying value. An impairment loss is reversed only to the extent that the asset’s carrying amount after reversal does not exceed the carrying amount, net of amortization, which would have been reported if no impairment loss had been recognized.

In Note C2, “Critical accounting estimates and judgments,” further disclosure is presented in relation to (i) key sources of estimation uncertainty and (ii) the decision made in relation to accounting policies applied.

Goodwill

As from the acquisition date, goodwill acquired in a business combination is allocated to each cash-generating unit (CGU) of the Company expected to benefit from the synergies of the combination. The Company’s three operating segments have been identified as CGUs.

 

54


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

An annual impairment test for the CGUs to which goodwill has been allocated is performed in the fourth quarter, or when there is an indication of impairment. Impairment testing as well as recognition of impairment of goodwill is performed in the same manner as for intangible assets other than goodwill: see description under “Intangible assets other than goodwill” above. An impairment loss in respect of goodwill is not reversed.

Additional disclosure is required in relation to goodwill impairment testing: see Note C2, “Critical accounting estimates and judgments” below and Note C10, “Intangible assets.”

Property, plant, and equipment

Property, plant, and equipment consist of real estate, machinery, servers and other technical assets, other equipment, tools and installation and construction in process and advance payment. They are stated at cost less accumulated depreciation and any impairment losses.

Depreciation is charged to income, on a straight-line basis, over the estimated useful life of each component of an item of property, plant, and equipment, including buildings. Estimated useful lives are, in general, 25–50 years for real estate and 3–10 years for machinery and equipment. Depreciation and any impairment charges are included in Cost of sales, Research and development or Selling and administrative expenses.

The Company recognizes in the carrying amount of an item of property, plant, and equipment the cost of replacing a component and derecog-nizes the residual value of the replaced component.

Impairment testing as well as recognition or reversal of impairment of property, plant and equipment is performed in the same manner as for intangible assets other than goodwill: see description under “Intangible assets other than goodwill” above.

Gains and losses on disposals are determined by comparing the proceeds less cost to sell with the carrying amount and are recognized within Other operating income and expenses in the income statement.

Leasing

Leasing when the Company is the lessee

Leases on terms in which the Company assumes substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership are classified as finance leases. Upon initial recognition, the leased asset is measured at an amount equal to the lower of its fair value and the present value of the minimum lease payments. Subsequent to initial recognition, the asset is accounted for in accordance with the accounting policy applicable to that type of asset, although the depreciation period must not exceed the lease term.

Other leases are operating leases, and the leased assets under such contracts are not recognized on the balance sheet. Costs under operating leases are recognized in the income statement on a straight-line basis over the term of the lease. Lease incentives received are recognized as an integral part of the total lease expense, over the term of the lease.

Leasing when the Company is the lessor

Leasing contracts with the Company as lessor are classified as finance leases when the majority of risks and rewards are transferred to the lessee, and otherwise as operating leases. Under a finance lease, a receivable is recognized at an amount equal to the net investment in the lease and revenue is recognized in accordance with the revenue recognition principles.

Under operating leases the equipment is recorded as property, plant and equipment and revenue as well as depreciation is recognized on a straight-line basis over the lease term.

Income taxes

Income taxes in the consolidated financial statements include both current and deferred taxes. Income taxes are reported in the income statement unless the underlying item is reported directly in equity or OCI. For those items, the related income tax is also reported directly in equity or OCI. A current tax liability or asset is recognized for the estimated taxes payable or refundable for the current year or prior years.

Deferred tax is recognized for temporary differences between the book values of assets and liabilities and their tax values and for tax loss carry-forwards. A deferred tax asset is recognized only to the extent that it is probable that future taxable profits will be available against which the

deductible temporary differences and tax loss carry-forwards can be utilized. In the recognition of income taxes, the Company offsets current tax receivables against current tax liabilities and deferred tax assets against deferred tax liabilities in the balance sheet, when the Company has a legal right to offset these items and the intention to do so. Deferred tax is not recognized for the following temporary differences: goodwill not deductible for tax purposes, for the initial recognition of assets or liabilities that affect neither accounting nor taxable profit, and for differences related to investments in subsidiaries when it is probable that the temporary difference will not reverse in the foreseeable future.

Deferred tax is measured at the tax rate that is expected to be applied to the temporary differences when they reverse, based on the tax laws that have been enacted or substantively enacted by the reporting date. An adjustment of deferred tax asset/liability balances due to a change in the tax rate is recognized in the income statement, unless it relates to a temporary difference earlier recognized directly in equity or OCI, in which case the adjustment is also recognized in equity or OCI.

The measurement of deferred tax assets involves judgment regarding the deductibility of costs not yet subject to taxation and estimates regarding sufficient future taxable income to enable utilization of unused tax losses in different tax jurisdictions. All deferred tax assets are subject to annual review of probable utilization.

In Note C2, “Critical accounting estimates and judgments,” further disclosure is presented in relation to (i) key sources of estimation uncertainty and (ii) the decision made in relation to accounting policies applied.

Provisions and contingent liabilities

Provisions are made when there are legal or constructive obligations as a result of past events and when it is probable that an outflow of resources will be required to settle the obligations and the amounts can be reliably estimated. When the effect of the time value of money is material, discounting is made of estimated outflows. However, the actual outflows as a result of the obligations may differ from such estimates.

The provisions are mainly related to warranty commitments, restructuring, customer projects and other obligations, such as unresolved income tax and value added tax issues, claims or obligations as a result of patent infringement and other litigations, supplier claims and customer finance guarantees.

Product warranty commitments consider probabilities of all material quality issues based on historical performance for established products and expected performance for new products, estimates of repair cost per unit, and volumes sold still under warranty up to the reporting date.

A restructuring obligation is considered to have arisen when the Company has a detailed formal plan for the restructuring (approved by management), which has been communicated in such a way that a valid expectation has been raised among those affected. Provision for restructuring is recorded when the Company can reliably estimate the liabilities relating to the obligation. Project related provisions include estimated losses on onerous contracts, contractual penalties and undertakings. For losses on customer contracts, a provision equal to the total estimated loss is recorded when a loss from a contract is anticipated and possible to estimate reliably. These contract loss estimates include any probable penalties to a customer under a loss contract.

Other provisions include provisions for unresolved tax issues, litigations, supplier claims, customer finance and other provisions. The Company provides for estimated future settlements related to patent infringements based on the probable outcome of each infringement. The actual outcome or actual cost of settling an individual infringement may vary from the Company’s estimate.

The Company estimates the outcome of any potential patent infringement made known to the Company through assertion and through the Company’s own monitoring of patent-related cases in the relevant legal systems. To the extent that the Company makes the judgment that an identified potential infringement will more likely than not result in an outflow of resources, the Company records a provision based on the Company’s best estimate of the expenditure required to settle with the counterpart.

In the ordinary course of business, the Company is subject to proceedings, lawsuits and other unresolved claims, including proceedings under

 

55


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

laws and government regulations and other matters. These matters are often resolved over a long period of time. The Company regularly assesses the likelihood of any adverse judgments in or outcomes of these matters, as well as potential ranges of possible losses. Provisions are recognized when it is probable that an obligation has arisen and the amount can be reasonably estimated based on a detailed analysis of each individual issue.

Certain present obligations are not recognized as provisions as it is not probable that an economic outflow will be required to settle the obligation or the amount of the obligation cannot be measured with sufficient reliability. Such obligations are reported as contingent liabilities. For further detailed information, see Note C24, “Contingent liabilities.” In Note C2, “Critical accounting estimates and judgments,” further disclosure is presented in relation to (i) key sources of estimation uncertainty and (ii) the decision made in relation to accounting policies applied.

Post-employment benefits

Pensions and other post-employment benefits are classified as either defined contribution plans or defined benefit plans. Under a defined contribution plan, the Company’s only obligation is to pay a fixed amount to a separate entity (a pension trust fund) with no obligation to pay further contributions if the fund does not hold sufficient assets to pay all employee benefits. The related actuarial and investment risks fall on the employee. The expenditures for defined contribution plans are recognized as expenses during the period when the employee provides service.

Under a defined benefit plan, it is the Company’s obligation to provide agreed benefits to current and former employees. The related actuarial and investment risks fall on the Company.

The present value of the defined benefit obligations for current and former employees is calculated using the Projected Unit Credit Method. The discount rate for each country is determined by reference to market yields on high-quality corporate bonds that have maturity dates approximating the terms of the Company’s obligations. In countries where there is no deep market in such bonds, the market yields on government bonds are used. The calculations are based upon actuarial assumptions, assessed on a quarterly basis, and are as a minimum prepared annually. Actuarial assumptions are the Company’s best estimate of the variables that determine the cost of providing the benefits. When using actuarial assumptions, it is possible that the actual results will differ from the estimated results or that the actuarial assumptions will change from one period to another. These differences are reported as actuarial gains and losses. They are, for example, caused by unexpectedly high or low rates of employee turnover, changed life expectancy, salary changes, remeasurement of plan assets and changes in the discount rate. Actuarial gains and losses are recognized in OCI in the period in which they occur. The Company’s net liability for each defined benefit plan consists of the present value of pension commitments less the fair value of plan assets and is recognized net on the balance sheet. When the result is a net benefit to the Company, the recognized asset is limited to the present value of any future refunds from the plan or reductions in future contributions to the plan.

Interest cost on the defined benefit obligation and interest income on plan assets is calculated as a net interest amount by applying the discount rate to the net defined benefit liability. All past service costs are recognized immediately. Swedish special payroll tax is accounted for as a part of the pension cost and the pension liability respectively.

Payroll taxes related to actuarial gains and losses are included in determining actuarial gains and losses, reported under OCI.

In Note C2, “Critical accounting estimates and judgments,” further disclosure is presented in relation to key sources of estimation uncertainty.

Share-based compensation to employees and the Board of Directors

Share-based compensation is related to remuneration to all employees, including key management personnel and the Board of Directors.

Under IFRS, a company shall recognize compensation costs for share-based compensation programs based on a measure of the value to the company of services received under the plans.

This value is based on the fair value of, for example, free shares at grant date, measured as stock price as per each investment date. The value at grant date is charged to the income statement as any other remuneration over the service period. For example, value at grant date is 90. Given the normal service period of three years within Ericsson, 30 would be charged per year during the service period.

The amount charged to the income statement is reversed in equity each time of the income statement charge.

The reason for this IFRS accounting principle is that compensation cost is a cost with no direct cash flow impact. The purpose of share-based accounting according to IFRS (IFRS 2) is to present the impact of share-based programs, being part of the total remuneration, in the income statement.

Compensation to employees

Stock purchase plans

For stock purchase plans, compensation costs are recognized during the vesting period, based on the fair value of the Ericsson share at the employee’s investment date. The fair value is based upon the share price at investment date, adjusted for the fact that no dividends will be received on matching shares prior to matching and other features that are non- vesting conditions. The employee pays a price equal to the share price at investment date for the investment shares. The investment date is considered as the grant date. In the balance sheet, the corresponding amounts are accounted for as equity. Vesting conditions are non-market-based and affect the number of shares that Ericsson will match. Other features of a share-based payment are non-vesting conditions. These features would need to be included in the grant date fair value for transactions with employees and others providing similar services. Non-vesting conditions would not impact the number of awards expected to vest or valuation thereof subsequent to grant date. When calculating the compensation costs for shares under performance-based matching programs, the Company at each reporting date assesses the probability that the performance targets will be met. Compensation expenses are based on estimates of the number of shares that will match at the end of the vesting period. When shares are matched, social security charges are to be paid in certain countries on the value of the employee benefit. The employee benefit is generally based on the market value of the shares at the matching date. During the vesting period, estimated amounts for such social security charges are expensed and accrued.

Compensation to the Board of Directors

During 2008, the Parent Company introduced a share-based compensation program as a part of the remuneration to the Board of Directors. The program gives non-employee Directors elected by the General Meeting of Shareholders a right to receive part of their remuneration as a future payment of an amount which corresponds to the market value of a share of class B in the Parent Company at the time of payment, as further disclosed in Note C28, “Information regarding members of the Board of Directors, the Group management and employees.” The cost for cash settlements is measured and recognized based on the estimated costs for the program on a pro rata basis during the service period, being one year. The estimated costs are remeasured during and at the end of the service period.

Segment reporting

An operating segment is a component of a company whose operating results are regularly reviewed by the Company’s chief operating decision maker, (CODM), to make decisions about resources to be allocated to the segment and assess its performance. The President and the Chief Executive Officer is defined as the CODM function in the Company.

The segment presentation, as per each segment, is based on the Company’s accounting policies as disclosed in this note. The arm’s length principle is applied in transactions between the segments.

The Company’s segment disclosure about geographical areas is based on the country in which transfer of risks and rewards occur.

New standards and interpretations not yet adopted

A number of issued new standards, amendments to standards and interpretations are not yet effective for the year ended December 31, 2016 and have not been applied in preparing these consolidated financial statements.

 

56


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Below is a list of applicable standards/interpretations that have been issued and are effective for periods as described per standard.

IFRS 9, “Financial instruments.” The complete version of IFRS 9 replaces most of the guidance in IAS 39. IFRS 9 retains but simplifies the-mixed measurement model and establishes three primary measurement-categories for financial assets: amortized cost, fair value through OCI and fair value through profit or loss. The basis of classification depends on the entity’s business model and the contractual cash flow characteristics of the financial asset. Investments in equity instruments are required to be measured at fair value through profit or loss with the irrevocable option at inception to present changes in fair value in OCI. There is now a new expected credit losses model that replaces the incurred loss impairment model used in IAS 39. IFRS 9 also amends the principles for hedge accounting. This standard is effective as from January 1, 2018. The Company has not yet finalized the evaluation of any impact on financial result or position.

IFRS 15, “Revenue from Contracts with Customers,” establishes a new principle based model of recognizing revenue from customer contracts. This is a five-step model that requires revenue to be recognized as control over goods and services are transferred to the customer. IFRS 15 will be effective for implementation on January 1, 2018. The Company has evaluated the resulting changes to accounting principles and internal processes due to the new revenue recognition model and is currently implementing the changes in line with the implementation date January 1, 2018. The Company is currently assessing the impact of the implementation of the standard at transition date, including impact on the comparative numbers for prior reporting periods. This exercise is yet to be completed, therefore it is not practicably possible to disclose reliable estimates of the impact on financial statements at the transition date. The standard provides a choice of two transition methods, full retrospective or cumulative effect method. The full retrospective method requires restatement of prior year comparatives and adjustment to equity to the earliest presented comparative period, i.e. January 1, 2016, whereas with the cumulative effect method, the impact is adjusted to equity at the transition date of January 1, 2018. The Company has not decided on the transition method to be adopted at January 1, 2018 but will consider factors such as materiality of the impact on prior reporting periods (when reliably estimated), practicalities and costs of data gathering, in arriving at the decision.

IFRS 16 “Leases”. In January 2016, IASB issued a new lease standard that will replace IAS 17 Leases and the related interpretations IFRIC 4, SIC-15 and SIC-27. The standard requires assets and liabilities arising from all leases, with some exceptions, to be recognized on the balance sheet. This model reflects that, at the start of a lease, the lessee obtains the right to use an asset for a period of time and has an obligation to pay for that right. The accounting for lessors will be based on the same classification as under IAS 17, operating or finance leasing. The definition of a lease is amended. The standard is effective for annual periods beginning on or after January 1, 2019. Early adoption is permitted. EU has not yet adopted the standard. The Company will apply the new standard as from January 1, 2019. The initial assessment indicates that the main impact on the balance sheet is expected, where the Company is the lessee, primarily in contracts for real estate and vehicles.

C2     Critical accounting estimates and judgments

The preparation of financial statements and application of accounting standards often involve management’s judgment and the use of estimates and assumptions deemed to be reasonable at the time they are made. However, other results may be derived with different judgments or using different assumptions or estimates, and events may occur that could require a material adjustment to the carrying amount of the asset or liability affected. Following are the most important accounting policies subject to such judgments and the key sources of estimation uncertainty that the Company believes could have the most significant impact on the reported results and financial position.

The information in this note is grouped as per:

 

   

Key sources of estimation uncertainty

 

   

Judgments management has made in the process of applying the Company’s accounting policies.

Revenue recognition

Key sources of estimation uncertainty

Examples of estimates of total contract revenue and cost that are necessary are the assessing of customer possibility to reach conditional purchase volumes triggering contractual discounts to be given to the customer, the impact on the Company revenue in relation to performance criteria and whether any loss provisions shall be made. As disclosed in note C3 “Segment information” there is no customer for which revenues exceeds 10% of the Company’s total revenue. It is, however, also disclosed that most of the sales are derived from large, multi-year agreements with a limited number of significant customers.

For further discussion on revenue recognition, see Note C1, “Significant accounting policies” and Note C4, “Net sales.”

Judgments made in relation to accounting policies applied

Parts of the Company’s sales are generated from large and complex customer contracts. Managerial judgment is applied regarding, among other aspects, conformance with acceptance criteria and if transfer of risks and rewards to the buyer have taken place to determine if revenue and costs should be recognized in the current period, degree of completion and the customer credit standing to assess whether payment is likely or not to justify revenue recognition.

Trade and customer finance receivables

Key sources of estimation uncertainty

The Company monitors the financial stability of its customers and the environment in which they operate to make estimates regarding the likelihood that the individual receivables will be paid. Total allowances for estimated losses as of December 31, 2016, were SEK 1.7 (1.5) billion or 2.2% (2.0%) of gross trade and customer finance receivables. For further detailed information, see Note C14, “Trade receivables and customer finance.”

Credit risks for outstanding customer finance credits are regularly assessed as well, and allowances are recorded for estimated losses.

Inventory valuation

Key sources of estimation uncertainty

Inventories are valued at the lower of cost and net realizable value. Estimates are required in relation to forecasted sales volumes and inventory balances. In situations where excess inventory balances are identified, estimates of net realizable values for the excess volumes are made. Inventory allowances for estimated losses as of December 31, 2016, amounted to SEK 2.4 (2.6) billion or 7% (8%) of gross inventory. For further detailed information, see Note C13, “Inventories.”

Deferred taxes

Key sources of estimation uncertainty

Deferred tax assets and liabilities are recognized for temporary differences and for tax loss carry-forwards. Deferred tax is recognized net of

 

57


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

valuation allowances. The valuation of temporary differences and tax loss carry-forwards, is based on management’s estimates of future taxable profits in different tax jurisdictions against which the temporary differences and loss carry-forwards may be utilized.

The largest amounts of tax loss carry-forwards are reported in Sweden, with an indefinite period of utilization (i.e. with no expiry date). For further detailed information, please refer to Note C8, “Taxes.”

At December 31, 2016, the value of deferred tax assets amounted to SEK 15.5 (13.2) billion. The deferred tax assets related to loss carry-forwards are reported as non-current assets.

Accounting for income tax, value added tax, and other taxes

Key sources of estimation uncertainty

Accounting for these items is based upon evaluation of income, value added and other tax rules in all jurisdictions where the Company performs activities. The total complexity of rules related to taxes and the accounting for these require management’s involvement in judgments regarding classification of transactions and in estimates of probable outcomes of claimed deductions and/or disputes.

Acquired intellectual property rights and other intangible assets, including goodwill

Key sources of estimation uncertainty

At initial recognition, future cash flows are estimated, to ensure that the initial carrying values do not exceed the expected discounted cash flows for the items of this type of assets. After initial recognition, impairment testing is performed whenever there is an indication of impairment, except in the case of goodwill for which impairment testing is performed at least once per year. Negative deviations in actual cash flows compared to estimated cash flows as well as new estimates that indicate lower future cash flows might result in recognition of impairment charges.

For further discussion on goodwill, see Note C1, “Significant accounting policies” and Note C10, “Intangible assets.” Estimates related to acquired intangible assets are based on similar assumptions and risks as for goodwill. In Note C10 “Intangible assets,” it is disclosed that for the Media segment the headroom is SEK 5.6 billion when a discount of 8.0% is applied. The recoverable amount is equal to its carrying amount when the discount factor is increased to 10.0%. For more information, see Note C10, “Intangible assets.”

At December 31, 2016, the amount of acquired intellectual property rights and other intangible assets amounted to SEK 51.1 (50.4) billion, including goodwill of SEK 43.4 (41.1) billion.

Judgments made in relation to accounting policies applied

At initial recognition and subsequent remeasurement, management judgments are made, both for key assumptions and regarding impairment indicators. In the purchase price allocation made for each acquisition, the purchase price shall be assigned to the identifiable assets, liabilities and contingent liabilities based on fair values for these assets. Any remaining excess value is reported as goodwill.

This allocation requires management judgment as well as the definition of cash-generating units for impairment testing purposes. Other judgments might result in significantly different results and financial position in the future.

Provisions

Key sources of estimation uncertainty

Provisions mainly comprise amounts related to restructuring, warranty, contractual obligations and penalties to customers and estimated losses on customer contracts, risks associated with patent and other litigations, supplier or subcontractor claims and/or disputes, as well as provisions for unresolved income tax and value added tax issues. In relation to restructuring, the Company is executing a cost and efficiency program that was first initiated in the last quarter of 2014 and then expanded in the second quarter of 2016. The estimates related to the amounts of provisions for restructuring, penalties, claims or losses receive special attention from the management. At December 31, 2016, provisions amounted to SEK 6.4 (3.8) billion. For further detailed information, see Note C18, “Provisions.”

Judgments made in relation to accounting policies applied

Whether a present obligation is probable or not requires judgment. The nature and type of risks for these provisions differ and management’s judgment is applied regarding the nature and extent of obligations in deciding if an outflow of resources is probable or not.

Contingent liabilities

Key sources of estimation uncertainty

As disclosed under ‘Provisions’ there are uncertainties in the estimated amounts. The same type of uncertainty exists for contingent liabilities.

Judgments made in relation to accounting policies applied

As disclosed under Note C1, “Significant accounting policies” a potential obligation that is not likely to result in an economic outflow is classified as a contingent liability, with no impact on the Company’s financial statements. However, should an obligation in a later period be deemed to be probable, then a provision shall be recognized, impacting the financial statements.

Pension and other post-employment benefits

Key sources of estimation uncertainty

Accounting for the costs of defined benefit pension plans and other applicable post-employment benefits is based on actuarial valuations, relying on key estimates for discount rates, future salary increases, employee turnover rates and mortality tables. The discount rate assumptions are based on rates for high-quality fixed-income investments with durations as close as possible to the Company’s pension plans. In countries where there is not a deep market in high-quality corporate bonds, the market yields on government bonds shall be applied. As of 2015, due to the market situation in Sweden, the Company has applied yields on Swedish government bonds for the calculation of the defined benefit obligation in Sweden. The discount rate applied in Sweden was 1.8% (2.1%). At December 31, 2016, defined benefit obligations for pensions and other post-employment benefits amounted to SEK 87.2 (78.1) billion and fair value of plan assets to SEK 64.5 (58.2) billion. For more information on estimates and assumptions, see Note C17, “Post-employment benefits.”

Foreign exchange risks

Key sources of estimation uncertainty

Foreign exchange risk impacts the financial results of the Company: see further disclosure in Note C20, “Financial risk management and financial instruments,” under Foreign exchange risk.

 

58


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

C3    Segment information

Operating segments

When determining Ericsson’s operating segments, consideration has been given to which markets and what type of customers the products and services aim to attract, as well as the distribution channels they are sold through. Commonality regarding technology, research and development has also been taken into account. To best reflect the business focus and to facilitate comparability with peers, three operating segments are reported:

 

   

Networks

 

   

Global Services

 

   

Support Solutions

 

   

(Modems, closed during second half of 2015)

Networks delivers products and solutions for mobile access, IP and transmission networks, core networks and cloud. The offering includes:

 

   

Radio access solutions that interconnect with devices such as mobile phones, tablets and PCs.

 

   

IP routing and transport solutions including routers, Ericsson’s evolved IP network as well as backhaul including microwave (MINI-LINK) and optical transmission solutions for mobile and fixed networks

 

   

Core networks are based on the Ericsson Blade Server platform and include solutions such as the IMS

 

   

A cloud platform that can handle all types of workloads for all clouds; telecom cloud, IT cloud and commercial cloud.

Global Services delivers managed services, product-related services, consulting and systems integration services as well as broadcast and media services. The offering includes:

 

   

Managed Services: Services for designing, building, operating and managing the day-to-day operations of the customer’s network or solution; maintenance; network sharing solutions; plus shared solutions such as hosting of platforms and applications. Ericsson also offers managed services of IT environments.

 

   

Product-related services: Services to expand, upgrade, restructure or migrate networks; network-rollout services; customer support; network design and optimization services.

 

   

Consulting and Systems Integration: Technology and operational consulting; integration of multi-vendor equipment; design and integration of new solutions and transforming programs.

 

   

Broadcast Services: Services include responsibility for technical platforms and operational services related to TV content management, playout and service provisioning.

Support Solutions provides software suites for operators. The offering includes:

 

   

Operations Support Systems: plan, build and optimize, service fulfillment and service assurance.

 

   

Business Support Systems: revenue management (prepaid, post-paid, convergent charging and billing), mediation and customer care solutions.

 

   

TV & Media solutions: a suite of open, standards-based solutions and products for the creation, management and delivery of TV on any device over any network, including a TV platform for content creation, content management, on-demand video delivery, advanced video compression and video-optimized delivery network infrastructure.

 

   

M-Commerce solutions for money transfer: payment transactions and services between mobile subscribers and operators or other service providers.

Modems performed design, development and sales of the LTE multimode thin modems solutions, including 2G, 3G and 4G interoperability. Modems was consolidated into Ericsson in late 2013. Since the integration, the addressable market for thin modems has been reduced. In addition, there is strong competition, price erosion and an accelerating pace of technology innovation. As a consequence, Ericsson announced, on September 18, 2014, the discontinuation of further development of modems. Modems have had no impact on Group profit and loss from the second half of 2015.

Unallocated

Some revenues, costs, assets and liabilities are not identified as part of any operating segment and are therefore not allocated. Examples of such items are costs for corporate staff, IT costs and general marketing costs.

Regions

The Regions are the Company’s primary sales channel. The Company operates worldwide and reports its operations divided into ten geographical regions and one region Other:

 

   

North America

 

   

Latin America

 

   

Northern Europe & Central Asia

 

   

Western and Central Europe

 

   

Mediterranean

 

   

Middle East

 

   

Sub-Saharan Africa

 

   

India

 

   

North East Asia

 

   

South East Asia & Oceania

 

   

Other.

Region “Other” includes licensing revenues, broadcast services, power modules, mobile broadband modules, Ericsson-LG Enterprise and other businesses.

Major customers

The Company does not have any customer for which revenues from transactions have exceeded 10% of the Company’s total revenues for the years 2016, 2015 or 2014.

Ericsson derives most of its sales from large, multi-year agreements with a limited number of significant customers. Out of a customer base of more than 500, mainly consisting of network operators, the 10 largest customers accounted for 46% (46%) of net sales. The largest customer accounted for approximately 7% (7%) of sales in 2016.

For more information, see Risk Factors, “Market, Technology and Business Risks.”

Marketing channels

Marketing in a business-to-business environment is expanding, from being primarily conducted through personal meetings, to on-line forums, expert blogs and social media. Ericsson performs marketing through:

 

   

Customer engagement with a consultative approach

 

   

Selective focus on events and experience centers for customer experience and interaction

 

   

Continuous dialogue with customers and target audiences through social and other digital media (including virtual events)

 

   

Activation of the open social and digital media landscape to strengthen message reach and impact

 

   

Execution of solutions-driven programs, aligned globally and regionally.

New segment structure from January 1, 2017

From January 1, 2017, segment reporting is based on a new structure, with three new operating segments:

 

   

Segment Networks. Products and services with a focus on evolving and managing our customers’ telecom networks. The portfolio of radio networks and backhaul solutions are based on industry standards and can also be industrialized and adjusted to meet the demands of other industry verticals as utilities, transport and public safety. In addition, Ericsson services capabilities address operator demand in an increasingly complex network environment.

 

   

Segment IT & Cloud. Products and services providing solutions for our customers’ digital transformation journeys across the Support Systems, Telecom core and IT Cloud domains through a combination of products, technology and expertise in networks, software, cloud and business processes.

 

   

Segment Media. Products and services that enable content owners, broadcasters, TV service providers and network operators to efficiently deliver, manage and monetize new TV experiences.

 

59


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Operating segments 2016

 

       Networks     Global
Services
    Support
Solutions
    Total
Segments
    Unallocated      Group  

Segment sales

     108,338       101,722       12,548       222,608       —          222,608  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net sales

     108,338       101,722       12,548       222,608       —          222,608  

Operating income

     4,727       3,308       –951       7,084       –785        6,299  

Operating margin (%)

     4     3     –8     3     —          3

Financial income

                –115  

Financial expenses

                –2,158  
             

 

 

 

Income after financial items

                4,026  

Taxes

                –2,131  
             

 

 

 

Net income

                1,895  
             

 

 

 

Other segment items

             

Share in earnings of JV and associated companies

     19       46       3       68       –37        31  

Amortization

     –2,320       –869       –1,276       –4,465       —          –4,465  

Depreciation

     –3,018       –1,207       –196       –4,421       —          –4,421  

Impairment losses

     –107       –42       –92       –241       —          –241  

Reversals of impairment losses

     6       2       —         8       —          8  

Restructuring expenses

     –4,040       –2,984       –449       –7,473       –94        –7,567  

Gains/losses from divestments

     –15       —         —         –15       138        123  

Operating segments 2015

 

       Networks     Global
Services
    Support
Solutions
    Modems 1)
     Total
Segments
    Unallocated      Group  

Segment sales

     123,720       108,018       15,049       133        246,920       —          246,920  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net sales

     123,720       108,018       15,049       133        246,920       —          246,920  

Operating income

     12,943       8,215       1,504       7        22,669       –864        21,805  

Operating margin (%)

     10     8     10     —          9     —          9

Financial income

                   525  

Financial expenses

                   –2,458  
                

 

 

 

Income after financial items

                   19,872  

Taxes

                   –6,199  
                

 

 

 

Net income

                   13,673  
                

 

 

 

Other segment items

                

Share in earnings of JV and associated companies

     –95       43       –33       —          –85       47        –38  

Amortization

     –3,327       –1,029       –1,118       —          –5,474       –44        –5,518  

Depreciation

     –3,197       –1,212       –188       –108        –4,705       —          –4,705  

Impairment losses

     –20       —         —         —          –20       —          –20  

Reversals of impairment losses

     11       4       1       —          16       —          16  

Restructuring expenses

     –2,839       –1,681       –480       –15        –5,015       –25        –5,040  

Gains/losses from divestments

     —         1       —         —          1       –50        –49  

 

1) Modems was closed during second half of 2015.

 

60


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Operating segments 2014

 

       Networks     Global
Services
    Support
Solutions
    Modems      Total
Segments
    Unallocated      Group  

Segment sales

     117,487       97,659       12,655       182        227,983       —          227,983  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net sales

     117,487       97,659       12,655       182        227,983       —          227,983  

Operating income

     13,544       6,067       –31       –2,025        17,555       –748        16,807  

Operating margin (%)

     12     6     0     —          8     —          7

Financial income

                   1,277  

Financial expenses

                   –2,273  
                

 

 

 

Income after financial items

                   15,811  

Taxes

                   –4,668  
                

 

 

 

Net income

                   11,143  
                

 

 

 

Other segment items

                

Share in earnings of JV and associated companies

     33       32       –52       —          13       –69        –56  

Amortization

     –3,497       –1,036       –902       –168        –5,603       5        –5,598  

Depreciation

     –3,225       –820       –124       –160        –4,329       —          –4,329  

Impairment losses

     –34       –1       –2       —          –37       —          –37  

Reversals of impairment losses

     14       4       —         1        19       —          19  

Restructuring expenses

     –443       –835       –146       –32        –1,456       —          –1,456  

Gains/losses from divestments

     —         —         —         —          —         –36        –36  

Regions

 

       Net sales      Non-current assets 5)  
     2016      2015      2014      2016      2015      2014  

North America 3)

     54,747        58,261        54,509        14,650        14,870        16,148  

Latin America

     17,933        21,357        22,570        1,543        1,321        1,749  

Northern Europe & Central Asia 1)2)

     9,069        10,649        12,373        53,647        48,910        43,868  

Western & Central Europe 2)

     16,210        19,732        19,706        3,499        3,886        4,227  

Mediterranean 2)

     20,905        23,310        23,003        1,048        1,208        1,389  

Middle East

     19,156        22,849        21,277        50        99        100  

Sub-Saharan Africa

     9,177        10,349        8,749        36        40        54  

India

     10,748        13,381        7,702        458        390        471  

North East Asia 4)

     27,365        28,237        27,572        1,556        2,005        2,217  

South East Asia & Oceania

     22,180        19,235        15,858        232        278        345  

Other 1)2)3)4)

     15,118        19,560        14,664        —          —          —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     222,608        246,920        227,983        76,719        73,007        70,568  

1) Of which in Sweden 6)

     3,123        3,796        4,144        53,111        48,467        43,298  

2) Of which in EU 6)

     38,525        45,585        45,101        57,759        53,759        48,881  

3) Of which in the United States 6)

     56,748        64,299        55,722        11,053        12,325        13,116  

4) Of which in China 6)

     19,156        18,977        14,335        530        1,547        1,370  

 

5) Total non-current assets excluding financial instruments, deferred tax assets, and post-employment benefit assets.
6) Including IPR revenue reported under Other above.

For employee information, see Note C28, “Information regarding members of the Board of Directors, the Group management and employees.”

 

61


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

C4    Net sales

Net sales

 

     2016      2015      2014  

Sales of products and network rollout services

     135,778        150,775        147,235  

Professional Services sales

     76,816        81,749        70,831  

License revenues

     10,014        14,396        9,917  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net sales

     222,608        246,920        227,983  

Export sales from Sweden

     107,036        117,486        113,734  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

C5    Expenses by nature

Expenses by nature

 

     2016      2015      2014  

Goods and services

     133,848        137,458        132,185  

Employee remuneration

     77,774        80,054        70,166  

Amortization and depreciation

     8,886        10,223        9,927  

Impairments and obsolescence allowances, net of reversals

     1,325        1,438        1,138  

Financial expenses

     2,158        2,458        2,273  

Taxes

     2,131        6,199        4,668  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Expenses incurred

     226,122        237,830        220,357  

Inventory increase/decrease (–/+) 1)

     –606        –394        –2,929  

Additions to capitalized development

     –4,483        –3,548        –1,523  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Expenses charged to the income statement

     221,033        233,888        215,905  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) The inventory changes are based on changes of net inventory values.

Total restructuring charges in 2016 were SEK 7.6 (5.0) billion and were mainly related to the cost and efficiency program initially announced in November 2014. Restructuring charges are included in the expenses presented above.

Restructuring charges by function

 

     2016      2015      2014  

Cost of sales

     3,475        2,274        1,029  

R&D expenses

     2,739        2,021        304  

Selling and administrative expenses

     1,353        745        123  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total restructuring charges

     7,567        5,040        1,456  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

C6    Other operating income and expenses

Other operating income and expenses

 

     2016      2015      2014  

Gains on sales of intangible assets and PP&E

     423        363        843  

Losses on sales of intangible assets and PP&E

     –509        –158        –935  

Gains on sales of investments and operations 1)

     219        1        8  

Losses on sales of investments and operations 1)

     –96        –50        –44  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Capital gains/losses, net

     37        156        –128  

Other operating revenues/expenses 2)

     367        –3        –2,028  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total other operating income and expenses

     404        153        –2,156  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) Includes divestments presented in Note C26 “Business combinations.”
2) Includes revaluation of cash flow hedges of SEK –0.9 billion (SEK –1.1 billion in 2015 and SEK –2.8 billion in 2014) partly offset by result from trading activities.

C7    Financial income and expenses

Financial income and expenses

 

     2016      2015      2014  
     Financial
income
     Financial
expenses
     Financial
income
     Financial
expenses
     Financial
income
     Financial
expenses
 

Contractual interest on financial assets

     32        —          385        —          713        —    

Of which on financial assets at fair value through profit or loss

     –316        —          –110        —          297        —    

Contractual interest on financial liabilities

     —          –1,355        —          –1,428        —          –1,376  

Net gains/losses on:

                 

Instruments at fair value through profit or loss 1)

     –68        –729        190        –760        624        –651  

Of which included in fair value hedge relationships

     —          71        —          152        —          –123  

Loans and receivables

     –79        —          –53        —          –70        —    

Liabilities at amortized cost

     —          218        —          213        —          –32  

Other financial income and expenses

     —          –292        3        –483        10        –214  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     –115        –2,158        525        –2,458        1,277        –2,273  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) Excluding net loss from operating assets and liabilities, SEK 234 million (net loss of SEK 165 million in 2015 and net loss of SEK 143 million in 2014), reported as Cost of sales.

 

62


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

C8    Taxes

The Company’s tax expense for 2016 was SEK –2,131 (–6,199) million or 52.9% (31.2%) of income after financial items. The tax rate may vary between years depending on business and geographical mix.

Income taxes recognized in the income statement

 

     2016     2015      2014  

Current income taxes for the year

     –3,654       –6,641        –5,714  

Current income taxes related to prior years

     –489 1)       –104        –66  

Deferred tax income/expense (+/–)

     2,017       546        1,112  

Share of taxes in joint ventures and associated companies

     –5       —          —    
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Tax expense

     –2,131       –6,199        –4,668  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) The amount refers to a change in an estimate.

A reconciliation between reported tax expense for the year and the theoretical tax expense that would arise when applying statutory tax rate in Sweden, 22.0%, on the consolidated income before taxes, is shown in the table below.

Reconciliation of Swedish income tax rate with effective tax rate

 

     2016     2015     2014  

Expected tax expense at Swedish tax rate 22.0%

     –886       –4,372       –3,479  

Effect of foreign tax rates

     –536       –1,101       –856  

Of which joint ventures and associated companies

     —         —         –2  

Current income taxes related to prior years

     –489       –104       –66  

Remeasurement of tax loss carry-forwards

     143       –250       –51  

Remeasurement of deductible temporary differences

     119       185       –459  

Tax effect of non-deductible expenses

     –1,357       –1,559       –2,125  

Tax effect of non-taxable income

     935       981       2,383  

Tax effect of changes in tax rates

     –60       21       –15  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Tax expense

     –2,131       –6,199       –4,668  

Effective tax rate

     52.9     31.2     29.5

Deferred tax balances

Deferred tax assets and liabilities are derived from the balance sheet items as shown in the table below.

Tax effects of temporary differences and tax loss carry-forwards

 

     Deferred
tax assets
     Deferred
tax  liabilities
     Net balance  

2016

        

Intangible assets and property, plant and equipment

     1,223        4,173     

Current assets

     2,352        501     

Post-employment benefits

     4,382        692     

Provisions

     1,631        13     

Other

     4,557        274     

Loss carry-forwards

     4,883        —       
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Deferred tax assets/liabilities

     19,028        5,653        13,375  

Netting of assets/liabilities

     –3,506        –3,506     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Deferred tax balances, net

     15,522        2,147        13,375  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

2015

        

Intangible assets and property, plant and equipment

     1,056        4,032     

Current assets

     2,218        568     

Post-employment benefits

     4,247        776     

Provisions

     1,813        83     

Other

     2,799        204     

Loss carry-forwards

     4,241        —       
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Deferred tax assets/liabilities

     16,374        5,663        10,711  

Netting of assets/liabilities

     –3,191        –3,191     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Deferred tax balances, net

     13,183        2,472        10,711  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Changes in deferred taxes, net

 

     2016      2015  

Opening balance, net

     10,711        9,601  

Recognized in Net income

     2,017        546  

Recognized in Other comprehensive income

     521        721  

Acquisitions/disposals of subsidiaries

     –57        121  

Currency translation differences

     183        –278  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Closing balance, net

     13,375        10,711  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Tax effects reported directly in Other comprehensive income amount to SEK 521 (721) million, of which actuarial gains and losses related to pensions constituted SEK 520 (721) million.

Deferred tax assets are only recognized in countries where the Company expects to be able to generate corresponding taxable income in the future to benefit from tax reductions.

Significant tax loss carry-forwards are related to countries with long or indefinite periods of utilization, mainly Sweden and Germany. Of the total SEK 4,883 (4,241) million recognized deferred tax assets related to tax loss carry-forwards, SEK 3,774 (3,378) million relates to Sweden with indefinite periods of utilization. The assessment is that the Company will be able to generate sufficient income in the coming years to also utilize the remaining part of the recognized amounts.

 

63


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Tax loss carry-forwards

Deferred tax assets regarding tax loss carry-forwards are reported to the extent that realization of the related tax benefit through future taxable profits is probable also when considering the period during which these can be utilized, as described below.

As of December 31, 2016, the recognized tax loss carry-forwards amounted to SEK 20,929 (18,162) million. The tax value of these tax loss carry-forwards is reported as an asset.

The final years in which the recognized tax loss carry-forwards can be utilized are shown in the following table.

Tax loss carry-forwards: year of expiration

 

Year of expiration

   Tax loss
carry-forwards
     Tax
value
 

2017

     301        95  

2018

     34        8  

2019

     105        25  

2020

     259        83  

2021

     254        43  

2022 or later

     19,976        4,629  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     20,929        4,883  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

In addition to the table above there are tax loss carry-forwards of SEK 3,936 (5,300) million at a tax value of SEK 950 (1,436) million that have not been recognized due to judgments of the possibility they will be used against future taxable profits in the respective jurisdictions. The majority of these tax loss carry-forwards have an expiration date in excess of five years.

C9    Earnings per share

Earnings per share

 

     2016      2015      2014  

Basic

        

Net income attributable to stockholders of the Parent Company (SEK million)

     1,716        13,549        11,568  

Average number of shares outstanding, basic (millions)

     3,263        3,249        3,237  

Earnings per share, basic (SEK)

     0.53        4.17        3.57  

Diluted

        

Net income attributable to stockholders of the Parent Company (SEK million)

     1,716        13,549        11,568  

Average number of shares outstanding, basic (millions)

     3,263        3,249        3,237  

Dilutive effect for stock purchase plans (millions)

     40        33        33  

Average number of shares outstanding, diluted (millions)

     3,303        3,282        3,270  

Earnings per share, diluted (SEK)

     0.52        4.13        3.54  

C10    Intangible assets

Intangible assets 2016

 

     Capitalized development expenses      Goodwill          Intellectual property rights (IPR),    
trademarks and other
intangible assets
 
                                        Trademarks,                
            For internal use                    customer      Patents         
                                 relationships      and         
     To be
marketed
     Acquired
costs
     Internal
costs
     Total      Total      and similar
rights
     acquired
R&D
     Total  

Cost

                       

Opening balance

     15,307        2,213        1,697        19,217        41,105        24,284        31,611        55,895  

Acquisitions/capitalization

     4,333        —          150        4,483        —          4        11        15  

Balances regarding acquired/divested businesses 1)

     —          —          —          —          585        175        2        177  

Sales/disposals

     –1,394        —          —          –1,394        —          –842        –28        –870  

Reclassifications

     —          —          —          —          –640        640        —          640  

Translation difference

     —          —          —          —          2,355        803        680        1,483  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Closing balance

     18,246        2,213        1,847        22,306        43,405        25,064        32,276        57,340  

Accumulated amortization

                       

Opening balance

     –7,995        –2,158        –1,441        –11,594        —          –15,976        –25,272        –41,248  

Amortization

     –1,642        —          –173        –1,815        —          –1,418        –1,232        –2,650  

Sales/disposals

     1,394        —          —          1,394        —          812        28        840  

Translation difference

     —          —          —          —          —          –735        –469        –1,204  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Closing balance

     –8,243        –2,158        –1,614        –12,015        —          –17,317        –26,945        –44,262  

Accumulated impairment losses

                       

Opening balance

     –2,038        –55        –37        –2,130        –18        —          –5,331        –5,331  

Impairment losses

     –85        —          —          –85        —          —          —          —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Closing balance

     –2,123        –55        –37        –2,215        –18        —          –5,331        –5,331  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net carrying value

     7,880        —          196        8,076        43,387        7,747        —          7,747  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) For more information on acquired/divested businesses, see Note C26, “Business combinations.”

 

64


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Intangible assets 2015

 

     Capitalized development expenses      Goodwill          Intellectual property rights (IPR),    
trademarks and other intangible
assets
 
            For internal use      Total      Total      Trademarks,
customer
relationships
and similar
rights
     Patents
and
acquired
R&D
     Total  
     To be
marketed
     Acquired
costs
     Internal
costs
                

Cost

                       

Opening balance

     12,204        2,213        1,478        15,895        38,348        23,362        31,005        54,367  

Acquisitions/capitalization

     3,329        —          219        3,548        —          70        —          70  

Balances regarding acquired/divested businesses 1)

     —          —          —          —          1,165        261        184        445  

Sales/disposals

     —          —          —          —          —          –28        –55        –83  

Reclassification

     –226        —          —          –226        —          —          —          —    

Translation difference

     —          —          —          —          1,592        619        477        1,096  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Closing balance

     15,307        2,213        1,697        19,217        41,105        24,284        31,611        55,895  

Accumulated amortization

                       

Opening balance

     –6,616        –2,158        –1,441        –10,215        —          –13,444        –23,058        –36,502  

Amortization

     –1,379        —          —          –1,379        —          –2,147        –1,992        –4,139  

Sales/disposals

     —          —          —          —          —          24        52        76  

Translation difference

     —          —          —          —          —          –409        –274        –683  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Closing balance

     –7,995        –2,158        –1,441        –11,594        —          –15,976        –25,272        –41,248  

Accumulated impairment losses

                       

Opening balance

     –2,018        –55        –37        –2,110        –18        —          –5,331        –5,331  

Impairment losses

     –20        —          —          –20        —          —          —          —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Closing balance

     –2,038        –55        –37        –2,130        –18        —          –5,331        –5,331  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net carrying value

     5,274        —          219        5,493        41,087        8,308        1,008        9,316  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) For more information on acquired/divested businesses, see Note C26, “Business combinations.”

The goodwill impairment testing is based on five-year business plans. The testing has been based on the new segments that became effective as per January 1, 2017 due to that the business plans where prepared for the new segments. In Note C3 “Operating segments” information about the new segments is disclosed.

The total goodwill for the Company is SEK 43.4 (41.1) billion and is allocated to the new operating segments Networks, at the sum of SEK 26.2 (n/a) billion, IT & Cloud, at the sum of SEK 9.8 (n/a) billion and Media, at the sum of SEK 7.4 (n/a) billion. The allocation of goodwill to the new segments has been done using a relative value approach, except for the goodwill related to one acquisition where the alternative approach has been used.

The recoverable amounts for cash-generating units are established as the present value of expected future cash flows. Estimation of future cash flows includes assumptions mainly for the following key financial parameters:

 

   

Sales growth

 

   

Development of operating income (based on operating margin or cost of goods sold and operating expenses relative to sales)

 

   

Development of working capital and capital expenditure requirements.

 

   

The assumptions regarding industry-specific market drivers and market growth are approved by Group management and each operating segment’s management. These assumptions are based on industry sources as input to the projections made within the Company for the development 2016–2021 for key industry parameters:

 

   

The number of global mobile subscriptions is estimated to grow from around 7.9 billion by the end of 2016 to around 9.9 billion by the end of 2021 (including Cellular M2M). Of these, around 7.9 billion will be mobile broadband subscriptions, taking mobile PC, tablets, routers and Cellular connected Internet of Things devices and handsets into account. Out of all phone subscriptions, 6.4 billion will be associated with a smartphone.

 

   

The overall number of connected things will grow to around 26 billion devices in 2021, including also M2M and connected consumer electronics.

 

   

Mobile data traffic volume is estimated to increase by around six times in the period 2016–2021. The mobile traffic is driven by smartphone users and video traffic. Smartphone traffic will grow by around seven times, and video traffic will grow around eight times in the period of 2016–2021.

The assumptions are also based upon information gathered in the Company’s long-term strategy process, including assessments of new technology, the Company’s competitive position and new types of business and customers, driven by the continued integration of telecom, data and media industries.

The impairment testing is based on specific estimates for the first five years and with a reduction of nominal annual growth rate to an average GDP growth of 1% (3%) per year thereafter. The impairment tests for goodwill did not result in any impairment. If impairment tests for goodwill had been based on the segment structure at the end of 2016, it would not have resulted in any impairment.

An after-tax discount rate of 8.0% (8.5%) has been applied for the discounting of projected after-tax cash flows. The same rate has been applied for all cash-generating units, since there is a high degree of integration between them. In addition, when a reasonably higher discount rate of 10.0% has been applied in the impairment tests, headroom for Networks and IT & Cloud is still positive.

For the Media segment the headroom is SEK 5.6 billion when a discount of 8.0% is applied. The recoverable amount is equal to its carrying amount when the discount factor is increased to 10.0%.

Group sales of media products and services declined in 2016 due to lower sales of legacy products. The transition to next-generation platform is ongoing with several customer trials. However, this has not yet translated into sales. Mobile video consumption is growing rapidly however there are significant M&A activities ongoing in the industry impacting purchasing behavior and the short- to mid-term addressable market growth.

The assumptions for 2015 are disclosed in Note C10, “Intangible assets” in the Annual Report of 2015.

The Company’s discounting is based on after-tax future cash flows and after-tax discount rates. This discounting is not materially different from a discounting based on before-tax future cash flows and before-tax discount rates, as required by IFRS. In Note C1, “Significant accounting policies,” and Note C2, “Critical accounting estimates and judgments,” further disclosures are given regarding goodwill impairment testing.

 

65


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

C11    Property, plant and equipment

Property, plant and equipment 2016

 

       Real
estate
     Machinery and
other  technical
assets
     Other equipment,
tools and
installations
     Construction in
progress and
advance payments
     Total  

Cost

              

Opening balance

     6,475        4,560        28,753        4,750        44,538  

Additions

     177        148        1,519        4,285        6,129  

Balances regarding acquired/divested businesses

     –1        –53        2        —          –52  

Sales/disposals

     –1,410        –596        –2,610        –269        –4,885  

Reclassifications

     1,633        110        4,570        –6,315        –2  

Translation difference

     258        117        900        197        1,472  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Closing balance

     7,132        4,286        33,134        2,648        47,200  

Accumulated depreciation

              

Opening balance

     –3,634        –3,779        –21,208        —          –28,621  

Depreciations

     –506        –330        –3,585        —          –4,421  

Balances regarding divested businesses

     2        26        7        —          35  

Sales/disposals

     643        534        2,434        —          3,611  

Reclassifications

     4        1        –4        —          1  

Translation difference

     –138        –103        –705        —          –946  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Closing balance

     –3,629        –3,651        –23,061        —          –30,341  

Accumulated impairment losses

              

Opening balance

     —          –10        –6        —          –16  

Impairment losses

     –43        –1        –112        —          –156  

Reversals of impairment losses

     —          8        —          —          8  

Sales/disposals

     —          —          39        —          39  

Translation difference

     —          —          —          —          —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Closing balance

     –43        –3        –79        —          –125  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net carrying value

     3,460        632        9,994        2,648        16,734  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Contractual commitments for the acquisition of property, plant and equipment as per December 31, 2016, amounted to SEK 476 (394) million.

Property, plant and equipment 2015

 

       Real estate      Machinery and
other technical
assets
     Other equipment,
tools and
installations
     Construction in
progress and
advance payments
     Total  

Cost

              

Opening balance

     6,378        5,273        27,026        2,190        40,867  

Additions

     49        163        2,222        5,904        8,338  

Balances regarding acquired/divested businesses

     13        —          32        —          45  

Sales/disposals

     –773        –1,006        –2,412        –250        –4,441  

Reclassifications

     771        166        1,994        –2,931        —    

Translation difference

     37        –36        –109        –163        –271  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Closing balance

     6,475        4,560        28,753        4,750        44,538  

Accumulated depreciation

              

Opening balance

     –2,980        –4,074        –20,406        —          –27,460  

Depreciations

     –501        –441        –3,763        —          –4,705  

Sales/disposals

     151        909        2,403        —          3,463  

Reclassifications

     –323        –196        519        —          —    

Translation difference

     19        23        39        —          81  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Closing balance

     –3,634        –3,779        –21,208        —          –28,621  

Accumulated impairment losses

              

Opening balance

     –32        –20        –14        —          –66  

Reversals of impairment losses

     —          11        5        —          16  

Sales/disposals

     32        —          2        —          34  

Translation difference

     —          –1        1        —          —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Closing balance

     —          –10        –6        —          –16  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net carrying value

     2,841        771        7,539        4,750        15,901  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

66


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

C12    Financial assets, non-current

Equity in joint ventures and associated companies

 

     2016      2015  

Opening balance

     1,210        2,793  

Share in earnings

     31        –38  

Distribution of capital stock

     —          –1,558  

Taxes

     –5        —    

Reclassification

     —          –36  

Dividends

     –84        –92  

Divested business 1)

     –15        —    

Translation difference

     –362        141  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Closing balance 2)

     775        1,210  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) For more information see Note C26, “Business combinations.”
2) Goodwill, net, amounts to SEK 1 (15) million.

There were no major holdings in joint ventures or associated companies in 2016. Significant holdings from previous years are specified below.

All companies apply IFRS in the reporting to the Company as issued by IASB.

Ericsson’s share of assets, liabilities and income in associated company Rockstar Consortium

 

     2016     2015     2014  

Percentage in ownership interest

     21,26     21.26     21.26

Total assets

     22       21       7,348  

Total liabilities

     —         5       196  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net assets (100%)

     22       16       7,152  

Company’s share of net assets (21.26%)

     3       3       1,520  

Net sales

     —         —         —    

Income after financial items

     —         –642       –484  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income and total comprehensive income (100%)

     —         –642       –484  

Company’s share of net income and other comprehensive income (21.26%)

     —         –137       –103  

Rockstar Consortium LLC (Rockstar) is a company that was formed in 2011 by Apple, Blackberry, Ericsson, Microsoft, and Sony to purchase approximately 4,000 patent assets out of the original about 6,000 from the Nortel bankruptcy estate. On December 23, 2014, it was agreed between the owners of Rockstar and RPX Corporation (RPXC) that RPX shall purchase the remaining patents of Rockstar. The transaction occured in 2015 and after that the main part of the capital stock has been distributed to the owners. Rockstar Consortium has concluded its operations.

Financial assets, non-current

 

    

Other investments
in shares and
participations
 
 
 
    
Customer finance,
non-current
 
 
    


Interest-bearing

securities,
non-current

 

 
 

    
Derivatives,
non-current
 
 
    

Other

financial assets,

non-current

 

 

 

     2016        2015        2016        2015        2016        2015        2016        2015        2016        2015  

Cost

                             

Opening balance

     2,567        2,115        1,755        2,011        —          —          452        551        5,365        5,621  

Additions

     133        234        2,704        2,324        7,593        —          —          —          785        1,882  

Disposals/repayments/deductions

     –267        –240        –2,333        –2,018        —          —          —          —          –187        –1,174  

Change in value in funded pension plans 1)

     —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          –1,622        –740  

Revaluation

     2        457        —          —          –7        —          —          –99        62        —    

Reclassification

     —          —          –12        –581        —          —          –452        —          —          —    

Translation difference

     81        1        23        19        —          —          —          —          245        –224  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Closing balance

     2,516        2,567        2,137        1,755        7,586        —          —          452        4,648        5,365  

Accumulated impairment losses/allowances

                             

Opening balance

     –1,292        –1,524        –16        –79        —          —          —          —          –183        –272  

Impairment losses/allowances

     37        62        –5        –4        —          —          —          —          –1        74  

Disposals/repayments/deductions

     –1        217        12        67        —          —          —          —          –1        –7  

Translation difference

     –81        –47        —          —          —          —          —          —          –21        22  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Closing balance

     –1,337        –1,292        –9        –16        —          —          —          —          –206        –183  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net carrying value

     1,179        1,275        2,128        1,739        7,586        —          —          452        4,442        5,182  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) This amount includes asset ceiling. For further information, see Note C17, “Post-employment benefits.”

 

67


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

C13    Inventories

Inventories

 

     2016      2015  

Raw materials, components, consumables and manufacturing work in progress

     5,043        6,807  

Finished products and goods for resale

     12,183        8,778  

Contract work in progress

     13,081        12,851  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Inventories, net

     30,307        28,436  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

The amount of inventories, excluding contract work in progress, recognized as expense and included in Cost of sales was SEK 63,386 (66,886) million.

Contract work in progress includes amounts related to delivery-type contracts and service contracts with ongoing work in progress.

Reported amounts are net of obsolescence allowances of SEK 2,412 (2,555) million.

Movements in obsolescence allowances

 

     2016      2015      2014  

Opening balance

     2,555        2,326        2,496  

Additions, net

     725        1,480        691  

Utilization

     –981        –1,295        –979  

Translation difference

     113        44        204  

Balances regarding acquired/ divested businesses

     —          —          –86  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Closing balance

     2,412        2,555        2,326  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

C14    Trade receivables and customer finance

Trade receivables and customer finance

 

     2016      2015  

Trade receivables excluding associated companies and joint ventures

     69,430        72,208  

Allowances for impairment

     –1,403        –1,202  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Trade receivables, net

     68,027        71,006  

Trade receivables related to associated companies and joint ventures

     90        63  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Trade receivables, total

     68,117        71,069  

Customer finance credits

     5,003        4,066  

Allowances for impairment

     –250        –286  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Customer finance credits, net

     4,753        3,780  

Of which current

     2,625        2,041  

Credit commitments for customer finance

     13,082        11,101  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Days sales outstanding (DSO) were 95 (87) in December 2016.

Movements in allowances for impairment

 

     Trade receivables      Customer finance  
     2016      2015      2016      2015  

Opening balance

     1,202        1,123        286        408  

Additions

     356        184        78        27  

Utilized

     –156        –59        –108        –47  

Reversal of excess amounts

     –28        –26        –8        –99  

Reclassification

     —          –2        —          —    

Translation difference

     29        –18        2        –3  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Closing balance

     1,403        1,202        250        286  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Aging analysis as per December 31

 

    Total     Of which
neither impaired
nor past due
    Of which
impaired,
not past due
    Of which past
due in
the following time
intervals:
    Of which past due and
impaired in the following
time intervals:
 
          less than
90 days
    90 days
or more
        less than    
90 days
        90 days or    
more
 

2016

             

Trade receivables, excluding associated companies and joint ventures

    69,430       58,198       62       4,406       5,423       10       1,331  

Allowances for impairment

    –1,403       —         –62       —         —         –10       –1,331  

Customer finance credits

    5,003       3,250       1,480       10       3       24       236  

Allowances for impairment

    –250       —         –64       —         —         –6       –180  

2015

             

Trade receivables, excluding associated companies and joint ventures

    72,208       64,485       82       3,150       3,371       74       1,046  

Allowances for impairment

    –1,202       —         –82       —         —         –74       –1,046  

Customer finance credits

    4,066       2,323       1,419       4       5       16       299  

Allowances for impairment

    –286       —         –24       —         —         –9       –253  

 

68


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Credit risk

Credit risk is divided into three categories: credit risk in trade receivables, customer finance risk and financial credit risk, see Note C20, “Financial risk management and financial instruments.”

Credit risk in trade receivables

Credit risk in trade receivables is governed by a policy applicable to all legal entities in the Company. The purpose of the policy is to:

 

   

Avoid credit losses through establishing internal standard credit approval routines in all the Company’s legal entities

 

   

Ensure monitoring and risk mitigation of defaulting accounts, i.e. events of non-payment and/or delayed payments from customers

 

   

Ensure efficient credit management within the Company and thereby improve Days sales outstanding and Cash flow

 

   

Define escalation path and approval process for customer credit limits.

The credit worthiness of all customers is regularly assessed. Through credit management system functionality, credit checks are performed every time a sales order or an invoice is generated in the source system. These are based on the credit risk set on the customer. Credit blocks appear if past due receivables are higher than permitted levels. Release of a credit block requires authorization.

Letters of credits are used as a method for securing payments from customers operating in emerging markets, in particular in markets with unstable political and/or economic environments. By having banks confirming the letters of credit, the political and commercial credit risk exposures to the Company are mitigated.

Trade receivables amounted to SEK 69,430 (72,208) million as of December 31, 2016. Provisions for expected losses are regularly assessed and amounted to SEK 1,403 (1,202) million as of December 31, 2016. The Company’s nominal credit losses have, however, historically been low. The amounts of trade receivables closely follow the distribution of the Company’s sales and do not include any major concentrations of credit risk by customer or by geography. The five largest customers represented 27% (30%) of the total trade receivables in 2016.

Customer finance credit risk

All major commitments to finance customers are made only after approval by the Finance Committee of the Board of Directors, according to the established credit approval process.

Prior to the approval of new facilities reported as customer finance, an internal credit risk assessment is conducted in order to assess the credit rating of each transaction, for political and commercial risk. The credit risk analysis is made by using an assessment tool, where the political risk rating is identical to the rating used by all Export Credit Agencies within the OECD. The commercial risk is assessed by analyzing a large number of parameters, which may affect the level of the future commercial credit risk exposure. The output from the assessment tool for the credit rating also includes an internal pricing of the risk. This is expressed as a risk margin per annum over funding cost. The reference pricing for political and commercial risk, on which the tool is based, is reviewed using information from Export Credit Agencies and prevailing pricing in the bank loan market for structured financed deals. The objective is that the internally set risk margin shall reflect the assessed risk and that the pricing is as close as possible to the current market pricing. A reassessment of the credit rating for each customer finance facility is made on a regular basis.

Risk provisions related to customer finance risk exposures are only made upon events which occur after the financing arrangement has become effective and which are expected to have a significant adverse impact on the borrower’s ability and/or willingness to service the outstanding debt. These events can be political (normally outside the control of the borrower) or commercial, e.g. a borrower’s deteriorated creditworthiness.

As of December 31, 2016, the Company’s total outstanding exposure related to customer finance was SEK 5,003 (4,066) million. As of December 31, 2016, the Company also had unutilized customer finance commitments of SEK 13,082 (11,101) million. Customer finance is arranged for infrastructure projects in different geographic markets and for a large number of customers. As of December 31, 2016, there were a total of 81 (91) customer finance arrangements originated by or guaranteed by the Company. The five largest facilities represented 55% (50%) of the total credit exposure in 2016.

Total outstanding customer finance exposure per region as of December 31

 

Percent

   2016      2015  

North America

     7        12  

Latin America

     7        16  

Northern Europe & Central Asia

     5        3  

Western & Central Europe

     2        5  

Mediterranean

     6        13  

Middle East

     31        29  

Sub-Saharan Africa

     25        12  

India

     3        1  

North East Asia

     —          —    

South East Asia and Oceania

     14        9  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     100        100  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

The effect of risk provisions and reversals for customer finance affecting the income statement amounted to a net negative impact of SEK 24 million in 2016 compared to a net positive impact of SEK 33 million in 2015. Credit losses amounted to SEK 108 (47) million in 2016.

Security arrangements for customer finance facilities normally include pledges of equipment, pledges of certain assets belonging to the borrower and pledges of shares in the operating company. If available, third-party risk coverage is, as a rule, arranged. “Third-party risk coverage” means that a financial payment guarantee covering the credit risk has been issued by a bank, an export credit agency or other financial institution. A credit risk cover from a third-party may also be issued by an insurance company. A credit risk transfer under a sub-participation arrangement with a bank can also be arranged. In this case the entire credit risk and the funding is taken care of by the bank for the part that they cover.

Information about guarantees related to customer finance is included in Note C24, “Contingent liabilities,” and information about leasing is included in Note C27, “Leasing.” The table below summarizes the Company’s outstanding customer finance as of December 31, 2016 and 2015.

Outstanding customer finance

 

     2016      2015  

Customer finance credits

     5,003        4,066  

Financial guarantees for third-parties

     124        70  

Accrued interest

     16        26  

Less third-party risk coverage

     –805        –1,478  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Ericsson’s risk exposure, including financial guarantees

     4,338        2,684  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Transfers of financial assets

Transfers where the Company has not derecognized the assets in their entirety

As of December 31, 2016, there existed no customer financing assets that the Company had transferred to third parties where the Company did not derecognize the assets in their entirety. However, it existed such transactions in 2015. The total carrying amount of the original assets transferred was in 2015 SEK 534 million; the amount of the assets that the Company continued to recognize in 2015 was SEK 27 million; and the carrying amount of the associated liabilities was SEK 0.

Transfers where the Company has continuing involvement

During 2016, the Company derecognized financial assets where it had continuing involvement. A repurchase of these assets would amount to SEK 630 (0) million. No assets or liabilities were recognized in relation to the continuing involvement.

 

69


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

C15    Other current receivables

Other current receivables

 

     2016      2015  

Prepaid expenses

     4,501        4,883  

Accrued revenues

     1,584        1,604  

Advance payments to suppliers

     1,384        515  

Derivatives with a positive value 1)

     1,108        950  

Taxes

     13,974        11,582  

Other

     1,880        2,175  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     24,431        21,709  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) See also Note C20, “Financial risk management and financial instruments.”

C16    Equity and other comprehensive Income

Capital stock 2016

Capital stock at December 31, 2016, consisted of the following:

Capital stock

 

Parent Company

   Number of shares      Capital stock
(SEK  million)
 

Class A shares

     261,755,983        1,309  

Class B shares

     3,069,395,752        15,348  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     3,331,151,735        16,657  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

The capital stock of the Parent Company is divided into two classes: Class A shares (quota value SEK 5.00) and Class B shares (quota value SEK 5.00). Both classes have the same rights of participation in the net assets and earnings. Class A shares, however, are entitled to one vote per share while Class B shares are entitled to one tenth of one vote per share.

At December 31, 2016, the total number of treasury shares was 62,192,390 (49,367,641 in 2015 and 63,450,558 in 2014) Class B shares. Ericsson repurchased 26.1 million shares in 2016 in relation to the Stock Purchase Plan.

Reconciliation of number of shares

 

       Number of shares      Capital stock
(SEK  million)
 

Number of shares Jan 1, 2016

     3,305,051,735        16,526  

Number of shares Dec 31, 2016

     3,331,151,735        16,657  

For further information about the number of shares, see the chapter Share Information.

Dividend proposal

The Board of Directors will propose to the Annual General Meeting 2017 a dividend of SEK 1.00 per share (SEK 3.70 in 2016 and SEK 3.40 in 2015).

Additional paid in capital

This relates to payments made by owners and includes share premiums paid.

Retained earnings

Retained earnings, including net income for the year, comprise the earned profits of the Parent Company and its share of net income in subsidiaries, joint ventures and associated companies. Retained earnings also include:

Remeasurements related to post-employment benefits

Actuarial gains and losses resulting from experience-based events and changes in actuarial assumptions, fluctuations in the effect of the asset ceiling, and adjustments related to the Swedish special payroll taxes.

Revaluation of other investments in shares and participations

The fair value reserve comprises the cumulative net change in the fair value of available-for-sale financial assets.

Cash flow hedges

The cash flow hedge reserve comprises the effective portion of the cumulative net change in the fair value of cash-flow-hedging instruments related to hedged transactions that have not yet occurred.

Cumulative translation adjustments

The cumulative translation adjustments comprise all foreign currency differences arising from the translation of the financial statements of foreign operations and changes regarding revaluation of excess value in local currency as well as from the translation of liabilities that hedge the Company’s net investment in foreign subsidiaries.

 

70


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

C17    Post-employment benefits

Ericsson sponsors a number of post-employment benefit plans throughout the Company, which are in line with market practice in each country. The year 2016 was characterized by a decrease in discount rates in most plans. In total, discount rate changes resulted in actuarial losses on defined benefit obligations of SEK 9 billion. The development of plan assets was greater than expected resulting in actuarial gains of SEK 4 billion.

Swedish plans

Sweden has both defined benefit and defined contribution plans based on collective agreement between the parties in the Swedish labor market:

 

   

A defined benefit plan, known as ITP 2 (occupational pension for salaried employees in manufacturing industries and trade), complemented by a defined contribution plan, known as ITPK (supplementary retirement benefits). This is a final salary-based plan.

 

   

A defined contribution plan, known as ITP 1, for employees born in 1979 or later.

 

   

A defined contribution plan ITP 1 or alternative ITP, for employees earning more than 10 income base amount and who have opted out of the defined benefit plan ITP 2, where rules are set by the Company and approved by each employee selected to participate.

The Company has by far most of its Swedish pension liabilities under defined benefit plans which are funded to 55% (52%) through Ericsson Pensionsstiftelse (a Swedish Pension Foundation). The Pensionsstiftelse covers the liability up to the value of the defined benefit obligation based on Swedish GAAP calculations. There are no funding requirements for the Swedish plans. The disability and survivors’ pension part of the ITP-plan is secured through an insurance solution with the company Alecta, see section about Multi-employer plans.

The benefit payments are made by the Company since the liability is growing and the necessary surplus therefore is not yet reached. For the unfunded plans the Company meets the payment obligation when it falls due. The responsibility for governance of the plans and the plan assets lies with the Company and the Pensionsstiftelse. The Swedish Pensions-stiftelse is managed on the basis of a capital preservation strategy and the risk profile is set accordingly. Traditional asset-liability matching (ALM) studies are undertaken on a regular basis to allocate within different asset classes.

The plans are exposed to various risks, e.g., a sudden decrease in the bond yields, which would lead to an increase in the plan liability. A sudden instability in the financial market might also lead to a decrease in fair value of plan assets held by the Pensionsstiftelse, as the holdings of plan assets partly are exposed to equity markets; however, this may be partly offset by higher values in fixed income holdings. Swedish plans are linked to inflation and higher inflation will most likely lead to a higher liability. For the time being, inflation is a low risk factor to the Swedish plans as actual rate of inflation has not reached the ceiling target set by the Central Bank of Sweden.

Multi-employer plans

As before, the Company has secured the disability and survivors’ pension part of the ITP Plan through an insurance solution with the insurance company Alecta. Although this part of the plan is classified as a multi-employer defined benefit plan, it is not possible to get sufficient information to apply defined benefit accounting, as for most of the accrued pension benefits in Alecta, information is missing on the allocation of earnings process between employers. Full vesting is instead registered on the last employer. Alecta is not able to calculate a breakdown of assets and provisions for each respective employer, and therefore, the disability and survivors’ pension portion of the ITP Plan has been accounted for as a defined contribution plan.

Alecta has a collective funding ratio which acts as a buffer for its insurance commitments to protect against fluctuations in investment return and insurance risks. Alecta’s target ratio is 140% and reflects the fair value of Alecta’s plan assets as a percentage of plan commitments, then measured in accordance with Alecta’s actuarial assumptions, which are different from those in IAS 19R. Alecta’s collective funding ratio was 149% (153%) as of December 31, 2016. The Company’s share of Alecta’s saving premiums is 0.6%; the total share of active members in Alecta are 2.2%. The expected contribution to the plan is SEK 136 million for 2017.

Contingent liabilities / Assets pledged as collateral

Contingent liabilities include the Company’s mutual responsibility as a credit insured company of PRI Pensionsgaranti in Sweden. This mutual responsibility can only be imposed in the instance that PRI Pensions-garanti has consumed all of its assets, and it amounts to a maximum of 2% of the Company’s pension liability in Sweden. The Company has a pledged business mortgage of SEK 2 billion to PRI Pensionsgaranti.

US plans

The Company operates defined benefit pension plans in the US, which are a combination of final salary pension plans and contribution-based arrangements. The final salary pension plans provide benefits to members in the form of a guaranteed level of pension payable for life. The level of benefits provided depends on members’ length of service and their salary in the final years leading up to retirement. Retirees generally do not receive inflationary increases once in payment.

The other type of plan is a contribution-based pension plan, which provides a benefit determined using a “cash balance” approach. The balance is credited monthly with interest credits and contribution credits, based on a combination of current year salary and length of service.

The majority of benefit payments are from trustee-administered funds; however, there are also a number of unfunded plans where the Company meets the benefit payment obligation as it falls due. In the US, the Company’s policy is at least to meet or exceed the funding requirements of federal regulations. The funded level in the US Pension Plan is above the point at which minimum funding would be required for fiscal year 2016.

Plan assets held in trusts are governed by local regulations and practice, as is the nature of the relationship between the Company and the trustees (or equivalent) and their composition. Responsibility for governance of the plans – including investment decisions and contribution schedules – lies with the Plan Administrative Committee (PAC). The PAC is composed of representatives from the Company.

The Company’s plans are exposed to various risks associated with pension plans, i.e., a sudden decrease in bond yields would lead to an increase in the present value of the defined benefit obligation. A sudden instability in the financial markets might also lead to a decrease in the fair value of plan assets held by the trust. Pension benefits in the US are not linked to inflation; however, higher inflation poses the risk of increased final salaries being used to determine benefits for active employees. There is also a risk that the duration of payments to retirees will exceed the life expectancy in mortality tables.

Other plans

The Company also sponsors plans in other countries. The main plans are in Brazil, Ireland and the United Kingdom. The plan in Brazil is a pension plan wholly funded with a net surplus of assets. The plans in Ireland and the UK are final salary pension plans and are partly or wholly funded. The plans are managed by corporate trustees with directors appointed partly by the local company and partly by the plan members. The trustees are independent from the local company and subject to the specific country’s pension laws.

 

71


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Amount recognized in the Consolidated balance sheet

Amount recognized in the Consolidated balance sheet

 

     Sweden      US      Other      Total  

2016

           

Defined benefit obligation (DBO)

     38,202        22,710        26,263        87,175  

Fair value of plan assets

     20,956        21,545        21,984        64,485  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Deficit/surplus (+/–)

     17,246        1,165        4,279        22,690  

Plans with net surplus, excluding asset ceiling 1)

     —          —          1,033        1,033  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Provision for post-employment benefits 2)

     17,246        1,165        5,312        23,723  

2015

           

Defined benefit obligation (DBO)

     37,109        19,873        21,159        78,141  

Fair value of plan assets

     19,271        20,114        18,793        58,178  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Deficit/surplus (+/–)

     17,838        –241        2,366        19,963  

Plans with net surplus, excluding asset ceiling 1)

     —          918        1,783        2,701  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Provision for post-employment benefits 2)

     17,838        677        4,149        22,664  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) Plans with a net surplus, i.e., where plan assets exceed DBO, are reported as Other financial assets, non-current: see Note C12, “Financial assets.” The asset ceiling decreased during the year by SEK 46 million from SEK 530 million in 2015 to SEK 484 million in 2016.
2) Plans with net liabilities are reported in the balance sheet as Post-employment benefits, non-current.

Total pension cost recognized in the Consolidated income statement

The costs for post-employment benefits within the Company are distributed between defined contribution plans and defined benefit plans, with a trend toward defined contribution plans.

Pension costs for defined contribution plans and defined benefit plans

 

         Sweden              US              Other              Total      

2016

           

Pension cost for defined contribution plans

     1,061        687        1,472        3,220  

Pension cost for defined benefit plans

     1,314        167        633        2,114  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     2,375        854        2,105        5,334  

Total pension cost expressed as a percentage of wages and salaries

              8.9

2015

           

Pension cost for defined contribution plans

     1,136        729        1,375        3,240  

Pension cost for defined benefit plans

     1,806        81        666        2,553  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     2,942        810        2,041        5,793  

Total pension cost expressed as a percentage of wages and salaries

              9.5

2014

           

Pension cost for defined contribution plans

     953        562        713        2,228  

Pension cost for defined benefit plans

     1,039        39        651        1,729  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     1,992        601        1,364        3,957  

Total pension cost expressed as a percentage of wages and salaries

              6.8
           

 

 

 

 

72


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Change in the net defined benefit obligation

Change in the net defined benefit obligation

 

     Present
value of
obligation
2016 2)
     Fair value
of  plan

assets
2016
     Total
2016
     Present
value of
obligation
2015 2)
     Fair value
of plan
assets
2015
     Total
2015
 

Opening balance

     78,141        –58,178        19,963        73,752        –56,862        16,890  

Reclassification

     104        –104        —          —          —          —    

Included in the income statement

                 

Current service cost

     1,853        —          1,853        1,975        —          1,975  

Past service cost and gains and losses on settlements

     –182        —          –182        169        —          169  

Interest cost/ income (+/–)

     2,451        –2,176        275        2,446        –2,172        274  

Taxes and administrative expenses

     53        49        102        143        22        165  

Other

     –16        2        –14        –10        2        –8  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     4,159        –2,125        2,034        4,723        –2,148        2,575  

Remeasurements

                 

Return on plan assets excluding amounts in interest expense/income

     —          –4,280        –4,280        —          1,088        1,088  

Actuarial gains/losses (–/+) arising from changes in demographic assumptions

     –405        —          –405        1,768        —          1,768  

Actuarial gains/losses (–/+) arising from changes in financial assumptions

     8,255        —          8,255        135        —          135  

Experience-based gains/losses (–/+)

     –1,550        —          –1,550        –1,020        —          –1,020  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     6,300        –4,280        2,020        883        1,088        1,971  

Other changes

                 

Translation difference

     1,002        –834        168        1,167        –1,243        –76  

Contributions and payments from:

                 

Employers 1)

     –902        –562        –1,464        –764        –579        –1,343  

Plan participants

     28        –22        6        57        –38        19  

Payments from plans:

                 

Benefit payments

     –1,568        1,568        —          –1,550        1,570        20  

Settlements

     —          —          —          –127        34        –93  

Business combinations and divestments

     –89        52        –37        —          —          —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Closing balance

     87,175        –64,485        22,690        78,141        –58,178        19,963  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) The expected contribution to the plans is SEK 1,286 million during 2017.
2) The weighted average duration of DBO is 20.4 years.

Present value of the defined benefit obligation

 

     Sweden      US      Other      Total  

2016

           

DBO, closing balance

     38,202        22,710        26,263        87,175  

Of which partially or fully funded

     37,679        21,956        23,449        83,084  

Of which unfunded

     523        754        2,814        4,091  

2015

           

DBO, closing balance

     37,109        19,873        21,159        78,141  

Of which partially or fully funded

     36,583        19,196        18,590        74,369  

Of which unfunded

     526        677        2,569        3,772  

 

73


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Asset allocation by asset type and geography

 

     Sweden      US      Other      Total      Of which
unquoted
 

2016

              

Cash and cash equivalents

     1,819        414        793        3,026        14

Equity securities

     3,983        692        4,195        8,870        19

Debt securities

     8,791        18,286        13,898        40,975        70

Real estate

     4,093        —          330        4,423        100

Investment funds

     2,270        1,505        476        4,251        65

Assets held by insurance company

     —          —          1,125        1,125        100

Other

     —          648        1,167        1,815        69
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

Total

     20,956        21,545        21,984        64,485     

Of which real estate occupied by the Company

     —          —          —          —       

Of which securities issued by the Company

     —          —          —          —       

2015

              

Cash and cash equivalents

     3,001        715        141        3,857        19

Equity securities

     4,588        612        4,428        9,628        12

Debt securities

     6,602        16,884        12,404        35,890        79

Real estate

     2,654        —          155        2,809        100

Investment funds

     2,426        1,354        233        4,013        71

Assets held by insurance company

     —          —          629        629        100

Other

     —          549        803        1,352        48
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

Total

     19,271        20,114        18,793        58,178     

Of which real estate occupied by the Company

     —          —          —          —       

Of which securities issued by the Company

     —          —          —          —       

Actuarial assumptions

Financial and demographic actuarial assumptions 1)

 

     2016     2015  

Financial assumptions

    

Discount rate, weighted average

     2.8     3.3

Demographic assumptions

    

Life expectancy after age 65 in years, weighted average

     23       23  

 

1) Weighted average for the Group for disclosure purposes only. Country-specific assumptions were used for each actuarial calculation.

Actuarial assumptions are assessed on a quarterly basis. See also Note C1 “Significant accounting policies” and Note C2 “Critical accounting estimates and judgments.”

Sweden

The defined benefit obligation has been calculated using a discount rate based on yields of Swedish government bonds. IAS 19 Employee Benefits prescribes that if there is not a deep market in high-quality corporate bonds the market yields on government bonds shall be applied for the pension liability calculation.

US

The defined benefit obligation has been calculated using a discount rate based on yields of high-quality corporate bonds, where “high-quality” has been defined as a rating of AA and above.

Total remeasurements in Other comprehensive income related to post-employment benefits

 

     2016      2015  

Actuarial gains and losses (+/–)

     –1,955        –1,507  

The effect of asset ceiling

     254        –55  

Swedish special payroll taxes 1)

     –65        –464  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     –1,766        –2,026  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) Swedish payroll taxes are included in recognized gain/loss during the year in OCI.

Sensitivity analysis of significant actuarial assumptions

 

     2016      2015  

Impact on DBO, SEK billion

     

Discount rate +0.5%

     –9        –8  

Discount rate –0.5%

     +8        +7  

 

74


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

C18    Provisions

Provisions

 

     Warranty      Restructuring      Other      Total  

2016

           

Opening balance

     528        1,466        1,844        3,838  

Additions

     267        5,271        808        6,346  

Reversal of excess amounts

     –207        –130        –352        –689  

Negative effect on Income statement

              5,657  

Utilization/Cash out

     –365        –2,440        –348        –3,153  

Reclassifications

     9        1        –18        –8  

Translation difference

     16        –5        12        23  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Closing balance

     248        4,163        1,946        6,357  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

2015

           

Opening balance

     824        801        2,802        4,427  

Additions

     723        3,619        634        4,976  

Reversal of excess amounts

     –59        –189        –230        –478  

Negative effect on Income statement

              4,498  

Utilization/Cash out

     –984        –2,766        –1,312        –5,062  

Reclassifications

     1        14        —          15  

Translation difference

     23        –13        –50        –40  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Closing balance

     528        1,466        1,844        3,838  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Provisions will fluctuate over time depending on business mix, market mix and technology shifts. Risk assessment in the ongoing business is performed monthly to identify the need for new additions and reversals. During certain years the Company undertakes restructuring activities that may require recognition of provisions. Management uses its best judgment to estimate provisions based on this assessment. Under certain circumstances, provisions are no longer required due to outcomes being more favorable than anticipated, which affect the provisions balance as a reversal. In other cases, the outcome can be negative, and if so, a charge is recorded in the income statement.

For 2016, new or additional provisions amounting to SEK 6.3 billion were made, and SEK 0.7 billion of provisions were reversed. The actual cash outlays for 2016 were SEK 3.2 billion compared with the estimated SEK 2.5 billion. The total cash out for 2016 was made up of warranty provisions of SEK 0.4 billion, restructuring provisions of SEK 2.4 billion and other provisions of SEK 0.3 billion. The expected total cash outlays in 2017 are approximately SEK 4.4 billion.

Of the total provisions, SEK 946 (176) million is classified as non-current. For more information, see Note C1, “Significant accounting policies” and Note C2, “Critical accounting estimates and judgments.”

Warranty provisions

Warranty provisions are based on historic quality rates for established products as well as estimates regarding quality rates for new products and costs to remedy the various types of faults predicted. Provisions amounting to SEK 0.3 billion were made and due to more favorable outcomes in certain cases reversals of SEK 0.2 billion were made.

The actual cash outlays for 2016 were SEK 0.4 billion, in line with the expected SEK 0.4 billion. The cash outlays of warranty provisions during year 2017 are estimated to total approximately SEK 0.1 billion.

Restructuring provisions

In 2016, SEK 5.3 billion in provisions were made and SEK 0.1 billion were reversed due to a more favorable outcome than expected. Provisions were mainly related to the cost and efficiency program initially announced in November 2014. The scope of the structural efficiency measures involves service delivery, supply and manufacturing, R&D and SG&A (Selling, General and Administrative expenses). The cash outlays for restructuring provisions were SEK 2.4 billion for the full-year, compared with the expected SEK 1.2 billion. The cash outlays for 2017 for these provisions are estimated to total approximately SEK 3.2 billion.

Other provisions

Other provisions include provisions for probable contractual penalties, tax issues, litigations, supplier claims, and other. During 2016, new provisions amounting to SEK 0.8 billion were made and SEK 0.4 billion were reversed due to a more favorable outcome. The cash outlays were SEK 0.3 billion in 2016 compared to the estimate of SEK 0.8 billion. For 2017, the cash outlays for other provisions are estimated to total approximately SEK 1.1 billion.

 

75


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

C19 Interest-bearing liabilities

As of December 31, 2016, the Company’s outstanding interest-bearing liabilities was SEK 26.7 (25.1) billion.

Interest-bearing liabilities

 

     2016      2015  

Borrowings, current

     

Current part of non-current borrowings 1)

     4,954        435  

Other current borrowings

     3,079        1,941  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total current borrowings

     8,033        2,376  

Borrowings, non-current

     

Notes and bond loans

     10,556        14,699  

Other borrowings, non-current

     8,097        8,045  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total non-current interest-bearing liabilities

     18,653        22,744  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total interest-bearing liabilities

     26,686        25,120  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) Including notes and bond loans of SEK 4,900 (0) million.

To secure long-term funding, the Company uses notes and bond programs together with bilateral research and development loans. All outstanding notes and bond loans are issued by the Parent Company under its Euro Medium-Term Note (EMTN) program or under its U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) Registered program. Bonds issued at a fixed interest rate are normally swapped to a floating interest rate using interest rate swaps leaving a maximum of 50% of outstanding loans at fixed interest rates. Total weighted average interest rate cost for the long-term funding during the year was 2.76% (2.58%). The outstanding EUR bond is revalued based on changes in benchmark interest rates according to the fair value hedge methodology stipulated in IAS 39.

In June 2016, the Company exercised its first extension option under the USD 2 billion multi-currency revolving credit facility, extending the maturity date to June 2021. One extension option of one year remains.

In November 2016, the Company signed a new EUR 0.5 billion term loan facility. The new facility has a tenor of two years with one extension option of one year and the facility serves for general corporate purposes.

Notes, bonds, bilateral loans and committed credit

 

Issued–maturing

   Nominal
amount
     Coupon     Currency      Book value
(SEK  million) 9)
    Maturity date      Unrealized  hedge
gain/loss (included
in book value)
 

Notes and bond loans

               

2007–2017

     500        5.375     EUR        4,900 1)       June 27, 2017        –120  

2010–2020 2)

     170          USD        1,540       December 23, 2020     

2012–2022

     1,000        4.125     USD        9,016 8)       May 15, 2022     
          

 

 

      

 

 

 

Total notes and bond loans

             15,456          –120  

Bilateral loans

               

2012–2019 3)

     98          USD        887       September 30, 2019     

2012–2021 4)

     98          USD        889       September 30, 2021     

2013–2020 5)

     684          USD        6,193       November 6, 2020     
          

 

 

      

Total bilateral loans

             7,969       
          

 

 

      

Committed credit

               

Long-term committed credit facility 6)

     2,000          USD        —         June 5, 2021     

Term loan facility 7)

     500          EUR        —         November 10, 2018     
          

 

 

      

Total committed credit

             —         
          

 

 

      

 

1) Interest rate swaps are designated as fair value hedges.
2) Private Placement, Swedish Export Credit Corporation (SEK).
3) Nordic Investment Bank (NIB), R&D project financing.
4) Nordic Investment Bank (NIB), R&D project financing.
5) European Investment Bank (EIB), R&D project financing.
6) Multi-currency revolving credit facility. Unutilized. One one-year extension option remains.
7) Bridge term loan facility. Unutilized. One one-year extension option remains.
8) Market value SEK 9,092 million.
9) Market value is approximately equal to book value except where indicated.

 

76


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

C20    Financial risk management and financial instruments

The Company’s financial risk management is governed by a policy approved by the Board of Directors. The Finance Committee of the Board of Directors is responsible for overseeing the capital structure and financial management of the Company and approving certain matters (such as investments, customer finance commitments, guarantees and borrowing) and continuously monitors the exposure to financial risks.

The Company defines its managed capital as the total Company equity. For the Company, a robust financial position with a strong equity ratio, solid investment grade rating, low leverage and ample liquidity is deemed important. This provides financial flexibility and independence to operate and manage variations in working capital needs as well as to capitalize on business opportunities.

The Company’s overall capital structure should support the financial targets: to grow faster than the market, deliver best-in-class margins and generate a healthy cash flow. The capital structure is managed by balancing equity, debt financing and liquidity in such a way that the Company can secure funding of operations at a reasonable cost of capital. Regular borrowings are complemented with committed credit facilities to give additional flexibility to manage unforeseen funding needs. The Company strives to finance growth, normal capital expenditures and dividends to shareholders by generating cash flows from operating activities.

The Company’s capital objectives are:

 

   

To maintain an equity ratio above 40%

 

   

A cash conversion rate above 70%

 

   

To maintain a positive net cash position larger than the pension liability

 

   

To maintain a solid investment grade rating by Moody’s and Standard & Poor’s.

Capital objectives-related information, SEK billion

 

     2016     2015  

Capital

     140       147  

Equity ratio

     50     52

Cash conversion

     175     85

Positive net cash

     31.2       41.2  

Credit rating

    

Moody’s

     Baa3, negative       Baa1, stable  

Standard & Poor’s

     BBB, negative       BBB+, stable  

The definition of Net cash has been adjusted in order to more clearly represent Ericsson’s ability to meet financial obligations. Post-employment benefits are no longer included in the calculation of Net cash. Interest-bearing securities, non-current are now included in Net cash because these are liquid instruments with low credit risk. The revised definition is as follows:

Net cash: Cash and cash equivalents plus interest-bearing securities (current and non-current) less interest-bearing liabilities (which include: non-current borrowings and current borrowings).

In October 2016, Moody’s announced that they have downgraded the senior unsecured debt ratings to Baa2 from Baa1 and the MTN program rating to Baa2 from Baa1. At the same time, the agency placed the company’s Baa2/Baa2 ratings on review for further downgrade. In December 2016, Moody’s concluded their review and announced that they have downgraded the senior unsecured debt ratings to Baa3 from Baa2 and the MTN program rating to Baa3 from Baa2, with a negative outlook. In October 2016, S&P announced that they have downgraded the long-term corporate credit rating on Ericsson to BBB from BBB+, with a negative outlook.

The Company has a treasury function with the principal role to ensure that appropriate financing is in place through loans and committed credit facilities, actively managing the Company’s liquidity as well as financial assets and liabilities, and managing and controlling financial risk exposures in a manner consistent with underlying business risks and financial policies.

Hedging activities, cash management and insurance management are largely centralized to the treasury function in Stockholm.

The Company also has a customer finance function with the main objective to find suitable third-party financing solutions for customers and to minimize recourse to the Company. To the extent that customer loans are not provided directly by banks, the Parent Company provides or guarantees vendor credits. The customer finance function monitors the exposure from outstanding vendor credits and credit commitments.

The Company classifies financial risks as:

 

   

Foreign exchange risk

 

   

Interest rate risk

 

   

Credit risk

 

   

Liquidity and refinancing risk

 

   

Market price risk in own and other equity instruments.

The Board of Directors has established risk limits for defined exposures to foreign exchange and interest rate risks as well as to political risks in certain countries.

For further information about accounting policies, see Note C1, “Significant accounting policies.”

Foreign exchange risk

The Company is a global company with sales mainly outside Sweden. Sales and incurred costs are to a large extent denominated in currencies other than SEK and therefore the financial results of the Company are impacted by currency fluctuations.

The Company reports the financial statements in SEK. Movements in exchange rates between currencies that affect these statements are impacting the comparability between periods.

Line items, primarily sales, are impacted by translation exposure incurred when converting foreign entities’ financial statements into SEK. Line items and profitability, such as operating income are impacted by transaction exposure incurred when financial assets and liabilities, primarily trade receivables and trade payables, are initially recognized and subsequently remeasured due to change in foreign exchange rates. The table below presents the net exposure for the largest currencies impact on sales and also net transaction exposure of these currencies on profitability.

Currency exposure, SEK billion

 

Exposure currency

   Sales
translation
exposure
     Sales
transaction
exposure
     Sales net
exposure
     Incurred
cost
transaction
exposure 1)
     Net
transaction

exposure
 

USD

     55.2        45.8        101.0        –17.4        28.4  

EUR

     26.5        13.1        39.6        –7.4        5.7  

CNY

     15.8        –0.3        15.5        –5.1        –5.4  

INR

     10.5        0.0        10.5        –1.3        –1.3  

JPY

     7.0        0.0        7.0        4.5        4.5  

AUD

     5.9        –0.1        5.8        2.1        2.0  

GBP

     7.1        –1.7        5.4        0.9        –0.8  

SAR

     4.3        0.3        4.6        2.8        3.1  

BRL

     4.3        0.0        4.3        0.6        0.6  

 

1)

Transactions in foreign currency – internal sales, internal purchases, external purchases.

Translation exposure

Translation exposure relates to sales and cost incurred in foreign entities when converted into SEK upon consolidation. These exposures cannot be addressed by hedging, but as the income statement is translated using average rate, the impact of volatility in foreign currency rates is reduced.

Transaction exposure

Transaction exposure relates to sales and cost incurred in non-reporting currencies in individual group companies. Foreign exchange risk is as far as possible concentrated in Swedish group companies, primarily Ericsson

 

77


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

AB. Sales to foreign subsidiaries are normally denominated in the functional currency of the customers, and so tend to be denominated in USD or another foreign currency. In order to limit the exposure toward exchange rate fluctuations on future revenues and costs, committed and forecasted future sales and purchases in major currencies are hedged with 7% of 12-month forecast monthly. By this, the Company will have hedged 84% of the next month and 7% of the 12th month of an average forecast of the individual month at any given reporting date. This corresponds to approximately 5–6 months of an average forecast.

Outstanding derivatives contracts that are hedging future sales and costs incurred are revalued against “Other operating income and expense.” The sensitivity in “Other operating income and expense” in relation to this revaluation is dependent on changes in foreign exchange rates, forecasts, seasonality and hedging policy. USD is the Company’s largest exposure and at year-end a change by 0.25 SEK/USD would impact profit and loss with approximately SEK 0.3 billion. Revaluation results of these derivative contracts amounted to SEK –0.4 billion in 2016. According to Company policy, transaction exposure in subsidiaries’ balance sheets (i.e., trade receivables and payables and customer finance receivables) should be fully hedged, except for non-tradable currencies.

Foreign exchange exposures in balance sheet items are hedged through offsetting balances or derivatives.

Interest rate risk

The Company is exposed to interest rate risk through market value fluctuations in certain balance sheet items and through changes in interest revenues and expenses. The net cash position was SEK 31.2 (41.2) billion at the end of 2016, consisting of cash, cash equivalents and interest-bearing securities of SEK 57.9 (66.3) billion, interest-bearing liabilities of SEK 26.7 (25.1) .

The Company manages the interest rate risk by i) matching fixed and floating interest rates in interest-bearing balance sheet items and ii) avoiding significant fixed interest rate exposure in the Company’s net cash position. The policy is that interest-bearing assets shall have an average interest duration of between 6 and 14 months, taking derivative instruments into consideration. Interest-bearing liabilities do not have a firm target for the duration, nor a firm target for fixed/floating interest rate, as duration and interest mix are decided based on market conditions when the liabilities are issued. The treasury function has a mandate to deviate from the asset management benchmark given by the Board and take foreign exchange positions up to an aggregated risk of VaR SEK 45 million given a confidence level of 99% and a 1-day horizon.

Interest duration, SEK billion

 

     < 3M      3–12M      1–3Y      3–5Y      >5Y      Total  

Interest-bearing trading

     1.4        –1.4        0.0        0.0        0.0        0.0  

Interest-bearing assets

     30.5        –4.6        24.2        11.7        –3.9        57.9  

Interest-bearing liabilities

     29.4        –18.0        –17.4        –11.4        –9.3        –26.7  

When managing the interest rate exposure, the Company uses derivative instruments, such as interest rate swaps. Derivative instruments used for converting fixed rate debt into floating rate debt are designated as fair value hedges.

Outstanding derivatives

Outstanding derivatives 1)

 

     2016      2015  

Fair value

   Asset     Liability      Asset     Liability  

Currency derivatives

         

Maturity within 3 months

     351       193        316       137  

Maturity between 3 and 12 months

     262       137        224       41  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

     613       330        540       178  

Interest rate derivatives

         

Maturity within 3 months

     —         —          5       —    

Maturity between 3 and 12 months

     239       82        165       234  

Maturity between 1 and 3 years

     191       205        545       243  

Maturity between 3 and 5 years

     —         6        53       176  

Maturity of more than 5 years

     65       116        94       108  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

     495 2)       409        862 2)       761  

Of which designated in fair value hedge relations

     120       —          338       —    

 

1) Some of the derivatives hedging non-current liabilities are recognized in the balance sheet as non-current derivatives due to hedge accounting.
2) Of which SEK 0 (452) million is reported as non-current assets.

Sensitivity analysis

The Company uses the VaR methodology to measure foreign exchange and interest rate risks in portfolios managed by the treasury function. This statistical method expresses the maximum potential loss that can arise with a certain degree of probability during a certain period of time. For the VaR measurement, the Company has chosen a probability level of 99% and a 1-day time horizon. The daily VaR measurement uses market volatilities and correlations based on historical daily data (one year).

The average VaR calculated for 2016 was SEK 16.3 (11.7) million for the combined mandates. No VaR-limits were exceeded during 2016.

Financial credit risk

Financial instruments carry an element of risk in that counterparts may be unable to fulfill their payment obligations. This exposure arises in the investments in cash, cash equivalents, interest-bearing securities and from derivative positions with positive unrealized results against banks and other counterparties.

The Company mitigates these risks by investing cash primarily in well-rated securities such as treasury bills, government bonds, commercial papers, and mortgage-covered bonds with short-term ratings of at least A-2/P-2 or equivalents, and long-term ratings of AAA. Separate credit limits are assigned to each counterpart in order to minimize risk concentration. All derivative transactions are covered by ISDA netting agreements to reduce the credit risk.

At December 31, 2016, the credit risk in financial cash instruments was equal to the instruments’ carrying value. Credit exposure in derivative instruments was SEK 1.1 (1.4) billion.

Liquidity risk

The Company minimizes the liquidity risk by maintaining a sufficient cash position, centralized cash management, investments in highly liquid interest-bearing securities, and by having sufficient committed credit lines in place to meet potential funding needs. For information about contractual obligations, see Note C31, “Contractual obligations.” The current cash position is deemed to satisfy all short-term liquidity requirements as well as non-current borrowings.

 

78


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Cash, cash equivalents and interest-bearing securities

 

     Remaining time to maturity         

SEK billion

   < 3
months
     3–12
months
     1–5
years
     >5
years
     Total  

Banks

     29.0        0.1        0.2        0.0        29.3  

Type of issuer/counterpart

              

Governments

     0.0        0.5        7.1        0.3        7.9  

Corporates

     8.0        0.0        0.0        0.0        8.0  

Mortgage institutes

     0.0        0.7        12.0        0.0        12.7  

2016

     37.0        1.3        19.3        0.3        57.9  

2015

     40.3        3.0        22.4        0.6        66.3  

The instruments are classified as held for trading, loans and receivables, or available-for-sale. Cash, cash equivalents and interest-bearing securities are mainly held in SEK unless offset by EUR-funding. Instruments held for trading with a remaining maturity longer than one year amounted to SEK 12.0 billion and were reported as Interest-bearing securities, current.

Refinancing risk

Refinancing risk is the risk that the Company is unable to refinance outstanding debt under reasonable terms and conditions, or at all, at a given point in time.

Debt financing is mainly carried out through borrowing in the Swedish and international debt capital markets.

Bank financing is used for certain subsidiary funding and to obtain committed credit facilities, see Note C19, “Interest-bearing liabilities.”

Funding programs 1)

 

     Amount      Utilized      Unutilized  

Euro Medium-Term Note program (USD million)

     5,000        698        4,288  

SEC Registered program (USD million)

          2 )        1,000        —    

 

1) There are no financial covenants related to these programs.
2) Program amount indeterminate.

Fair valuation of the Company’s financial instruments

The Company’s financial instruments accounted for at fair value generally meet the requirements of level 1 valuation due to the fact that they are based on quoted prices in active markets for identical assets.

Exceptions to this relates to:

 

   

OTC derivatives with an amount of gross SEK 1.2 (1.8) billion in relation to assets and gross SEK 0.9 (1.3) billion in relation to liabilities were valued based on references to other market data as currency or interest rates. These valuations fall under level 2 valuation as defined by IFRS.

 

   

Ownership in other companies and other financial investments where the Company neither has control nor significant influence. The amount recognized in these cases was SEK 2.1 (2.1) billion. These assets, classified as level 3 assets for valuation purposes, have been valued based on value in use technique.

Financial instruments carried at other than fair value

The fair value of the Company’s financial instruments, recognized at fair value, is determined based on quoted market prices or rates. For further information about valuation principles, see Note C1, “Significant accounting policies.”

Financial instruments, such as trade receivables, borrowings and payables, are carried at amortized cost which is deemed to be equal to fair value, except for those noted in the table Notes, bonds, bilateral loans and committed credits in Note C19, “Interest-bearing liabilities.” When a market price is not readily available and there is insignificant interest rate exposure and credit spreads affecting the value, the carrying value is considered to represent a reasonable estimate of fair value.

Market price risk in own shares and other listed equity investments

The Company is exposed to fluctuations in its own share price through stock purchase plans for employees and synthetic share-based compensations to the Board of Directors.

Stock purchase plans for employees

The obligation to deliver shares under the stock purchase plan is covered by holding Ericsson Class B shares as treasury stock. A change in the share price will result in a change in social security charges, which represents a risk to the income statement. The cash flow exposure is fully hedged through the holding of Ericsson Class B shares as treasury stock to be sold to generate funds, which also cover social security payments.

Synthetic share-based compensations to the Board of Directors

In the case of these plans, the Company is exposed to risks in relation to own share price, both with regards to compensation expenses and social security charges. The obligation to pay compensation amounts under the synthetic share-based compensations to the Board of Directors is covered by a liability in the balance sheet.

For further information about the stock purchase plan and synthetic share-based compensations to the Board of Directors, see Note C28, “Information regarding members of the Board of Directors, the Group management and employees.”

Offsetting financial assets and liabilities

As required by IFRS, the Company has off set financial instruments under ISDA agreements. The related assets amounted to SEK 1.2 (1.8) billion, prior to offsetting of SEK 0.1 (0.4) billion, with a net amount of SEK 1.1 (1.4) billion recognized in the balance sheet. The related liabilities amounted to SEK 0.9 (1.3) billion, prior to offsetting of SEK 0.1 (0.4) billion, with a net amount of SEK 0.8 (0.9) billion recognized in the balance sheet.

Financial instruments, book value

 

SEK billion

   Customer
finance
     Trade
receivables
     Interest-
bearing
securities
     Cash
equiva-
lents
     Borrowings      Trade
payables
     Other
financial
assets
     Other
current

receiv-
ables
     Other
current
liabilities
     2016      2015  

Note

     C14        C14        C12        C25        C19        C22        C12        C15        C21        

Assets at fair value through profit or loss

           13.3        8.9              0.9        1.1        –0.7        23.5        40.2  

Loans and receivables

     4.8        68.1           2.5              3.5              78.9        84.2  

Available-for-sale

           7.6                 1.2              8.8        1.3  

Financial liabilities at amortized cost

                 –26.7        –25.3                 –52.0        –47.5  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     4.8        68.1        20.9        11.4        –26.7        –25.3        5.6        1.1        –0.7        59.2        78.2  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

79


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

C21    Other current liabilities

Other current liabilities

 

     2016      2015  

Income tax liabilities

     —          3,924  

Advances from customers

     5,391        5,038  

Accrued interest

     367        475  

Accrued expenses

     30,716        32,629  

Of which employee-related

     9,414        13,229  

Of which supplier-related

     13,003        12,119  

Of which other 1)

     8,299        7,281  

Deferred revenues

     13,990        11,229  

Derivatives with a negative value 2)

     739        939  

Other 3)

     4,800        4,429  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     56,003        58,663  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) Major balance relates to accrued expenses for customer projects.
2) See Note C20, “Financial risk management and financial instruments.”
3) Includes items such as VAT and withholding tax payables and other payroll deductions, and liabilities for goods received where the related invoice has not yet been received.

C22    Trade payables

Trade payables

 

     2016      2015  

Trade payables to associated companies and joint ventures

     296        329  

Trade payables, excluding associated companies and joint ventures

     25,022        22,060  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     25,318        22,389  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

C23    Assets pledged as collateral

Assets pledged as collateral

 

     2016      2015  

Chattel mortgages 1)

     2,240        2,231  

Bank deposits

     344        295  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     2,584        2,526  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) See also Note C17, “Post-Employment benefits.”

C24    Contingent liabilities

Contingent liabilities

 

     2016      2015  

Contingent liabilities

     1,186        922  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     1,186        922  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Contingent liabilities assumed by Ericsson include guarantees of loans to other companies of SEK 24 (23) million. Ericsson has SEK 33 (32) million issued to guarantee the performance of a third-party.

All ongoing legal and tax proceedings have been evaluated, their potential economic outflows and probability estimated and necessary provisions made. In Note C2, “Critical Accounting Estimates and Judgments.” further disclosure is presented in relation to (i) key sources of estimation uncertainty and (ii) the decision made in relation to accounting policies applied.

Financial guarantees for third-parties amounted to SEK 124 (70) million as of December 31, 2016. The maturity date for the majority of the issued guarantees occurs in 2020 at the latest.

C25    Statement of cash flows

Interest paid in 2016 was SEK –1,269 million (SEK 926 million in 2015 and SEK 1,120 million in 2014) and interest received in 2016 was SEK 110 million (SEK 550 million in 2015 and SEK 1,369 million in 2014). Taxes paid, including withholding tax, were SEK 9,105 million in 2016 (SEK 7,705 million in 2015 and SEK 6,114 million in 2014).

Cash and cash equivalents include cash of SEK 25,577 (22,431) million and temporary investments of SEK 11,389 (17,793) million. For more information regarding the disposition of cash and cash equivalents and unutilized credit commitments, see Note C20, “Financial risk management and financial instruments.”

Cash and cash equivalents as of December 31, 2016, include SEK 4.2 billion (4.7) in countries where there exist significant cross-border conversion restrictions due to hard currency shortage or strict government controls. This amount is therefore not considered available for general use by the Parent Company.

 

80


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Adjustments to reconcile net income to cash

 

     2016      2015      2014  

Property, plant and equipment

        

Depreciation

     4,421        4,705        4,329  

Impairment losses/reversals of impairments

     148        –16        –13  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     4,569        4,689        4,316  

Intangible assets

        

Amortization

        

Capitalized development expenses

     1,815        1,379        1,270  

Intellectual Property Rights, brands and other intangible assets

     2,650        4,139        4,328  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total amortization

     4,465        5,518        5,598  

Impairments

        

Capitalized development expenses

     85        20        31  

Intellectual Property Rights, brands and other intangible assets

     —          —          —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     4,550        5,538        5,629  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total depreciation, amortization and impairment losses on property, plant and equipment and intangible assets

     9,119        10,227        9,945  

Taxes

     –6,200        –2,835        –1,235  

Dividends from joint ventures/associated companies 1)

     84        92        249  

Undistributed earnings in joint ventures/associated companies 1)

     –26        38        56  

Gains/losses on sales of investments and operations, intangible assets and PP&E, net 2)

     –37        –156        128  

Other non-cash items 3)

     3,172        3,245        2,057  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total adjustments to reconcile net income to cash

     6,112        10,611        11,200  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) See Note C12, “Financial assets, non-current.”
2) See Note C6, “Other operating income and expense.”
3) Refers mainly to unrealized foreign exchange, gains/losses on financial instruments.

Acquisitions/divestments of subsidiaries and other operations

 

     Acquisitions      Divestments  

2016

     

Cash flow from business combinations 1)

     –781        25  

Acquisitions/divestments of other investments

     –203        337  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     –984        362  

2015

     

Cash flow from business combinations 1)

     –1,867        —    

Acquisitions/divestments of other investments

     –334        1  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     –2,201        1  

2014

     

Cash flow from business combinations 1)

     –4,410        42  

Acquisitions/divestments of other investments

     –32        6  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     –4,442        48  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) See also Note C26, “Business combinations.”

C26    Business combinations

Acquisitions and divestments

Acquisitions

Acquisitions 2014–2016

 

     2016     2015      2014  

Total consideration, including cash

     920       2,119        4,767  

Acquisition-related costs 1)

     4       19        50  

Net assets acquired

       

Cash and cash equivalents

     139       271        407  

Property, plant and equipment

     19       45        427  

Intangible assets

     817       445        2,540  

Other assets

     290       572        817  

Provisions, including post-employment benefits

     —         —          –288  

Other liabilities

     –290       –379        –1,150  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total identifiable net assets

     975       954        2,753  

Goodwill

     –55 2)       1,165        2,014  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     920       2,119        4,767  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) Acquisition-related costs are included in Selling and administrative expenses in the consolidated income statement.
2) Of which SEK 585 million was acquired goodwill and SEK –640 million refers to a reclassification when the preliminary purchase price allocations made in 2015 were finalized 2016.

In 2016, Ericsson made acquisitions with a negative cash flow effect amounting to SEK 781 (1,867) million. The acquisitions presented below are not material but the Company gives the information to provide the reader a summarized view of the content of the acquisitions made. The acquisitions consist primarily of:

 

   

FYI Television: On January 25, 2016, the Company acquired 100% of the shares in FYI Television, a US based premier entertainment metadata and rich media content supplier based in Grand Prairie, Texas, with approximately 150 employees. The acquisition makes it possible to combine FYI Television’s US-market expertise and reach with Ericsson’s experience in content discovery in Europe, which is a key component of Ericsson’s TV and Media strategy to improve the video experience in a multiscreen world. Balances to facilitate the Purchase price allocation are final.

 

   

Ericpol: On April 13, 2016, the Company acquired 100% of the shares in Ericpol a software development company in Poland within telecommunications who has been a supplier to Ericsson for over 20 years. Approximately 2,000 employees joined the Company. With the acquisition of Ericpol’s operations in Poland and Ukraine, the Company secures well integrated software development competence within radio, cloud and IP to enable business continuity. Balances to facilitate the Purchase price allocation are preliminary.

 

   

Nodeprime: On April 15, 2016, the Company acquired 100% of the shares in Nodeprime a US based company, with an infrastructure management platform, designed to support the command and control of the complete ecosystem of components in today’s existing datacenters. Integrated into the Ericsson Hyperscale Datacenter System 8000, this software platform enables discovery, analysis and automated configuration of existing and new datacenter hardware platforms. This allows datacenters to become hyperscale and adopt distributed infrastructure. By acquiring Nodeprime’s competence, the Company aims to reduce sourcing risk and to secure control of roadmap direction and acceleration. Balances to facilitate the Purchase price allocation are final.

 

81


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

The preliminary purchase price allocations made in 2015 were finalized during 2016 with the following effects: An increase in intangible assets of SEK 585 million and a decrease in goodwill of SEK 640 million.

In order to finalize a purchase price allocation all relevant information needs to be in place. Examples of such information are final consideration and final opening balances, which may remain preliminary for a period of time due to for example adjustments of working capital, tax items or decisions from local authorities.

Divestments

Divestments 2014–2016

 

     2016      2015      2014  

Proceeds

     25        0        42  

Net assets disposed of

        

Property, plant and equipment

     36        —          —    

Investments in joint ventures and associated companies

     15        —          32  

Other assets

     5        52        46  

Other liabilities

     –114        –3        —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     –58        49        78  

Net gains/losses from divestments

     83        –49        –36  

Less Cash and cash equivalents

     —          —          —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cash flow effect

     25        0        42  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

In 2016, the Company made some minor divestments with a cash flow effect amounting to SEK 25 (0) million.

Acquisitions 2014–2016

 

Company

  

Description

   Transaction
date

Nodeprime

   A US based software development company with an infrastructure management platform.    Apr 2016

Ericpol

   A software development company in Poland within telecommunications.    Apr 2016

FYI Television

   A US based premier entertainment metadata and rich media content supplier.    Jan 2016

Envivio

   A US-based company with competence in software-defined and cloud-enabled architectures for video processing.    Oct 2015

ICON

   A consulting and systems integration business with approximately 250 employees and consultants.    Aug 2015

Sunrise technology

   A business which has a strong track record of delivering complex IT solutions to leading operators in China.    Jul 2015

Timelessmind

   A Canada-based consulting and systems integration business specializing in operations and business support (OSS and/BSS).    Apr 2015

Apcera

   The acquisition of a majority stake in Apcera strengthens Ericsson’s position in enterprise cloud.    Oct 2014

Fabrix

   The acquisition of Fabrix Systems extends Ericsson’s overall leadership position in TV & Media.    Oct 2014

MetraTech

   The acquisition of MetraTech accelerates Ericsson’s cloud and enterprise billing capabilities within BSS.    Sep 2014

Red Bee Media

   A leading media services company headquartered in the UK with an extensive list of high-profile broadcast services customers.    May 2014

Azuki

   A provider of TV Anywhere delivery platforms for service providers, content owners and broadcasters.    Feb 2014

Divestments 2014–2016

 

Company

  

Description

   Transaction
date

Birla Ericsson Optical Ltd

   A divestment of the shares in the associated company.    Jul 2016

 

82


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

C27    Leasing

Leasing with the Company as lessee

Assets under finance leases, recorded as property, plant and equipment, consist of:

Finance leases

 

     2016      2015  

Cost

     

Real estate

     —          701  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     —          701  

Accumulated depreciation

     

Real estate

     —          –249  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     —          –249  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net carrying value

     —          452  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Due to replacement of former lease contract with operating lease contract the Company has from 2016 no finance leases.

As of December 31, 2016, future minimum lease payment obligations were distributed as follows:

Future minimum lease payment obligations

 

     Finance
leases
     Operating
leases
 

2017

     —          3,120  

2018

     —          2,745  

2019

     —          1,985  

2020

     —          1,575  

2021

     —          1,717  

2022 and later

     —          5,493  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     —          16,635  

Future finance charges

     —          n/a  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Present value of finance lease liabilities

     —          n/a  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Expenses in 2016 for leasing of assets were SEK 3,710 (3,449) million, of which variable expenses comprised SEK 217 (35) million. The leasing contracts vary in length from 1 to 15 years.

The Company’s lease agreements normally do not include any contingent rents. In the few cases they occur, they relate to charges for heating linked to the oil price index. Most of the leases of real estate contain terms of renewal, giving the Company the right to prolong the agreement in question for a predefined period of time.

Leases with the Company as lessor

Leasing income relates to subleasing of real estate as well as equipment provided to customers under leasing arrangements. These leasing contracts vary in length from 1 to 16 years.

At December 31, 2016, future minimum payment receivables were distributed as follows:

Future minimum payment receivables

 

     Finance
leases
     Operating
leases
 

2017

     —          40  

2018

     —          21  

2019

     —          10  

2020

     —          7  

2021

     —          7  

2022 and later

     —          8  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     —          93  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Leasing income in 2016 was SEK 47 (73) million.

 

83


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

C28    Information regarding members of the Board of Directors, the Group management and employees

Remuneration to the Board of Directors

Remuneration to members of the Board of Directors

 

SEK

   Board fees      Number
of synthetic
shares/
portion of
Board fee
    Value at
grant date of
synthetic

shares
allocated in 2016
A
     Number of
previously
allocated
synthetic
shares
outstanding
    Net change
in value
of synthetic
shares 1)

B
    Committee
fees
     Total fees
paid in

cash 2)
C
    Total
remuneration
2016
(A+B+C)
 

Board member

                   

Leif Johansson

     4,075,000        0/0     —          —         —         400,000        4,475,000 4)       4,475,000  

Helena Stjernholm

     990,000        11,093/75     742,454        —         –148,979 1)       175,000        422,500       1,015,975  

Jacob Wallenberg

     990,000        7,395/50     494,947        17,791       –444,785 1)       175,000        670,000 5)       720,162  

Nora Denzel

     990,000        0/0     —          5,489       –127,656 1)       250,000        1,240,000       1,112,344  

Börje Ekholm 3)

     742,500        8,319/75     556,790        35,360       –791,841 1)       131,250        316,875       81,824  

Ulf J. Johansson

     990,000        0/0     —          —         —         350,000        1,340,000 6)       1,340,000  

Kristin Skogen Lund

     990,000        3,697/25     247,440        8,293       –229,741 1)       250,000        992,500       1,010,199  

Kristin S. Rinne

     990,000        7,395/50     494,947        —         –99,315 1)       —          495,000       890,632  

Sukhinder Singh Cassidy

     990,000        3,697/25     247,440        2,513       –112,727 1)       175,000        917,500       1,052,213  

Employee Representatives

                   

Pehr Claesson

     39,000        —         —          —         —         —          39,000       39,000  

Mikael Lännqvist

     31,500        —         —          —         —         —          31,500       31,500  

Karin Åberg

     30,000        —         —          —         —         —          30,000       30,000  

Zlatko Hadzic (deputy)

     18,000        —         —          —         —         —          18,000       18,000  

Kjell-Åke Soting (deputy)

     19,500        —         —          —         —         —          19,500       19,500  

Roger Svensson (deputy)

     19,500        —         —          —         —         —          19,500       19,500  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

     11,905,000        41,596       2,784,018        69,446       –1,955,044       1,906,250        11,026,875       11,855,849 7)  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

     11,905,000        41,596       2,784,018        96,508 8)       –2,422,266 8)9)       1,906,250        11,026,875       11,388,627 7)  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

1) The difference in value as of the time for payment, compared to December 31, 2015, for synthetic shares allocated in 2011 (for which payment was made in 2016).

The difference in value as of December 31, 2016, compared to December 31, 2015, for synthetic shares allocated in 2012, 2013, 2014 and 2015. Calculated on a share price of SEK 53.50.

The difference in value as of December 31, 2016, compared to grant date for synthetic shares allocated in 2016.

The value of synthetic shares allocated in 2012, 2013, 2014 and 2015 includes respectively SEK 2.75, SEK 3.00, SEK 3.40 and SEK 3.70 per share in compensation for dividends resolved by the Annual General Meetings 2013, 2014, 2015 and 2016 and the value of the synthetic shares allocated in 2011 includes dividend compensation for dividends resolved in 2012, 2013, 2014 and 2015.

2) Committee fee and cash portion of the Board fee.
3) The Board remuneration resolved by the annual general meeting of shareholders is only for non-employee Board members. Since Börje Ekholm is employed by the Company as President and CEO since January 16, 2017, his shareholder resolved remuneration has been adjusted accordingly.
4) In addition, an amount corresponding to statutory social charges in respect of the part of the fee that has been invoiced from a business was paid, amounting to SEK 1,406,045.
5) In addition, an amount corresponding to statutory social charges in respect of the part of the fee that has been invoiced from a business was paid, amounting to SEK 210,514.
6) In addition, an amount corresponding to statutory social charges in respect of the part of the fee that has been invoiced from a business was paid, amounting to SEK 219,224.
7) Excluding social security charges and amounts invoiced through a business corresponding to such social security charges in to the amount of SEK 2,248,324.
8) Including synthetic shares previously allocated to the former Directors Roxanne S. Austin and Alexander Izosimov.
9) Including synthetic shares previously allocated to the former Director Nancy McKinstry and Sir Peter L. Bonfield. For these synthetic shares, the net change in value corresponds to the difference in value as of the time for payment compared to December 31, 2015.

Comments to the table

 

   

The Chairman of the Board was entitled to a Board fee of SEK 4,075,000 and a fee of SEK 200,000 for each Board Committee on which he served as Chairman.

 

   

The other Directors elected by the Annual General Meeting were entitled to a fee of SEK 990,000 each. In addition, the Chairman of the Audit Committee was entitled to a fee of SEK 350,000 and the other non-employee members of the Audit Committee were entitled to a fee of SEK 250,000 each. The Chairmen of the Finance and Remuneration Committees were entitled to a fee of SEK 200,000 each and the other non-employee members of the Finance and the Remuneration Committees were entitled to a fee of SEK 175,000 each.

 

   

Members of the Board, who are not employees of the Company, have not received any remuneration other than the fees and synthetic shares as above. None of the Directors have entered into a service contract with the Parent Company or any of its subsidiaries, providing for termination benefits.

 

   

Members and deputy members of the Board who are Ericsson employees received no remuneration or benefits other than their entitlements as employees and a fee to the employee representatives and their deputies of SEK 1,500 per attended Board meeting, and Committee meeting.

 

   

Board members invoicing for the amount of the Board and Committee fee from a business may add to the invoice an amount corresponding to social charges. The social charges thus included in the invoiced amount are not higher than the general payroll tax that would otherwise have been paid by the Company. The entire amount, i.e., the cash portion of the Board fee and the Committee fee, including social charges, constitutes the invoiced Board fee.

 

   

The Annual General Meeting 2016 resolved that non-employee Directors may choose to receive the Board fee (i.e., exclusive of Committee fee) as follows: i) 25% of the Board fee in cash and 75% in the form of synthetic shares, with a value corresponding to 75% of the Board fee at the time of allocation, ii) 50% in cash and 50% in the form of synthetic shares, or iii) 75% in cash and 25% in the form of synthetic shares. Directors may also choose not to participate in the synthetic share program and receive 100% of the Board fee in cash. Committee fees are always paid in cash.

The number of synthetic shares allocated is based on a volume-weighted average of the market price of Ericsson Class B shares on Nasdaq Stockholm during the five trading days immediately following the publication of Ericsson’s interim report for the first quarter 2016; SEK 66.93. The number of synthetic shares is rounded down to the nearest whole number of shares.

The synthetic shares are vested during the Directors’ term of office and the right to receive payment with regard to the allocated synthetic shares occurs after the publication of the Company’s year-end financial statement during the fifth year following the Annual General Meeting which

 

84


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

resolved on the synthetic share program, i.e., in 2021. The amount payable shall be determined based on the volume-weighted average price for shares of Class B during the five trading days immediately following the publication of the year-end financial statement.

Synthetic shares were allocated to members of the Board for the first time in 2008 and have been allocated annually since then on equal terms and conditions. Payment based on synthetic shares allocated in 2011 occurred in 2016 and, in accordance with the terms and conditions for the synthetic share advance payment was then also made to the former Director Sir Peter L. Bonfield. The amounts paid in 2016 under the synthetic share programs were determined based on the volume-weighed average price for shares of Class B on Nasdaq Stockholm during the five trading days immediately following the publication of the year-end financial statements for 2015: SEK 74.68 and totalled SEK 2,245,951 excluding social security charges. The payments made do not constitute a cost for the Company in 2016. The Company’s costs for the synthetic shares have been disclosed each year and the net change in value of the synthetic shares for which payment was made in 2016, is disclosed in the table “Remuneration to members of the Board of Directors” on page 84.

The value of all outstanding synthetic shares fluctuates in line with the market value of Ericsson’s Class B share and may differ from year to year compared to the original value on their respective grant dates. The change in value of the outstanding synthetic shares is established each year and affects the total recognized costs that year. As of December 31, 2016, the total outstanding number of synthetic shares under the programs is 138,105 and the total accounted debt is SEK 8,207,895 (including synthetic shares previously allocated to the former Directors Roxanne S. Austin and Alexander Izosimov).

Remuneration to the Group management

The Company’s costs for remuneration to the Group management are the costs recognized in the Income statement during the fiscal year. These costs are disclosed under “Remuneration costs” below.

Costs recognized during a fiscal year in the Income statement are not fully paid by the Company at the end of the fiscal year. The unpaid amounts that the Company has in relation to the Group management are disclosed under “Outstanding balances.”

Remuneration costs

The total remuneration to the President and CEO and to other members of the Group management, consisting of the Executive Leadership Team (ELT), includes fixed salary, short- and long-term variable compensation, pension and other benefits. These remuneration elements are based on the guidelines for remuneration to Group management as approved by the Annual General Meeting held in 2016: see the approved guidelines in section “Guidelines for remuneration to Group management 2016.”

Remuneration costs for the President and CEO and other members of Executive Leadership Team (ELT)

 

SEK

  President
and CEO 1)  2016
    President
and CEO 2)  2016
    Total: President
and CEO 2016
    President and
CEO 2015
    Other members
of ELT 2016
    Other members
of ELT 2015
    Total 2016     Total 2015  

Salary

    40,069,722 3)       5,812,635       45,882,357       14,165,287       119,501,092       98,777,226       165,383,449       112,942,513  

Cost for annual variable remuneration earned in the year to be paid the year after

    —         —         —         16,173,429       6,230,285       45,485,406       6,230,285       61,658,835  

Long-term variable compensation provision

    8,240,244       486,839       8,727,083       7,183,919       9,278,252       8,671,955       18,005,336       15,855,873  

Pension costs

    10,350,001       1,604,757       11,954,758       9,452,006       29,387,498       24,608,406       41,342,256       34,060,412  

Other benefits

    44,080       25,912       69,992       75,630       12,604,635       8,247,554       12,674,627       8,323,184  

Social charges and taxes

    17,864,315       2,376,750       20,241,066       14,106,432       29,147,247       23,515,519       49,388,312       37,621,951  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    76,568,362       10,306,894       86,875,256       61,156,702       206,149,008       209,306,065       293,024,265       270,462,767  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

1) Hans Vestberg served as President and CEO until July 25, 2016 and left Ericsson as of January 25, 2017. Remuneration costs shown for Hans Vestberg includes this full period.
2) Jan Frykhammar served as President and CEO from July 25, 2016 to January 16, 2017. Remuneration costs shown for Jan Frykhammar includes the period from July 25, 2016 to December 31, 2016 (costs for the rest of the year is included in “Other members of ELT 2016”).
3) Includes severance pay and compensation for unused vacation.

Comments to the table

 

   

Hans Vestberg was President and CEO of Ericsson until July 25, 2016, and Jan Frykhammar was appointed President and CEO from July 25, 2016.

 

   

During 2016, there were two Executive Vice Presidents who have been appointed by the Board of Directors, none of which acted as deputy to the President and CEO during the year. Executive Vice Presidents are included in the group “Other members of ELT”.

 

   

The group “Other members of ELT” comprises the following persons: Per Borgklint, Bina Chaurasia (left ELT effective November 15 and Ericsson December 31, 2016), Ulf Ewaldsson, Jan Frykhammar, Nina Macpherson, Magnus Mandersson, Helena Norrman, Mats H. Olsson (left ELT effective May 18 and Ericsson November 18, 2016), Rima Qureshi, Angel Ruiz (left ELT effective June 30, 2016), Anders Thulin (left ELT and Ericsson June 30, 2016), and Jan Wäreby (left ELT effective June 30 and Ericsson November 30, 2016). In addition, Arun Bansal, Niklas Heuveldop, Chris Houghton, Fredrik Jejdling, Anders Lindblad, Jean-Philippe Poirault, Charlotta Sund and Elaine Weidman- Grunewald all joined ELT on July 1, 2016. Carl Mellander joined ELT on July 25, 2016 and MajBritt Arfert joined ELT on November 15, 2016.

 

   

The salary stated in the table for the President and CEO and other members of the ELT includes vacation pay paid during 2016 as well as other contracted compensation expensed in 2016. During 2016, a decision was taken by the Remuneration Committee to pay out saved vacation balances. These payments are included in salaries stated above.

 

   

The remuneration costs for 2016 includes termination provisions, including estimates of future severance pay and compensation for unused vacation, in respect of individuals who left Ericsson during 2016. For the former President and CEO, Hans Vestberg, the contractual severance pay amounted to 18 months’ salary (SEK 21,206,863 excluding social charges and taxes).

 

   

“Long-term variable compensation provision” refers to the compensation costs during 2016 for all outstanding share-based plans.

 

   

For the former President and CEO, Hans Vestberg, and other members of the ELT employed in Sweden before 2011, a supplementary plan is applied in addition to the occupational pension plan for salaried staff on the Swedish labor market (ITP) with pension payable from the age of 60 years. These pension plans are not conditional upon future employment at Ericsson.

Outstanding balances

The Company has recognized the following liabilities relating to unpaid remunerations in the Balance sheet:

 

   

Ericsson’s commitments for defined benefit based pensions as of December 31, 2016 under IAS 19 amounted to SEK 13,949,474 for the President and CEO which includes disability and survivor’s pension. For other members of the ELT the Company’s commitments amounted to SEK 44,800,609 of which SEK 38,333,332 refers to the ITP and early retirement and the remaining SEK 6,467,277 to disability and survivor’s pensions.

 

   

For previous Presidents and CEOs, the Company has made provisions for defined benefit pension plans in connection with their active service periods within the Company.

 

   

Deferred salary, earned in 2016 or earlier, to be paid 12 months after period end or later, amounts to SEK 9,665,780.

 

85


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Maximum outstanding matching rights

 

As of December 31, 2016

Number of Class B shares

   The President
and CEO
     Other members
of the ELT
 

Stock Purchase Plans 2013–2016 Executive Performance Stock Plans 2013–2016

     84,871        388,296  

Comments to the table

 

   

For the definition of matching rights, see the description in section “Long-term variable compensation”.

 

   

Matching result of 39.7% is included for the 2013 plan.

 

   

Cash conversion targets for 2014, 2015 and 2016 were reached.

 

   

During 2016, the two serving Presidents and CEOs received 90,086 matching shares and other members of the ELT received 122,648 matching shares.

Option agreements

Prior to taking office as President and CEO of Ericsson, Board member Börje Ekholm entered into an option agreement with Investor AB and AB Industrivärden, shareholders of Ericsson. Each of these two shareholders has issued 1,000,000 call options to Börje Ekholm on market terms (valuation conducted, using the Black & Scholes model, by an independent third party). Under the agreements, Börje Ekholm has purchased in total 2,000,000 call options, issued by the shareholders, for a purchase price of SEK 0.49 per call option. Each call option entitles the purchase of one Ericsson B share from the shareholders at a strike price of SEK 80 per share during one year after a seven-year period. Since the President and CEO has the power to influence the dividend paid by the Company, a potential conflict of interest exists. The option agreements therefore contain a strike price recalculation mechanism which is intended to make the options payoff neutral regardless of what the actual dividends are. Due to the fact that the call options were purchased on market terms as described above, no compensation expense has been recognized by the Company and will not be recognized during the remaining part of the seven-year period.

Guidelines for remuneration to Group management 2016

For Group management consisting of the Executive Leadership Team, including the President and CEO, total remuneration consists of fixed salary, short- and long-term variable compensation, pension and other benefits.

The following guidelines apply to the remuneration of the Executive Leadership Team:

 

   

Variable compensation is in cash and stock-based programs awarded against specific business targets derived from the long-term business plan approved by the Board of Directors. Targets may include financial targets at either Group or unit level, operational targets, employee engagement targets or customer satisfaction targets.

 

   

All benefits, including pension benefits, follow the competitive practice in the home country taking total compensation into account.

 

   

By way of exception, additional arrangements can be made when deemed necessary. An additional arrangement can be renewed but each such arrangement shall be limited in time and shall not exceed a period of 36 months and twice the remuneration that the individual would have received had no additional arrangement been made.

 

   

The mutual notice period may be no more than six months. Upon termination of employment by the Company, severance pay amounting to a maximum of 18 months fixed salary is paid. Notice of termination given by the employee due to significant structural changes, or other events that in a determining manner affect the content of work or the condition for the position, is equated with notice of termination served by the Company.

Long-Term Variable compensation

The Stock Purchase Plan

The Stock Purchase Plan has been designed to offer an incentive for all employees to participate in the Company where practicable. For the 2016 plan, employees are able to save up to 7.5% of their gross fixed salary (The former President and CEO, Hans Vestberg, could save up to 10% of gross fixed salary and short-term variable remuneration) for purchase of Class B contribution shares at market price on Nasdaq Stockholm or American Depositary Shares (ADSs) on NASDAQ New York (contribution shares) during a twelve-month period (contribution period). If the contribution shares are retained by the employee for three years after the investment and their employment with the Ericsson Group continues during that time, then the employee’s shares will be matched with a corresponding number of Class B shares or ADSs free of consideration. Employees in 100 countries participate in the plans.

The table below shows the contribution periods and participation details for ongoing plans as of December 31, 2016.

Stock Purchase Plans

 

Plan

   Contribution period      Number of
participants
at launch
     Take-up
rate –percent of
eligible  employees
 

Stock Purchase plan 2013

     August 2013–July 2014        29,000        29

Stock Purchase plan 2014

     August 2014–July 2015        32,000        30

Stock Purchase plan 2015

     August 2015–July 2016        33,800        31

Stock Purchase plan 2016

     August 2016–July 2017        31,500        29

Participants save each month, beginning with the August payroll, towards quarterly investments. These investments (in November, February, May and August) are matched on the third anniversary of each such investment, subject to continued employment, and hence the matching spans over two financial years and two tax years.

No Stock Purchase Plan is being proposed for 2017.

The Key Contributor Retention Plan

The Key Contributor Retention Plan is part of Ericsson’s talent management strategy and is designed to give recognition for performance, critical skills and potential as well as to encourage retention of key employees. Under the program, up to 10% of employees (2016 plan: 10,742 employees nominated) are selected through a nomination process that identifies individuals according to performance, critical skills and potential. Participants selected obtain one extra matching share in addition to the ordinary one matching share for each contribution share purchased under the Stock Purchase Plan during a twelve-month period.

Since no Stock Purchase Plan will be proposed for 2017, alternative arrangements will be developed to replace the Key Contributor Plan.

 

86


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Executive Performance Stock Plan targets

 

     Base year
value
SEK billion
     Year 1     Year 2     Year 3  

2016

         

Growth (Net sales growth)

     246.9       

Compound annual

growth rate of 2–6%

 

 

Margin (Operating income growth) 1)

     24.8       
Compound annual
growth rate of 5–15%
 
 

Cash Flow (Cash conversion)

     —        ³ 70   ³ 70   ³ 70

2015

         

Growth (Net sales growth)

     228.0       

Compound annual

growth rate of 2–6%

 

 

Margin (Operating income growth) 1)

     16.8       
Compound annual
growth rate of 5–15%
 
 

Cash Flow (Cash conversion)

     —        ³ 70   ³ 70   ³ 70

2014

         

Growth (Net sales growth) 2)

     225.3       
Compound annual
growth rate of 2–8%
 
 

Margin (Operating income growth) 2)

     15.7       
Compound annual
growth rate of 5–15%
 
 

Cash Flow (Cash conversion)

     —        ³ 70   ³ 70   ³ 70

 

1) Excluding extraordinary restructuring charges.
2) Base year 2013 has been adjusted for the impact of the Samsung IPR agreement.

The Executive Performance Stock Plan

The Executive Performance Stock Plan has been designed to focus management on driving earnings and provide competitive remuneration. Senior managers, including ELT, were selected to obtain up to four or six extra shares (performance matching shares) in addition to the ordinary one matching share for each contribution share purchased under the Stock Purchase Plan. Up to 0.5% of employees (2016 plan: 509 executives) are offered participation in the plan. The former President and CEO, Hans Vestberg, could save up to 10% of gross fixed salary and short-term variable compensation, and could obtain up to nine performance-matching shares in addition to the Stock Purchase Plan matching share for each contribution share. The performance targets are linked to growth of Net Sales, Operating Income and Cash Conversion.

The table “Executive Performance Stock Plan targets” show ongoing Executive Performance Stock Plans as of December 31, 2016.

Since no Stock Purchase Plan will be proposed for 2017, alternative arrangements will be developed to replace the Executive Performance Stock Plan. For the Global Leadership Team, a share-based arrangement is proposed for approval by the 2017 Annual General Meeting of shareholders.

Shares for all plans

 

            Stock Purchase Plan, Key
Contributor Retention Plan and
Executive Performance Stock Plans
   

 

 

Plan (million shares)

          2016     2015     2014     2013     2012     Total  

Originally designated

     A        21.6       23.5       22.8       26.6       26.2       120.7  

Outstanding beginning of 2016

     B        —         4.4       13.5       11.5       6.6       36.0  

Awarded during 2016

     C        7.6       16.1       —         —         —         23.7  

Exercised/matched during 2016

     D        —         1.0       1.0       3.0       6.5       11.5  

Forfeited/expired during 2016

     E        0.1       0.8       0.7       1.5       0.1       3.2  

Outstanding end of 2016 1)

     F=B+C–D–E        7.5       18.7       11.8       7.0       —         45.0  

Compensation costs charged during 2016 (SEK million) 3)

     G        11.7 2)       288.3 2)       348.5 2)       250.1 2)       58.1 2)       956.7  

 

1) Shares under the Executive Performance Stock Plans were based on the fact that the 2012 plan came out at 33%, in casu 67% lapsed and that the 2013 plan vested for 39.7% and lapsed for 60.3%. For the other ongoing plans, cost is estimated.
2) Fair value is calculated as the share price on the investment date, reduced by the net present value of the dividend expectations during the three-year vesting period. Net present value calculations are based on data from external party. For shares under the Executive Performance Stock Plans, the company makes a forecast for the fulfillment of the financial targets for all ongoing plans except for 2012 and 2013 plans as disclosed under 1) when calculating the compensation cost. Fair value of the Class B share at each investment date during 2016 was: February 15 SEK 63.62, May 15 SEK 50.52, August 15 SEK 50.39 and November 15 SEK 38.83.
3) Total compensation costs charged during 2015: SEK 865 million, 2014: SEK 717 million.

Shares for all plans

All plans are funded with treasury stock and are equity settled. Treasury stock for all plans has been issued in directed cash issues of Class C shares at the quotient value and purchased under a public offering at the subscription price plus a premium corresponding to the subscribers’ financing costs, and then converted to Class B shares.

For all plans, additional shares have been allocated for financing of social security expenses. Treasury stock is sold on the Nasdaq Stockholm to cover social security payments when arising due to matching of shares. During 2016, 1,706,600 shares were sold at an average price of SEK 61.31. Sales of shares are recognized directly in equity.

If, as of December 31, 2016, all shares allocated for future matching under the Stock Purchase Plan were transferred, and shares designated to cover social security payments were disposed of as a result of the exercise and the matching, approximately 64 million Class B shares would be transferred, corresponding to 2.0% of the total number of shares outstanding, or 3,269 million not including treasury stock. As of December 31, 2016, 62 million Class B shares were held as treasury stock.

The table above shows how shares (representing matching rights but excluding shares for social security expenses) are being used for all outstanding plans. From up to down the table includes (A) the number of shares originally approved by the Annual General Meeting; (B) the number of originally designated shares that were outstanding at the beginning of 2016; (C) the number of shares awarded during 2016; (D) the number of shares matched during 2016; (E) the number of shares forfeited by participants or expired under the plan rules during 2016; and (F) the balance left as outstanding at the end of 2016, having added new awards to the shares outstanding at the beginning of the year and deducted the shares related to awards matched, forfeited and expired. The final row (G) shows the compensation costs charged to the accounts during 2016 for each plan, calculated as fair value in SEK.

For a description of compensation cost, including accounting treatment, see Note C1, “Significant accounting policies,” section Share-based compensation to employees and the Board of Directors.

 

87


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Employee numbers, wages and salaries

Employee numbers

Average number of employees

 

       2016      2015  
     Women      Men      Total      Women      Men      Total  

North America

     2,862        10,667        13,529        3,117        11,912        15,029  

Latin America

     2,343        8,672        11,015        2,583        9,812        12,395  

Northern Europe & Central Asia 1) 2)

     5,070        14,941        20,011        5,256        15,549        20,805  

Western & Central Europe 2)

     2,502        11,312        13,814        2,399        10,144        12,543  

Mediterranean 2)

     3,035        9,718        12,753        3,122        10,023        13,145  

Middle East

     374        2,775        3,149        513        3,215        3,728  

Sub-Saharan Africa

     369        1,795        2,164        520        1,997        2,517  

India

     4,396        17,983        22,379        3,967        17,865        21,832  

North East Asia

     4,297        9,186        13,483        4,178        9,446        13,624  

South East Asia & Oceania

     1,688        2,431        4,119        1,200        2,900        4,100  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     26,936        89,480        116,416        26,854        92,864        119,718  

 

1)        Of which in Sweden

     3,650        12,359        16,009        4,002        13,106        17,108  

2)         Of which in EU

     10,056        33,852        43,907        10,052        33,908        43,960  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Number of employees by region at year-end

 

       2016      2015  

North America

     11,547        14,548  

Latin America

     9,513        10,412  

Northern Europe & Central Asia 1) 2)

     19,136        20,700  

Western & Central Europe 2)

     13,646        12,220  

Mediterranean 2)

     12,578        12,702  

Middle East

     3,346        3,639  

Sub-Saharan Africa

     2,086        2,301  

India

     22,552        21,999  

North East Asia

     13,042        13,706  

South East Asia & Oceania

     4,018        4,054  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     111,464        116,281  

 

1) Of which in Sweden

     15,303        17,041  

2) Of which in EU

     42,625        43,117  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Number of employees by gender and age at year-end 2016

 

     Women     Men     Percent
of total
 

Under 25 years old

     2,037       2,767       4

25–35 years old

     10,562       32,120       38

36–45 years old

     7,036       27,594       31

46–55 years old

     4,375       17,817       20

Over 55 years old

     1,539       5,617       7
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Percent of total

     23     77     100
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Employee movements

 

              2016      2015  

Headcount at year-end

        111,464        116,281  

Employees who have left the Company

        19,865        16,610  

Employees who have joined the Company

        15,048        14,836  

Temporary employees

        1,148        1,413  

Employee wages and salaries

Wages and salaries and social security expenses

 

(SEK million)

   2016      2015  

Wages and salaries

     60,064        60,805  

Social security expenses

     17,710        19,249  

Of which pension costs

     5,254        5,793  

Amounts related to the President and CEO and the Executive Leadership Team are included in the table above.

Remuneration to Board members and Presidents in subsidiaries

 

(SEK million)

   2016      2015  

Salary and other remuneration

     462        368  

Of which annual variable remuneration

     106        56  

Pension costs

     38        47  

Board members, Presidents and Group management by gender at year end

 

       2016     2015  
     Women     Men     Women     Men  

Parent Company

        

Board members and President

     46     54     36     64

Group Management

     35     65     31     69

Subsidiaries

        

Board members and Presidents

     19     81     13     87

 

88


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

C29    Related party transactions

During 2016, various minor related party transactions were executed pursuant to contracts based on terms customary in the industry and negotiated on an arm’s length basis. For information regarding equity and Ericsson’s share of assets, liabilities and income in joint ventures and associated companies, see Note C12, “Financial assets, non-current. ” For information regarding transactions with the Board of Directors and Group management, see Note C28, “Information regarding members of the Board of Directors, the Group management and employees.”

For information about the Company’s pension trusts, see Note C17, ”Post-employment benefits.”

C30    Fees to Auditors

Fees to auditors

 

     PwC      Others      Total  

2016

        

Audit fees

     90        3        93  

Audit-related fees

     10        —          10  

Tax fees

     10        8        18  

Other fees

     16        11        27  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     126        22        148  

2015

        

Audit fees

     91        2        93  

Audit-related fees

     11        —          11  

Tax fees

     19        13        32  

Other fees

     8        —          8  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     129        15        144  

2014

        

Audit fees

     83        7        90  

Audit-related fees

     11        0        11  

Tax fees

     15        4        19  

Other fees

     18        1        19  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     127        12        139  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

During the period 2014–2016, in addition to audit services, PwC provided certain audit-related services, tax and other services to the Company. The audit-related services include quarterly reviews, ISO audits, SSAE 16 reviews and services in connection with the issuing of certificates and opinions and consultation on financial accounting. The tax services include general expatriate services and corporate tax compliance work. Other services include, work related to acquisitions and operational effectiveness.

Audit fees to other auditors largely consist of local statutory audits.

C31    Contractual obligations

Contractual obligations 2016

 

     Payment due by period         

SEK billion

   <1
year
     1–3
years
     3–5
years
     >5
years
     Total  

Current and Non-current debt 1) 2)

     8.0        1.0        8.8        9.4        27.2  

Finance lease obligations 3)

     —          —          —          —          —    

Operating leases 3)

     3.1        4.7        3.3        5.5        16.6  

Other non-current liabilities

     —          0.2        —          2.4        2.6  

Purchase obligations 4)

     5.3        0.5        1.2        —          7.0  

Trade payables

     25.3        —          —          —          25.3  

Commitments for customer finance 5)

     13.1        —          —          —          13.1  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     54.8        6.4        13.3        17.3        91.8  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) Including interest payments.
2) See also Note C19, “Interest-bearing liabilities.”
3) See also Note C27, “Leasing.”
4) The amounts of purchase obligations are gross, before deduction of any related provisions.
5) See also Note C14, “Trade receivables and customer finance.”

For information about financial guarantees, see Note C24, “Contingent liabilities.”

Except for those transactions described in this report, the Company has not been a party to any material contracts over the past three years other than those entered into during the ordinary course of business.

C32    Events after the reporting period

New segment structure from January 1, 2017

From January 1, 2017, financial reporting is done according to the new structure, i.e., by the new segments Networks, IT & Cloud and Media.

Börje Ekholm takes office as CEO and President

Börje Ekholm takes office as CEO and President. On January 16, 2017, Ericsson announced that in connection with Börje Ekholm assuming the position as President and CEO of Ericsson, Jan Frykhammar, who has temporarily held the position as President and CEO, remains a member of the Executive Leadership Team and is appointed Executive Vice President and advisor to the CEO. Jan Frykhammar will support Börje Ekholm during a transition period and will focus on corporate governance and efficiency.

Magnus Mandersson remains Executive Vice President, advisor to the CEO, focusing on customer relationships, and a member of the Executive Leadership Team. Magnus Mandersson also remains Chairperson of four out of Ericsson’s ten regions.

Carl Mellander remains acting Chief Financial Officer and a member of the Executive Leadership Team.

 

89


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Ericsson issues two bonds of EUR 500 million each, maturing in 2021 and 2024, on February 24, 2017

Ericsson has successfully placed one Euro denominated 500 million four year bond with a fixed coupon rate of 0.875% and one Euro denominated 500 million seven year bond with a fixed coupon rate of 1.875% per year.

The bonds were issued under Ericsson’s Euro Medium Term Note Program (EMTN).

Joint bookrunners were Citi, Credit Agricole CIB and SEB and co-managers were Nordea, Standard Chartered and Swedbank.

The proceeds will be used to refinance debt maturing in 2017 and for general corporate purposes.

Ericsson presented focused business strategy

On March 28, 2017, Ericsson presented a focused business strategy to revitalize technology and market leadership, improve group profitability and enable customer success. The company announced that it will reallocate resources and increase investments in the following core portfolio areas: networks, digital services (OSS, BSS and telecom core) and Internet of Things (IoT).

In addition, the company will implement a refocused strategy for Managed Services to improve profitability and also explore strategic opportunities for the Media and Cloud infrastructure hardware businesses. When announced, the refocused strategy was estimated to have the following financial consequences in the short term: write down of assets to be made in Q1, 2017, with an estimated impact on operating income of SEK 3-4 b, restructuring charges estimated to approximately SEK 6-8 b. for 2017, of which approximately SEK 2 b. in Q1. The actual result reported in Q1 2017 was in line with the estimates: write down of assets were SEK 3.3 b., restructuring charges in Q1 2017 were SEK 1.7 b.

Separately, but in the same announcement, the company announced that it would make provisions of an estimated SEK 7-9 b. in Q1, triggered by recent negative developments related to certain large customer projects. The actual result recognized in Q1 2017 was SEK 8.4 b. and in line with the estimate.

In March, 2017, the Company made a restructuring provision of SEK 0.9 billion related to the reduction of operations in Borås and Kumla in Sweden. This was recognized in the first quarter of 2017.

Ericsson Simplifies Organization and Names Executive Team

In line with the business strategy announced on March 28, 2017, Ericsson has simplified its organizational structure by removing the two-tiered leadership structure, Executive Leadership Team and Global Leadership Team, and forming a single Executive Team. In addition, the geographical setup with ten regions has become five market areas, and the business areas were re-defined and reduced to three. The new Executive Team roles and the new organization took effect April 1, 2017.

The following Business Area and Market Area structure has been applied to Ericsson as of April 1, 2017:

 

   

Business Area Networks; Business Area Digital Services; Business Area Managed Services

 

   

Market Area North America; Market Area Europe & Latin America; Market Area Middle East & Africa; Market Area North East Asia; Market Area South East Asia, Oceania & India

Effective April 1, 2017, Ericsson’s Executive Team members are:

President and CEO – Börje Ekholm

Business Area Networks – Fredrik Jejdling, Senior Vice President, previously head of Business Unit Network Services

Business Area Managed Services – Peter Laurin, Senior Vice President, previously head of Region Northern Europe and Central Asia

Business Area Digital Services – Ulf Ewaldsson, Senior Vice President, previously head of Group Function Strategy & Technology

Market Area North America – Rima Qureshi, Senior Vice President, previously head of Region North America

Market Area Europe & Latin America – Arun Bansal, Senior Vice President, previously head of Business Unit Network Products

Market Area Middle East & Africa – Rafiah Ibrahim, Senior Vice President, previously head of Region Middle East

Market Area North East Asia – Chris Houghton, Senior Vice President, previously head of Region North East Asia

South East Asia, Oceania & India – Nunzio Mirtillo, Senior Vice President, previously head of Region Mediterranean

Technology & Emerging Business – Niklas Heuveldop, Senior Vice President, previously head of Group Function Sales

Finance & Common Functions – Carl Mellander, Senior Vice President, previously acting Head of Group Function Finance & Common Functions

Human Resources – MajBritt Arfert, Senior Vice President, previously acting Head of Group Function Human Resources

Marketing & Communications – Helena Norrman, Senior Vice President, previously in the same role

Sustainability & Corporate Responsibility – Elaine Weidman Grunewald, Senior Vice President, previously in the same role

Legal Affairs – Nina Macpherson, Senior Vice President, previously in the same role

Advisor to the CEO – Jan Frykhammar, Executive Vice President¸ previously in the same role

Advisor to the CEO – Magnus Mandersson, Executive Vice President, previously in the same role

Per Borgklint, Anders Lindblad, Jean-Philippe Poirault and Charlotta Sund left the Executive Leadership Team effective April 1, 2017.

Changes resolved in connection with the Annual General Meeting of shareholders (AGM) held on March 29, 2017

Decisions at the AGM 2017 included:

 

 

Payment of a dividend of SEK 1 per share

 

 

Re-election of Leif Johansson as Chairman of the Board of Directors

 

 

Re-election of other members of the Board of Directors: Nora Denzel, Börje Ekholm, Kristin Skogen Lund, Kristin S. Rinne, Sukhinder Singh Cassidy, Helena Sjernholm and Jacob Wallenberg

 

 

Election of new Board members: Jon Fredrik Baksaas, Jan Carlson and Eric A. Elzvik

 

 

Approval of Board of Directors’ fees:

 

   

Chairman: SEK 4,075,000 (unchanged)

 

   

Other non-employee Board members: SEK 990,000 each (unchanged)

 

   

Chairman of the Audit Committee: SEK 350,000 (unchanged)

 

   

Other non-employee members of the Audit Committee: SEK 250,000 each (unchanged)

 

   

Chairmen of the Finance and Remuneration Committees: SEK 200,000 each (unchanged)

 

   

Other non-employee members of the Finance and Remuneration Committees: SEK 175,000 each (unchanged)

 

   

Chairman of the newly-established Technology and Science Committee: SEK 200,000

 

   

Other non-employee members of the newly-established Technology and Science Committee: SEK 175,000 each

 

 

Approval for part of the Directors’ fees to be paid in the form of synthetic shares

 

 

Approval of Guidelines for remuneration to Group Management

 

 

Implementation of a Long-Term Variable Compensation Program 2017 for the members of the Global Leaderhisp Team, including a share issue of and authorization to the Board to buy back 3,000,000 shares for the program.

 

90


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Information on new Board members

Jon Fredrik Baksaas

Born 1954. Master of Science in Economics, NHH Norwegian School of Economics & Business Administration, Norway.

Board member: Svenska Handelsbanken AB.

Holdings in Ericsson: None.*

Principal work experience and other information: President and CEO of Telenor (2002-2015). Previous positions within the Telenor Group since 1989, including deputy CEO, Chief Financial Officer and CEO of TBK AS. Previous positions include CFO of Aker AS, finance director of Stolt Nielsen Seaway AS and controller at Det Norske Veritas, Norway and Japan. Member of the GSMA Board (2008-2016) and Chairman of the GSMA Board (2014-2016).

Jan Carlson

Born 1960. Master of Science degree in Engineering Physics and Electrical Engineering, the University of Linköping, Sweden.

Board Chairman: Autoliv Inc.

Board member: BorgWarner Inc., Teknikföretagen, The Confederation of Swedish Enterprise and Trelleborg AB.

Holdings in Ericsson: 7,900 Class B Shares.*

Principal work experience and other information: President and CEO of Autoliv Inc. since 2007 and Chairman of Autoliv Inc. since 2014. Previous positions within the Autoliv Group since 1999, including President Autoliv Europe, Vice President Engineering of Autoliv and President Autoliv Electronics. Previous positions include President of Saab Combitech and of Swedish Gate Array.

Eric A. Elzvik

Born 1960. Master of Science in Business Administration, Stockholm School of Economics, Sweden.

Board member: IMD Foundation, Lausanne and the Swiss Swedish Chamber of Commerce, Zurich, Switzerland.

Holdings in Ericsson: 10,000 Class B shares*.

Principal work experience and other information: Chief Financial Officer and member of the Group Executive Committee of ABB Ltd (2013-2017). Division CFO ABB Discrete Automation & Motion (2010-2012) and division CFO Automation Products Division (2006-2010). Previous positions within the ABB Group since 1984, including senior management positions within finance, mergers & acquisitions and new ventures.

 

* The holdings in Ericsson are as of the date of the notice convening the Annual General Meeting and includes holdings by related persons as well as holdings of ADS, if applicable.

The minutes from the AGM 2017 are available on Ericsson’s website.

The employee representatives appointed as of March 29, 2017 are: Kjell-Åke Soting, Roger Svensson and Karin Åberg, with the deputies Torbjörn Nyman, Anders Ripa and Loredana Roslund.

The Nomination Committee’s independence assessment

Before the AGM 2017, The Nomination Committee considered that at least the following Board members were independent in respect of all applicable independence requirements:

a. Jon Fredrik Baksaas

b. Jan Carlson

c. Nora Denzel

d. Eric A. Elzvik

e. Leif Johansson

f. Kristin Skogen Lund

g. Kristin S. Rinne

h. Sukhinder Singh Cassidy

New Board Committee on Technology and Science and new Committee members

At the statutory Board meeting held in connection with the Annual General Meeting 2017, the Board resolved to establish a new Board Committee on Technology and Science and the following Board members were appointed members of the new Committee: Kristin S. Rinne (Chairman), Jan Carlson, Nora Denzel and Roger Svensson (employee representative).

The tasks of the Committee include monitoring and preparing for consideration and/or resolution of the Board various matters relating to technology strategy and direction, technical matters, technology ecosystem and science direction.

The Board members appointed to the other Board Committees as of March 29, 2017 are:

Audit Committee: Eric A. Elzvik (Chairman), Nora Denzel, Kristin Skogen Lund and Karin Åberg (employee representative) Finance Committee: Leif Johansson (Chairman), Helena Stjernholm, Jacob Wallenberg and Roger Svensson (employee representative) Remuneration Committee: Leif Johansson (Chairman), Jon Fredrik Baksaas, Sukhinder Singh Cassidy and Kjell Åke Soting (employee representative)

 

91


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

MANAGEMENT’S REPORT ON INTERNAL CONTROL OVER FINANCIAL REPORTING

Internal control over financial reporting

Ericsson’s management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting for the Company. Ericsson’s internal control system related to financial reporting is designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) and includes those policies and procedures that:

 

   

pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the Company;

 

   

provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS), and that receipts and expenditures of the Company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the Company; and

 

   

provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of the Company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Although the purpose of internal control systems is to ensure adequate risk management all internal control systems, no matter how well designed, have inherent limitations which may result in that misstatements are not prevented or detected. Therefore, even systems determined to be effective can provide only reasonable assurance with respect to the reliability of financial statement preparation and presentation.

Ericsson’s management assessed the effectiveness of Ericsson’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31,2016. In making this assessment, management used the criteria set forth in “Internal Control—Integrated Framework (2013)”, issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission.

Based on this assessment, management has concluded that, as of December 31, 2016, Ericsson’s internal control over financial reporting was effective at a reasonable assurance level.

Attestation report of registered public accounting firm

The effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2016, has been audited by PricewaterhouseCoopers AB, an independent registered public accounting firm. PricewaterhouseCoopers AB has issued an attestation report on Ericsson’s internal control over financial reporting, which appears on page 43.

Changes in internal control over financial reporting

During the period covered by the Annual Report 2016, there were no changes to the internal control over financial reporting that have materially affected, or are likely to materially affect, the internal control over financial reporting.

 

92


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

RISK FACTORS

You should carefully consider all the information in this Annual Report and in particular the risks and uncertainties outlined below. Based on the information currently known to us, we believe that the following information identifies the most significant risk factors affecting our business. Any of the factors described below, or any other risk factors discussed elsewhere in this report, could have a material negative effect on our business, revenues, operating and after-tax results, profit margins, financial condition, cash flow, liquidity, credit rating, market share, reputation, brand and/or our share price. Additional risks and uncertainties not presently known to us or that we currently believe to be immaterial may also materially adversely affect our business. Furthermore, our operating results may have a greater variability than in the past and we may have difficulties in accurately predicting future developments. See also “Forward-Looking Statements.”

Market, Technology and Business Risks

Challenging global economic conditions and political unrest and uncertainty as well as geopolitical risks may adversely impact the demand and pricing for our products and services as well as limit our ability to grow.

Challenging global economic conditions and political unrest and uncertainty as well as geopolitical risk could have adverse, wide-ranging effects on demand for our products and for the products of our customers. Adverse global economic conditions and political unrest and uncertainty as well as geopolitical risk could cause operators and other customers to postpone investments or initiate other cost-cutting initiatives to improve their financial position. This could result in significantly reduced expenditures for our products and services, including network infrastructure, in which case our operating results would suffer. If demand for our products and services were to fall in the future, we could experience material adverse effects on our revenues, cash flow, capital employed and value of our assets and we could incur operating losses. Furthermore, if demand is significantly weaker or more volatile than expected, our credit rating, borrowing opportunities and costs as well as the trading price of our shares could be adversely impacted. Should global economic conditions fail to improve or worsen or should political unrest and uncertainty or geopolitical problems fail to, improve, or worsen, other business risks we face could intensify and could also negatively impact the business prospects of operators and other customers. Some operators and other customers, in particular in markets with weak currencies, may incur borrowing difficulties and slower traffic development, which may negatively affect their investment plans and cause them to purchase less of our products and services. The potential adverse effects of an economic downturn include:

 

   

Reduced demand for products and services, resulting in increased price competition or deferrals of purchases, with lower revenues not fully compensated through reduced costs

 

   

Risks of excess and obsolete inventories and excess manufacturing capacity

 

   

Risk of financial difficulties or failures among our suppliers

 

   

Increased demand for customer finance, difficulties in collection of accounts receivable and increased risk of counter party failures

 

   

Risk of further impairment losses related to our intangible assets as a result of lower forecasted sales of certain products

 

   

Increased difficulties in forecasting sales and financial results as well as increased volatility in our reported results

 

   

Changes in the value in our pension plan assets resulting from for example, adverse equity and credit market developments and/or increased pension liabilities resulting from, for example, lower discount rates. Such development may trigger additional pension trust capitalization needs affecting the company’s cash balance negatively

 

   

End user demand could also be adversely affected by reduced consumer spending on technology, changed operator pricing, security breaches and trust issues.

 

   

On June 23, 2016, the UK held a referendum in which voters approved an exit from the European Union, commonly referred to as “Brexit”. As a result of the referendum it is expected that the British government will begin negotiating the terms of the UK’s withdrawal from the European Union. The long-term effects of Brexit will depend on any agreements the UK makes to retain access to European markets either during a transitional period or permanently as well as on the agreements the UK makes with other trading partners. Any of the potential effects of Brexit could have unpredictable consequences for credit markets and adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial performance.

 

   

The recent change in political leadership in the U.S. has led to uncertainty about the U.S.’ position in a number of areas such as foreign policy, international trade, customs and taxation, which could adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial performance.

 

93


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

We may not be successful in implementing our strategy or in achieving improvements in our earnings or in estimating addressable markets or market CAGR in the markets where we operate.

There can be no assurance that we will be able to successfully implement our strategy to achieve future earnings, growth or create shareholder value. When deemed necessary, we undertake specific restructuring or cost-saving initiatives; however, there are no guarantees that such initiatives will be sufficient, successful or executed in time to deliver any improvements in our earnings. Furthermore, this annual report includes certain estimates with respect to addressable markets as well as with respect to CAGR in the markets in which we operate, including the Networks, IT & Cloud, Media, and Industry and Society business. If the underlying assumptions on which our estimates are based prove not to be accurate, the actual addressable markets and CAGR may be materially different from the estimates presented in this annual report.

The telecommunications industry fluctuates and is affected by many factors, including the economic environment, and decisions made by operators and other customers regarding their deployment of technology and their timing of purchases.

The telecommunications industry has experienced downturns in the past in which operators substantially reduced their capital spending on new equipment. While we expect the network service provider equipment market, telecommunications services market and ICT market to grow in the coming years, the uncertainty surrounding the global economic recovery and the geopolitical situation may materially harm actual market conditions. Moreover, market conditions are subject to substantial fluctuation, and could vary geographically and across technologies. Even if global conditions improve, conditions in the specific industry segments in which we participate may be weaker than in other segments. In that case, our revenue and operating results may be adversely affected.

If capital expenditures by operators and other customers are weaker than we anticipate, our revenues, operating results and profitability may be adversely affected. The level of demand from operators and other customers who buy our products and services can change quickly and can vary over short periods of time, including from month to month. Due to the uncertainty and variations in the telecommunication industry, as well as in the ICT industry, accurately forecasting revenues, results, and cash flow remains difficult.

Sales volumes and gross margin levels are affected by the mix and order time of our products and services.

Our sales to operators and other customers represent a mix of equipment, software and services, which normally generate different gross margins. We sell our own products as well as third-party products, which normally have lower margins than our own products. As a consequence, our reported gross margin in a specific period will be affected by the overall mix of products and services as well as the relative content of third-party products. In the areas IT & Cloud, Media and Industry and Society, third-party products and services represent a larger portion of our business than our traditional sales, which challenge our business models including our terms and conditions. Further, network expansions and upgrades have much shorter lead times for delivery than initial network build outs. Orders for such network expansions and upgrades are normally placed at short notice by customers, often less than a month in advance, and consequently variations in demand are difficult to forecast. As a result, changes in our product and service mix and the short order time for certain of our products may affect our ability to accurately forecast sales and margins or detect in advance whether actual results will deviate from market consensus. Short-term variation could have a material adverse effect on our business, operating results, financial condition and cash flow.

We may not be able to properly respond to market trends in the industries in which we operate, including the convergence of IT and telecom.

We are affected by market conditions and trends within the industries in which we operate, including the convergence of the IT and telecom industries. Technological developments largely drive convergences enabling digitalization and a move from dedicated hardware to software and cloud based services. This is changing the competitive landscape as well as value chains and business models and affects our objective-setting, risk assessment and strategies. The change lowers entry barriers to the market and competitors new to our business have entered and may continue to enter the market and negatively impact our market share in selected areas. If we fail to understand the market development, or fail to acquire the necessary competencies to develop and sell products, services and solutions that are competitive in this changing business environment, our business, operating results and financial condition will suffer.

Our business depends upon the continued growth of mobile communications and the success of our existing customer base, the telecom operators. If growth slows or if our customers do not manage to maintain or grow relevance in the emerging digital value chain or if our products and/or services are not successful , our customers’ investment in networks may slow or stop, harming our business and operating results.

A substantial portion of our business depends on the continued growth of mobile communications in terms of both the number of subscriptions and usage per subscriber, which in turn drives the continued deployment and expansion of network systems by our customers. If operators fail to increase the number of subscribers and/or usage does not increase, our business and operating results could be materially adversely affected. Also, if operators fail to monetize services, fail to adapt their business models or experience a decline in operator revenues or profitability, their willingness to further invest in their networks may decrease which will reduce their demand for our products and services and have an adverse effect on our business, operating results, and financial condition.

Traffic development on cellular network could be affected if more traffic is offloaded to WI-FI-networks. Further alternative services provided over the internet have profound effects on operator voice/SMS revenues with possible reduced capital expenses consequences. Our value system is depending on the development and success of global standards. This could be affected adversely in the future by industry forces more interested in de-facto standards and or geo-political forces leading to standards fragmentation and increased difficulties of creating economies of scale.

Fixed and mobile networks converge and new technologies, such as IP and broadband, enable operators to deliver services in both fixed and mobile networks. We are dependent of the uptake of such services and the outcome of regulatory and standardization activities such as spectrum allocation. If delays in uptake, standardization or regulation occur, this could adversely affect our business, operating results, and financial condition.

 

94


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

We face intense competition from our existing competitors as well as new entrants, including IT companies entering the telecommunications market, and this could materially adversely affect our results.

The markets in which we operate are highly competitive in terms of price, functionality, service quality, customization, timing of development, and the introduction of new products and services. We face intense competition from significant competitors, many of which are very large, with substantial technological and financial resources and established relationships with operators. We also encounter increased competition from new market entrants and alternative technologies are evolving industry standards. In particular, we face competition from large IT companies and web scale companies entering the telecommunications market who benefit from economies of scale due to being active in several industries. We cannot assure that we will be able to compete successfully with these companies. Our competitors may implement new technologies before we do, offer more attractively priced or enhanced products, services or solutions, or they may offer other incentives that we do not provide. Some of our competitors may also have greater resources in certain business segments or geographic markets than we do. Increased competition could result in reduced profit margins, loss of market share, increased research and development costs as well as increased sales and marketing expenses, which could have a material adverse effect on our business, operating results, financial condition and market share.

Additionally, we operate in markets characterized by rapidly changing technology and also the nature in which this technology is being brought to market is rapidly changing e.g. through open-source projects. This results in continuous price erosion and increased price competition for our products and services. If our counter measures, including enhanced products and business models or cost reductions cannot be achieved or do not occur in a timely manner, there could be adverse impacts on our business, operating results, financial condition and market share.

Vendor consolidation may lead to stronger competitors who are able to benefit from integration, scale and greater resources.

Industry convergence and consolidation among equipment and services suppliers could potentially result in stronger competitors that are competing as end-to-end suppliers as well as competitors more specialized in particular areas, which could for example impact our areas such as IT & Cloud, Media and Industry and Society. Consolidation may also result in competitors with greater resources than we have or in reduction of our current scale advantages. This could have a materially adverse effect on our business, operating results, financial condition and market share.

A significant portion of our revenue is currently generated from a limited number of key customers, and operator consolidation may increase our dependence on key customers. We also are significantly dependent on the sales of certain of our products and services both in core business and targeted areas.

We derive most of our business from large, multi-year agreements with a limited number of significant customers. Many of these agreements are opened up on a yearly basis to renegotiate the price for our products and services and do not contain committed purchase volumes. Although no single customer represented more than 7% of our sales in 2016, our ten largest customers accounted for 46% of our sales in 2016. A loss of or a reduced role with a key customer could have a significant adverse impact on sales, profit and market share for an extended period. In addition, our dependence on the sales of certain of our products and services in both core business and targeted areas may have significant adverse impact on sales, profit and market share.

In recent years, network operators have undergone significant consolidation, resulting in fewer operators with activities in several countries. This trend is expected to continue, and intra-country consolidation is likely to accelerate as a result of competitive pressure. A market with fewer and larger operators will increase our reliance on key customers and may negatively impact our bargaining position and profit margins. Moreover, if the combined companies operate in the same geographic market, networks may be shared and less network equipment and fewer associated services may be required. Network investments could be delayed by the consolidation process, which may include, among others, actions relating to merger or acquisition agreements, securing necessary regulatory approvals, or integration of businesses. Network operators also share parts of their network infrastructure through cooperation agreements rather than legal consolidations, which may adversely affect demand for network equipment. Accordingly, operator consolidation may have a material adverse effect on our business, operating results, market share and financial condition.

Certain long-term agreements with customers still include commitments to future price reductions, requiring us to constantly manage and control our cost base.

Long-term agreements with our customers are typically awarded on a competitive bidding basis. In some cases, such agreements also include a commitment to future price reductions. In order to maintain our gross margin with such price reductions, we continuously strive to reduce the costs of our products through design improvements, negotiation of better purchase prices from our suppliers, allocation of more production to low-cost countries and increased productivity in our own production. However, there can be no assurance that our actions to reduce costs will be sufficient or quick enough to maintain our gross margin in such contracts, which may have a material adverse effect on our business, operating results and financial condition.

Growth of our managed services business is difficult to predict, and requires taking significant contractual risks.

Operators increasingly outsource parts of their operations to reduce cost and focus on new services. To address this opportunity, we offer operators various services in which we manage their networks. The growth rate in the managed services market is difficult to forecast and each new contract carries a risk that transformation and integration of the operations will not be as fast or smooth as planned. Additionally, early contract margins are generally low and the mix of new and old contracts may negatively affect reported results in a given period. Contracts for such services normally cover several years and generate recurring revenues. However, such contracts have been, and may in the future be, terminated or reduced in scope, which has negative impacts on sales and earnings. While we believe we have a strong position in the managed services market, competition in this area is increasing, which may have adverse effects on our future growth, business, operating results and profitability.

 

95


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

We depend upon the development of new products and enhancements to our existing products, and the success of our substantial research and development investments is uncertain.

Rapid technological and market changes in our industry require us to make significant investments in technological innovation. We invest significantly in new technology, products and solutions. In order for us to be successful, those technologies, products and solutions must be accepted by relevant standardization bodies and by the industry as a whole. The failure of our research and development efforts to be technically or commercially successful could have adverse effects on our business, operating results and financial condition. If we invest in the development of technologies, products and solutions that do not function as expected, are not adopted by the industry, are not ready in time, or are not successful in the marketplace, our sales and earnings may materially suffer. Additionally, it is common for research and development projects to encounter delays due to unforeseen problems. Delays in production and research and development may increase the cost of research and development efforts and put us at a disadvantage against our competition. This could have a material adverse effect upon our business, operating results and financial condition.

We engage in acquisitions and divestments which may be disruptive and require us to incur significant expenses.

In addition to in-house innovation efforts, we make strategic acquisitions in order to obtain various benefits such as reduced time-to-market, access to technology and competence, increased scale or to broaden our product portfolio or customer base. Future acquisitions could result in the incurrence of contingent liabilities and an increase in amortization expenses related to goodwill and other intangible assets, which could have a material adverse effect upon our business, operating results, financial condition and liquidity. Risks we could face with respect to acquisitions include:

 

   

Difficulties in the integration of the operations, technologies, products and personnel of the acquired company

 

   

Risks of entering markets in which we have no or limited prior experience

 

   

Potential loss of employees

 

   

Diversion of management’s attention away from other business concerns

 

   

Expenses of any undisclosed or potential legal liabilities of the acquired company

 

   

Difficulties in identifying attractive available targets.

From time to time we also divest parts of our business to optimize our product portfolio or operations. Any decision to dispose of or otherwise exit businesses may result in the recording of special charges, such as workforce reduction costs and industry- and technology-related write-offs. We cannot assure that we will be successful in consummating future acquisitions or divestments on favorable terms or at all. The risks associated with such acquisitions and divestments could have a material adverse effect upon our business, operating results, financial condition and liquidity.

We are in, and may enter into new, JV arrangements and have, and may have new, partnerships, which may not be successful and expose us to future costs.

Our JV and partnership arrangements, including for example our partnership with Cisco, may fail to perform as expected for various reasons, including an incorrect assessment of our needs and synergies, our inability to take action without the approval of our partners, our difficulties in implementing our business plans, the lack of capabilities or financial instability of our strategic partners. Our ability to work with these partners or develop new products and solutions may become constrained, which could harm our competitive position in the market.

Additionally, our share of any losses from or commitments to contribute additional capital to such JVs and partnerships may adversely affect our business, operating results, financial condition and cash flow.

We rely on a limited number of suppliers of components, production capacity and R&D and IT services, which exposes us to supply disruptions and cost increases.

Our ability to deliver according to market demands and contractual commitments depends significantly on obtaining a timely and adequate supply of materials, components, production capacity and other vital services on competitive terms. Although we strive to avoid single-source supplier solutions, this is not always possible. Accordingly, there is a risk that we will be unable to obtain key supplies we need to produce our products and provide our services on commercially reasonable terms, or at all. Failure by any of our suppliers could interrupt our product or services supply or operations and significantly limit sales or increase our costs. To find an alternative supplier or redesign products to replace components may take significant time which could cause significant delays or interruptions in the delivery of our products and services. We have from time to time experienced interruptions of supply and we may experience such interruptions in the future. Furthermore, our procurement of supplies requires us to predict future customer demands. If we fail to anticipate customer demand properly, an over or under supply of components and production capacity could occur. In many cases, some of our competitors utilize the same manufacturers and if they have purchased capacity ahead of us we could be blocked from acquiring the needed products. This factor could limit our ability to supply our customers and increase costs. At the same time, we commit to certain capacity levels or component quantities, which, if unused, will result in charges for unused capacity or scrapping costs. We are also exposed to financial counterpart risks to suppliers when we pay in advance for supplies. Such supply disruptions and cost increases may negatively affect our business, operating results and financial condition.

Product or service quality issues could lead to reduced revenue and gross margins and declining sales to existing and new customers.

Sales contracts normally include warranty undertakings for faulty products and often include provisions regarding penalties and/or termination rights in the event of a failure to deliver ordered products or services on time or with required quality. Although we undertake a number of quality assurance measures to reduce such risks, product quality or service performance issues may negatively affect our reputation, business, operating results and financial condition. If significant warranty obligations arise due to reliability or quality issues, our operating results and financial position could be negatively impacted by costs associated with fixing software or hardware defects, high service and warranty expenses, high inventory obsolescence expense, delays in collecting accounts receivable or declining sales to existing and new customers.

 

96


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Due to having a significant portion of our costs in SEK and revenues in other currencies, our business is exposed to foreign exchange fluctuations that could negatively impact our revenues and operating results.

We incur a significant portion of our expenses in SEK. As a result of our international operations, we generate, and expect to continue to generate, a significant portion of our revenue in currencies other than SEK. To the extent we are unable to match revenue received in foreign currencies with costs paid in the same currency, exchange rate fluctuations could have a negative impact on our consolidated income statement, balance sheet and cash flows when foreign currencies are exchanged or translated to SEK, which increases volatility in reported results.

As market prices are predominantly established in US dollars or Euros, we presently have a net revenue exposure in foreign currencies which means that a stronger SEK exchange rate would generally have a negative effect on our reported results. Our attempts to reduce the effects of exchange rate fluctuations through a variety of hedging activities may not be sufficient or successful, resulting in an adverse impact on our results and financial condition.

Our ability to benefit from intellectual property rights (IPR), which are critical to our business, may be limited by changes in regulation relating to patents, inability to prevent infringement, the loss of licenses to or from third-parties, infringement claims brought against us by competitors and others and changes in the area of open standards, especially in light of recent attention on licensing of open standard essential patents.

Although we have a large number of patents, there can be no assurance that they will not be challenged, invalidated, or circumvented, or that any rights granted in relation to our patents will in fact provide us with competitive advantages.

We utilize a combination of trade secrets, confidentiality policies, nondisclosure and other contractual arrangements in addition to relying on patent, copyright and trademark laws to protect our intellectual property rights. However, these measures may not be adequate to prevent or deter infringement or other misappropriation. In addition, we rely on many software patents, and limitations on the patentability of software may materially affect our business.

Moreover, we may not be able to detect unauthorized use or take appropriate and timely steps to establish and enforce our proprietary rights. In fact, existing legal systems of some countries in which we conduct business offer only limited protection of intellectual property rights, if at all. Our solutions may also require us to license technologies from third-parties. It may be necessary in the future to seek or renew licenses and there can be no assurance that they will be available on acceptable terms, or at all. Moreover, the inclusion in our products of software or other intellectual property licensed from third-parties on a non-exclusive basis could limit our ability to protect proprietary rights in our products.

Many key aspects of telecommunications and data network technology are governed by industry-wide standards usable by all market participants. As the number of market entrants and the complexity of technology increases, the possibility of functional overlap and inadvertent infringement of intellectual property rights also increases. In addition to industry-wide standards, other key industry-wide software solutions are today developed by market participants as free and open source software. Contributing to the development and distribution of software developed as free and open source software may limit our ability to enforce applicable patents in the future. Third-parties have asserted, and may assert in the future, claims, directly against us or against our customers, alleging infringement of their intellectual property rights. Defending such claims may be expensive, time-consuming and divert the efforts of our management and/or technical personnel. As a result of litigation, we could be required to pay damages and other compensation directly or to indemnify our customers for such damages and other compensation, develop non-infringing products/technology or enter into royalty or licensing agreements. However, we cannot be certain that such licenses will be available to us on commercially reasonable terms or at all, and such judgments could have a material adverse effect on our business, reputation, operating results and financial condition. Using free and open source software may allow third-parties to further investigate our software due to the accessibility of source code. This may in turn make this software more prone to assertions from third-parties.

Recent attention on licensing of patents necessary to conduct an open standard (e.g. 2G, 3G and 4G technology), investigations held by antitrust authorities, court judgments and legislative change could potentially affect Ericsson’s ability to benefit from its patent portfolio in the area of such open standards, which could have a material adverse effect on our business, reputation, operating results and financial condition. Ericsson holds a leading patent portfolio in open standards and possible changes regarding such a portfolio may materially affect our reputation, business, operating results and financial condition.

We are involved in lawsuits and investigations which, if determined against us, could require us to pay substantial damages, fines and/or penalties.

In the normal course of our business we are involved in legal proceedings. These lawsuits include such matters as commercial disputes, claims regarding intellectual property, antitrust, tax and labor disputes. Litigation can be expensive, lengthy and disruptive to normal business operations. Moreover, the results of complex legal proceedings are difficult to predict. An unfavorable resolution of a particular lawsuit could have a material adverse effect on our business, operating results, financial condition and reputation.

As a publicly listed company, Ericsson may be exposed to lawsuits in which plaintiffs allege that the Company or its officers have failed to comply with securities laws, stock market regulations or other laws, regulations or requirements. Whether or not there is merit to such claims, the time and costs incurred to defend the Company and its officers and the potential settlement or compensation to the plaintiffs could have significant impact on our reported results and reputation. For additional information regarding certain of the lawsuits in which we are involved, see “Legal Proceedings” in the Board of Directors’ Report.

Our operations are complex and several critical operations are centralized in a single location. Any disruption of our operations, whether due to natural or man-made events, may be highly damaging to the operation of our business.

Our business operations rely on complex operations and communications networks, which are vulnerable to damage or disturbance from a variety of sources. Having outsourced significant portions of our operations, such as IT, finance and HR operations, we depend on the performance of external companies, including their security and reliability measures. Regardless of protection measures, systems and communications networks are susceptible to disruption due to failure, vandalism, computer viruses, security or privacy breaches, natural disasters, power outages and other events. We also have a concentration of operations on

 

97


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

certain sites, including R&D, production, network operation centers, ICT centers and logistic centers and shared services centers, where business interruptions could cause material damage and costs. The delivery of goods from suppliers, and to customers, could also be hampered for the reasons stated above. Interruptions to our systems and communications may have an adverse effect on our operations and financial condition.

Cyber security incidents may have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, reputation and brand.

Ericsson’s business operations involve areas that are particularly vulnerable to cyber security incidents that may impact confidentiality, availability or integrity of products, services, or solutions. These incidents may include data breaches, intrusions, espionage, know-how and data privacy infringements, leakage, unauthorized or accidental modification of data and general malfeasance. Examples of these areas include, among others, research and development, managed services, usage of cloud solutions, software development, lawful interception, product engineering, IT, finance and HR operations. Any cyber security incident including unintended use, involving our operations, product development, services, our third-party providers or installed product base, could cause severe harm to Ericsson and could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, reputation and brand.

Ericsson relies heavily on third-parties to whom we have outsourced significant aspects of our IT infrastructure, product development, engineering services, finance and HR operations. While we have taken precautions relating to the selection, integration and ongoing management of these third-parties, any event or incident that is caused as a result of vulnerabilities in their operations or products supplied to us could have a material adverse effect upon Ericsson, our business, financial condition, reputation and brand, potentially slowing operations, leaking valuable intellectual property or sensitive information or damaging our products which have been installed in our customers’ networks.

We must continue to attract and retain highly qualified employees to remain competitive.

We believe that our future success largely depends on our continued ability to hire, develop, motivate and retain engineers and other qualified personnel needed to develop successful new products, support our existing product range and provide services to our customers.

Competition for skilled personnel and highly qualified managers in the industries in which we operate remains intense. We are continuously developing our corporate culture, remuneration, promotion and benefits policies as well as other measures aimed at empowering our employees and reducing employee turnover. However, there are no guarantees that we will be successful in attracting and retaining employees with appropriate skills in the future, and failure in retention and recruiting could have a material adverse effect on our business and brand. Recent initiatives to drive cost reduction could adversely impact our ability to attract and retain talent.

If our customers’ financial conditions decline, we will be exposed to increased credit and commercial risks.

After completing sales to customers, we may encounter difficulty collecting accounts receivables and could be exposed to risks associated with uncollectable accounts receivable. We regularly assess the credit worthiness of our customers and based on that assessment we determine a credit limit for each one of them. Challenging economic conditions have impacted some of our customers’ ability to pay their invoices. Although we have policies and procedures for managing customer finance credit risk, we may be unable to avoid future losses on our trade receivables. We have also experienced demands for customer financing, and in adverse financial markets or more competitive environments, those demands may increase. Upon the financial failure of a customer, we may experience losses on credit extended and loans made to such customer, losses relating to our commercial risk exposure, and the loss of the customer’s ongoing business. If customers fail to meet their obligations to us, we may experience reduced cash flows and losses in excess of reserves, which could materially adversely impact our operating results and financial condition.

We rely on various sources for short-term and long-term capital for the funding of our business. Should such capital become unavailable or available in insufficient amounts or unreasonable terms, our business, financial condition and cash flow may materially suffer.

Our business requires a significant amount of cash. If we do not generate sufficient amounts of capital to support our operations, service our debt and continue our research and development and customer finance programs, or if we cannot raise sufficient amounts of capital at the required times and on reasonable terms, our business, financial condition and cash flow are likely to be adversely affected. Access to funding may decrease or become more expensive as a result of our operational and financial condition, market conditions, including financial conditions in the Eurozone, or due to deterioration in our credit rating. There can be no assurance that additional sources of funds that we may need from time to time will be available on reasonable terms or at all. If we cannot access capital on a commercially viable basis, our business, financial condition and cash flow could materially suffer.

Impairment of goodwill or other intangible assets may negatively impact our financial condition and results of operations.

An impairment of goodwill or other intangible assets could adversely affect our financial condition or results of operations. We have a significant amount of goodwill and other intangible assets; for example, patents, customer relations, trademarks and software.

Goodwill is the only intangible asset the Company has recognized to have indefinite useful life. Other intangible assets are mainly amortized on a straight-line basis over their estimated useful lives, but for no more than ten years, and are reviewed for impairment whenever events such as product discontinuances, product dispositions or other changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount may not be fully recoverable. Those not yet in use are tested for impairment annually.

Historically, we have recognized impairment charges related to intangible assets for example due to change and strategy and restructuring. Additional impairment charges may be incurred in the future that could be significant due to various reasons, including restructuring actions or adverse market conditions that are either specific to us or the broader industry or more general in nature and that could have an adverse effect on our operating results and financial condition.

Negative deviations in actual cash flows compared to estimated cash flows as well as new estimates that indicate lower future cash flows might result in recognition of impairment charges. Estimates require management judgment as well as the definition of cash-generating units for impairment testing purposes. Other judgments might result in significantly different results and may differ from the actual financial condition in the future.

 

98


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Regulatory, Compliance and Corporate Governance Risks

Ericsson may fail or be unable to comply with laws or regulations and could experience penalties and adverse rulings in enforcement or other proceedings. Compliance with changed laws or regulations may subject Ericsson to increased costs or reduced products and services demand. Compliance failure as well as required operational changes could have a material adverse impact on our business, financial condition and brand.

The industries in which we operate are subject to laws and regulations. While Ericsson strives for compliance, we cannot assure that violations do not occur. If we fail to or are unable to comply with applicable laws and regulations, we could experience penalties and adverse rulings in enforcement or other proceedings, which could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and reputation.

Further changes in laws or regulations could subject us to liability, increased costs, or reduced products and services demand and have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and brand.

Changes to regulations may adversely affect both our customers’ and our own operations. For example, regulations imposing more stringent, time-consuming or costly planning and zoning requirements or building approvals for radio base stations and other network infrastructure could adversely affect the timing and costs of network construction or expansion, and ultimately the commercial launch and success of these networks. Similarly, tariff and roaming regulations or rules on network neutrality could also affect operators’ ability or willingness to invest in network infrastructure, which in turn could affect the sales of our systems and services. Additionally, delay in radio frequency spectrum allocation, and allocation between different types of usage may adversely affect operator spending or force us to develop new products to be able to compete.

Further, we develop many of our products and services based on existing regulations and technical standards. Changes to existing regulations and technical standards, or the implementation of new regulations and technical standards relating to products and services not previously regulated, could adversely affect our development efforts by increasing compliance costs and causing delay. Demand for those products and services could also decline. Regulatory changes in license fees, environmental, health and safety, privacy (including the cross-border transfer of personal data for example between the EU and the US), and other regulatory areas may increase costs and restrict our operations or the operations of network operators and service providers. Also indirect impacts of such changes and regulatory changes in other fields, such as pricing regulations, could have an adverse impact on our business even though the specific regulations may not apply directly to our products or us.

Our substantial international operations are subject to uncertainties which could affect our operating results.

We conduct business throughout the world and are subject to the effects of general global economic conditions as well as conditions unique to specific countries or regions. We have customers in more than 180 countries, with a significant proportion of our sales to emerging markets in the Asia Pacific region, Latin America, Eastern Europe, the Middle East and Africa.

Our extensive operations are subject to additional risks, including civil disturbances, acts of terrorism, economic and geopolitical instability and conflict, potential misuse of technology leading to human rights violations, pandemics, the imposition of exchange controls, economies which are subject to significant fluctuations, nationalization of private assets or other governmental actions affecting the flow of goods and currency, effects from changing climate and difficulty of enforcing agreements and collecting receivables through local legal systems. Further, in certain markets in which we operate, there is a risk of protectionist governmental measures implemented to assist domestic market participants at the expense of foreign competitors. The implementation of such measures could adversely affect our sales or our ability to purchase critical components.

We must always comply with relevant export control regulations and sanctions or other trade embargoes in force in all parts of the business process. The political situation in parts of the world, particularly in the Middle East, remains uncertain and the level of sanctions is still high. A universal element of these sanctions are the financial restrictions with respect to individuals and/or legal entities, but sanctions can also restrict certain exports and ultimately lead to a complete trade embargo towards a country. Specifically, on Iran, the Joint Comprehensive Plan of Action (“JCPOA”) agreement between Iran and other countries have relaxed many of the nuclear related sanctions towards Iran, particularly the EU sanctions. Although many sanctions against Iran have already been relaxed, there are provisions to re-introduce sanctions if parts of the agreement are not met. The change in political leadership in the U.S. has also led to uncertainty about their position in foreign policy, including sanctions towards Iran and other sanctioned countries. Further there is a risk in many countries of unexpected changes in regulatory requirements, tariffs and other trade barriers, price or exchange controls, or other governmental policies which could limit our operations and decrease our profitability. Further export control regulations, sanctions or other forms of trade restrictions put upon countries in which we are active may result in a reduction of commitment in those countries. The need to terminate activities as a result of further trade restrictions may also expose us to customer claims and other actions. Although we seek to comply with all such regulations, there can be no assurance that we are or will be compliant with all relevant regulations at all times. Such potential violations could have material adverse effects on our business, operating results, reputation and brand.

 

99


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

The business operations are complex involving the development, production and delivery of telecom solutions to customers in a very large number of jurisdictions. Each jurisdiction has its own tax legislation and regulations and we therefore face the challenge of complying with the relevant rules in each of these countries. These rules involve income taxes and indirect taxes such as VAT and sales taxes as well as withholding taxes on domestic and cross border payments and social security charges related to our employees. Constant changes of the rules and the interpretation of the legislation also create exposures regarding taxes. This results in complex tax issues and tax disputes that may lead to additional tax payment obligations. Being a global operation, we also face risk of being taxed for the same income in more than one jurisdiction (double taxation). This could have adverse effects on our operating results, reputation and brand.

In certain regional markets, there are trade barriers that limit competition. Should these trade barriers be removed or lowered, competition may increase, which could have material adverse effects on our business and operating results.

There has been a concern reported by some media and others, that certain countries may use features of their telecommunications systems in ways that could result in potential violation of human rights. This may adversely affect the telecommunications business and may have a negative impact for people, our reputation and brand.

We may fail to comply with our corporate governance standards, which could negatively affect our business, operating results, financial condition, reputation and brand.

We are subject to corporate governance laws and regulations as well as several corporate responsibility and sustainability requirements. In some of the countries where we operate, corruption risks are high, therefore there is a higher focus on anticorruption, for example with changed legislation in many countries. To ensure that our operations are conducted in accordance with applicable laws and requirements, our management system includes a Code of Business Ethics, a Code of Conduct and a Sustainability Policy, as well as other policies and directives to govern our processes and operations. Our commitment to apply the UN Global Compact ten principles, the UN Guiding Principles on Business and Human Rights and principles of the World Economic Forum’s Partnering Against Corruption Initiative to our operations cannot fully prevent unintended or unlawful use of our technology by democratic and non-democratic regimes, violation of our Code of Business Ethics, corruption or violations of our Code of Conduct in the supply chain. There is also an increased demand from external stakeholders, for example non-governmental organizations and investors, on transparency about sustainability and corporate responsibility issues that might be difficult to fulfill. Ericsson is voluntarily cooperating with inquiries from the United States Securities and Exchange Commission and the United States Department of Justice regarding its compliance with the U.S. Foreign Corrupt Practices Act. These inquiries concern the last ten years. While Ericsson is fully cooperating with the U.S. authorities to answer these and additional questions, the outcome of these questions is currently not determinable. While we attempt to monitor and audit internally and externally our compliance with the policies and directives as well as our suppliers’ adherence to our Code of Conduct and strive for continuous improvements, we cannot provide any assurances that violations will not occur which could have material adverse effects on our business, operating results, financial condition, reputation, and brand.

Failure to comply with environmental, health and safety regulations in many jurisdictions may expose us to significant penalties and other sanctions.

We are subject to certain environmental, health and safety laws and regulations that affect our operations, facilities, products and services in each of the jurisdictions in which we operate. While we work actively to ensure compliance with material laws, regulations and customer requirements related to the environment, health, and safety that apply to us, we can provide no assurance that we have been, are, or will be compliant with these laws, regulations and requirements. If we have failed or fail to comply with these laws, regulations and requirements we could be subject to significant penalties and other sanctions that could have a material adverse effect on our business, operating results, financial condition, reputation and brand. Additionally, there is a risk that we may have to incur expenditures to cover environmental and health and safety-liabilities to maintain compliance with current or future applicable laws and regulations or to undertake any necessary remediation. It is difficult to reasonably estimate the future impact of environmental matters, such as climate change and extreme weather events, including potential liabilities. Adverse future events, regulations, or judgments could have a material adverse effect on our business, operating results, financial condition, reputation and brand.

Potential health risks related to radiofrequency electromagnetic fields may subject us to various product liability claims and result in regulatory changes.

The mobile telecommunications industry is subject to claims that mobile devices and other equipment that generate radiofrequency electromagnetic fields may expose users to health risks. At present, a substantial number of scientific reviews conducted by various independent research bodies have concluded that radiofrequency electromagnetic fields, at levels within the limits prescribed by public health authority safety standards and recommendations, cause no adverse effects to human health. However, any perceived risk or new scientific findings of adverse health effects from mobile communication devices and equipment could adversely affect us through a reduction in sales or through liability claims.

 

100


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Although Ericsson’s products are designed to comply with currently applicable safety standards and regulations regarding radiofrequency electromagnetic fields, we cannot guarantee that we will not become the subject of product liability claims or be held liable for such claims or be required to comply with future changed regulatory requirements that may have an adverse effect on our business, operating results, financial condition, reputation and brand.

Regulations related to “conflict minerals” may cause us to incur additional expenses, and may make our supply chain more complex.

In 2012, the US Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”) adopted a rule requiring disclosures of specified minerals ( “conflict minerals”) that are necessary to the functionality or production of products manufactured or contracted to be manufactured by companies that file periodic reports with the SEC, whether or not these products or their components are manufactured by third- parties. While we believe that we are able to fulfill these requirements without materially affecting our costs or access to materials we can provide no assurance that there will not be material costs associated with complying with the disclosure requirements. These requirements could adversely affect the sourcing, availability and pricing of minerals used in the manufacture of certain of our products. In addition, since our supply chain is complex, we may not be able to sufficiently verify the origins for these minerals contained in our products through the due diligence procedures that we implement, which may harm our reputation. We may also encounter challenges if customers require that all of the components of our products be certified as conflict-free.

Risks associated with owning Ericsson shares

Our share price has been and may continue to be volatile, especially as technology companies, securities and markets as a whole remain volatile.

Our share price has been volatile due to various factors, including our operating performance as well as the high volatility in the securities markets generally and volatility in telecommunications and technology companies’ securities in particular. Our share price is also likely to be affected by future developments in our market, our financial results and the expectations of financial analysts, as well as statements and market speculation regarding our prospects or the timing or content of any public communications, including reports of operating results, by us or our competitors. Factors other than our financial results that may affect our share price include, but are not limited to:

 

   

A weakening of our brand name or other circumstances with adverse effects on our reputation

 

   

Announcements by our customers, competitors or us regarding capital spending plans of our customers

 

   

Financial difficulties for our customers

 

   

Awards of large supply or service contracts

 

   

Speculation in the press or investment community about the company and its operations or about the business level or growth in the telecommunications market

 

   

Technical problems, in particular those relating to the introduction and viability of new network systems, including LTE evolution / 5G small cells products and new platforms such as the HDS 8000 ( Hyperscale Datacenter System) platform.

 

   

Actual or expected results of ongoing or potential litigation

 

   

Announcements concerning bankruptcy or investigations into the accounting procedures of ourselves or other telecommunications companies

 

   

Our ability to forecast and communicate our future results in a manner consistent with investor expectation

Our corporate restructure may not produce the expected results.

Ericsson is undergoing a corporate restructure as well as a company transformation in an effort to drive efficiency and growth across the company. This includes changes to the business, management and a reduction in our workforce. These activities pose certain risks to our business and may not produce the expected results which could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations, reputation, brand and share price.

Currency fluctuations may adversely affect our share price or value of dividends.

Because our shares are quoted in SEK on Nasdaq Stockholm (our primary stock exchange), but in US dollars on NASDAQ New York (ADSs), fluctuations in exchange rates between SEK and US dollars may affect our share price. In addition, because we pay cash dividends in SEK, fluctuations in exchange rates may affect the value of distributions when converted into other currencies. An increasing part of the trade in our shares is carried out on alternative exchanges or markets, which may lead to less accurate share price information on Nasdaq Stockholm or NASDAQ New York.

 

101


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

This Annual Report includes forward-looking statements, including statements reflecting management’s current views relating to the growth of the market, future market conditions, future events and expected operational and financial performance. The words “believe,” “expect,” “foresee,” “anticipate,” “assume,” “intend,” “may,” “could,” “plan,” “estimate,” “forecast,” “will,” “should,” “predict,” “aim,” “ambition,” “target,” “might,” or, in each case, their negative, and similar words are intended to help identify forward-looking statements.

Forward-looking statements may be found throughout this document, and include statements regarding:

 

   

Our goals, strategies and operational or financial performance expectations

 

   

Development of corporate governance standards, stock market regulations and related legislation

 

   

The future characteristics of the markets in which we operate

 

   

Projections and other characterizations of future events

 

   

Our liquidity, capital resources, capital expenditures, our credit ratings and the development in the capital markets, affecting our industry or us

 

   

The expected demand for our existing as well as new products and services

 

   

The expected operational or financial performance of joint ventures and other strategic cooperation activities

 

   

The time until acquired entities will be accretive to income

 

   

Technology and industry trends including regulatory and standardization environment, competition and our customer structure

 

   

Our plans for new products and services including research and development expenditures.

Although we believe that the expectations reflected in these and other forward-looking statements are reasonable, we cannot assure you that these expectations will materialize. Because forward-looking statements are based on assumptions, judgments and estimates, and are subject to risks and uncertainties, actual results could differ materially from those described or implied herein.

Important factors that could affect whether and to what extent any of our forward-looking statements materialize include, but are not limited to the factors described in “Risk factors”.

We undertake no obligation to publicly update or revise any forward-looking statements included in this Annual Report, whether as a result of new information, future events or otherwise, except as required by applicable law or stock exchange regulation.

 

102


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

CORPORATE GOVERNANCE – Corporate Governance Report

CORPORATE GOVERNANCE REPORT 2016

Corporate governance describes how rights and responsibilities are distributed among corporate bodies according to applicable laws, rules and internal processes. Corporate governance also defines the decision-making systems and structure through which owners directly or indirectly control a company.

“I believe that a robust corporate culture is fundamental to maintain credible, competitive and sustainable business operations worldwide. Having global operations implies challenges. Therefore, as Chairman of the Board, I must continuously work to keep good governance, leadership and talent management high on the agenda in the Board room as well as throughout the global operations. A robust corporate culture must be anchored in a strong commitment from the Board and from management who must clearly emphasize the importance of conducting business with integrity. Such commitment is fundamental to create and maintain a robust corporate culture throughout a global organization. 2016 has been a year of change for Ericsson with a new organization, many new members of the Executive Leadership Team and a new CEO appointed. In a professional executive recruitment process, evaluating both internal and external candidates, many important in depth considerations are made by the Board, for example in relation to the Group strategy, talent management and corporate culture, which is valuable for the Board. In times of change, stability in terms of corporate culture and core values becomes even more important.

The Board of Directors also has an important role to give Group management clear governance frameworks and mandates, and to set the Group strategy. I always strive to enable an open and meaningful dialogue, both within the Board and between the Board and the Group management. The management dialogue aims to give the Board relevant insights in the business activities of Ericsson and in the markets in which Ericsson operates. The Board also visits various parts of the Group’s business operations as well as engages with customers, partners, academia and thought leaders in order to gain further insights. I believe that these insights are necessary for the Board to provide relevant support to management and add value, while also exercising due control of the business operations. Ericsson takes compliance concerns very seriously and the Company uses considerable resources to investigate alleged compliance concerns.

This Corporate Governance Report 2016 aims to describe how Ericsson continuously works with these matters and how we focus on establishing efficient and reliable controls and procedures. I believe that Ericsson’s continuous corporate governance focus and work to create a robust corporate culture have an important role to build trust, and in turn generate value for our investors.

Leif Johansson

Chairman of the Board of Directors

This Corporate Governance Report is rendered as a separate report added to the Annual Report in accordance with the Annual Accounts Act ((SFS 1995:1554) Chapter 6, Sections 6 and 8) and the Swedish Corporate Governance Code.

The report has been reviewed by Ericsson’s auditor in accordance with the Annual Accounts Act. A report from the auditor is appended hereto.

Key events

 

   

Börje Ekholm was appointed new President and CEO effective January 16, 2017

 

   

Effective July 25, 2016, Jan Frykhammar was appointed new President and CEO when the former Director and President and CEO Hans Vestberg left his positions

 

   

Effective July 1, 2016, new members of the Executive Leadership Team were appointed following a series of organizational and structural changes to strengthen strategy execution

 

   

Kristin S. Rinne and Helena Stjernholm were elected new members of the Board at the Annual General Meeting 2016

 

103


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Regulation and compliance

External rules

As a Swedish public limited liability company with securities quoted on Nasdaq Stockholm as well as on NASDAQ New York, Ericsson is subject to a variety of rules that affect its governance. The most relevant external rules applicable to us include:

 

   

The Swedish Companies Act

 

   

Applicable EU regulations

 

   

The Rule Book for issuers of Nasdaq Stockholm

 

   

The Swedish Corporate Governance Code (the “Code”)

 

   

NASDAQ Stock Market Rules, including applicable NASDAQ New York corporate governance requirements (subject to certain exemptions principally reflecting mandatory Swedish legal requirements)

 

   

Applicable requirements of the US Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”)

Internal rules

In addition, to ensure compliance with legal and regulatory requirements and the high standards that we set for ourselves, Ericsson has adopted internal rules that include:

 

   

A Code of Business Ethics

 

   

Group Steering Documents, including Group policies and directives, instructions and business processes for approval, control and risk management

 

   

A Code of Conduct, which applies to product development, production, supply and support of Ericsson products and services worldwide.

The articles of association and the work procedure for the Board of Directors also include internal corporate governance rules.

Code of Business Ethics

Ericsson’s Code of Business Ethics summarizes fundamental Group policies and directives and contains rules to ensure that business is conducted with a strong sense of integrity. This is critical to maintain trust and credibility with Ericsson’s customers, partners, employees, shareholders and other stakeholders.

The Code of Business Ethics contains rules for all individuals performing work for Ericsson under the staff management of Ericsson. The Code of Business Ethics has been translated into more than 30 languages. This ensures that it is accessible to everyone working for Ericsson. Upon recruitment, employees acknowledge that they are aware of the principles of the Code of Business Ethics. This procedure is repeated during the term of employment. Through this process, Ericsson strives to raise awareness throughout its global operations.

Everyone working for Ericsson has an individual responsibility to ensure that business practices adhere to the Code of Business Ethics.

Ericsson’s core values

LOGO

 

LOGO

Compliance with regulations

 

 

Compliance with the Swedish Corporate Governance Code

The Code is based on the principle of “comply or explain” and is published on the website of the Swedish Corporate Governance Board, which administrates the Code: www.corporategovernanceboard.se. Ericsson is committed to complying with best-practice corporate governance on a global level wherever possible. This includes continued compliance with the Code. Ericsson does not report any deviations from the rules of the Code in 2016.

Compliance with applicable stock exchange rules

There has been no infringement by Ericsson of applicable stock exchange rules and no breach of good practice on the securities market reported by the disciplinary committee of Nasdaq Stockholm or the Swedish Securities Council in 2016.

 

104


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Governance structure

Shareholders may exercise their decision-making rights in Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson (the “Parent Company”) at General Meetings of shareholders.

A Nomination Committee is appointed each year by the major shareholders in accordance with the Instruction for the Nomination Committee adopted by the Annual General Meeting of shareholders. The tasks of the Nomination Committee include the proposal of Board members and external auditor for election by the Annual General Meeting of shareholders and proposal of Board member and auditor remuneration.

In addition to the Board members elected by shareholders, the Board of Directors consists of employee representatives and their deputies that the unions have the right to appoint under Swedish law. The Board of Directors is ultimately responsible for the strategy and the organization of Ericsson and the management of its operations.

The President and CEO, appointed by the Board of Directors, is responsible for handling the day-to-day management of Ericsson in accordance with guidelines issued by the Board. The President and CEO is supported by the Executive Leadership Team.

The external auditor of Ericsson is elected by the General Meeting of shareholders.

 

LOGO

Shareholders

Ownership structure

As of December 31, 2016, the Parent Company had 465,733 registered shareholders, of which 453,424 were resident or located in Sweden (according to the share register kept by Euro-clear Sweden AB). Swedish institutions held approximately 55.2% of the votes. The largest shareholders as of December 31, 2016 were Investor AB with approximately 21.8% of the votes and AB Industrivärden (together with Svenska Handelsbankens Pensionsstiftelse and Pensionskassan SHB Försäkringsförening), with approximately 19.3% of the votes.

A significant number of the shares held by foreign investors are nominee-registered, i.e. held of record by banks, brokers and/or nominees. This means that the actual shareholder is not displayed in the share register or included in the shareholding statistics.

More information on Ericsson’s shareholders can be found in the chapter “Share Information” in the Annual Report.

 

LOGO

Shares and voting rights

The share capital of the Parent Company consists of two classes of shares listed on Nasdaq Stockholm: A and B shares. Each Class A share carries one vote and each Class B share carries one tenth of one vote. Class A and B shares entitle the holder to the same proportion of assets and earnings and carry equal rights to dividends.

The Parent Company may also issue Class C shares, which shares are converted into Class B shares before they are used to create treasury stock to finance and hedge long-term variable compensation programs resolved by the General Meeting of shareholders.

In the United States, the Ericsson Class B shares are listed on NASDAQ New York in the form of American Depositary Shares (ADS) evidenced by American Depositary Receipts (ADR). Each ADS represents one Class B share.

The members of the Board of Directors and the Executive Leadership Team have the same voting rights on shares as other shareholders holding the same class of shares.

 

105


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

General Meetings of shareholders

Decision-making at General Meetings

The decision-making rights of Ericsson’s shareholders are exercised at General Meetings of shareholders. Most resolutions at General Meetings are passed by a simple majority. However, the Swedish Companies Act requires qualified majorities in certain cases, for example in case of:

 

   

Amendment of the Articles of Association

 

   

Resolution to transfer treasury stock to employees participating in long-term variable compensation programs.

The Annual General Meeting of shareholders

The Annual General Meeting of shareholders (AGM) is held in Stockholm. The date and venue for the meeting are announced on the Ericsson website no later than at the time of release of the third-quarter interim financial report in the preceding year.

Shareholders who cannot participate in person may be represented by proxy. Only shareholders registered in the share register have voting rights. Nominee-registered shareholders who wish to vote must request to be entered into the share register by the record date for the AGM.

The AGM is held in Swedish and is simultaneously translated into English. All documentation provided by the Company is available in both Swedish and English.

The AGM gives shareholders the opportunity to raise questions relating to the operations of the Group. Normally, the majority of the members of the Board of Directors and the Executive Leadership Team is present to answer such questions.

The external auditor is always present at the AGM.

Ericsson’s Annual General Meeting 2016

Including shareholders represented by proxy, 3,251 shareholders were represented at the AGM held on April 13, 2016, representing more than 69% of the votes.

The meeting was also attended by members of the Board of Directors, members of the Executive Leadership Team and the external auditor.

Decisions of the AGM 2016 included:

 

   

Payment of a dividend of SEK 3.70 per share

 

   

Re-election of Leif Johansson as Chairman of the Board of Directors

 

   

Re-election of other members of the Board of Directors: Nora Denzel, Börje Ekholm, Ulf J. Johansson, Kristin Skogen Lund, Sukhinder Singh Cassidy, Hans Vestberg and Jacob Wallenberg

 

   

Election of new Board members: Kristin S. Rinne and Helena Stjernholm

 

   

Approval of Board of Directors’ fees:

 

   

Chairman: SEK 4,075,000 (previously SEK 4,000,000)

 

   

Other non-employee Board members: SEK 990,000 each (previously SEK 975,000)

 

   

Chairman of the Audit Committee: SEK 350,000 (unchanged)

 

   

Other non-employee members of the Audit Committee: SEK 250,000 each (unchanged)

 

   

Chairmen of the Finance and Remuneration Committees: SEK 200,000 each (unchanged)

 

   

Other non-employee members of the Finance and Remuneration Committees: SEK 175,000 each (unchanged)

 

   

Approval for part of the Directors’ fees to be paid in the form of synthetic shares

 

   

Approval of Guidelines for remuneration to Group management

 

   

Implementation of a Long-Term Variable Compensation Program 2016, including a share issue of and authorization to the Board to buy back 26,100,000 shares for the program.

The minutes from the AGM 2016 are available on Ericsson’s website.

 

LOGO

Contact the Board of Directors

The Board of Directors Secretariat

SE-164 83 Stockholm

Sweden

boardsecretariat@ericsson.com

Annual General Meeting 2017

 

 

Ericsson’s AGM 2017 will take place on March 29, 2017, at 3 p.m. at Kistamässan in Stockholm. Further information is available on Ericsson’s website.

 

106


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Nomination Committee

The Annual General Meeting of shareholders has adopted an Instruction for the Nomination Committee that includes the tasks of the Nomination Committee and the procedures for appointing its members. The Instruction applies until the General Meeting of shareholders resolves otherwise. Under the Instruction, the Nomination Committee shall consist of:

 

   

Representatives of the four largest shareholders by voting power by the end of the month in which the AGM was held, and

 

   

The Chairman of the Board of Directors.

The Committee may also include additional members following a request by a shareholder. The request must be justified by changes in the shareholder’s ownership of shares and be received by the Nomination Committee no later than December 31 of each year. No fees are paid to the members of the Nomination Committee.

Members of the Nomination Committee

The current Nomination Committee members appointed in May 2016 are:

 

   

Petra Hedengran (Investor AB), Chairman of the Nomination Committee

 

   

Bengt Kjell (AB Industrivärden, Svenska Handelsbankens Pensionsstiftelse)

 

   

Johan Held (AFA Försäkring)

 

   

Anders Oscarsson (AMF – Försäkring och Fonder)

 

   

Leif Johansson, Chairman of the Board of Directors

The tasks of the Nomination Committee

The main task of the Committee is to propose Board members for election by the AGM. As member of the Nomination Committee, the Chairman of the Board of Directors fulfills an important role to inform the Committee of the Company’s strategy and future challenges. Such insights are necessary for the Committee to be able to assess the competence and experience that is required by the Board. In addition, the Committee must consider independence rules applicable to the Board of Directors and its committees.

The Nomination Committee also makes the following proposals, for resolution by the AGM:

 

   

Proposal for remuneration to non-employee Directors elected by the AGM and remuneration to the auditor

 

   

Proposal for election of auditor, whereby candidates are selected in cooperation with the Audit Committee of the Board

 

   

Proposal for election of Chairman at the AGM

 

   

Proposal of changes to the Instruction for the Nomination Committee (if any).

Work of the Nomination Committee for the AGM 2017

The Nomination Committee started its work by going through a checklist of its duties under the Code and the Instruction for the Nomination Committee and by setting a time plan for its work ahead. A good understanding of Ericsson’s business and strategy is important for the members of the Nomination Committee. Therefore, the Chairman of the Board presented his views to the Committee members on the Company’s position and strategy. During the fall of 2016, the Committee also met with Ericsson’s President and CEO, Jan Frykhammar, who presented his views in this respect.

The Committee was thoroughly informed of the results of the evaluation of the Board work and procedures, including the performance of the Chairman of the Board. On this basis, the Committee has assessed the competence and experience required by Ericsson Board members. The Nomination Committee has applied the Swedish Corporate Governance Code, section 4.1, as diversity policy and has continuously assessed the need for improvement of the composition of the Board in terms of diversity in competence, experience, age, gender and cultural/geographic background. The Nomination Committee aims to propose a composition of Board members with complementing experiences and competencies to make it possible for the Board to contribute to a positive development of Ericsson. The Nomination Committee searches for potential Board member candidates both with a long-term and a short-term perspective and always focuses on diversity to ensure that the Board get different perspectives into the Board work and considerations. The Nomination Committee also considers the need for renewal and carefully assesses whether the proposed Directors have the capability to devote necessary time and care to the Board work.

In 2016, the Committee met with the Chairman of the Audit Committee to acquaint itself with the assessments made by the Company and the Audit Committee of the quality and efficiency of external auditor work. The Audit Committee also provided its recommendations on external auditor and audit fees.

As of February 24, 2017, the current Nomination Committee has held six meetings.

LOGO

Contact the Nomination Committee

Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson

The Nomination Committee

c/o The Board of Directors Secretariat

SE-164 83 Stockholm

Sweden

nomination.committee@ericsson.com

 

LOGO

Proposals to the Nomination Committee

Shareholders may submit proposals to the Nomination Committee at any time, but should do so in due time before the AGM to ensure that the proposals can be considered by the Committee. Further information is available on Ericsson’s website.

 

107


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Board of Directors

The Board of Directors is ultimately responsible for the organization of Ericsson and the management of Ericsson’s operations. The Board appoints the President and CEO who is responsible for managing the day-to-day operations in accordance with guidelines from the Board. The President and CEO ensures that the Board is updated regularly on issues of importance to Ericsson. This includes updates on business development, results, financial position and liquidity.

Directors serve from the close of one AGM to the close of the next, but can serve any number of consecutive terms.

The President and CEO may be elected a Director of the Board, but, under the Swedish Companies Act, the President of a public company may not be elected Chairman of the Board.

Conflicts of interest

Ericsson maintains rules and regulations regarding conflicts of interest. Directors are disqualified from participating in any decision regarding agreements between themselves and Ericsson. The same applies to agreements between Ericsson and any third-party or legal entity in which the Board member has an interest that may be contrary to the interests of Ericsson.

The Audit Committee oversees the procedures for related-party transactions and has implemented a pre-approval process for non-audit services carried out by the external auditor.

Composition of the Board of Directors

The current Board of Directors consists of nine Directors elected by the shareholders at the AGM 2016 for the period until the close of the AGM 2017. The former Director and President and CEO, Hans Vestberg, was also elected Director at the AGM 2016 but, on July 25, 2016, it was announced that he left his positions with Ericsson, including his Board position, effective immediately. The Board of Directors also consists of three employee representatives, each with a deputy, appointed by the trade unions for the same period of time.

Work procedure

Pursuant to the Swedish Companies Act, the Board of Directors has adopted a work procedure and Committee charters outlining rules for the distribution of tasks among the Board, its Committees and the President and CEO. This complements rules in the Swedish Companies Act and in the Articles of Association of the Company. The work procedure and the Committee charters are reviewed, evaluated and amended by the Board as required or appropriate, and are adopted by the Board at least once a year.

Independence

The Board of Directors and its Committees are subject to a variety of independence rules under applicable Swedish law, the Code and applicable US securities laws, SEC rules and the NASDAQ Stock Market Rules. Ericsson can rely on exemptions from certain US and SEC requirements and may decide to follow Swedish practices in lieu of the NASDAQ Stock Market independence rules.

The composition of the Board of Directors meets all applicable independence criteria. The Nomination Committee concluded before the AGM 2016 that, for purposes of the Code, at least six of the nominated Directors were independent from Ericsson, its senior management and its major shareholders. These were Nora Denzel, Leif Johansson, Ulf J. Johansson, Kristin S. Rinne, Kristin Skogen Lund and Sukhinder Singh Cassidy.

Structure of the work of the Board of Directors

The work of the Board follows a yearly cycle. This enables the Board to appropriately address each of its duties and to keep strategy, risk assessment and value creation high on the agenda. In addition to Board meetings, the annual work cycle of the Board includes two Board Strategic Days held in connection with Board meetings. The Board Strategic Days are described below under Training and Board Strategic Days.

As the Board is responsible for financial oversight, financial information is presented and evaluated at each Board meeting. Furthermore, the Chairman of each Committee, reports on Committee work at each Board meeting and minutes from Committee meetings are distributed to all Directors prior to the Board meetings.

At Board meetings, the President and CEO reports on business and market developments as well as on the financial performance of the Group. Strategic issues and risks are also addressed at most Board meetings. The Board is regularly informed of developments in legal and regulatory matters of importance. Board and Committee meetings may, as appropriate, be held by way of telephone or video conference, and resolutions may be taken per capsulam (unanimous written consent). Such resolutions are accounted for as Board/Committee meetings.

 

108


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

The 2016 annual work cycle of the Board:

 

   

Fourth-quarter and full-year financial results meeting

Following the end of the calendar year, the Board held a meeting which focused on the financial results of the entire year 2015 and handled the fourth-quarter financial report.

 

   

Board Strategic Day

A Board Strategic Day, focusing on deepening Board member knowledge of matters of strategic importance for Ericsson, was held in connection with a Board meeting in the spring.

 

   

Board meeting

In March, an ordinary Board meeting was held to address various matters, including for example regular executive succession planning review.

 

   

Statutory Board meeting

The statutory Board meeting was held in connection with the AGM 2016. At this meeting, members of each of the three Board Commit- tees were appointed and the Board resolved on signatory powers.

 

   

First interim report meeting

At the next ordinary meeting, the Board handled the interim financial report for the first quarter of the year.

 

   

Main strategy meeting

In accordance with the annual cycle for the strategy process, a main strategy Board meeting was held, in essence dedicated to short- and long-term strategies of the Group. Following the Board’s input on, and approval of, the overall strategy, the strategy was cascaded throughout the entire organization, starting at the Global Leadership Summit held after the summer with Ericsson’s top 300 leaders.

 

   

Second interim report meeting

At the second interim report meeting, the Board handled the interim financial report for the second quarter of the year.

 

   

Follow-up strategy and risk management meeting

Following the summer, a meeting was held to address particular strategy matters in further detail and to finally confirm the Group strategy. The meeting also addressed the overall risk management of the Group.

 

   

Board Strategic Day

Board Strategic Day, focusing on deepening Board member knowledge of matters of strategic importance for Ericsson, was held in connection with a Board meeting in October.

 

   

Third interim report meeting

A Board meeting was held to handle the interim financial report for the third quarter of the year. At this meeting, the results of the Board evaluation were presented to and discussed by the Board.

 

   

Budget and financial outlook meeting

A meeting was held for the Board to address the budget and financial outlook as well as to further analyze internal and external risks.

Training and Board Strategic Days

New Directors receive comprehensive training tailored to their individual needs. Introductory training typically includes meetings with heads

 

LOGO

 

109


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

of business units, customer groups and Group functions, as well as training required by Nasdaq Stockholm on listing issues and insider rules. In addition, the company arranges training for Board members at regular intervals.

Bi-annual Board Strategic Days are arranged for Board members as part of ordinary Board meetings, normally spanning one full day each. The Board Strategic Days focus on combining strategy issues with making deep dives into issues of importance for the Ericsson Group. The purpose of the Board Strategic Days is to ensure that members of the Board have knowledge and understanding of the business activities of the Group, the business environment and the Group’s strategic options and challenges. Directors’ knowledge in these fields is crucial to allow well-founded Board resolutions, and to ensure that the Company takes due advantage of the different competences of the Directors. The Board Strategic Days also form an important platform for contacts between Directors and talent from different parts of Ericsson’s organization where the Board gets the opportunity to meet Ericsson employees and leaders. Such contacts and meetings are highly valued by the Board as part of the Board’s involvement in Ericsson’s talent management.

During 2016, focus areas at Board Strategic Days included cyber security, 5G, Industry and Society, IoT and Media. As a rule, the Board Strategic Days also include sustainability and corporate responsibility updates for Board members.

Auditor involvement

The Board meets with Ericsson’s external auditor in closed sessions at least once a year to receive and consider the auditor’s observations. The auditor reports to management on the accounting and financial reporting practices of the Group.

The Audit Committee also meets regularly with the auditor to receive and consider observations on the interim reports and the Annual Report. The auditor has been instructed to report on whether the accounts, the management of funds and the general financial position of the Group are presented fairly in all material respects.

In addition, the Board reviews and assesses the process for financial reporting, as described below under “Internal control over financial reporting 2016”. Combined with other steps taken internally, the Board’s and the auditor’s review of the interim and annual reports are deemed to give reasonable assurance of the effectiveness of the internal controls over financial reporting.

Work of the Board of Directors in 2016

In 2016, 13 Board meetings were held. For attendance at Board meetings, see the table on page 114.

Strategy and risk management are always high on the Board’s agenda and the bi-annual Board Strategic Days aim at providing the Board with good insight into these matters. Sustainability and corporate responsibility are increasingly important to Ericsson and are integrated into Ericsson’s business strategy.

The Board continuously monitors the international developments and their possible impact on Ericsson. Industry transformation, talent management, cybersecurity, profitability, cost reductions and efficiency gains are among the matters that have continued to be in focus within Ericsson during the year. The Board also addressed the re-organization carried out during the year, and the process to appoint a new President and CEO.

Board work evaluation

A key objective of the Board evaluation is to ensure that the Board work is functioning well. This includes gaining an understanding of the issues that the Board thinks warrant greater focus, as well as determining areas where additional competence is needed within the Board and whether the Board composition is appropriate. The evaluation also serves as guidance for the work of the Nomination Committee.

 

LOGO

 

110


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Each year, the Chairman of the Board initiates and leads the evaluation of the Board and Committee work and procedures. Evaluation tools include detailed questionnaires and discussions. The services of an external corporate advisory firm have been retained by the Company to assist in developing questionnaires, carrying out surveys and summarizing responses.

In 2016, Directors responded to written questionnaires, covering the Director’s individual performance, Board work in general, Committee work and the Chairman’s performance. The Chairman was not involved in the development or compilation of the questionnaire which related to his performance, nor was he present when his performance was evaluated. The Chairman evaluation was coordinated by one of the Deputy Chairmen, Jacob Wallenberg. As part of the evaluation process, the Chairman of the Board also had individual discussions with each of the Directors. The results from the evaluations were presented to the Board and were thoroughly discussed. An action plan was developed to further improve the work of the Board. The Nomination Committee was informed of the results of the Board work and Chairman evaluation.

Committees of the Board of Directors

The Board of Directors has established three Committees: the Audit Committee, the Finance Committee and the Remuneration Committee. Members of each Committee are appointed for one year from amongst the Board members. In January 2017, the Board resolved to establish a fourth Board Committee for Technology and Science as from the statutory Board meeting to be held in connection with the 2017 Annual General Meeting of shareholders.

The task of the Committees is mainly to prepare matters for resolution by the Board. However, the Board has authorized each Committee to determine and handle certain issues in limited areas. It may also on occasion provide extended authorization for the Committees to determine specific matters.

If deemed appropriate, the Board of Directors and each Committee have the right to engage independent external expertise, either in general or with respect to specific matters.

Prior to the Board meetings, each Committee submits the minutes of Committee meetings to the Board and the Chairman of the Committee reports on the work of the Committee at each Board meeting.

Audit Committee

On behalf of the Board, the Audit Committee monitors the following:

 

   

The scope and accuracy of the financial statements

 

   

Compliance with legal and regulatory requirements

 

   

Internal control over financial reporting

 

   

Risk management

 

   

The effectiveness and appropriateness of the Group’s anti-corruption program.

The Audit Committee also reviews the annual and interim financial reports and oversees the external audit process, including audit fees.

The Audit Committee itself does not perform audit work. Ericsson’s internal audit function reports directly to the Audit Committee.

Ericsson’s external auditor is elected by the AGM. The Committee is involved in the preparatory work for the Nomination Committee to propose external auditor for election by the AGM. It also monitors Group transactions and the ongoing performance and independence of the auditor with the aim to avoid conflicts of interest.

In order to ensure the auditor’s independence, the Audit Committee has established pre-approval policies and procedures for non-audit related services to be performed by the external auditor. Pre-approval authority may not be delegated to management.

The Audit Committee also oversees Ericsson’s process for reviewing transactions with related parties and Ericsson’s whistle-blower procedures.

 

LOGO

 

111


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Whistle-blower procedures

Ericsson’s whistle-blower tool, Ericsson Compliance Line, managed by an external service provider, can be used for reporting of alleged violations of laws or the Code of Business Ethics that:

 

   

are conducted by Group or local management, and

 

   

relate to corruption, questionable accounting or auditing matters or otherwise seriously affect vital interests of the Group or personal health and safety.

Violations reported through the Ericsson Compliance Line are handled by Ericsson’s Group Compliance Forum, consisting of representatives from Ericsson’s internal audit function, Group Function Legal Affairs, Group Security, and Group Function Human Resources. Alleged violations reported in Ericsson Compliance Line are reported to the Audit Committee. Reports include information about the incident category and a description of the report and decision and output. Investigations relating to severe alleged violations are handled by Corporate Audit’s Corporate Investigation team to secure independence. Other investigations are handled in the Regions. The Corporate Investigation team oversees these investigations as deemed appropriate.

Members of the Audit Committee

The Audit Committee consists of four Board members appointed by the Board in connection with the AGM 2016: Ulf J. Johansson (Chairman), Nora Denzel, Kristin Skogen Lund and Mikael Lännqvist (employee representative). The Board has appointed shareholder elected Board members with CEO experience to the Committee.

The composition of the Audit Committee meets all applicable independence requirements, including the conditions for reliance on an exemption for employee representatives. The Board of Directors has determined that each of Ulf J. Johansson, Nora Denzel and Kristin Skogen Lund is an audit committee financial expert, as defined under the SEC rule. Each of these three members is considered independent under applicable US securities laws, SEC rules and NASDAQ Stock Market Rules and each of them is financially literate and familiar with the accounting practices of an international company, such as Ericsson.

Work of the Audit Committee in 2016

The Audit Committee held eight meetings in 2016. Directors’ attendance is reflected in the table on page 114. During the year, the Audit Committee reviewed the scope and results of external financial audits and the independence of the external auditor. Prior to publishing it, the Committee also reviewed and discussed each interim report and the annual report with the external auditor. The Committee also reviewed the pre-approval policies and procedures to secure compliance with new EU regulations regarding audits, and monitored the external audit fees and approved non-audit-services performed by the external auditor in accordance with such policies and procedures.

The Committee approved the audit plan for the internal audit function based on among other things the annual risk assessment, and reviewed the reports of the internal audit function. The Committee also received and reviewed reports under the whistle-blower tool, Ericsson Compliance Line.

The Committee monitored the continued compliance with the Sarbanes-Oxley Act as well as the internal control and risk management process and monitored and evaluated the effectiveness and appropriateness of Ericsson’s anti-corruption program. In 2016, the Committee received training on new IFRS rules.

Finance Committee

The Finance Committee’s responsibilities include:

 

   

Handling matters related to acquisitions, investments and divestments

 

   

Handling capital contributions to Group and affiliated companies

 

   

Raising loans, issuing guarantees and similar undertakings, and approving financial sup- port to customers and suppliers

 

   

Continuously monitoring the Group’s financial risk exposure.

The Finance Committee is authorized to determine matters such as:

 

   

Direct or indirect financing

 

   

Provision of credits

 

   

Granting of guarantees and similar undertakings

 

   

Certain investments, divestments and financial commitments.

Members of the Finance Committee

The Finance Committee consists of four Board members appointed by the Board in connection with the AGM 2016: Leif Johansson (Chairman), Pehr Claesson (employee representative), Helena Stjernholm and Jacob Wallenberg. The Board has appointed shareholder elected Board members with extensive industrial and financial experience to the Committee.

Work of the Finance Committee in 2016

The Finance Committee held 13 meetings in 2016. Directors’ attendance is reflected in the table on page 114. During the year, the Finance Committee approved numerous customer finance credit arrangements and reviewed a number of potential acquisitions and divestments and real estate investments. The Finance Committee spent significant time discussing

 

112


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

and securing an adequate capital structure, as well as examining cash flow and working capital performance. International developments and their impact on Ericsson are continuously monitored, as well as Ericsson’s financial position and foreign exchange and credit exposures.

Remuneration Committee

The Remuneration Committee’s responsibilities include:

 

   

Reviewing and preparing, for resolution by the Board, proposals on salary and other remuneration, including retirement compensation, for the President and CEO.

 

   

Reviewing and preparing, for resolution by the Board, proposals to the AGM on guidelines for remuneration to the Executive Leadership Team (ELT).

 

   

Approving proposals on salary and other remuneration, including retirement compensation, for the other members of the ELT.

 

   

Reviewing and preparing, for resolution by the Board, proposals to the AGM on the Long-Term Variable Compensation Program and similar equity arrangements.

In its work, the Remuneration Committee considers trends in remuneration, legislative changes, disclosure rules and the general global executive remuneration environment. It reviews salary survey data before preparing salary adjustment recommendations for the President and CEO for resolution by the Board and before approving any salary adjustments for the other members of the ELT.

Members of the Remuneration Committee

The Remuneration Committee appointed by the Board in connection with the AGM 2016 consisted of four Board members: Leif Johansson (Chairman), Börje Ekholm, Sukhinder Singh Cassidy and Karin Åberg (employee representative). Börje Ekholm left the Committee upon his appointment as President and CEO on January 16, 2017 and the Committee now consists of three Board members. The Board has appointed shareholder elected Board members to the Committee with experiences from different markets of relevance to the Group, including the Swedish and the US markets.

During the year 2016, Piia Pilv advised and assisted the Remuneration Committee as an independent expert. At its final meeting of 2016, the Remuneration Committee resolved to appoint Peter Boreham from Mercer as its independent advisor for 2017.

Work of the Remuneration Committee in 2016

The Remuneration Committee held seven meetings in 2016. Director’s attendance is reflected in the table on page 114.

The Remuneration Committee reviewed and prepared a proposal for the Long-Term Variable Compensation program (LTV) 2016 for resolution by the Board and further approval by the AGM 2016. It further resolved on salaries and Short-Term Variable remuneration for 2016 for the members of the ELT and prepared proposals regarding remuneration to the President and CEO for resolution by the Board. It also prepared guidelines for remuneration to the ELT for resolution by the Board and subsequent referral to the AGM for approval. With several changes to the ELT during 2016, the Remuneration Committee has also resolved on salaries and Short-Term Variable remuneration for individuals joining the ELT.

During the latter part of 2016, the Remuneration Committee reviewed the current LTV structure and executive remuneration. The resulting proposals on LTV and guidelines for remuneration to the ELT will be referred to the AGM 2017 for resolution.

For further information on fixed and variable remuneration, please see Notes to the consolidated financial statements – Note C28 “Information regarding members of the Board of Directors, the Group management and employees” and the “Remuneration Report” included in the Annual Report.

 

113


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Directors’ attendance and fees 2016

 

     Fees resolved by the AGM 2016      Number of Board/Committee meetings attended in 2016  

Board member

   Board fees,
SEK  1)
    Committee fees,
SEK
     Board      Audit
Committee
     Finance
Committee
     Remuneration
Committee
 

Leif Johansson

     4,075,000       400,000        13           13        7  

Anders Nyrén 2)

     —         —          2           4     

Helena Stjernholm 3)4)

     990,000       175,000        11           9     

Jacob Wallenberg

     990,000       175,000        12           13     

Roxanne S. Austin 5)

     —         —          2              2  

Nora Denzel 6)

     990,000       250,000        13        5        

Börje Ekholm 7)

     742,500       131,250        12              7  

Alexander Izosimov 8)

     —         —          2        3        

Ulf J. Johansson

     990,000       350,000        13        8        

Kristin Skogen Lund

     975,000       250,000        13        8        

Kristin S. Rinne 3)

     990,000       —          11           

Sukhinder Singh Cassidy 9)

     990,000       175,000        13              5  

Hans Vestberg 10)

     —         —          7           

Pehr Claesson

     39,000  11)       —          13           13     

Mikael Lännqvist

     31,500  11)       —          13        8        

Karin Åberg

     30,000  11)       —          13              7  

Zlatko Hadzic

     18.000  11)       —          12           

Kjell-Åke Soting

     19,500  11)       —          13           

Roger Svensson

     19,500  11)       —          13           
       

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total number of meetings

          13        8        13        7  
       

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) Non-employee Directors can choose to receive part of their Board fee (exclusive of Committee fees) in the form of synthetic shares.
2) Resigned from the Board and from the Finance Committee as of April 13, 2016.
3) Elected member of the Board at the AGM held on April 13, 2016.
4) Appointed member of the Finance Committee as of April 13, 2016.
5) Resigned from the Board and from the Remuneration Committee as of April 13, 2016.
6) Appointed member of the Audit Committee as of April 13, 2016.
7) Board member remuneration resolved by the AGM is only for non-employee Directors elected by the shareholders. Since January 16, 2017, Börje Ekholm is employed by the Company and his Board and Committee remuneration have been adjusted accordingly.
8) Resigned from the Board and from the Audit Committee as of April 13, 2016.
9) Appointed member of the Remuneration Committee as of April 13, 2016.
10) Resigned from the Board as of July 25, 2016. Board member remuneration resolved by the AGM is only for non-employee Directors elected by the shareholders. Hans Vestberg was employed by the Company.
11) Employee representative Board members and their deputies are not entitled to a Board fee, but instead get paid compensation in the amount of SEK 1,500 per attended Board and Committee meeting.

Remuneration to Board members

Remuneration to Board members not employed by the Company is proposed by the Nomination Committee for resolution by the AGM.

The AGM 2016 approved the Nomination Committee’s proposal for fees to non-employee Board members for Board and Committee work. For further information on Board of Directors’ fees 2016, please refer to Notes to the consolidated financial statements—Note C28 “Information regarding members of the Board of Directors, the Group management and employees” in the Annual Report.

The AGM 2016 also approved the Nomination Committee’s proposal that Board members may be paid part of their Board fee in the form of synthetic shares. A synthetic share gives the right to receive a future cash payment of an amount which corresponds to the market value of a Class B share in Ericsson at the time of payment. The Director’s right to receive payment with regard to allocated synthetic shares occurs, as a general rule, after the publication of the Company’s year-end financial statement during the fifth year following the General Meeting that resolved on the allocation of the synthetic shares. The purpose of paying part of the Board of Directors’ fee in the form of synthetic shares is to further align the Directors’ interests with shareholder interests. For more information on the terms and conditions of the synthetic shares, please refer to the notice convening the AGM 2016 and to the minutes from the AGM 2016, which are available at Ericsson’s website.

 

114


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Members of the Board of Directors

Board members elected by the AGM 2016

 

LOGO

Leif Johansson (first elected 2011)

Chairman of the Board of Directors, Chairman of the Remuneration Committee and of the Finance Committee

Born 1951. Master of Science in Engineering, Chalmers University of Technology, Gothenburg, Sweden.

Board Chairman: Astra Zeneca PLC.

Board Member: Autoliv, Inc., Ecolean AB and The Confederation of Swedish Enterprise.

Holdings in Ericsson: 103,933 Class B shares 1) .

Principal work experience and other information: Member of the European Round Table of Industrialists since 2002, and served as its Chairman 2009–2014. President of the Royal Swedish Academy of Engineering Sciences since 2012. Chairman of the International Advisory Board of the Nobel Foundation. President and CEO of AB Volvo 1997–2011. Executive Vice President of AB Electrolux 1988–1991, President 1991–1994 and President and CEO of AB Electrolux 1994–1997. Holds honorary Doctorates at Blekinge Institute of Technology, the University of Gothenburg and Chalmers University of Technology. Awarded the Large Gold Medal of the Royal Swedish Academy of Engineering Sciences in 2011.

 

LOGO

Helena Stjernholm (first elected 2016)

Deputy Chairman of the Board of Directors, Member of the Finance Committee

Born 1970. Master of Science in Business Administration, Stockholm School of Economics, Sweden.

Board Member: AB Industrivärden, AB Volvo and Sandvik AB.

Holdings in Ericsson: 20,060 Class B shares 1) , and 11,093 synthetic shares 2) .

Principal work experience and other information: President and CEO of AB Industrivärden since 2015. Partner in the private equity firm IK Investment Partners (2008–2015), with responsibility for the Stockholm office from 2011 to 2015. Investment Manager at IK Investment Partners (1998–2008). Previous experience as consultant for Bain & Company (1997–1998).

 

LOGO

Jacob Wallenberg (first elected 2011)

Deputy Chairman of the Board of Directors, Member of the Finance Committee

Born 1956. Bachelor of Science in Economics and Master of Business Administration, Wharton School, University of Pennsylvania, USA. Officer of the Reserve, Swedish Navy.

Board Chairman: Investor AB.

Deputy Board Chairman: SAS AB, ABB Ltd, FAM and Patricia Industries.

Board Member: The Knut and Alice Wallenberg Foundation, the Stockholm School of Economics and The Confederation of Swedish Enterprise.

Holdings in Ericsson: 227,703 Class B shares 1) , and 25,186 synthetic shares 2) .

Principal work experience and other information: Chairman of the Board of Investor AB since 2005. President and CEO of SEB in 1997 and Chairman of SEB’s Board of Directors 1998–2005. Executive Vice President and CFO of Investor AB 1990–1993. Honorary Chairman of IBLAC (Mayor of Shanghai’s International Business Leaders Advisory Council) and member of The European Round Table of Industrialists.

The Board memberships and holdings in Ericsson reported above are as of December 31, 2016.

 

1) The number of shares includes holdings by related persons, as well as holdings of any ADS, if applicable.
2) Since 2008, the AGM has each year resolved that part of the Board fee may be received in the form of synthetic shares. A synthetic share is a right to receive in the future a payment corresponding to the value of the Class B share in Ericsson at the time of payment. Please see page 114 for further information.

 

115


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

LOGO

Nora Denzel (first elected 2013)

Member of the Audit Committee

Born 1962. Master of Business Administration, Santa Clara University, USA. Bachelor of Science in Computer Science, State University of New York, USA.

Board Member: Advanced Micro Devices, Inc.

Holdings in Ericsson: 3,850 Class B shares 1) , and 5,489 synthetic shares 2) .

Principal work experience and other information: CEO (interim) of Outerwall Inc. (January 2015 – August 2015). Senior Vice President Big Data, Marketing and Social Product Design and General Manager QuickBooks Payroll Division (2008–2012). Previous positions include Senior Vice President and General Manager of HP’s Global Software, Storage and Consulting Divisions (2000–2006), Senior Vice President Product Operations Legato Systems (bought by EMC) and various engineering, marketing and executive positions at IBM. Non-Profit board member of the Anita Borg Institute and the Northern California Chapter of the National Association of Corporate Directors (NACD). Industrial Advisor to the Private Equity Firm EQT.

 

LOGO

Börje Ekholm (first elected 2006)

Member of the Remuneration Committee (until January 15, 2017)

Born 1963. Master of Science in Electrical Engineering, KTH Royal Institute of Technology, Stockholm, Sweden. Master of Business Administration, INSEAD, France.

Board Chairman: NASDAQ OMX Group Inc. and KTH Royal Institute of Technology.

Board Member: Alibaba, Inc. and Trimble Inc.

Holdings in Ericsson: 1,030,760 Class B shares 1) , 2,000,000 call options, and 43,679 synthetic shares 2) .

Principal work experience and other information: President and CEO of Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson since January 16, 2017. CEO of Patricia Industries, a division within Investor AB (2015 – January 15, 2017). President and CEO of Investor AB (2005–2015). Formerly Head of Investor Growth Capital Inc. and New Investments. Previous positions at Novare Kapital AB and McKinsey & Co Inc. Member of the Board of Trustees of Choate Rosemary Hall.

 

LOGO

Ulf J. Johansson (first elected 2005)

Chairman of the Audit Committee

Born 1945. Doctor of Technology and Master of Science in Electrical Engineering, KTH Royal Institute of Technology, Stockholm, Sweden.

Board Chairman: Acando AB, Eurostep Group AB and Trimble Inc.

Holdings in Ericsson: 6,435 Class B shares 1) .

Principal work experience and other information: Founder of Europolitan Vodafone AB, where he was the Chairman of the Board 1990–2005. Previous positions at Spectra-Physics AB as President and CEO and at Ericsson Radio Systems AB. Member of the Royal Swedish Academy of Engineering Sciences.

The Board memberships and holdings in Ericsson reported above are as of December 31, 2016.

 

1) The number of shares includes holdings by related persons, as well as holdings of any ADS, if applicable.
2) Since 2008, the AGM has each year resolved that part of the Board fee may be received in the form of synthetic shares. A synthetic share is a right to receive in the future a payment corresponding to the value of the Class B share in Ericsson at the time of payment. Please see page 114 for further information.

 

116


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

LOGO

Kristin Skogen Lund (first elected 2013)

Member of the Audit Committee

Born 1966. Master of Business Administration, INSEAD, France. Bachelor in International Studies and Business Administration, University of Oregon, USA.

Board Chairman: The Oslo Philharmonic Orchestra.

Holdings in Ericsson: 11,990 synthetic shares 2) .

Principal work experience and other information: Director General of the Confederation of Norwegian Enterprise (NHO) since 2012. Executive Vice President and Head of Digital Services and Broadcast and Executive Vice President and Head of Nordic Region, Group Executive Management at Telenor (2010–2012). Previous positions include Chief Executive Officer and Commercial Director at Aftenposten, Chief Executive Officer at Scanpix, Managing Director and Editor in Chief at Scandinavia Online, and several positions at the Coca-Cola Company, Unilever and Norges Eksportråd.

 

LOGO

Kristin S. Rinne (first elected 2016)

Born 1954. Bachelor of Arts, Washburn University, USA.

Board Member: None.

Holdings in Ericsson: 7,395 synthetic shares 2) .

Principal work experience and other information: Previously Senior Vice President, Network Technology, Network Architecture & Planning, at AT&T (2007–2014). CTO of Cingular Wireless (2005–2007) and VP Technology & New Product Development of Cingular Wireless (2000–2005). Previous positions within Southwestern Bell and SBC (1976–2000). Non-profit Board member of Curing Kids Cancer, Washburn University Foundation and Wycliffe Associates.

 

LOGO

Sukhinder Singh Cassidy (first elected 2015)

Member of the Remuneration Committee

Born 1970. Bachelor of Arts Degree in Honors Business Administration from the Richard Ivey School of Business, University of Western Ontario, Canada.

Board Chairman: Joyus.com.

Board Member: Tripadvisor LLC.

Holdings in Ericsson: 6,210 synthetic shares 2) .

Principal work experience and other information: Founder, CEO and Chairman of Joyus.com since 2011. Founder of Choose-Possibility Inc. (a benefit corporation focused on gender diversity in the tech industry). CEO of Polyvore, Inc. 2010, CEO-in-Residence of Accel Partners 2009–2010, senior executive positions with Google Inc., 2003–2009, including President, Asia-Pacific and Latin America Sales & Operations, Vice President Asia-Pacific and Latin America, and General Manager, Local Search & Content Partnerships. Previous positions with Yodlee.com, Amazon.com, British Sky Broadcasting Group and Merrill Lynch.

The Board memberships and holdings in Ericsson reported above are as of December 31, 2016.

 

1) The number of shares includes holdings by related persons, as well as holdings of any ADS, if applicable.
2) Since 2008, the AGM has each year resolved that part of the Board fee may be received in the form of synthetic shares. A synthetic share is a right to receive in the future a payment corresponding to the value of the Class B share in Ericsson at the time of payment. Please see page 114 for further information.

 

117


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Board members and deputies appointed by the trade unions

 

LOGO

Pehr Claesson (first appointed 2008)

Employee representative, Member of the Finance Committee

Born 1966. Appointed by the union The Swedish Association of Graduate Engineers.

Holdings in Ericsson: 2,955 Class B shares 1) .

Employed since 1997. Has currently an industry marketing position within Group Function Marketing and Communications, IT & Cloud.

 

LOGO

Mikael Lännqvist (first appointed 2015)

Employee representative, Member of the Audit Committee

Born 1969. Appointed by the union IF Metall.

Holdings in Ericsson: 1,552 Class B shares 1) .

Employed since 1995. Working as Analysis Technician within Business Unit Network Products.

 

LOGO

Karin Åberg (first appointed 2007)

Employee representative, Member of the Remuneration Committee

Born 1959. Appointed by the union Unionen.

Holdings in Ericsson: 4,596 Class B shares 1) .

Employed since 1998. Working as a Service Engineer within the IT organization.

 

LOGO

Zlatko Hadzic (first appointed 2015)

Deputy employee representative

Born 1970. Appointed by the union IF Metall.

Holdings in Ericsson: None 1) .

Employed since 2010. Working as NPI Operator within Business Unit Network Products.

 

LOGO

Kjell-Åke Soting (first appointed 2016)

Deputy employee representative

Born 1963. Appointed by the union Unionen.

Holdings in Ericsson: 2,797 Class B shares 1) .

Employed since 1996. Working as EMS Manager within Business Unit Network Products

 

LOGO

Roger Svensson (first appointed 2011)

Deputy employee representative

Born 1971. Appointed by the union The Swedish Association of Graduate Engineers.

Holdings in Ericsson: 16,333 Class B shares 1) .

Employed since 1999. Working as Global Process Architect for Test within Business Unit Network Products.

 

 

Hans Vestberg was the only Director who held an operational management position at Ericsson in 2016. On July 25, 2016, Hans Vestberg left the Board. As of January 16, 2017, Börje Ekholm has been appointed President and CEO.

Roxanne S. Austin, Alexander Izosimov and Anders Nyrén left the Board in connection with the AGM 2016 and Helena Stjernholm and Kristin S. Rinne were elected new members of the Board at the AGM 2016.

 

1) The number of shares reflects ownership as of December 31, 2016 and includes holdings by related persons, as well as holdings of any ADS, if applicable.

 

118


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Management

The President/CEO and the Executive Leadership Team

The Board of Directors appoints the President and CEO and the Executive Vice Presidents. The President and CEO is responsible for the management of day-to-day operations and is supported by the other members of the Executive Leadership Team (ELT). The ELT members as of December 31, 2016, are presented on pages 123–127 together with the new CEO appointed as of January 16, 2017.

The role of the ELT is to:

 

   

Establish a strong corporate culture, a long-term vision and Group strategies and policies, all based on objectives stated by the Board.

 

   

Determine targets for operational units, allocate resources and monitor unit performance.

 

   

Secure operational excellence and realize global synergies through efficient organization of the Group.

During 2016, many new appointments to the ELT were made following the re-organization effective July 1, 2016. During 2016, the ELT had a great focus on strategy execution and on ensuring due implementation of the re-organization throughout Ericsson. Execution of the cost-efficiency program has also been a prioritized area.

Remuneration to the Executive Leadership Team

Guidelines for remuneration to the ELT were approved by the AGM 2016. For further information on fixed and variable remuneration, see the Remuneration Report and Notes to the consolidated financial statements – Note C28, “Information regarding members of the Board of Directors, the Group management and employees” in the Annual Report.

The Ericsson Group Management System

Ericsson has one global management system, known as the Ericsson Group Management System (EGMS) to drive corporate culture and to ensure that the business is managed:

 

   

To fulfill the objectives of Ericsson’s major stakeholders (customers, shareholders, employees).

 

   

Within established risk limits and with reliable internal control.

 

   

In compliance with relevant applicable laws, listing requirements, governance codes and corporate responsibilities.

The EGMS is a framework consisting of rules and requirements for Ericsson’s business, specified through process and organization descriptions, policies, directives and instructions. The management system is applied in all Ericsson’s operations globally, and its consistency and global reach is designed to build trust in the way Ericsson works. The EGMS is founded on ISO 9001 (international standard for quality management systems) but is designed as a dynamic governance system, enabling Ericsson to adapt the system to evolving demands and expectations, including new legislation as well as customers’ and other stakeholders’ requirements. Ericsson does not implement external requirements without analyzing them and putting them into the Ericsson context.

The EGMS comprises three elements:

 

   

Management and control

 

   

Ericsson business processes

 

   

Organization and resources.

 

 

LOGO

Management and control

Ericsson’s strategy and target-setting processes consider the demands and expectations of customers as well as other key stakeholders. Ericsson uses balanced scorecards as tools for translating strategic objectives into a set of performance indicators for its operational units. Based on annual strategy work, these scorecards are updated with targets for each unit for the next year and are communicated throughout the organization.

Group-wide policies and directives govern how the organization works and are core elements in managing and controlling Ericsson. The Group Policies and Directives include, among other things, a Code of Business Ethics, a Code of Conduct and accounting and reporting directives to fulfill external reporting requirements.

 

119


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Ericsson has a Group Steering Documents Committee for purposes of aligning policies and directives with Group strategies, values and structures.

Ericsson business processes

As a market leader, Ericsson utilizes the competitive advantages that are gained through global scale and has implemented common processes and IT tools across all operational units worldwide. Customer requirements are identified, clarified and formalized in Ericsson Business Processes where requirements transform from theory to practice. Ericsson attempts to reduce costs with efficient and effective process flows and with standardized internal controls and performance indicators.

Organization and resources

Ericsson is operated in two dimensions: one operational structure and one legal structure. The operational structure aligns accountability and authority regardless of country borders and supports the process flows with cross-country operations. In the operational structure, Ericsson is organized in group functions, segments, business units, customer groups and regions. The legal structure is the basis for legal requirements and responsibility as well as for tax and statutory reporting purposes. There are more than 200 legal entities within the Ericsson Group with approximately 80 branch offices with representation (via legal entities, branch and representative offices) in more than 150 countries.

Chief Compliance Officer

Ericsson has a Chief Compliance Officer (CCO), reporting to the Chief Legal Officer. The CCO’s responsibilities among other things include to further develop Ericsson’s anti-corruption program and the CCO regularly reports to the Audit Committee. Attention from senior-management level on anti-corruption and compliance is crucial, as is ensuring that these matters are addressed from a cross-functional perspective. Ericsson’s anti-corruption program is reviewed and evaluated by the Audit Committee at least annually.

Audits, assessments and certification

The purpose of audits and assessments is to determine levels of compliance and to provide valuable information for understanding, analyzing and continually improving performance. Management monitors compliance with policies, directives and processes through internal self-assessment within all units. This is complemented by internal and external audits.

Due to demands and requirements from customers and other external stakeholders, Ericsson sometimes needs to take decisions on certification in order to stay competitive in the market. Certification means that Ericsson’s interpretation of standards or requirements are confirmed by a third-party assessment.

As the EGMS is a global system, group-wide certificates are issued by a third-party certification body proving that the system is efficient throughout the whole organization. Ericsson is currently globally certified to ISO 9001 (Quality), ISO 14001 (Environment) and OHSAS 18001 (Health & Safety). Selected Ericsson units are also certified to additional standards, for example ISO 27001 (Information Security) and TL 9000 (telecom-specific standard). EGMS is also audited within the scope of the audit plan of Ericsson’s internal audit function.

Ericsson’s external financial audits are performed by PricewaterhouseCoopers, and ISO/ management system audits are performed by EY. Internal audits are performed by the company’s internal audit function which reports to the Audit Committee.

Ericsson conducts audits of suppliers in order to secure compliance with Ericsson’s Code of Conduct, which includes rules that suppliers to the Ericsson Group must comply with.

Risk management

Ericsson’s risk management is integrated into the operational processes of the business, and is a part of the EGMS to ensure accountability, effectiveness, efficiency, business continuity and compliance with corporate governance, legal and other requirements. The Board of Directors also oversees the Company’s risk management. Risks related to long-term objectives for Ericsson’s business units and customer groups are discussed and strategies are formally approved by the Board as part of the annual strategy process. Risks related to annual targets for the Company are also reviewed by the Board and then monitored continuously during the year. Certain transactional risks require specific Board approval, e.g. acquisitions, divestments management remuneration, borrowing or customer finance in excess of pre-defined limits.

Operational, financial and compliance risks

Operational and financial risk

Operational risks are owned and managed by operational units. Risk management is embedded in various process controls, such as decision tollgates and approvals. Certain cross-process risks are centrally coordinated, such as information security, IT security, corporate responsibility and business continuity and insurable risks. Financial risk management is governed by a Group policy and carried out by the Treasury and Customer Finance functions, both supervised by the Finance Committee. The policy governs risk exposures related to foreign exchange, liquidity/financing, interest rates, credit risk and market price risk in equity instruments.

 

120


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

For further information on financial risk management, see Notes to the consolidated financial statements – Note C14, “Trade receivables and customer finance,” Note C19, “Interest-bearing liabilities” and Note C20, “Financial risk management and financial instruments” in the Annual Report.

Compliance risks

Ericsson has implemented Group policies and directives in order to comply with applicable laws and regulations, as well as its Code of Business Ethics and Code of Conduct. Risk management is integrated in the Company’s business processes. Policies and controls are implemented to comply with financial reporting standards and stock market regulations.

Risk mitigation

Examples of significant activities to mitigate risks are:

 

   

Conducting regular supplier Code of Conduct audits

 

   

Continuously assessing and managing risks relating to Corporate Responsibility including anti-corruption

 

   

Conducting business continuity management in an efficient way

 

   

Continuously monitoring information systems to guard against data breaches

 

   

Reviewing top risks and mitigating actions in regular monthly reporting and at various internal governance meetings

Strategic and tactical risks

Strategic risks constitute the highest risk to the Company if not managed properly as they could have a long-term impact. Ericsson therefore reviews its long-term objectives, main strategies and business scope on an annual basis and continuously works on its tactics to reach these objectives and to mitigate any risks identified.

Objectives are set for three to five years in the annual strategy process and for one year in the target setting process. Risks are assessed and strategies are developed to achieve the objectives. The strategy process in the Company is well established and involves regions, business units, customer groups and group functions. The strategy is summarized and discussed in a yearly Leadership Summit with approximately 300 leaders from all parts of the business attending. By involving all parts of the business in the process, potential risks are identified early and mitigating actions can be incorporated in the strategy and in the annual target-setting process following the finalization of the strategy.

Key components in the evaluation of risk related to Ericsson’s long-term objectives include for example technology development, cyber security related matters, industry and market fundamentals, the development of the economy, the political and international environment, health and environmental aspects and laws and regulations.

The outcome of the strategy process forms the basis for the annual target-setting process,

 

 

LOGO

 

121


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

which involves regions, business units, customer groups and group functions. Risks related to the targets are identified as part of this process together with actions to mitigate the identified risks. Follow-up of targets, risks and mitigating actions are reported and discussed continuously in internal governance meetings and are reviewed by the Board of Directors.

Ericsson continuously strives to improve its risk management and believes that it is important that the entire global organization takes part in the risk management and strategy work. For more information on risks related to Ericsson’s business, see the chapter “Risk factors” in the Annual Report.

 

LOGO

Example of risk heat map document

Risk heat maps are generated by business units, regions and Group functions in four risk categories:

 

   

Industry & market

 

   

Commercial

 

   

Operational

 

   

Compliance

 

 

LOGO

 

122


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Members of the Executive Leadership Team

 

LOGO

Börje Ekholm

President and CEO since January 16, 2017

Born 1963. Master of Science in Electrical Engineering, KTH Royal Institute of Technology, Stockholm, Sweden. Master of Business Administration, INSEAD, France.

Board Chairman: NASDAQ OMX Group Inc. and KTH Royal Institute of Technology

Board Member: Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson, Alibaba, Inc. and Trimble Inc.

Holdings in Ericsson: 1,030,760 Class B shares 1) , 2,000,000 call options, and 43,679 synthetic shares.

Background: President and CEO of Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson since January 16, 2017. CEO of Patricia Industries, a division within Investor AB (2015 – January 15, 2017). President and CEO of Investor AB (2005–2015). Formerly Head of Investor Growth Capital Inc. and New Investments. Previous positions at Novare Kapital AB and McKinsey & Co Inc. Member of the Board of Trustees of Choate Rosemary Hall.

 

LOGO

Jan Frykhammar

Executive Vice President and Advisor to the CEO (since January 16, 2017) and President and CEO (July 25, 2016 – January 15, 2017) and Head of Segment Networks (July 25, 2016 – December 31, 2016)

Born 1965. Bachelor of Business Administration and Economics, University of Uppsala, Sweden.

Board Member: Attendo AB, Confederation of Swedish Enterprises, the Swedish International Chamber of Commerce and Teknikföretagen.

Holdings in Ericsson: 1) 62,340 Class B shares.

Background: Executive Vice President and Head of Group Function Finance (2009–2016). Previously Senior Vice President and Head of Business Unit Global Services. Various previous positions within Ericsson including Sales and Business Control in Business Unit Global Services, CFO in North America and Vice President, Finance and Commercial within the Global Customer Account Vodafone.

 

LOGO

Magnus Mandersson

Executive Vice President (since 2011), Advisor to the CEO (since July 1, 2016) and Head of Segment and Business Unit Global Services (2010–December 31, 2016)

Born 1959. Bachelor of Business Administration, University of Lund, Sweden.

Board Member: Lund University and the Supervisory Council of Interogo Foundation.

Holdings in Ericsson: 1) 53,920 Class B shares.

Background: Head of Business Unit Global Services (2010–2016). Previously Head of Business Unit CDMA, Market Unit Northern Europe, Global Customer Account Deutsche Telekom AG and Product Area Managed Services. Previously also President and CEO of SEC/Tele2 Europe and COO of Millicom International Cellular S.A.

 

LOGO

MajBritt Arfert

Acting Senior Vice President, Chief Human Resources Officer and Head of Group Function Human Resources (since November 15, 2016)

Born 1963. Bachelor of Human Resources, University of Gothenburg, Sweden.

Board Member: None.

Holdings in Ericsson: 1) 18,681 Class B shares.

Background: Head of Human Resources Ericsson Sweden since September 2015. Previously Vice President and Head of Human Resources Business Unit Support Solutions (2007–2015). Previous positions include various Human Resources positions, including Head of Human Resources for Sony Ericsson in Germany (2001–2004).

 

 

Changes in the Executive Leadership Team

Effective January 16, 2017, the Director Börje Ekholm was appointed new President and CEO of Ericsson replacing Jan Frykhammar who assumed the role on July 25, 2016, when the former President and CEO, Hans Vestberg, left his position. Effective January 16, 2017, Jan Frykhammar assumed the role as Executive Vice President and Advisor of the CEO .

Bina Chaurasia left her role as Chief Human Resources Officer and Head of Group Function Human Resources, effective November 15, 2016, and was replaced by MajBritt Arfert who has been acting in that role since that date.

Ulf Ewaldsson was appointed Chief Technology Officer and Head of Strategy on September 20, 2016, and former Chief Strategy Officer, Rima Qureshi was appointed Head of Region North America on July 1, 2016.

The Board memberships and Ericsson holdings reported above are as of December 31, 2016.

 

1) The number of shares includes holdings by related persons, as well as holdings of any ADS, if applicable.

 

123


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

LOGO

Arun Bansal

Senior Vice President and Head of Business Unit Network Products (since July 1, 2016)

Born 1968. Bachelor of Engineering (Electronics) University of Jiwaji and Postgraduate Diploma in Marketing, Indira Gandhi National Open University, India.

Board Member: OPCOM Cables Sdn Bhd, Malaysia.

Holdings in Ericsson: 1) 35,000 Class B shares.

Background: Previously Senior Vice President and Head of Business Unit Radio. Joined Ericsson in 1995 and has held various senior positions in the company, including Head of Region South East Asia and Oceania and Country Manager in Indonesia and Bangladesh.

 

LOGO

Per Borgklint

Senior Vice President, Chief Innovation Officer, Head of Business United Media (since July 1, 2016) and Head of Segment Support Solutions (2011–December 31, 2016)

Born 1972. Master of Science in Business Administration, Jönköping International Business School, Sweden.

Board Member: None.

Holdings in Ericsson: 1) 7,583 Class B shares.

Background: Senior Vice President and Head of Business Unit Support Solutions (2011–2016). Previously CEO of Net1 (Ice. net), Canal Plus Nordic and Versatel. Has also previously held several leading positions at Tele2.

 

LOGO

Ulf Ewaldsson

Senior Vice President, Chief Technology Officer, Head of Strategy and Head of Group Function Strategy and Technology (since September 20, 2016)

Born 1965. Master of Science in Engineering and Business Management, Linköping Institute of Technology, Sweden.

Board Member: KTH Royal Institute of Technology, Sweden, Assa Abloy AB, and TM Forum.

Holdings in Ericsson: 1) 44,421 Class B shares.

Background: Chief Technology Officer and Head of Group Function Technology (2012 – September 19, 2016). Joined Ericsson in 1990 and has held various managerial positions within Ericsson, including Head of Product Area Radio within Business Unit Networks. Member of the European Cloud Partnership Steering Board.

 

LOGO

Niklas Heuveldop

Senior Vice President, Chief Customer Officer and Head of Group Function Sales (since July 1, 2016)

Born 1968. Master of Science in Industrial Engineering and Management, the Linköping Institute of Technology, Sweden.

Board Member: The Swedish-American Chamber of Commerce New York.

Holdings in Ericsson: 1) 8,241 Class B shares.

Background: Previous positions include Head of Global Customer Unit AT&T and a series of senior leadership positions across Ericsson, including Head of Market Unit Central America and Caribbean. Previously CEO of ServiceFactory and COO of WaterCove Networks.

 

 

Mats H. Olsson (former Head of Ericsson Asia-Pacific) left ELT on May 18, 2017. In connection with the re-organization, effective July 1, 2016, the following former ELT members left the ELT: Angel Ruiz (former Head of Region North America), Anders Thulin (former Chief Information Officer and Head of Group Function Business Excellence and Common Functions) and Jan Wäreby (former Head of Group Function Sales).

In connection with the announcement of the appointment of Börje Ekholm as new President and CEO of Ericsson, Investor AB and AB Industrivärden, shareholders in Ericsson, announced that both companies were to enter into an option agreement with Börje Ekholm on market terms (valuation conducted, using the Black & Scholes model, by an independent third party) under which each of them would issue 1,000,000 call options to Börje Ekholm. Under these agreements, Börje Ekholm has purchased in total 2,000,000 call options issued by the shareholders, for a purchase price of SEK 0.49 per call option. Each call option entitles the purchase of one Ericsson B share from the shareholders at a strike price of SEK 80 per share during one year after a seven-year period. See Notes to the consolidated financial statements – Note C28 “Information regarding members of the Board of Directors, the Group management and employees” in the Annual Report for further information.

The Board memberships and Ericsson holdings reported above are as of December 31, 2016.

 

1) The number of shares includes holdings by related persons, as well as holdings of any ADS, if applicable.

 

124


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Members of the Executive Leadership Team, cont.

 

LOGO

Chris Houghton

Senior Vice President and Head of Region North East Asia (since August 2015)

Born 1966. Bachelor of Law, Huddersfield Polytechnic, England.

Board Member: None.

Holdings in Ericsson: 1) 21,584 Class B shares.

Background: Previously Head of Region India and Head of Customer Unit UK and Ireland. Has also previously held management positions within Ericsson in China, Hungary, India, Ireland, Japan, Sweden and the UK.

 

LOGO

Fredrik Jejdling

Senior Vice President and Head of Business Unit Network Services (since July 1, 2016)

Born 1969. Master of Science in Economics and Business Administration, Stockholm School of Economics, Sweden.

Board Member: None.

Holdings in Ericsson: 1) 8,989 Class B shares.

Background: Previously Head of Region Sub-Saharan Africa. Has held a variety of positions in commercial operations and financials, including Head of Region India, and Head of Sales and Finance for Business Unit Global Services. Previous positions include senior positions with LUX Asia Pacific and Tele2 Group.

 

LOGO

Anders Lindblad

Senior Vice President and Head of Business Unit IT & Cloud Products (since July 1, 2016)

Born 1968. Master of Science in Industrial Engineering and Management, Linköping University, Sweden.

Board Member: LUISS Business School, Rome, Italy.

Holdings in Ericsson: 1) 30,766 Class B shares.

Background: Previously Senior Vice President and Head of Business Unit Cloud & IP, and Head of Region Middle East. Has held a variety of international positions in business development and commercial operations. Has previously served as a fighter pilot and air force engineer in the Swedish Air Force.

 

LOGO

Nina Macpherson

Senior Vice President, Chief Legal Officer, Head of Group Function Legal Affairs and secretary to the Board of Directors (since 2011)

Born 1958. Master of Laws, LL.M., University of Stockholm, Sweden.

Board Member: The Association for Swedish Listed Companies and the Arbitration Institute of the Stockholm Chamber of Commerce (SCC).

Holdings in Ericsson: 1) 33,375 Class B shares.

Background: Previously Vice President and Deputy Head of Group Function Legal Affairs at Ericsson. Previous positions also include private practice and in-house attorney. Member of the Swedish Securities Council.

The Board memberships and Ericsson holdings reported above are as of December 31, 2016.

 

1) The number of shares includes holdings by related persons, as well as holdings of any ADS, if applicable.

 

125


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

LOGO

Carl Mellander

Acting Chief Financial Officer and Head of Group Function Finance and Common Functions (since July 25, 2016)

Born 1964. Bachelor of Business Administration and Economics, University of Stockholm, Sweden.

Board Member: Swedish Association of Corporate Treasurers.

Holdings in Ericsson: 1) 22,127 Class B shares.

Background: Previously Vice President and Head of Treasury at Ericsson. Has previously held various positions within finance and business control within Ericsson, including Head of Finance in Region Western and Central Europe (2010–2015), and prior to that Head of Finance for Market Unit Northern Europe.

 

LOGO

Helena Norrman

Senior Vice President, Chief Marketing and Communications Officer and Head of Group Function Marketing and Communications (since 2014)

Born 1970. Master of International Business Administration, Linköping University, Sweden.

Board Member: None.

Holdings in Ericsson: 1) 29,588 Class B shares.

Background: Senior Vice President and Head of Group Function Communications (2011–2014). Previously Vice President, Communications Operations at Group Function Communications. Has held various positions within Ericsson’s global communications organization since 1998. Previous positions as communications consultant.

 

LOGO

Jean-Philippe Poirault

Senior Vice President and Head of Business Unit IT & Cloud Services (since July 1, 2016)

Born 1965. Master’s degrees from École supérieure d’électricité (CentraleSupelec Group) and ESTP Paris, France.

Board Member: None.

Holdings in Ericsson: 1) 1,406 Class B shares.

Background: Previously Head of Consulting and Systems Integration, Business Unit Global Services, and Head of Strategy & Portfolio Innovation. Prior to joining Ericsson in 2011, President of Alcatel-Lucent’s Multimedia, IT and Telecom Service Business Unit.

 

LOGO

Rima Qureshi

Senior Vice President and Head of Region North America (since July 1, 2016)

Born 1965. Bachelor of Information Systems and Master of Business Administration, McGill University, Montreal, Canada.

Board Member: MasterCard Incorporated and Great-West Lifeco Inc.

Holdings in Ericsson: 1) 15,165 Class B shares.

Background: Previously Chief Strategy Officer and Head of Group Function Strategy (2014 September 19, 2016). Has held various positions within Ericsson since 1993 including Senior Vice President Strategic Projects (2013–2014), and Head of Business Unit CDMA Mobile Systems (2010–2012).

The Board memberships and Ericsson holdings reported above are as of December 31, 2016.

 

1) The number of shares includes holdings by related persons, as well as holdings of any ADS, if applicable.

 

126


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Members of the Executive Leadership Team, cont.

 

LOGO

Charlotta Sund

Senior Vice President and Head of Customer Group Industry and Society (since July 1, 2016)

Born 1963. Master of Science in Industrial Engineering and Management from the the Institute of Technology, Linköping University, Sweden.

Board Member: None.

Holdings in Ericsson: 1) 9,600 Class B shares.

Background: Previously Head of Region Northern Europe and Central Asia. Has held a variety of positions within Ericsson, including Head of Customer Unit Industry and Society, Region Northern Europe and Central Asia, and Vice President and Head of Multimedia & Systems Integration, Market Unit Nordic and Baltics.

 

LOGO

Elaine Weidman-Grunewald

Senior Vice President, Chief Sustainability Officer and Head of Group Function Sustainability and Corporate Responsibility (since July 1, 2016)

Born 1967. Double Master’s degree in Resource and Environmental Management and International Relations, Boston University Center for Energy and Environmental Studies in the US.

Board Member: Millennium Promise.

Holdings in Ericsson: 1) 8,997 Class B shares.

Background: Head of Sustainability and Corporate Responsibility and held various positions in this field at Ericsson since 2005. Joined Ericsson in 1998 and has previously held positions in product management, marketing and sales in the US and Sweden. Prior to joining Ericsson, she worked in international sales, business development and environmental certification.

The Board memberships and Ericsson holdings reported above are as of December 31, 2016.

 

1) The number of shares includes holdings by related persons, as well as holdings of any ADS, if applicable.

Auditor

According to the Articles of Association, the Parent Company shall have no less than one and no more than three registered public accounting firms as external independent auditor. Ericsson’s auditor is currently elected each year at the AGM pursuant to the Swedish Companies Act for a one-year mandate period. The auditor reports to the shareholders at General Meetings.

The duties of the auditor include:

 

   

Updating the Board of Directors regarding the planning, scope and content of the annual audit work

 

   

Reviewing the interim reports to assess that the financial statements are presented fairly in all material respects and providing review opinions over the interim reports for the third and fourth quarters and the year-end financial statements

 

   

Reviewing and providing an audit opinion over the Annual Report

 

   

Advising the Board of Directors of non-audit services performed, the consideration paid and other issues that determine the auditor’s independence.

Auditing work is carried out by the auditor continuously throughout the year. For further information on the contacts between the Board and the auditor, please see “Work of the Board of Directors” earlier in this Corporate Governance Report.

Current auditor

PricewaterhouseCoopers AB was elected auditor at the AGM 2016 for a period of one year, i.e. until the close of the AGM 2017.

PricewaterhouseCoopers AB has appointed Bo Hjalmarsson, Authorized Public Accountant, to serve as auditor in charge. Bo Hjalmarsson is also auditor in charge in SAS AB and SAAB AB.

Fees to the auditor

Ericsson paid the fees (including expenses) for audit-related and other services listed in the table in Notes to the consolidated financial statements—Note C30, “Fees to auditors” in the Annual Report.

 

 

127


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Internal control over financial reporting 2016

This section has been prepared in accordance with the Annual Accounts Act and the Swedish Corporate Governance Code and is limited to internal control over financial reporting.

Since Ericsson is listed in the United States, the requirements outlined in the Sarbanes-Oxley Act (SOX) apply, subject to certain exceptions. These regulate the establishment and maintenance of internal control over financial reporting as well as management’s assessment of the effectiveness of the controls.

In order to support high-quality reporting and to meet the requirement of SOX, the Company has implemented detailed documented controls and testing and reporting procedures based on the internationally established 2013 COSO framework for internal control. The COSO framework is issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO).

Management’s internal control report according to SOX will be included in Ericsson’s Annual Report on Form 20-F and filed with the SEC in the United States.

Disclosure policies

Ericsson’s financial reporting and disclosure policies aim to ensure transparent, relevant and consistent communication with equity and debt investors on a timely, fair and equal basis. This will support a fair market value for Ericsson securities. Ericsson wants current and potential investors to have a good understanding of how the Company works, including operational performance, prospects and potential risks.

To achieve these objectives, financial reporting and disclosure must be:

 

   

Transparent—enhancing understanding of the economic drivers and operational performance of the business, building trust and credibility.

 

   

Consistent—comparable in scope and level of detail to facilitate comparison between reporting periods.

 

   

Simple—to support understanding of business operations and performance and to avoid misinterpretations.

 

   

Relevant—with focus on what is relevant to Ericsson’s stakeholders or required by regulation or listing agreements, to avoid information overload.

 

   

Timely—with regularly scheduled disclosures as well as ad-hoc information, such as press releases on important events, performed in a timely manner.

 

   

Fair and equal—where all material information is published via press releases to ensure that the whole investor community receives the information at the same time.

 

   

Complete, free from material errors and a reflection of best practice – disclosures compliant with applicable financial reporting standards and listing requirements and in line with industry norms.

Ericsson’s website comprises comprehensive information on the Group, including:

 

   

An archive of annual and interim reports.

 

   

Access to recent news.

Disclosure controls and procedures

Ericsson has controls and procedures in place to allow for timely disclosure in accordance with applicable laws and regulations, including the US Securities Exchange Act of 1934, and under agreements with Nasdaq Stockholm and NASDAQ New York. These procedures also require that such information is provided to management, including the CEO and the CFO, so timely decisions can be made regarding required disclosure.

The Disclosure Committee comprises members with various expertise. It assists management in fulfilling their responsibility regarding disclosures made to the shareholders and the investment community. One of the main tasks of the committee is to monitor the integrity and effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures.

Ericsson has investments in certain entities that the Company does not control or manage. With respect to such entities, disclosure controls and procedures are substantially more limited than those maintained with respect to subsidiaries.

Ericsson’s President and CEO and the CFO evaluated the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures and concluded that they were effective at a reasonable assurance level as of December 31, 2016. Any controls and procedures, no matter how well designed and operated, can provide only reasonable assurance of achieving the desired control objectives.

Internal control over financial reporting

Ericsson has integrated risk management and internal control into its business processes. As defined in the COSO framework, internal control is an aggregation of components such as a control environment, risk assessment, control activities, information and communication and monitoring.

During the period covered by the Annual Report 2016, there were no changes to the internal control over financial reporting that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, the internal control over financial reporting.

Control environment

The Company’s internal control structure is based on the division of tasks between the Board of Directors and its Committees and the President and CEO. The Company has implemented a management system that is based on:

 

   

Steering documents, such as policies, directives and a Code of Business Ethics.

 

   

A strong corporate culture.

 

   

The Company’s organization and mode of operations, with well-defined roles and responsibilities and delegations of authority.

 

   

Several well-defined Group-wide processes for planning, operations and support.

 

128


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

The most essential parts of the control environment relative to financial reporting are included in steering documents and processes for accounting and financial reporting. These steering documents are updated regularly to include, among other things:

 

   

Changes to laws.

 

   

Financial reporting standards and listing requirements, such as IFRS and SOX.

The processes include specific controls to be performed to ensure high-quality financial reports. The management of each reporting legal entity, region and business unit is supported by a financial controller function with execution of controls related to transactions and reporting. The financial controller functions are organized in a number of Company Control Hubs, each supporting a number of legal entities within a geographical area. A financial controller function is also established on Group level, reporting to the CFO.

Risk assessment

Risks of material misstatements in financial reporting may exist in relation to recognition and measurement of assets, liabilities, revenue and cost or insufficient disclosure. Other risks related to financial reporting include fraud, loss or embezzlement of assets and undue favorable treatment of counterparties at the expense of the Company.

Policies and directives regarding accounting and financial reporting cover areas of particular significance to support correct, complete and timely accounting, reporting and disclosure.

Identified types of risks are mitigated through well-defined business processes with integrated risk management activities, segregation of duties and appropriate delegation of authority. This requires specific approval of material transactions and ensures adequate asset management.

Control activities

The Company’s business processes include financial controls regarding the approval and accounting of business transactions. The financial closing and reporting process has controls regarding recognition, measurement and disclosure. These include the application of critical accounting policies and estimates, in individual subsidiaries as well as in the consolidated accounts.

Regular analyses of the financial results for each subsidiary, region and business unit cover the significant elements of assets, liabilities, revenues, costs and cash flow. Together with further analysis of the consolidated financial statements performed at Group level, these procedures are designed to produce financial reports without material errors.

For external financial reporting purposes, the Disclosure Committee performs additional control procedures to review whether the disclosure requirements are fulfilled.

The Company has implemented controls to ensure that financial reports are prepared in accordance with its internal accounting and reporting policies and IFRS as well as with relevant listing regulations. It maintains detailed documentation on internal controls related to accounting and financial reporting. It also keeps records on the monitoring of the execution and results of such controls. This allows the President and CEO and the CFO to assess the effectiveness of the controls in a way that is compliant with SOX.

Entity-wide controls, focusing on the control environment and compliance with financial reporting policies and directives, are implemented in all subsidiaries. Detailed process controls and documentation of controls performed are also implemented in almost all subsidiaries, covering the items with significant materiality and risk.

In order to secure compliance, governance and risk management in the areas of legal entity accounting and taxation, as well as securing funding and equity levels, the Company operates through a Company Control hub structure, covering subsidiaries in each respective geographical area. During 2016, the Company further developed its internal control function within Group Function Finance, Financial Control to cover a wider scope than previously.

Based on a common IT platform, a common chart of account and common master data, the hubs and shared services centers perform accounting and financial reporting services for most subsidiaries.

Information and communication

The Company’s information and communication channels support complete, correct and timely financial reporting by making all relevant internal process instructions and policies accessible to all the employees concerned. Regular updates and briefing documents regarding changes in accounting policies, reporting and disclosure requirements are also supplied.

Subsidiaries and operating units prepare regular financial and management reports for internal steering groups and Company management. These include analysis and comments on financial performance and risks. The Board of Directors receives financial reports monthly. Ericsson has established a whistleblower tool, Ericsson Compliance Line, that can be used for the reporting of alleged violations that:

 

   

are conducted by Group or local management, and

 

   

relate to corruption, questionable accounting or auditing matters or otherwise seriously affect vital interests of the Group or personal health and safety.

Monitoring

The Company’s process for financial reporting is reviewed annually by management. This forms a basis for evaluating the internal management system and internal steering documents to ensure that they cover all significant areas related to financial reporting. The shared

 

129


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

service center and Company Control hub management continuously monitor accounting quality through a set of performance indicators. Compliance with policies and directives is monitored through annual self-assessments and representation letters from heads and company controllers in subsidiaries as well as in business units and regions.

The Company’s financial performance is also reviewed at each Board meeting. The Committees of the Board fulfill important monitoring functions regarding remuneration, borrowing, investments, customer finance, cash management, financial reporting and internal control. The Audit Committee and the Board of Directors review all interim and annual financial reports before they are released to the market. The Company’s internal audit function reports directly to the Audit Committee. The Audit Committee also receives regular reports from the external auditor. The Audit Committee follows up on any actions taken to improve or modify controls.

Board of Directors

Stockholm, February 24, 2017

Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson (publ)

Org. no. 556016-0680

 

130


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

REMUNERATION REPORT

Introduction

This report outlines how the remuneration policy is implemented throughout Ericsson in line with corporate governance best practice, with specific references to Group management.

The work of the Remuneration Committee in 2016 and the remuneration policy are explained below, followed by descriptions of plans and their outcomes.

More details on the remuneration of Group management and Board members’ fees can be found in the Notes to the Consolidated financial statements – Note C28, “Information regarding members of the Board of Directors, the Group management and employees” in the Annual Report.

Board member remuneration is resolved annually by the Annual General Meeting.

The Remuneration Committee

The Remuneration Committee (the Committee) advises the Board of Directors on the remuneration to the Group management, consisting of the Executive Leadership Team (ELT). This includes fixed salaries, pensions, other benefits and short-and long-term variable compensation. The Committee reviews and prepares for resolution by the Board:

 

   

Proposals on salary and other remuneration, including retirement compensation, for the President and CEO.

 

   

Proposals to the Annual General Meeting on guidelines for remuneration to the ELT.

 

   

Proposals to the Annual General Meeting on long-term variable compensation and equity arrangements.

The responsibility of the Committee is also to:

 

   

Approve proposals on salary and other remuneration, including retirement compensation, for the ELT members.

 

   

Approve proposals on targets for the short-term variable compensation (STV) for the ELT members. The new President & CEO, Börje Ekholm, does not have any short-term variable compensation.

 

   

Approve payout of the short-term variable compensation for the ELT, based on achievements and performance.

The Committee’s work forms the foundation for the governance of Ericsson’s remuneration processes, together with Ericsson’s internal systems and audit controls. The Committee is chaired by Leif Johansson and its other members are Roxanne S. Austin and Karin Åberg. Börje Ekholm was a member of the Committee until his appointment as President and CEO effective January 16, 2017, at which point he left the Committee. All members are non-executive directors, independent (except for the employee representative) as required by the Swedish Corporate Governance Code and have relevant knowledge and experience of remuneration matters.

The Company’s Chief Legal Officer acts as secretary to the Committee. The President and CEO, the Senior Vice President, Head of Human Resources, the Vice President, Head of Total Rewards and the Head of Executive Remuneration attend Committee meetings by invitation and assist the Committee in its considerations. Nobody is present at the Committee´s meeting when issues relating to their own remuneration are being discussed.

The Committee used an independent expert advisor, Piia Pilv, to assist and advise in its work during 2016. The independent advisor provided no other services to the Company during 2016. At its final meeting in 2016, the Committee resolved to appoint Peter Boreham at Mercer as its independent advisor for 2017. The Committee is also furnished with national and international pay data collected from external survey providers and can call on other independent expertise, should it so require. The Chairman strives to ensure that contact is maintained, as necessary and appropriate, with shareholders regarding remuneration.

Further information on the Committee and its responsibilities can be found in the Corporate Governance Report. These responsibilities, together with the Guidelines for remuneration to Group management and the Long-Term Variable (LTV) compensation program is reviewed and evaluated annually in light of matters such as changes to corporate governance best practice or changes to accounting, legislation, political opinion or business practices among peers. This helps to ensure that the policy continues to provide Ericsson with a competitive remuneration strategy.

The Guidelines for remuneration to Group management are, in accordance with Swedish law, brought to shareholders annually for approval.

The Committee held seven meetings during 2016. The winter meetings focused on following up on results from the 2015 variable compensation programs and preparing proposals to shareholders for the 2016 Annual General Meeting (AGM). The Committee proposed to the Board of Directors to approve the LTV 2013 vesting result. During spring and summer, the Committee reviewed and approved the remuneration for a number of new appointments to the ELT as well as revised STV targets for the ELT. During fall, the Committee completed its annual overview of the global technology sector pay practices together with the independent

Remuneration policy

 

Remuneration at Ericsson is based on the principles of performance, competitiveness and fairness. The remuneration policy, together with the mix of remuneration elements, is designed to reflect these principles by creating a balanced remuneration package. The Guidelines for remuneration to Group management 2016, approved by the AGM, can be found in Note C28. The auditor’s report regarding whether the company has complied with the guidelines for remuneration to Group management during 2016 is posted on the Ericsson website.

 

131


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

advisor. As in previous years, the Committee concluded that Ericsson’s remuneration level is competitive but that the pay mix is more fixed in nature with larger emphasis on base salary compared to typical market practice in the US, Europe and Asia. In the high-tech industry, the prevalent long-term incentive vehicle is restricted shares (shares that vest based on time only) as retention and recognition continue to be the key drivers for plan design. Ericsson’s Long-Term Variable Compensation program (LTV) is the least competitive remuneration element in terms of design and levels in the total compensation package. The Committee has therefore worked to prepare a new long-term incentive arrangement for Ericsson’s Global Leadership Team (GLT) which is proposed for approval at the 2017 Annual General Meeting of shareholders. Towards the end of 2016, the Committee approved the CEO proposal for salary adjustments for the ELT and established the framework for the short-term targets for 2017.

Evaluation of the Guidelines for remuneration to Group management and of the LTV program

The Committee supports the Board with the review and evaluation of the Guidelines for remuneration to Group management and Ericsson’s application of these guidelines. The Committee and the Board have concluded that the guidelines remain valid and right for Ericsson and that the only change to the guidelines for 2017 shall be to allow the use of share-price related targets in the variable compensation programs.

The number of participants in the Stock Purchase Plan with the objective to promote employees to become shareholders were as of December 1, 2016 approximately 31,500 employees (34,000 as of December 1, 2015). The evaluation confirms that the Key Contributor Retention Plan meets the purpose of retaining the Company’s key employees. The voluntary attrition rate among Key Contributors is far smaller compared to the overall employee attrition rate. However, the Stock Purchase Plan has been criticized by the owners and after careful consideration the Committee concluded that the plan have an unsustainable share dilution effect. Therefore, the Committee recommended to the Board to not propose a new Stock Purchase Plan for 2017. Thereby the Executive Performance Stock Plan will also be obsolete as it is built on the Stock Purchase Plan. A new long-term incentive program for the GLT will be proposed for approval at the 2017 Annual General Meeting of shareholders. For other senior management and key contributors in Ericsson, cash-based arrangements will be developed.

Total remuneration in 2016

When considering the remuneration of an individual, it is the total remuneration that matters. First, the total annual cash compensation is defined, consisting of the target level of short-term variable compensation plus fixed salary. Thereafter, target long-term variable compensation is added to get to the total target compensation and, finally, pension and other benefits are added to arrive at the total remuneration.

For the ELT, remuneration consists of fixed salary, short-term and long-term variable compensation, pension and other benefits. If the size of any one of these elements is increased or decreased when setting the remuneration, at least one other element has to change if the total compensation is to remain unchanged.

The remuneration costs for the CEO and the ELT are reported in Note C28.

Fixed salary

When setting fixed salaries, the Committee considers the impact on total remuneration, including pensions and associated costs. The absolute levels are determined based on the size and complexity of the position and the year-on-year performance of the individual. Together with other elements of remuneration, ELT salaries are subject to an annual review by the Committee, which considers external pay data to ensure that levels of pay remain competitive and appropriate to the remuneration policy.

Variable compensation

Ericsson strongly believes that, where possible, variable compensation should be encouraged as an integral part of total remuneration. First and foremost, this aligns employees with clear and relevant targets, but it also enables more flexible payroll costs and emphasizes the link between performance and pay.

All variable compensation plans have maximum award and vesting limits. Short-term variable compensation is to a greater extent dependent on the performance of the specific unit or function, while long-term variable compensation is dependent on the achievements of the Ericsson Group.

Ericsson measures business performance according to five categories of measurements derived from the overall strategy: growing sales faster than the market, best-in-class operating margin, strong cash conversion, customer satisfaction and employee engagement. These categories have formed the basis for the short- and long-term variable compensation programs and have set the framework of what measurements shall be used for variable compensation.

 

LOGO

 

132


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Summaries of 2016 short- and long-term variable compensation

 

What we call it

 

What is it?

 

What is the objective?

 

Who participates?

  How is it earned?

Short-term: Compensation delivered over twelve months or less

Fixed salary   Fixed compensation paid at set times   Attract and retain employees, delivering part of annual compensation in a predictable format   All employees   Market appropriate levels
set according to position
and evaluated according
to individual
performance
Short-Term Variable compensation (STV)   A variable plan that is measured and paid over a single year   Align employees with clear and relevant targets, providing an earnings opportunity in return for performance, and flexible cost   Enrolled employees, including Executive Leadership Team. Approximately 82,800 in 2016   Achievements against set
targets. Reward can
increase to up to twice
the target level and
decrease to zero,
depending on
performance
Sales Incentive Plan (SIP)   Tailored versions of the STV   As for STV, tailored for local or business requirements, such as sales   Employees in sales. Approximately 2,800 in 2016   Similar to STV, but
reward can increase up to
three times the target
level depending on
performance. All plans
have maximum award
and vesting limits

Long-term: Compensation delivered over three years or more

Stock Purchase Plan (SPP)   All-employee share-based plan   Reinforce a “One Ericsson” mentality and align employees’ interests with those of shareholders   Where practicable, all employees are eligible   Buy one share and it will
be matched by one share
after three years if still
employed
Key Contributor Retention Plan (KC)   Share-based plan for selected individuals   Recognize, retain and motivate key contributors for performance, critical skills and potential   Up to 10% of employees   If selected, get one more
matching share in
addition to the SPP one
Executive Performance Stock Plan (EPSP)   Share-based plan for senior managers   Compensation for long-term commitment and value creation   Senior managers, including Executive Leadership Team   Subject to performance,
get up to four, six or, for
the former President and
CEO, nine further shares
matched to each SPP
share for long-term
performance

Short-term variable compensation

Annual variable compensation is delivered through cash-based programs. Specific business targets are derived from the annual business plan approved by the Board of Directors and, in turn, defined by the Company’s long-term strategy. Ericsson strives to grow faster than the market with best-in-class margins and strong cash conversion and therefore the starting point is to have three core targets:

 

   

Net sales

 

   

Operating income

 

   

Cash flow

For the ELT, targets are financial at either Group level (for Heads of Group functions and business units) or at the individual unit level (for Heads of regions or customer groups).

The chart on the previous page illustrates how payouts to the ELT have varied with performance over the past five years.

The Board of Directors decided on the financial targets for the former CEO (the new CEO does not have any short-term variable compensation), and the Committee decides on all targets which are set for the ELT. These targets are cascaded within the organization and broken down to unit-related targets throughout the Company. This is always subject to a two-level management approval process. The Committee monitors the appropriateness and fairness of Group target levels throughout the performance year and has the authority to revise them should they cease to be relevant or stretching or to enhance shareholder value.

During 2016, approximately 85,600 employees participated in short-term variable compensation plans.

Long-term variable compensation

Share-based long-term variable compensation plans have been submitted each year for approval by shareholders at the AGM.

All long-term variable compensation plans have been designed to form part of a well-balanced total remuneration package and to span over a minimum of three years. As these are variable plans, outcomes are unknown and rewards depend on long-term personal investment, corporate performance and the share price performance. During 2016, share-based compensation was made up of three different but linked plans: the all-employee Stock Purchase Plan, the Key Contributor Retention Plan and the Executive Performance Stock Plan.

The Stock Purchase Plan

The all-employee Stock Purchase Plan was designed to offer, where practicable, an incentive for all employees to participate. Employees can save up to 7.5% of gross fixed salary (the former President and CEO, Hans Vestberg, could save up to 10% of gross fixed salary and short-term variable compensation) for purchase of Class B shares at market price on Nasdaq Stockholm or ADSs on NASDAQ New York (Contribution Shares) over a twelve-month period. If the Contribution Shares are retained by the employee for three years after the investment and employment with the Ericsson Group continues during that time, then the Contribution Shares will be matched with a corresponding number of Class B shares or ADSs, as applicable. The plan was introduced in 2002 and employees in 71 countries participated during its first year. In December 2016, the number of participants was approximately 31,500, or approximately 29% of eligible employees in 100 countries.

Participants save each month, beginning with the August payroll, towards quarterly investments. These investments (in November, February, May and August) are matched on the third anniversary of each such investment and hence the matching spans over two financial years and two tax years.

For the reasons previously outlined, no Stock Purchase Plan is being proposed for 2017.

The Key Contributor Retention Plan

The Key Contributor Retention Plan has been part of Ericsson’s talent management strategy. It was designed to recognize individuals for performance, critical skills and potential as well as to encourage retention of key employees.

 

133


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Short-term variable compensation structure

 

     Short-term variable compensation
as percentage of fixed salary
    Percentage of short-term variable
compensation maximal opportunity
 
     Target
level
    Maximum
level
    Actual paid     Group financial
targets
    Unit/functional
financial targets
    Non-financial
targets
 

President and CEO 2015

     80     160     114     100     0     0

President and CEO 2016 1)

     80     160     0     100     0     0

Average ELT 2015 2)

     51     102     66     48     25     28

Average ELT 2016 2)

     41     83     7     88     13     0

 

1) This relates to Hans Vestberg. Jan Frykhammar, while serving as President and CEO, remained on his previous short-term variable compensation opportunity, and received no payout for the year.
2) Excludes the President and CEO, differences in target and maximum levels from year to year are typically due to changes in the composition of the ELT.

Under the program, operating units around the world could nominate up to 10% of employees worldwide. Each unit nominated individuals identified according to performance, critical skills and potential. The nominations were calibrated in management teams locally and were reviewed by both local and corporate Human Resources.

Participants selected obtain one extra matching share in addition to the one matching share for each contribution share purchased under the Stock Purchase Plan during a twelve-month investment period. The plan was introduced in 2004.

Since no Stock Purchase Plan will be proposed for 2017, alternative arrangements will be developed to replace the Key Contributor Plan.

The Executive Performance Stock Plan

The Executive Performance Stock Plan was first introduced in 2004. The plan was designed to focus management on driving long-term financial performance and to provide market-competitive remuneration. Senior managers, including the ELT, were selected to obtain up to four or six extra shares (performance-matching shares). This is in addition to the one matching share for each contribution share purchased under the all-employee Stock Purchase Plan. The former President and CEO, Hans Vestberg, could obtain up to nine performance-matching shares in addition to the Stock Purchase Plan matching share for each contribution share. Performance matching is subject to the fulfillment of performance targets.

To support the long-term strategy and value creation the following targets for the 2016 Executive Performance Stock Plan were resolved at the AGM on proposal by the Board:

 

   

Net Sales Growth: Up to one-third of the award will vest if the compound annual growth rate of consolidated net sales is between 2 and 6% comparing 2018 financial results to 2015.

 

   

Operating Income Growth: Up to one-third of the award will vest if the compound annual growth rate of consolidated operating income is between 5 and 15% comparing 2018 financial results to 2015. Extraordinary restructuring charges are excluded.

 

   

Cash Conversion: Up to one-third of the award will vest if cash conversion is at or above 70% during each of the years 2016–2018, vesting one ninth of the total award for each year the target is achieved. Extraordinary restructuring charges are excluded.

Before the number of performance shares to be matched are finally determined, the Board of Directors shall examine whether the performance matching is reasonable considering the Company’s financial results and position, conditions on the share market and other circumstances, and if not, as determined by the Board of Directors, reduce the number of performance shares to be matched to the lower number of shares deemed appropriate by the Board of Directors. When undertaking its evaluation of performance, the Board of Directors will consider, in particular, the impact of larger acquisitions, divestments, the creation of joint ventures and any other significant capital event on the three targets on a case-by-case basis.

Since no Stock Purchase Plan will be proposed for 2017, alternative arrangements will be developed to replace the Executive Performance Stock Plan. For the Global Leadership Team, a share-based arrangement is proposed for approval by the 2017 Annual General Meeting of shareholders. Details of the performance criteria for the new long-term incentive program are outlined in the 2017 notice of Annual General Meeting of shareholders.

Benefits and terms of employment

Pension benefits follow the competitive practice in the employee’s home country and may contain various supplementary plans, in addition to any national system for social security. Where possible, pension plans are operated on a defined contribution basis, i.e. Ericsson pays contributions but does not guarantee the ultimate benefit. This applies unless local regulations or legislation prescribe that defined benefit plans that do give such guarantees have to be offered.

For the former President and CEO, Hans Vestberg, and other members of the ELT employed in Sweden before 2011, a supplementary pension plan is applied in addition to the occupational pension plan for salaried staff on the Swedish labor market (ITP).

The ELT members employed in Sweden since 2011 are normally covered by the defined contribution plan under the ITP1 scheme.

For members of the ELT who are not employed in Sweden, local market competitive pension arrangements apply.

Other benefits, such as company cars and medical insurance, are also set to be competitive in the local market. The ELT members may not receive loans from the Company.

The ELT members locally employed in Sweden have a mutual notice period of up to six months. Upon termination of employment by the Company, severance pay can amount to up to 18 months’ fixed salary.

Remuneration policy in practice

Ericsson has taken a number of measures over the years to enhance the understanding of how the company translates remuneration principles and policy into practice. This includes the launch of an Integrated Human Resources IT tool, and providing e-learning and training programs to line managers. Since then, enhancements of the IT tool and continuous briefings of line managers on pay principles and their practical execution enabled further progress towards globally consistent principles while allowing room for adaptation to local legislation and pay markets.

 

134


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

SHAREHOLDERS – Ericsson and the capital market

ERICSSON AND THE CAPITAL MARKET

Purpose of the capital markets communications

Ericsson’s overall goal is to create shareholder value. The communication with the capital markets aims to support the Company’s overall goal by ensuring increased understanding and decreased share volatility through transparency and clear messages. The Investor Relations department serves as the bridge between the Company’s strategic planning , development and activities, and the external valuation and perception.

Goals and measurement

Surveys are carried out on a regular basis to gauge the perceptions of messages at capital markets days, the web site, road shows and the availability and credibility of the IR department and the executive management.

Ericsson aims to maintain a long-term relationship with its shareholders, and the IR department monitors shareholder turnover on a regular basis.

IR activities are linked to the Company strategy and development

Throughout the year, the IR department carries out a number of activities aiming at meeting the goals of transparent communication and increased understanding. There are about 600 IR meetings with investors and analysts every year. The IR department also participates in communications such as product launches, M&A-activities etc, to ensure that financial communication is clear and relevant for the capital markets.

Working with other functions in the company

While communication with the rating institutions primarily falls with Group function Treasury, the IR department is also involved on a regular basis.

As there is an existing US bond program, as well as a large shareholder base, Treasury and IR do a joint annual roadshow to meet bondholders in the US market.

Sustainability and Corporate Responsibility (SCR) is of increasing importance for many investors. IR is together with the Ericsson SCR function performing several activities in this area during the year, including presentations for stakeholders and one-on-one investor meetings at SRI (Socially Responsible Investment) focused conferences.

Activities at Industry events

The IR department also participates at important industry events such as the annual Mobile World Congress. The IR activities include communication relating to important Company news, but also setting up meetings between Company spokes-people and different stakeholders.

IR in Transformation

Ericsson is transforming from a leader in telecommunications and related services into a leader in the ICT arena.

Simultaneously, the stakeholders in the capital markets have also transformed in recent years; from industry-specialists focusing on the technology sector to generalists covering several sectors. It has become increasingly important for the financial communication to make it easy for stakeholders to make the connection between the Company’s activities and development and its long-term strategy, thus putting higher demands on clear messages.

With two thirds of Ericsson’s holdings outside of Sweden, the demand for availability at a global level also means working with other tools besides regular meetings, such as digital media.

 

LOGO

 

LOGO

Important activities during the year 2016 facilitated by IR

 

   

At the Mobile World Congress in Barcelona in February, Ericsson showcased 5G, Internet of Things and cloud innovation. Presentations and Q&A sessions were performed by management with investors and analysts.

 

   

At the Annual General Meeting of shareholders in April, the agenda included a strategy summary, a review of 2015, the Sustainability and Corporate Responsibility report, as well as an update on how Ericsson is leading the way toward 5G.

 

   

In September, CFO Carl Mellander and Group Treasurer Fredrik Wikner performed the annual US investor roadshow to meet share- and bondholders. Ericsson performed 28 investor roadshows in 2016.

 

135


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

LOGO

Important events during the year 2016

LOGO

 

 

 

   

In November, Ericsson held an Investor Update in New York with approximately 130 attending participants. For more information.

 

   

In November, Elaine Weidman-Grunewald, head of Sustainability and Corporate Responsibility, participated and had one-on-one meetings at an SRI (Socially Responsible Investment) investor conference in Paris.

 

   

CEO Jan Frykhammar and CFO Carl Mellander participated in meetings and made a presentation at an investor conference in Barcelona in November. Ericsson participated in 22 investor conferences during 2016.

 

136


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

INVESTORS AND FINANCIAL ANALYSTS Q&A

Was Ericsson surprised by the significant sales decline in 2016?

A macro-economic environment weaker than expected had an increasing negative effect on demand during the year in many emerging markets, leading to an unexpected market decline. In addition, delayed 4G spectrum auctions slowed down investments in India. Business in markets such as North America and mainland China have developed in line with plan.

What is Ericsson doing to improve the results?

Profitability has declined and is below Ericsson’s ambitions. There are three focus areas to drive incremental profit improvements; improve efficiency, monetize Networks and build success in IT & Cloud, Media and Industry and Society. The cost and efficiency program is tracking towards target and has been expanded to adjust the organization to lower sales volumes.

Is Ericsson losing market shares?

The ongoing large deployments in China, where Chinese vendors have a large market share, impacts the global market shares between vendors. The sales reduction in 2016 was driven by weaker demand in mobile broadband, especially in markets with weak macro-economic environment.

What is the situation in emerging markets?

In 2016, there was a challenging situation in markets impacted by weak macro-economic environment. The situation is likely to prevail in 2017 based on current visibility. Future sales development is depending on macro development in those countries. After a slowdown it normally takes time before investments start and activities are picking up.

Are the ongoing cost reductions enough for restoring profits?

Ericsson believes the actions are sufficient to increase profitability with current market conditions, but are always seeking further opportunities to reduce cost and increase efficiency.

There has been several articles in Swedish media on Ericsson in 2016, comments?

There have been continued reports in Swedish media concerning Ericsson. Ericsson has posted clarifying statements which are available on the Company’s website in order to give the correct company view.

https://www.ericsson.com/thecompany/press/ericsson-comments

Ericsson has a zero tolerance approach to corruption, and the Company has worked systematically over the years to continuously strengthen and improve its approach. By the end of 2016, over 95,900 employees have completed the anti-corruption e-learning launched in 2013.

Will recent headcount reductions impact future innovation and risk necessary R&D investments?

Ericsson is reducing the cost level in light of current market conditions, while safeguarding enough investments in R&D to secure leadership in future technologies such as 5G. The reduction also involves ways of working to increase productivity and get more value from every dollar invested in R&D.

US dollar has strengthened compared to several currencies, how has this impacted the result?

Compared to 2015, the USD strengthened with a positive impact when translating USD to SEK in the financial statements. However, the strengthened US dollar also had a negative impact on operator investments in several markets.

 

137


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

SHARE INFORMATION

Share trading

The Ericsson Class A and Class B shares are listed on Nasdaq Stockholm. In the United States, the Class B shares are listed on NASDAQ New York in the form of American Depositary Shares (ADS) evidenced by American Depositary Receipts (ADR) under the symbol ERIC. Each ADS represents one Class B share.

In 2016, approximately 3.0 (2.3) billion shares were traded on Nasdaq Stockholm and approximately 1.3 (0.9) billion ADS were traded in the United States (incl. NASDAQ New York). A total of 4.3 (3.2) billion Ericsson shares were thus traded on the exchanges in Stockholm and in the United States. Trading volume in Ericsson shares increased by approximately 29% on Nasdaq Stockholm and increased by approximately 38% in the United States compared to 2015. With the implementation of the Mifid directive in the EU, share trading has become increasingly fragmented across a number of venues and trading categories. Trading on MTFs and other venues has gained market shares from stock exchanges like Nasdaq Stockholm.

Trading in Stockholm represented 37 percent of total trading in 2016, compared with 37 percent in 2012. Total trading in Ericsson B on all venues combined has increased over the past five years from 6.6 billion shares in 2012 to 7.9 billion shares in 2016. Over the same period, trading of Ericsson ADS in the US has increased slightly from 1.1 billion ADS to 1.3 billion ADS.

 

LOGO

The Ericsson share

 

Share/ADS listings

  

Nasdaq Stockholm

  

NASDAQ New York

  

Share data

  

Total number of shares in issue

     3,331,151,735  

of which Class A shares, each carrying one vote 1)

     261,755,983  

of which Class B shares, each carrying one tenth of one vote 1)

     3,069,395,752  

Ericsson treasury shares, Class B

     62,192,390  

Quotient value

     SEK 5.00  

Market capitalization, December 31, 2016

     approx. SEK 178 billion  

ICB (Industry Classification Benchmark)

     9500  

 

1) Both classes of shares have the same rights of participation in the net assets and earnings.

 

Ticker codes

  

Nasdaq Stockholm

     ERIC A/ERIC B  

NASDAQ New York

     ERIC  

Bloomberg Nasdaq Stockholm

     ERICA SS/ERICB SS  

Bloomberg NASDAQ

     ERIC US  

Reuters Nasdaq Stockholm

     ERICa.ST/ERICb.ST  

Reuters NASDAQ

     ERIC.O  

Changes in number of shares and capital stock 2012–2016

 

          Number of shares      Share capital (SEK)  

2012

  

June 29, new issue (Class C shares, later converted to Class B-shares)

     31,700,000        158,500,000  

2012

  

December 31

     3,305,051,735        16,525,258,678  

2013

  

December 31

     3,305,051,735        16,525,258,678  

2014

  

December 31

     3,305,051,735        16,525,258,678  

2015

  

December 31

     3,305,051,735        16,525,258,678  

2016

  

May 11, new issue (Class C shares, later converted to Class B-shares) 1)

     26,100,000        130,500,000  

2016

  

December 31

     3,331,151,735        16,655,758,678  

 

1) The Annual General Meeting (AGM) 2016 resolved to issue 26,100,000 Class C shares for the Long-Term Variable Compensation Program (LTV). In accordance with an authorization from the AGM, in the second quarter 2016, the Board of Directors resolved to repurchase the new issued shares, which were subsequently converted into Class B shares. The quotient value of the repurchased shares was SEK 5.00, totaling SEK 130.5 million, representing less than one percent of capital stock, and the acquisition cost was approximately SEK 130.7 million.

Share performance indicators

 

     2016      2015      2014      2013      2012  

Earnings per share, diluted (SEK) 1)

     0.52        4.13        3.54        3.69        1.78  

Earnings per share, non-IFRS (SEK) 2)

     2.66        6.06        4.80        5.62        2.74  

Dividend per share (SEK) 3)

     1.00        3.70        3.40        3.00        2.75  

Total shareholder return (%)

     –32        –9        24        25        –3  

Dividend per share (USD)

     0.11        0.39        0.41        0.46        0.42  

P/E ratio

     101        20        26        21        36  

 

1) Calculated on average number of shares outstanding, diluted.
2) EPS, diluted, excluding amortizations and write-downs of acquired intangible assets, and excluding restructuring charges, SEK. A reconcilation of Alternative performance measures is available on pages 143–147, and in a separate document available on www.ericsson.com/the-company/investors/financial-reports
3) For 2016 as proposed by the Board of Directors.

For definitions of the financial terms used, see Glossary and Financial Terminology.

 

138


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Share trend

In 2016, Ericsson’s total market capitalization decreased by –34.9% to SEK 178 billion, compared to a decrease by –12.6% reaching SEK 271 billion in 2015. In 2016, the index, OMX Stockholm, on Nasdaq Stockholm increased by 5.8%, the NASDAQ composite index increased by 7.5% and the S&P 500 Index increased by 9.5%.

 

LOGO

 

LOGO

 

139


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Share and ADS prices

Principal trading market—Nasdaq Stockholm—share prices

The table below states the high and low share prices for the Class A and Class B shares as reported by Nasdaq Stockholm for the periods indicated. Trading on the exchange generally continues until 5:30 p.m. (CET) each business day. In addition to trading on the exchange, there is trading off the exchange and on alternative venues during trading hours and also after 5:30 p.m. (CET).

Nasdaq Stockholm publishes a daily Official Price List of Shares which includes the volume of recorded transactions in each listed stock, together with the prices of the highest and lowest recorded trades of the day. The Official Price List of Shares reflects price and volume information for trades completed by the members. The equity securities listed on the Nasdaq Stockholm Official Price List of Shares currently comprise the shares of 341 companies.

Host market—NASDAQ New York—ADS prices

The table below states the high and low share prices quoted for the ADSs on NASDAQ New York for the periods indicated. The NASDAQ New York quotations represent prices between dealers, not including retail markups, markdowns or commissions, and do not necessarily represent actual transactions.

Share prices on Nasdaq Stockholm

 

(SEK)

   2016      2015      2014      2013      2012  

Class A at last day of trading

     53.00        79.35        88.25        74.50        63.90  

Class A high (April 13, 2016)

     80.80        111.30        91.80        86.95        72.00  

Class A low (October 26, 2016)

     45.20        72.00        71.55        50.00        55.55  

Class B at last day of trading

     53.50        82.30        94.35        78.50        65.10  

Class B high (April 13, 2016)

     83.60        120.00        96.40        90.95        71.90  

Class B low (October 26, 2016)

     43.19        75.30        75.05        64.50        55.90  

 

Source: Nasdaq Stockholm.

Share prices on NASDAQ New York

 

(USD)

   2016      2015      2014      2013      2012  

ADS at last day of trading

     5.83        9.61        12.10        12.24        10.10  

ADS high (April 13, 2016)

     10.20        13.14        13.61        14.22        10.60  

ADS low (October 28, 2016)

     4.83        8.87        11.20        9.78        8.23  

 

Source: NASDAQ New York.

Share prices on Nasdaq Stockholm and NASDAQ New York

 

     Nasdaq Stockholm      NASDAQ New York  
     SEK per Class A share      SEK per Class B share      USD per ADS 1)  

Period

       High              Low              High              Low              High              Low      

Annual high and low

                 

2012

     72.00        55.55        71.90        55.90        10.60        8.23  

2013

     86.95        50.00        90.95        64.50        14.22        9.78  

2014

     91.80        71.55        96.40        75.05        13.61        11.20  

2015

     111.30        72.00        120.00        75.30        13.14        8.87  

2016

     80.80        45.20        83.60        43.19        10.20        4.83  

Quarterly high and low

                 

2015 First Quarter

     107.10        88.75        113.70        92.90        13.14        11.75  

2015 Second Quarter

     111.30        80.05        120.00        85.85        13.10        10.33  

2015 Third Quarter

     91.00        72.00        96.40        77.45        11.08        9.23  

2015 Fourth Quarter

     83.70        73.00        88.30        75.30        10.58        8.87  

2016 First Quarter

     80.40        70.10        83.60        70.65        10.10        8.43  

2016 Second Quarter

     80.80        58.95        83.60        59.60        10.20        7.03  

2016 Third Quarter

     66.75        57.20        67.75        56.60        7.88        6.68  

2016 Fourth Quarter

     62.50        45.20        62.40        43.19        7.24        4.83  

Monthly high and low

                 

September 2016

     62.75        57.20        62.70        56.60        7.25        6.68  

October 2016

     62.50        45.20        62.40        43.19        7.24        4.83  

November 2016

     54.10        47.00        48.09        43.21        5.20        4.83  

December 2016

     56.00        48.00        56.55        47.15        6.02        5.10  

January 2017

     55.70        51.65        55.60        51.25        6.09        5.75  

February 2017

     61.00        50.50        60.15        49.45        6.65        5.61  

March 2017

     59.50        55.00        60.20        56.25        6.76        6.36  

 

1) One ADS = 1 Class B share.

Source: Nasdaq Stockholm and NASDAQ New York.

 

140


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Shareholders

As of December 31, 2016, the Parent Company had 465,732 shareholders registered at Euroclear Sweden AB (the Central Securities Depository—CSD), of which 1,049 holders had a US address. According to information provided by the Company’s depositary bank, Deutsche Bank, there were 326,213,417 ADSs outstanding as of December 31, 2016, and 3,868 registered holders of such ADSs. A significant number of Ericsson ADSs are held by banks, brokers and/or nominees for the accounts of their customers. As of January 10, 2017, the total number of bank, broker and/or nominee accounts holding Ericsson ADSs was 98,323.

According to information known at year-end 2016, approximately 89% of the Class A and Class B shares were owned by institutions, Swedish and international. The major shareholders do not have different voting rights than other shareholders holding the same classes of shares. As far as Ericsson knows, the Company is not directly or indirectly owned or controlled by another corporation, by any foreign government or by any other natural or legal person(s) separately or jointly.

The table below shows the total number of shares in the Parent Company owned by the Executive Leadership Team and Board members (including Deputy employee representatives) as a group as of December 31, 2016.

The Executive Leadership Team and Board members, ownership

 

     Number of
Class A
shares
     Number of
Class B
shares
     Voting
rights,
percent
 

The Executive Leadership Team and Board members as a group (32 persons)

     0        1,832,757        0.03

 

For individual holdings, see Corporate Governance Report.

 

LOGO

Share distribution 1)

 

Holding

   No. of
shareholders
     No. of
shares A
     No. of
shares B
     Percentage
of share capital
    Percentage
of voting  rights
    Market value
(MSEK)
 

1–500

     365,419        1,457,693        48,849,958        1.51     1,12     2,691  

501–1,000

     45,099        1,093,403        33,092,910        1.03     0.77     1,828  

1,001–5,000

     44,914        3,236,158        94,842,186        2.94     2.24     5,246  

5,001–10,000

     5,610        1,316,871        38,897,905        1.21     0.92     2,151  

10,001–15,000

     1,455        564,713        17,485,788        0.54     0.41     965  

15,001–20,000

     748        416,739        12,959,667        0.40     0.30     715  

20,001–

     2,487        253,670,406        2,823,083,391        92.36     94.25     164,479  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total, December 31, 2016 2)

     465,733        261,755,983        3,069,395,752        100.00     100.00     178,086  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

1) Source: Euroclear
2) Includes a nominee reporting discrepancy of 183,947 shares.

The following table shows share information as of December 31 2016. with respect to the 15 largest shareholders ranked by voting rights as well as their percentage of voting rights as of December 31 2015, 2014 and 2013.

Largest shareholders December 31 2016 and percentage of voting rights December 31 2016, 2015 and 2014

 

Identity of person or group 1)

  Number of
Class  A
shares
    Of total
Class  A
shares.
percent
    Number of
Class  B
shares
    Of total
Class  B
shares.
percent
    2016
Voting rights.
percent
    2015
Voting rights.
percent
    2014
Voting rights.
percent
 

Investor AB

    115,762,803       44.23       80,284,545       2.62       21.77       21.50       21.50  

AB Industrivärden

    86,052,615       32.88       1,000,000       0.03       15.15       15.20       15.20  

Svenska Handelsbankens Pensionsstiftelse

    23,430,790       8.95       0       0.00       4.12       4.85       4.85  

Swedbank Robur Fonder AB

    18,414       0.01       148,481,687       4.84       2.61       2.34       2.51  

AMF Pensionsförsäkring AB

    3,500,000       1.34       90,193,315       2.94       2.20       1.73       1.85  

AFA Försäkring AB

    11,723,000       4.48       6,679,127       0.22       2.18       2.18       2.06  

Dodge & Cox

    0       0.00       117,624,985       3.83       2.07       2.00       2.08  

BlackRock Institutional Trust Company, N.A.

    0       0.00       109,162,871       3.56       1.92       1.48       1.45  

PRIMECAP Management Company

    0       0.00       90,000,000       2.93       1.58       1.33       0.57  

State Street Global Advisors (US)

    0       0.00       87,332,521       2.85       1.54       1.01       0.92  

Livförsäkringsbolaget Skandia, ömsesidigt

    6,284,705       2.40       16,146,318       0.53       1.39       1.59       1.57  

Silchester International Investors, L.L.P.

    0       0.00       74,536,381       2.43       1.31       0.00       0.00  

Norges Bank Investment Management (NBIM)

    0       0.00       63,042,678       2.05       1.11       1.14       1.14  

Hotchkis and Wiley Capital Management, LLC

    0       0.00       62,430,121       2.03       1.10       0.51       0.30  

The Vanguard Group, Inc.

    0       0.00       60,753,704       1.98       1.07       0.96       0.77  

Others

    14,983,656       5.72       2,061,727,499       67.17       38.89       42.17       43.26  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    261,755,983       100.00       3,069,395,752       100.00       100.00       100.00       100.00  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

1) Source: Nasdaq

 

141


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

OTHER INFORMATION

FIVE-YEAR SUMMARY

For definitions of certain financial terms used, see Financial terminology.

Five-year summary

 

       2016     Change     2015     2014     2013     2012  

Income statement and cash flow items, SEK million

                                    

Net sales

     222,608       –10     246,920       227,983       227,376       227,779  

Operating expenses

     –60,501       –6     –64,129       –63,408       –58,509       –58,856  

Operating income

     6,299       –71     21,805       16,807       17,845       10,458  

Net income

     1,895       –86     13,673       11,143       12,174       5,938  

Restructuring charges

     7,567       50     5,040       1,456       4,453       3,447  

Cash flow from operating activities

     14,010       –32     20,597       18,702       17,389       22,031  

Year-end position, SEK million

                                    

Total assets

     283,347       0     284,363       293,558       269,190       274,996  

Property, plant and equipment

     16,734       5     15,901       13,341       11,433       11,493  

Stockholders’ equity

     139,817       –5     146,525       144,306       140,204       136,883  

Non-controlling interest

     675       –20     841       1,003       1,419       1,600  

Per share indicators

                                    

Earnings per share, basic, SEK

     0.53       –87     4.17       3.57       3.72       1.80  

Earnings per share, diluted, SEK

     0.52       –87     4.13       3.54       3.69       1.78  

Dividends per share, SEK

     1.00 1)       –73     3.70       3.40       3.00       2.75  

Dividend per share (USD)

     0.11       –71     0.39       0.41       0.46       0.42  

Number of shares outstanding (in millions)

                                    

end of period, basic

     3,269       —         3,256       3,242       3,231       3,220  

average, basic

     3,263       —         3,249       3,237       3,226       3,216  

average, diluted

     3,303       1     3,282       3,270       3,257       3,247  

Other information, SEK million

                                    

Additions to property, plant and equipment

     6,129       –26     8,338       5,322       4,503       5,429  

Depreciations and write-downs/impairments of property, plant and equipment

     4,569       –3     4,689       4,316       4,209       4,012  

Acquisitions/capitalization of intangible assets

     5,260       1     5,228       6,184       4,759       13,247  

Amortization and write-downs/impairments of intangible assets

     4,550       –18     5,538       5,629       5,928       5,877  

Research and development expenses

     31,635       –9     34,844       36,308       32,236       32,833  

as percentage of net sales

     14.2     —         14.1     15.9     14.2     14.4

Inventory turnover days

     69       8     64       64       62       73  

Alternative Performance Measures (APMs) 2)

                                    

Gross margin

     29.8     —         34.8     36.2     33.6     31.6

Operating margin

     2.8     —         8.8     7.4     7.8     4.6

EBITA margin

     4.0     —         10.5     9.3     9.8     6.6

Cash conversion

     175.0     —         85     84     79     116

Capital employed, SEK million

     190,901       –2     195,150       189,839       180,903       176,653  

Return on equity

     1.2     —         9.3     8.1     8.7     4.1

Return on capital employed

     3.2     —         11.6     9.8     10.7     6.7

Equity ratio

     49.6     —         51.8     49.5     52.6     50.4

Capital turnover

     1.2       —         1.3       1.2       1.3       1.3  

Working capital, SEK million

     89,039       –15     104,811       103,246       106,940       100,619  

Gross cash, SEK million

     57,877       –13     66,270       72,159       77,089       76,708  

Net cash, SEK million 3)

     31,191       –24     41,150       48,014       47,634       48,041  

Statistical data, year-end

                                    

Number of employees

     111,464       –4     116,281       118,055       114,340       110,255  

of which in Sweden

     15,303       –10     17,041       17,580       17,858       17,712  

Export sales from Sweden, SEK million

     107,036       –9     117,486       113,734       108,944       106,997  

 

1) For 2016, as proposed by the Board of Directors.
2) A reconciliation to the most directly reconcilable line items in the financial statements for 2016 and five comparison years is available on the following pages. Reconciliation of ten years is available in a separate document available on www.ericsson.com/thecompany/investors/financial-reports.
3) The definition of Net cash has been adjusted in 2016 (Post-employment benefits are no longer included and Interest-bearing securities, non-current are included). Net cash for prior periods has been recalculated using the new definition.

 

142


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

ALTERNATIVE PERFORMANCE MEASURES

This section includes a reconciliation of certain Alternative Performance Measures (APMs) to the most directly reconcilable line items in the financial statements. The presentation of APMs has limitations as analytical tools and should not be considered in isolation or as a substitute for related financial measures prepared in accordance with IFRS.

APMs are presented to enhance an investor’s evaluation of ongoing operating results, to aid in forecasting future periods and to facilitate meaningful comparison of results between periods.

Management uses these APMs to, among other things, evaluate ongoing operations in relation to historical results, for internal planning and forecasting purposes and in the calculation of certain performance-based compensation.

The APMs presented in this report may differ from similarly titled measures used by other companies.

Capital employed

 

SEK million

   2016      2015      2014      2013      2012  

Total assets

     283,347        284,363        293,558        269,190        274,996  

Non-interest-bearing provisions and liabilities

              

Provisions, non-current

     946        176        202        222        211  

Deferred tax liabilities

     2,147        2,472        3,177        2,650        3,120  

Other non-current liabilities

     2,621        1,851        1,797        1,459        2,377  

Provisions, current

     5,411        3,662        4,225        5,140        8,427  

Trade payables

     25,318        22,389        24,473        20,502        23,100  

Other current liabilities

     56,003        58,663        69,845        58,314        61,108  

Capital employed

     190,901        195,150        189,839        180,903        176,653  

Definition

Total assets less non-interest-bearing provisions and liabilities.

Reason to use

Capital employed represents the value of the balance sheet assets that contributes to revenue and profit generation. It is also used in the calculation of return on capital employed.

Capital turnover

 

SEK million

   2016      2015      2014      2013      2012  

Net sales

     222,608        246,920        227,983        227,376        227,779  

Average capital employed

              

Capital employed at beginning of period

     195,150        189,839        180,903        176,653        186,307  

Captial employed at end of period

     190,901        195,150        189,839        180,903        176,653  

Average capital employed

     193,026        192,495        185,371        178,778        181,480  

Capital turnover (times)

     1.2        1.3        1.2        1.3        1.3  

Definition

Net sales divided by average capital employed.

Reason to use

Capital turnover indicates how effectively investment capital is used to generate revenues.

Cash conversion

 

SEK million

   2016     2015     2014     2013     2012  

Cash flow from operating activities

     14,010       20,597       18,702       17,389       22,031  

Net income

     1,895       13,673       11,143       12,174       5,938  

Adjustments to reconcile net income to cash, see Note 25

     6,112       10,611       11,200       9,828       13,077  

Net income reconciled to cash

     8,007       24,284       22,343       22,002       19,015  

Cash conversion (%)

     175     85     84     79     116

Definition

Cash flow from operating activities divided by the sum of net income and adjustments to reconcile net income to cash, expressed as percent.

Reason to use

The cash conversion target reflects a high focus on cash flow in the company. The measurement has also been used as one of the three targets in the Long-Term Variable Compensation program (LTV).

 

143


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Earnings per share (non-IFRS)

 

SEK

   2016      2015      2014      2013      2012  

EPS diluted

     0.52        4.13        3.54        3.69        1.78  

Restructuring charges

     1.59        1.07        0.31        0.93        0.81  

Amortization and write-downs of acquired intangibles

     0.55        0.86        0.95        1.00        0.96  

EPS (non-IFRS)

     2.66        6.06        4.80        5.62        3.55  

Definition

Earnings per share (EPS), diluted, excluding amortizations and write-down of acquired intangible assets and excluding restructuring charges.

Reason to use

Restructuring charges vary between years. This measurement gives an indication of the performance without restructuring and without the impact of amortizations and write-down of acquired intangible assets from acquired companies.

EBITA margin

 

SEK million

   2016     2015     2014     2013     2012  

Net income

     1,895       13,673       11,143       12,174       5,938  

Taxes

     2,131       6,199       4,668       4,924       4,244  

Financial income and expenses

     2,273       1,933       996       747       276  

Amortization and write-downs of acquired intangibles

     2,650       4,139       4,328       4,521       4,553  

EBITA

     8,949       25,944       21,135       22,366       15,011  

Net sales

     222,608       246,920       227,983       227,376       227,779  

EBITA margin (%)

     4.0     10.5     9.3     9.8     6.6

Definition

Earnings before interest, taxes, amortization and write-downs of acquired intangibles, as a percentage of net sales.

Reason to use

Amortizations and write-downs of intangible assets are normally non-cash items in the annual income statement, EBITA margin % gives an indication of the financial performance without the impact from acquired companies.

Equity ratio

 

SEK million

   2016     2015     2014     2013     2012  

Total equity

     140,492       147,366       145,309       141,623       138,483  

Total assets

     283,347       284,363       293,558       269,190       274,996  

Equity ratio (%)

     49.6     51.8     49.5     52.6     50.4

Definition

Equity, expressed as a percentage of total assets.

Reason to use

An equity ratio above 40% is one of the company’s capital targets. This supports financial flexibility and independence to operate and manage variations in working capital needs as well as to capitalize on business opportunities.

Gross cash

 

SEK million

   2016      2015      2014      2013      2012  

Cash and cash equivalents

     36,966        40,224        40,988        42,095        44,682  

Interest-bearing securities, current

     13,325        26,046        31,171        34,994        32,026  

Interest-bearing securities, non-current

     7,586        —          —          —          —    

Gross cash

     57,877        66,270        72,159        77,089        76,708  

Definition

Cash and cash equivalents plus interest-bearing securities (current and non-current).

Reason to use

Gross cash is showing total available cash and interest-bearing securities and is a parameter for calculating the net cash position.

 

144


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Gross margin

 

SEK million

   2016     2015     2014     2013     2012  

Gross income

     66,365       85,819       82,427       76,371       72,080  

Net sales

     222,608       246,920       227,983       227,376       227,779  

Gross margin (%)

     29.8     34.8     36.2     33.6     31.6

Definition

Reported gross income as a percentage of net sales.

Reason to use

Gross margin shows the difference between net sales and cost of sales, in percentage of net sales. Gross margin is impacted by several factors such as business mix, service share, price development and cost reductions. Gross margin is an important internal measure and this number is also provided in the Income statement as the Company believes that it provides users of the financial statements with a better understanding of the Group’s business development.

Net cash

 

SEK million

   2016      2015      2014      2013      2012  

Cash and cash equivalents

     36,966        40,224        40,988        42,095        44,682  

+ Interest-bearing securities, current

     13,325        26,046        31,171        34,994        32,026  

+ Interest-bearing securities, non-current

     7,586        —          —          —          —    

– Borrowings, current

     8,033        2,376        2,281        7,388        4,769  

– Borrowings, non-current

     18,653        22,744        21,864        22,067        23,898  

Net cash

     31,191        41,150        48,014        47,634        48,041  

Definition

Cash and cash equivalents plus interest-bearing securities (current and non-current) less interest- bearing liabilities (which include: non-current borrowings and current borrowings).

Reason to use

A positive net cash position that is larger than the pension liability is one of the company’s capital targets. This creates financial flexibility and independence to operate and manage variations in working capital needs.

Operating expenses, excluding restructuring charges

 

SEK million

   2016      2015      2014      2013      2012  

Operating expenses

     –60,501        –64,129        –63,408        –58,509        –58,856  

Restructuring charges included in R&D expenses

     2,739        2,021        304        872        852  

Restructuring charges included in selling and administrative expenses

     1,353        745        123        924        370  

Operating expenses, excluding restructuring charges

     –56,409        –61,363        –62,981        –56,713        –57,634  

Definition

Reported operating expenses, excluding restructuring charges.

Reason to use

Restructuring charges vary between years and in order to analyse trends in reported expenses overtime, restructuring charges are excluded.

 

145


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Operating margin

 

SEK million

   2016     2015     2014     2013     2012  

Operating income

     6,299       21,805       16,807       17,845       10,458  

Net sales

     222,608       246,920       227,983       227,376       227,779  

Operating margin (%)

     2.8     8.8     7.4     7.8     4.6

Definition

Reported operating income as a percentage of net sales.

Reason to use

Operating margin shows the operating income in percentage of net sales. Operating margin is a key internal measure and this number is also provided in the Income statement as the Company believes that it provides users of the financial statements with a better understanding of the Group’s financial performance both short and long term.

Return on capital employed

 

SEK million

   2016     2015     2014     2013     2012  

Operating income

     6,299       21,805       16,807       17,845       10,458  

Financial income

     –115       525       1,277       1,346       1,708  

Total Operating income + Financial income

     6,184       22,330       18,084       19,191       12,166  

Average capital empolyed

          

Capital employed at beginning of period

     195,150       189,839       180,903       176,653       186,307  

Capital employed at end of period

     190,901       195,150       189,839       180,903       176,653  

Average capital empolyed

     193,026       192,495       185,371       178,778       181,480  

Return on capital employed (%)

     3.2     11.6     9.8     10.7     6.7

Definition

The total of operating income plus financial income as a percentage of average capital employed.

Reason to use

Return on capital employed is a measure of the profitability after taking into account the amount of capital used. A higher return on capital employed indicates a more efficient use of capital.

Return on equity

 

SEK million

   2016     2015     2014     2013     2012  

Net income attributable to stockholders of the Parent Company

     1,716       13,549       11,568       12,005       5,775  

Average stockholders’ equity

          

Stockholders’ equity, beginning of period

     146,525       144,306       140,204       136,883       143,105  

Stockholders’ equity, end of period

     139,817       146,525       144,306       140,204       136,883  

Average stockholders’ equity

     143,171       145,416       142,255       138,544       139,994  

Return on equity (%)

     1.2     9.3     8.1     8.7     4.1

Definition

Net income attributable to stockholders of the Parent Company as a percentage of average stockholders’ equity.

Reason to use

Return on equity is a measure of the profitability in relation to the book value of shareholder equity. Return on equity is a measure of how investments are used to generate earnings growth.

 

146


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

Sales growth adjusted for comparable units and currency

 

SEK million

   2016     2015     2014 1)  

Net sales

     222,608       246,920       227,983  

Acquired/divested business

     –313       –422       –2,590  

Net FX impact

     254       –30,307       –10,409  

Comparable net sales, excluding FX impact

     222,549       216,191       214,984  

Sales growth adjusted for comparable units and currency (%)

     –10     –5     –4

 

1) Partly adjusted for the initial IPR payment from Samsung in the fourth quarter 2013.

Definition

Sales growth adjusted for the impact of acquisitions and divestments as well as the effects of foreign currency fluctuations.

Reason to use

Ericsson’s presentation currency is SEK while the total revenues are mainly in other currencies. Reported sales growth is dependent on fluctuations in SEK versus other currencies and in addition acquired or divested business can have an impact on reported net sales. Sales growth adjusted for comparable units and currency shows the underlying sales development without these parameters.

Working capital

 

SEK million

   2016      2015      2014      2013      2012  

Current assets

     175,771        189,525        201,789        190,896        193,254  

Current non-interest-bearing provisions and liabilities

              

Provisions, current

     –5,411        –3,662        –4,225        –5,140        –8,427  

Trade payables

     –25,318        –22,389        –24,473        –20,502        –23,100  

Other current liabilities

     –56,003        –58,663        –69,845        –58,314        –61,108  

Working capital

     89,039        104,811        103,246        106,940        100,619  

Definition

Current assets less current non-interest-bearing provisions and liabilities (which include: current provisions; trade payables and other current liabilities).

Reason to use

Due to the need to optimize cash generation to create value for Ericsson’s shareholders, management focuses on working capital and reducing lead times between orders booked and cash received. Managing and reducing Working capital is key for reaching the Cash conversion target of the Long-Term Variable Compensation program (LTV).

 

147


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

FINANCIAL TERMINOLOGY

CAPEX

Capital expenditures.

Capital employed

Total assets less non-interest-bearing provisions and liabilities (which includes non-current provisions; deferred tax liabilities; other non-current liabilities; current provisions; trade payables and other current liabilities).

Capital turnover

Net sales divided by average capital employed.

Cash conversion

Cash flow from operating activities divided by the sum of net income and adjustments to reconcile net income to cash, expressed as percent.

Cash dividends per share

Dividends paid divided by average number of basic shares.

Compound annual growth rate (CAGR)

The year-over-year growth rate over a specified period of time.

Days sales outstanding (DSO)

Trade receivables balance at quarter end divided by net sales in the quarter and multiplied by 90 days. If the amount of trade receivables is larger than last quarter’s sales, the excess amount is divided by net sales in the previous quarter and multiplied by 90 days, and total DSO are the 90 days of the most current quarter plus the additional days from the previous quarter.

Earnings per share (EPS)

Basic earnings per share: profit or loss attributable to stockholders of the Parent Company divided by the weighted average number of ordinary shares outstanding during the period.

Earnings per share (EPS diluted)

The weighted average number of shares outstanding, adjusted for the effects of all dilutive potential ordinary shares.

Earnings per share (non-IFRS)

Earnings per share (EPS), diluted, excluding amortizations and write-down of acquired intangible assets and excluding restructuring charges.

EBITA margin

Earnings before interest, taxes, amortization and write-downs of acquired intangibles (intellectual property rights, trademarks and other intangible assets, see Note C10 “Intangible assets”) as a percentage of net sales.

Equity ratio

Equity, expressed as a percentage of total assets.

Gross cash

Cash and cash equivalents plus interest-bearing securities (current and non-current).

Gross margin

Reported gross income as a percentage of net sales.

Inventory turnover days (ITO days)

365 divided by inventory turnover, calculated as total cost of sales divided by the average inventories for the year (net of advances from customers).

Net cash

Cash and cash equivalents plus interest-bearing securities (current and non-current) less interest-bearing liabilities (which include non-current borrowings and current borrowings).

Operating margin

Reported operating income as a percentage of net sales.

OPEX

Operational expenses.

P/E ratio

The P/E ratio is calculated as the price of a Class B share at last day of trading divided by earnings per basic share.

Payable days

The average balance of trade payables at the beginning and at the end of the year divided by cost of sales for the year, and multiplied by 365 days.

Return on capital employed

The total of operating income plus financial income as a percentage of average capital employed (based on the amounts at January 1 and December 31).

Return on equity

Net income attributable to stockholders of the Parent Company as a percentage of average stockholders’ equity (based on the amounts at January 1 and December 31).

Sales growth, adjusted for comparable units and currency

Sales growth adjusted for the impact of acquisitions and divestments as well as the effects of foreign currency fluctuations.

Total shareholder return (TSR)

The increase or decrease in Class B share price during the period, including dividend, expressed as a percentage of the share price at the start of the period.

Value at risk (VaR)

A statistical method that expresses the maximum potential loss that can arise with a certain degree of probability during a certain period of time.

Working capital

Current assets less current non-interest-bearing provisions and liabilities (which include current provisions, trade payables and other current liabilities).

Exchange rates

Exchange rates in consolidation

 

     January–December  
     2016      2015  

SEK/EUR

     

Average rate 1)

     9.44        9.34  

Closing rate

     9.56        9.17  

SEK/USD

     

Average rate 1)

     8.56        8.39  

Closing rate

     9.06        8.40  

 

1) Average for the year for disclosure purpose only. Period income and expenses for each income statement are translated at period average exchange rates.

 

148


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

GLOSSARY

2G

The first digital generation of mobile systems. Includes GSM, TDMA, PDC and cdmaOne.

3G

Third generation mobile system. Includes WCDMA/HSPA, CDMA2000 and TD-SCDMA.

4G

See LTE.

Backhaul

Transmission between radio base stations and the core network.

BSS

Business support systems.

CAGR

Compound Annual Growth Rate.

CDMA

Code Division Multiple Access. A radio technology on which the cdmaOne (2G) and CDMA2000 (3G) mobile communication standards are both based.

Cloud

When data and applications reside in the network.

CO 2 e

The amount of a particular greenhouse gas, expressed as the amount of carbon dioxide that gives the same greenhouse effect.

EDGE

An enhancement of GSM. Enables the transmission of data at speeds up to 250 kbps (Evolved EDGE up to 1 Mbps.)

EPC

Evolved Packet Core. The core network of the LTE system.

Global ICT Centers

Ericsson has built three Global ICT Centers, facilities that allow the connection of both Telco and ICT (Information Communication Technology) equipment and allow access by over 20,000 engineers globally.

GRI G4 core

G4 is the fourth generation of GRI Sustainability Reporting Guidelines. There are two options to report in accordance with the Guidelines: Core and Comprehensive. These options designate the content to be included for the report to be prepared ‘in accordance’ with the Guidelines. The Core option contains the essential elements of a sustainability report. The Core option provides the background against which an organization communicates the impacts of its economic, environmental and social and governance performance.

GSM

Global System for Mobile Communications. A first digital generation mobile system.

HDS 8000

A product announced by Ericsson in 2015. Ericsson HDS 8000 (Hyperscale Datacenter System) is a new generation of hyperscale data-center systems that uses Intel ® Rack Scale Architecture.

Heterogeneous network

Densification and enhancement of a network to increase capacity.

HSPA

High Speed Packet Access. Enhancement of 3G/WCDMA that enables mobile broadband.

ICT

Information and Communication Technology.

IMS

IP Multimedia Subsystem. A standard for voice and multimedia services over mobile and fixed networks using IP.

IP

Internet Protocol. Defines how information travels between network elements across the internet.

IPR

Intellectual Property Rights.

IPTV

IP Television. A technology that delivers digital television via fixed broadband access.

JV

Joint Venture.

LTE

Long-Term Evolution. 4G; the evolutionary step of mobile technology beyond HSPA, allowing data rate above 100 Mbps.

M-commerce

Mobile commerce.

M2M

Machine-to-machine communication.

Managed services

Management of operator networks and/or hosting of their services.

Mobile broadband

Wireless high-speed internet access using the HSPA, LTE and CDMA2000EV-DO technologies.

Networked Society

Ericsson’s vision of what will happen when everything that can benefit from being connected is connected, empowering people, business and society.

NFV

Network Functions Virtualization. Software implementation of network functions that can be deployed in virtualized infrastructure, offering efficient orchestration, automation and scalability.

OSS

Operations Support Systems.

SDN

Software-Defined Network. A programmable network with physical separation of decisions about where network traffic is sent (control plane), from the underlying system that forward traffic to the selected destinations (data plane).

VoLTE (Voice over LTE)

VoLTE, based on the IP Multimedia Subsystem (IMS), is a voice service delivered as data flows in LTE, over time replacing the legacy circuit-switched voice network.

WCDMA

Wideband Code Division Multiple Access. A 3G mobile communication standard. WCDMA builds on the same core network infrastructure as GSM.

xDSL

Digital Subscriber Line technologies for broadband multimedia communications in fixed-line networks. Examples: IP-DSL, ADSL and VDSL.

The terms “Ericsson”, “the Company”, “the Group”, “us”, “we”, and “our” all refer to Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson and its subsidiaries.

 

149


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

SHAREHOLDER INFORMATION

Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson’s Annual General Meeting of shareholders 2017 will be held on March 29, 2017, at 3.00 p.m. at Kistamässan, Arne Beurlings Torg 5, Kista/Stockholm, Sweden.

Registration and notice of attendance

Shareholders who wish to attend the Annual General Meeting must:

 

   

Be recorded in the share register kept by Euroclear Sweden AB (the Swedish Securities Registry) on Thursday, March 23, 2017; and

 

   

Give notice of attendance to the Company at the latest on Thursday March 23, 2017. Notice of attendance can be given by telephone: +46 8 402 90 54 on weekdays between 10 a.m. and 4 p.m., or on Ericsson’s website: www.ericsson.com

Notice of attendance may also be given in writing to:

Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson

General Meeting of shareholders

Box 7835, SE-103 98 Stockholm, Sweden

When giving notice of attendance, please state the name, date of birth or registration number, address, telephone number and number of assistants, if any.

The meeting will be conducted in Swedish and simultaneously translated into English.

Shares registered in the name of a nominee

In addition to giving notice of attendance, shareholders having their shares registered in the name of a nominee must request the nominee to temporarily enter the shareholder into the share register as per Thursday, March 23, 2017, in order to be entitled to attend the meeting. The shareholder should inform the nominee to that effect well before that day.

Proxy

Shareholders represented by proxy shall issue and submit to the Company a power of attorney for the representative. A power of attorney issued by a legal entity must be accompanied by a copy of the entity’s certificate of registration, or if no such certificate exists, a corresponding document of authority. Such documents must not be older than one year unless the power of attorney explicitly provides that it is valid for a longer period, up to a maximum of five years. In order to facilitate the registration at the Annual General Meeting, the original power of attorney, certificates of registration and other documents of authority should be sent to the Company in advance to the address above for receipt by Tuesday, March 28, 2017. Forms of power of attorney in Swedish and English are available on Ericsson’s website: www.ericsson.com.

Dividend

The Board of Directors has decided to propose the Annual General Meeting to resolve on a dividend of SEK 1.00 per share for the year 2016 and that Friday, March 31, 2017 will be the record date for dividend.

Financial information from Ericsson

2016 Form 20-F for the US market April 26, 2017

 

Interim reports 2017

        Q1, April 25, 2017         Q3, October 20, 2017
        Q2, July 18, 2017         Q4, January 31, 2018

Annual Report 2017 March, 2018

 

150


Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2016

 

MORE INFORMATION

Information about Ericsson and its development is available on the website: www.ericsson.com

Annual and interim reports and other relevant shareholder information can be found at: www.ericsson.com/investors

Ericsson issues a separate Sustainability and Corporate Responsibility Report. www.ericsson.com/thecompany/ sustainability_corporateresponsibility

 

LOGO

 

 

For printed publications

A printed copy of the Annual Report is provided on request.

Strömberg Distribution

SE-120 88 Stockholm, Sweden

Phone: +46 8 449 89 57

Email: ericsson@strd.se

In the United States

Ericsson’s Transfer Agent Deutsche Bank, Deutsche Bank Shareholder Services American Stock Transfer & Trust Company

Registered holders

Toll-free number: +1 (800) 937-5449

Interested investors

Direct dial: +1 (718) 921-8124

Email: DB@amstock.com

Ordering a hard copy of the Annual Report

Phone: +1 (888) 301 2504

 

 

Contact details

Ericsson headquarters

Torshamnsgatan 21

Kista, Stockholm, Sweden

Registered office

Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson

SE-164 83 Stockholm, Sweden

Investor relations

For questions on the Company,

please contact Investor Relations:

Phone: +46 (10) 719 00 00

Email: investor.relations@ericsson.com

 

 

Ericsson Annual Report 2016

Project management

Ericsson Investor Relations

Design and production

Hallvarsson&Halvarsson

Group Management, Board of Directors photography

Per Myrehed

Printing

Göteborgstryckeriet 2017

Printed on Amber Graphic

 

LOGO

 

151

Exhibit 15.2

We hereby consent to the incorporation by reference in the Registration Statements on Form F-3 (No. 333-203977) and Form S-8 (Nos. 333-81524, 333-100472, 333-107160, 333-122785, 333-125978, 333-135116, 333-151490, 333-161683, 333-161684, 333-167643 and 333-196453) of Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson of our report dated April 26, 2017 relating to the financial statements and the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, which appears in this Annual Report on Form 20-F.

 

/s/ PricewaterhouseCoopers AB
PricewaterhouseCoopers AB
Stockholm, Sweden
April 26, 2017